Berry Guide
Berry Guide
Berry Guide
Berry Guide
20102011
Produced by The Pennsylvania State University in cooperation with Rutgers University, the University of Delaware, the University of Maryland, Virginia Tech, and West Virginia University.
Acknowledgments The Mid-Atlantic Berry Guide is intended to provide information for commercial berry growers within the region. Homeowners may use this publication for background information; however, many of the recommendations contained in this guide assume that the production is on a large scale and that producers have a commercial pesticide applicators license. Uses of pesticides listed in this publication were current as of October 1, 2009. However, changes in registration status may occur at any time, so please consult the label before usethe label is the law. If there are differences in use patterns between the pesticide label in your possession and those listed in this guide, follow the instructions on the label. If in doubt, consult your cooperative extension educator. coordinAtor Kathleen Demchak, Senior Extension Associate, Department of Horticulture, Penn State contributors Penn state Kathleen Demchak, Senior Extension Associate, Department of Horticulture Timothy E. Elkner, Senior Extension Educator, Penn State Cooperative Extension in Lancaster County C. John Esslinger, Extension Educator, Penn State Cooperative Extension, Northeast Region Maryann Frazier, Senior Extension Associate, Department of Entomology Scott D. Guiser, Senior Extension Educator, Penn State Cooperative Extension in Bucks County John M. Halbrendt, Associate Professor of Plant Pathology, Department of Plant Pathology Jayson K. Harper, Professor of Agricultural Economics, Department of Agricultural Economics and Rural Sociology Grzegorz Krawczyk, Senior Research Associate, Department of Entomology Henry K. Ngugi, Assistant Professor of Plant Pathology, Department of Plant Pathology Kerry M. Richards, Director, Pesticide Management Information Center
Elsa S. Snchez, Associate Professor of Horticultural Systems Management, Department of Horticulture Gary J. San Julian, Professor of Wildlife Resources, School of Forest Resources James W. Travis, Professor of Plant Pathology, Department of Plant Pathology rutgers university, new Jersey Agricultural experiment station Joseph R. Heckman, Extension Specialist, Department of Plant Biology and Pathology Bradley A. Majek, Extension Specialist, Department of Plant Biology and Pathology Peter Nitzsche, County Agent, Rutgers Cooperative Extension of Morris County Peter V. Oudemans, Associate Professor, Department of Plant Biology and Pathology Gary Pavlis, County Agent, Rutgers Cooperative Extension of Atlantic County Dean Polk, Statewide Fruit IPM Agent, Department of Agricultural and Resource Management Agents Cesar Rodriguez-Saona, Assistant Extension Specialist, Department of Entomology William J. Sciarappa, County Agent, Rutgers Cooperative Extension of Monmouth County Daniel L. Ward, Assistant Extension Specialist, Department of Plant Biology and Pathology the university of delaware Dewey M. Caron, Professor, Department of Entomology and Wildlife Ecology Gordon C. Johnson, Extension Agent, Kent County, University of Delaware Cooperative Extension the university of maryland Bryan R. Butler, Senior Agent, University of Maryland Extension in Carroll County Joseph A. Fiola, Professor and Specialist in Viticulture and Small Fruit, University of Maryland Extension Willie Lantz, Agent, University of Maryland Extension in Garrett County Harry J. Swartz, Associate Professor (retired), Department of Natural Resources and Landscape Architecture usdA-Ars, beltsville, maryland Mark Ehlenfeldt, Research Geneticist, Genetic Improvement of Fruits and Vegetables Laboratory Virginia tech Jeffrey F. Derr, Professor, Hampton Roads Agricultural Research and Extension Center Charles Johnson, Professor and Extension Plant Pathologist, Southern Piedmont Agricultural Research and Extension Center
Douglas G. Pfeiffer, Professor, Department of Entomology R. Allen Straw, Area Specialist, Southwest Virginia Agricultural Research and Extension Center Keith S. Yoder, Professor of Plant Pathology, Alson H. Smith Jr. Agricultural Research and Extension Center west Virginia university John F. Baniecki, Extension Specialist and Professor, West Virginia University Extension Service Alan R. Biggs, Professor of Plant Pathology and Extension Specialist, Kearneysville Tree Fruit Research and Education Center Henry W. Hogmire, Extension Specialist and Professor of Entomology, Kearneysville Tree Fruit Research and Education Center John W. Jett, Extension Specialist, West Virginia University Extension Service Lewis W. Jett, Extension Specialist, West Virginia University Extension Service Additional contributor Ed Mashburn, Northumberland, Pennsylvania, former President of The International Ribes Association Past contributors This guide includes material from authors whose work appeared in earlier extension publications in the region or in earlier editions of this guide. These authors include Ed Beste, Barbara Bowling, Tony Bratsch, Margaret Brittingham-Brant, Anne DeMarsay, Win Hock, Ed Kee, Jeremy Pattison, Sridhar Polavarapu, Pete Probasco, Ed Rajotte, Bob Rouse, Jo Rytter, Pete Shearer, Mike Stanghellini, Paul Steiner, and Richard Zimmerman. Their contributions and work, which laid the groundwork for this version, are gratefully acknowledged. editor Amanda Kirsten, Ag Communications and Marketing, Penn State designer Nora Serotkin, Ag Communications and Marketing, Penn State illustrations Illustrations, except Figure 7.2, by Ellen Lovelidge, Penn State. Figure 7.2 courtesy of Virginia Tech. Cover photos: Front cover: strawberry, K. Demchak; others, IStockphoto. Back cover: raspberry, K. Demchak
the Mid-Atlantic
Berry Guide
Contents List of Tables and Figures......................................................................................................... ii Chapter 1: Preplant Considerations .........................................................................................1 Chapter 2: Soil Management and Nutrition for Berry Crops .....................................................5 Chapter 3: Pesticides, Pesticide Safety, and Chemical Fumigation ......................................... 13 Chapter 4: Weed Management..............................................................................................25 Chapter 5: Wildlife Damage Control in Commercial Plantings ............................................... 35 Chapter 6: Strawberries.........................................................................................................43 Chapter 7: Blueberries ......................................................................................................... 109 Chapter 8: Brambles ............................................................................................................ 161 Chapter 9: Gooseberries and Currants ................................................................................. 213 Appendix A: Expanded Special Topics .................................................................................. 227 Appendix B: Diagnostic Services.......................................................................................... 235 Appendix C: Nursery Sources of Berry Plants ...................................................................... 249 Appendix D: Production Supplies and Services.................................................................... 253 Appendix E: Additional Sources of Information ................................................................... 261 Index ................................................................................................................................... 267
tABles And FiGures Chapter 2: Soil Management and Nutrition for Berry Crops .................................. 5 Table 2.1. Pounds of lime with a CCE (calcium carbonate equivalent) of 100 needed per acre to raise the soil pH to 6.5. ................................................... 6 Table 2.2. Green manure crops categorized by use, life cycle, and season. ......................... 10 Chapter 3: Pesticides, Pesticide Safety, and Chemical Fumigation ...................... 13 Table 3.1. Toxicity of pesticides to birds, fish, bees, and beneficials. .................................. 14 Table 3.2. General and restricted-use pesticides labeled for use on strawberries, brambles, blueberries, gooseberries, and currants ....................... 20 Table 3.3. Fumigant descriptions and spectrums of activity. .............................................. 23 Chapter 4: Weed Management......................................................................... 25 Table 4.1. Weed susceptibility to herbicides....................................................................... 28 Table 4.2. Herbicide water solubility and soil adsorption characteristics. ........................... 32 Chapter 6: Strawberries................................................................................... 43 Table 6.1. Number of strawberry plants per acre for different in-row and between-row spacings ...................................................................................... 46 Table 6.2. Recommended fertilizer amounts for June-bearing matted-row strawberry plantings ...........................................................................................47 Table 6.3. June-bearing matted-row strawberry cultivars. ................................................ 48 Table 6.4. Recommended nutrients for annual plasticulture strawberry plantings ..............52 Table 6.5. June-bearing strawberry cultivars for plasticulture production. ........................ 54 Table 6.6. Day-neutral strawberry cultivars ....................................................................... 58 Table 6.7. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year of land preparation for matted-row strawberries.......................................... 63 Table 6.8. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: planting year for matted-row strawberries. ....................................................... 64 Table 6.9. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: mature planting of matted-row strawberries. ................................................... 65 Table 6.10. Returns to risk and management for matted-row strawberries, 2009 ............... 66 Table 6.11. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: planting year for strawberry plasticulture.......................................................... 66 Table 6.12. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: mature planting for strawberry plasticulture. .................................................... 67 Table 6.13. Returns to risk and management for plasticulture strawberries, 2009 ............... 68 Table 6.14. Activity groups and effectiveness of fungicides for strawberry disease control .. 80 Table 6.15. Activity groups and effectiveness of insecticides, miticides, and molluscides on strawberry pests. ............................................................................................... 81 Table 6.16. Pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control. ......................................... 82 Table 6.17. Additional restrictions on strawberry fungicides and insecticides...................... 93 ii
Table 6.18. Per-acre rates per application for preemergence (residual) herbicides for common soil types for strawberries .................................................................................. 99 Table 6.19. Herbicides for matted-row strawberry weed control ........................................100 Figure 6.1. Figure 6.2. Figure 6.3. Figure 6.4. Figure 6.5. Figure 6.6. Figure 6.7. The strawberry plant. ........................................................................................ 44 Arrangement of strawberry blossoms on fruit truss. .......................................... 45 Common strawberry leaf diseases. .................................................................... 70 Tarnished plant bug adult. ................................................................................. 73 Strawberry sap beetle adult............................................................................... 73 Picnic beetle adult. ............................................................................................ 73 Potato leafhopper adult. .................................................................................... 75
Chapter 7: Blueberries....................................................................................109 Table 7.1. Amount of sulfur required to lower the soil pH. ................................................111 Table 7.2. Number of blueberry plants required per acre at various spacings. ...................112 Table 7.3. Relevant characteristics of various cover crops for row middles. .......................116 Table 7.4. Seeding rates and requirements for various seasonal and permanent cover crops for row middles. ...........................................................116 Table 7.5. Postplant nitrogen recommendations for blueberries.......................................116 Table 7.6. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year of land preparation for blueberries............................................................120 Table 7.7. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: planting year for blueberries.............................................................................121 Table 7.8. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year after planting for blueberries ....................................................................122 Table 7.9. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: mature planting for blueberries. .......................................................................123 Table 7.10. Returns to risk and management for blueberries, 2009 ....................................124 Table 7.11. Activity groups and effectiveness of fungicides for blueberry disease control ...133 Table 7.12. Activity groups and effectiveness of insecticides and miticides on blueberry pests ............................................................................................134 Table 7.13. Pesticides for blueberry disease and insect control ...........................................135 Table 7.14. Additional restrictions on blueberry pesticides .................................................143 Table 7.15. Crop safety of blueberry herbicides...................................................................147 Table 7.16. Herbicide water solubility and soil adsorption characteristics ...........................148 Table 7.17. Per-acre rates per application for preemergence (residual) herbicides for common soil types for blueberries...............................................................149 Table 7.18. Herbicides for blueberry weed control ..............................................................155 Figure 7.1. Types of buds on blueberry. ..............................................................................118 Figure 7.2. Blueberry bush before and after pruning. .........................................................118 Figure 7.3. Blueberry maggot adult. ..................................................................................128 iii
Figure 7.4. Cherry fruitworm adult. ....................................................................................128 Figure 7.5. Cranberry fruitworm adult. ...............................................................................129 Chapter 8: Brambles.......................................................................................161 Table 8.1. Number of bramble plants per acre at different spacings..................................168 Table 8.2. Postplant nitrogen recommendations for brambles (lbs N/acre). .....................169 Table 8.3. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year of land preparation for summer-bearing red raspberries or thornless blackberries. ..................................................................................176 Table 8.4. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: planting year for summer-bearing red raspberries. ..........................................177 Table 8.5. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year after establishment for summer-bearing red raspberries. .........................178 Table 8.6. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: mature planting of summer-bearing red raspberries. .......................................179 Table 8.7. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year of establishment for thornless blackberries...............................................180 Table 8.8. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year after establishment for thornless blackberries. .........................................181 Table 8.9. Summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: mature planting of thornless blackberries. .......................................................182 Table 8.10. Returns to risk and management for red raspberries, 2009 ..............................183 Table 8.11. Returns to risk and management for blackberries, 2009 ...................................183 Table 8.12. Bramble disease control strategies. ..................................................................195 Table 8.13. Activity groups and effectiveness of fungicides for bramble disease control .....196 Table 8.14. Activity groups and effectiveness of insecticides and miticides on bramble pests ..............................................................................................196 Table 8.15. Pesticides for bramble disease and insect control. ............................................197 Table 8.16. Additional restrictions on bramble pesticides ...................................................202 Table 8.17. Crop safety of bramble herbicides.....................................................................204 Table 8.18. Bramble herbicide water solubility and soil adsorption characteristics .............205 Table 8.19. Per-acre rates per application for preemergence (residual) herbicides for common soil types for raspberries and blackberries ........................................................206 Table 8.20. Herbicides for bramble weed control ................................................................208 Figure 8.1. Figure 8.2. Figure 8.3. Figure 8.4. Figure 8.5. Figure 8.6. iv Pruning red raspberries.....................................................................................172 Pruning black raspberries. ................................................................................173 Supported hedgerow trellis. .............................................................................174 T or Lincoln trellis..............................................................................................174 V trellis. ............................................................................................................174 Raspberry crown borer adult.............................................................................191
Figure 8.7. Rednecked cane borer adult..............................................................................192 Figure 8.8. Raspberry cane borer adult. ..............................................................................193 Chapter 9: Gooseberries and Currants..............................................................213 Table 9.1. Pesticides for Ribes disease and insect control. .................................................224 Appendix A: Expanded Special Topics ..............................................................227 Table A.1. Sample two-year preplant soil conditioning program. .....................................228 Table A.2. Critical temperatures for cold damage of flower buds based on stage of development. ......................................................................................229 Table A.3. Approximate dew points calculated from air temperature and relative humidity values. ..................................................................................230 Table A.4. Recommended temperatures for starting irrigation at various critical temperatures and dew points. ..........................................................................231 Table A.5. Irrigation application rates (inches/hour) for adequate protection of strawberries at various air temperatures, wind speeds, and relative humidity levels.....................................................................................232
IntroductIon
Although berry production can be very profitable, berry crops require intensive management and a significant investment of time and resources. Depending on the crop, berry plantings remain productive for varying lengths of time, which can be as little as 1 to 2 production years for plasticulture strawberries to up to 50 years for blueberries. Good preplant management decisions will benefit the grower throughout the life of a planting, but, alternatively, the grower may have to endure the consequences of early mistakes for many years. Therefore, a significant amount of planning should be done before planting a berry crop. Consideration should be given to both growing and marketing the crop in order to ensure profitability over the long run.
Preplant Considerations
contEnts
Introduction ..........................................................1 Economics and Marketing ......................................1 Site Selection ........................................................1 Soil Type, Structure, and Drainage ...................1 Air Drainage ....................................................2 Wind Exposure.................................................2 Row Orientation ..............................................2 Availability of Irrigation Water ........................2 Field Borders ...................................................2 Crop Rotation ..................................................2 Determining Whether Fumigation Is Warranted .............................................................3 Sampling for Nematodes .................................3 Choosing a Source of Plants ...................................4 Organic Production ................................................4
You must be prepared not only to produce a high-quality crop, but also to be an active and aggressive marketer. Before the plants go in the ground, new and established growers alike should develop a marketing strategy for the planned crop. Even well-established operations will need to adjust to changing costs and markets. The marketing plan should consider who your customers are or will be and how the berries will be sold (pick-yourown, ready-picked for your own market, or wholesale). Consider demographics of your area. Are a sufficient number of consumers nearby to purchase your fruit? If not, can they be attracted to your location? How will you let potential customers know about the availability of your product? Do you want to produce and market your fruit as organic? Only after you have considered these aspects and others and have decided that you wish to start or continue with berry production is it time to select a site for your plants.
sItE sElEctIon
When choosing a suitable site, you need to consider and, in some instances improve, many characteristics. These include soil type, fertility, structure and drainage, previous crops and rotations, air drainage and wind exposure, field access, and surrounding crops and/or field borders. Each of these topics is discussed in greater detail as they apply to individual crops and pests in later chapters; general considerations that apply to all berry crops are briefly discussed below.
where excess water can drain laterally to the space between rows and then to the area outside of the planting. Tile drainage can provide some benefits as well. Wet sites should be avoided.
air drainage
Select sites with good air drainage. Air drainage refers to a slow movement of air through the planting site due to differences in air temperature and air density. This is not to be confused with wind exposure, where plantings are exposed to high-velocity winds. Good air drainage reduces the potential for frost damagea serious problem with strawberries and, less frequently, with blueberries. It also promotes drying and less humidity within the planting, which in turn reduces the potential for problems with foliar and fruit diseases.
orientation for each site will vary. For example, a grower on a level breezy site with prevailing winds from the west may decide to orient the rows east to west, while a grower on a protected site with little wind may prefer north-to-south rows. There are other aspects to consider as well, such as slope and soil erosion potential, which may override other considerations. On sloping sites, rows should run across the slope.
Wind expoSure
Constant winds can desiccate plantings, especially over the winter. Additionally, while pollination is aided by wind in small fruit, the stigma, a female flower part, can dry and become unreceptive to pollen quickly in hot, dry winds. Protected sites should be selected, or protection should be provided by planting windbreaks or using other means for moderation. In general, 8 feet of wind protection occurs for each foot of vertical height of the windbreak. If a living windbreak is planted, the plant species used should not readily sucker or produce seed. Options besides windbreaks to minimize damage from wind exposure are floating row covers with plasticulture strawberries; straw (or snow in some locations) for matted-row strawberries; and trellising for brambles to minimize cane breakage.
field borderS
Uncultivated land and certain crops bordering small fruit crops can be sources of pests and pathogens. These include strawberry clipper beetles from woodlots and fencerows; plant bugs, spittlebugs, and leafhoppers from various forages; Japanese beetles from sod; and sap beetles from various fruits and vegetables. In addition, viruses and orange rust fungus from wild or abandoned small fruit crops can infect new plantings. While eradicating wild berry plants may not be possible, any measures that can be taken to keep plantings as far from wild plants as possible will be helpful. These problems and their management are discussed in detail in crop-specific chapters.
roW orienTaTion
Recommendations are often given to orient rows north to south, or to orient rows with the prevailing wind. In practice, however, these two recommendations often conflict with each other. North-to-south rows intercept sunlight more evenly than east-to-west rows; hence, sunscald is less problematic and fruit ripens more evenly. Rows that run with the wind will dry more quickly than those that block the wind. The best
crop roTaTion
Which crop(s) precede a berry crop can make the difference between having a healthy planting and having a disaster. Certain crops can encourage a buildup of pathogens to which berry crops are susceptible. Other crops have beneficial effects. Previous annual field crops may have residual herbicide carryover, which can damage new berry plantings.
a serious weed problem in strawberry plantings, as can other certain species. Avoid sites heavily infested with sedge, nutgrass, quackgrass, Johnsongrass, and/ or thistles, or treat with systemic herbicides before planting. Cover cropping with certain cover crops for 1 to 2 years before planting is also a good way to reduce weed species at a given site. Finally, raspberries are particularly susceptible to crown gall disease (caused by the bacterium Agrobacterium tumefaciens). Sites with a history of crown gall are best used for other less-sensitive crops such as strawberries, blueberries, and vegetables. Soil fumigation is not generally effective in eliminating a crown gall problem. Planting in areas where field crops, particularly field corn and soybeans, were previously grown takes advantage of residual fertility and weed control, but beware of possible herbicide carryover that can seriously damage newly set fruit plants. Tissue cultureproduced plants are particularly susceptible to any residual herbicide.
mentally friendly alternatives to fumigation, and the topic of biofumigation, are discussed in the chapter on soil management and nutrition. When high nematode populations are suspected, test soil for nematodes as described below.
roots and may migrate away from dying plants. Therefore, when sampling problem areas, take samples from adjacent plants that either appear healthy or show early symptoms of stress.
are grown from tested virus-free parent plants in isolation under supervision from each states Department of Agriculture. When available, these plants are best for any long-term investment. Plants sold as certified are good, but they are not the same as registered stock. Certified stock is grown under state supervision and is inspected and found to be free of most diseases and insects, but the plants may still harbor some viruses, diseases, or insects. Plants propagated from your own fields or other unsupervised sources, even when they appear healthy, are a risky choice because they may be symptomless carriers of viruses, pathogenic fungi, insects, and bacteria. Given the cost of establishing the planting and potential profit that can come from a healthy planting, choosing a certain plant source because it is the cheapest option is often a poor way to try to save money. Nursery sources for small fruit plants are listed in Appendix C.
materials have not been applied to an area, the transition phase may be less than three years. Consider the following questions before initiating organic production: 1. Does a market for organic berries exist in your area? 2. Are adequate resources and materials available to produce an organic crop, particularly in the area of pest and fertility management? 3. Are you willing to devote more time to monitoring pests? 4. Are you willing to devote more time to managing soil fertility? 5. Are you willing to devote more time to record keeping? If you answered yes to all of the above, organic production may be for you. Organic, sustainable, and conventional small fruit growers use many of the same management practices. However, for organic growers some management practices may differ in following the new production and handling requirements contained in the NOS (the standard can be viewed at www.ams.usda.gov/ AMSv1.0/nop). Also, the importance of cultural controls is amplified in organic production, and maintenance of soil fertility requires more planning compared to conventional production. This topic is discussed more fully in the next chapter. Growers beginning the transition from nonorganic to organic production may wish to consider a pretransition phase if pest pressures are high in the planting area. A pretransition phase is a cross between organic and nonorganic production. During this phase, conventional pesticides are used along with organic tactics to reduce pest pressures. Once pest pressures are reduced, organic pest-management measures are used exclusively. Growers may market berries from wild plantings as organic, providing prohibited products (see www.ams .usda.gov/AMSv1.0/nop) have not been applied to the planting in the three years prior to harvesting. Also, the berries must be harvested so that the environment is not harmed and the planting will grow and produce berries in subsequent years. Consult local and state regulations concerning gathering berries from property that is not privately owned.
organIc productIon
Organic produce is currently the fastestgrowing market segment in produce sales. If produce is to be grown organically, many factors need to be considered long before planting begins. Initial investment in organic production is high due to certification costs and increased time and labor for management; however, returns can be on average 10 to 20 percent higher than on conventionally produced products, provided that a premium market can be identified. The U.S. Department of Agriculture (USDA) regulates the term organic. To become certified organic, growers must follow production and handling practices contained in the National Organic Standards (NOS) and must be certified by a USDA-accredited certifying agency. Growers whose annual gross income from organic products is $5,000 or less can be exempted from certification. In this case growers must continue to use production and handling practices in accordance with the NOS, and some restrictions regarding labeling and combination with other organic products apply. Certified organic production is typically preceded by a three-year transition phase during which prohibited materials cannot be used. If prohibited
IntroductIon
Maintaining a productive soil is fundamental to growing a healthy crop. Soil fertility programs should optimize nutrient availability with long-term management in mind. The first step to understanding your soil is to conduct a soil test. From this test, key factors such as soil pH, phosphorus, potassium, and micronutrient levels can be determined, as well as organic matter content. Early adjustments in nutrients and organic matter levels are critical to success and are made through the application of liming materials, fertilizers, composts, animal manure, and/or growth of a green manure crop. Throughout the life of the planting, soil nutrient levels should be adjusted using the information obtained from tissue tests and subsequent soil tests.
contents
Introduction ......................................................... 5 Meeting the Crops Nutrient Requirements ........... 5 Soil Testing ..................................................... 5 Soil pH and Adjustment .................................. 5 Use of Inorganic Fertilizers.............................. 6 Adding Nutrients with Composts and Manures ......................................................... 7 Value of Organic Matter ................................. 9 Biofumigation: Managing Dagger Nematodes with Green Manures ............................................11 Which Rapeseed Varieties to Plant .................11 Keeping Your Nutrient Program on Track: Leaf Analysis........................................................11 Nutrient Management Plans ................................12
to a depth of at least 8 inches and be careful not to expose your soil sample to cardboard glue, as some glues may contain boron and can contaminate the sample, resulting in inaccurate results. After plant establishment, tissue testing in conjunction with soil testing is recommended as the primary means of guiding nutrient adjustments. General information on nutrient application is presented below, with information provided on both inorganic fertilizer application and application of nutrients through the use of composts and manures. Additional information specific to individual crops (such as with plasticulture strawberries and blueberries) is presented under Nutrition in individual crop chapters.
potassiumwhich is usually caused by competition between magnesium and potassium ions for uptake. Applying dolomitic lime when magnesium is already sufficient in the soil aggravates this situation. Excessive liming, regardless of source, can increase the soil pH beyond what is recommended and result in suboptimal plant growth and development. This is partly because the availability of many nutrients is limited at high pH levels. For example, overliming (and excessive soil phosphorus levels) can tie up zinc, making it unavailable to the plant. If soil tests indicate that more than 4,000 pounds (2 tons) per acre of lime are needed, apply half of the total requirement in each of two successive years before planting rather than in large amounts in a single season. Lime does not move well through the soil profile, so the soil must be worked thoroughly to ensure even distribution in the root zone.
ations, boron, which is easily leached from the soil, should be monitored and added routinely. Nitrogen is the primary element required for vegetative growth. Soil nitrogen tests have not correlated well with plant growth. This is because soil nitrogen is present in several different forms, which are in constant states of flux, and only a small proportion is in forms available to the plants at any given time. Nitrogen requirements after planting are best determined by tissue analysis. Also, plant vigor provides many clues to nitrogen levels. If plants are not growing as vigorously as they should be and are an even light green, nitrogen deficiency should be suspected. As with liming, excessive nitrogen fertilization can lead to production problems, including greater susceptibility to diseases and winter-kill. Phosphorus is especially important during the early establishment years. Because its mobility in the soil profile is limited, phosphorus should be worked well into the rooting zone prior to planting. Surface applications later in the life of the planting generally have little impact and are either bound to the surface or washed away by heavy rains. Excess phosphorus application can result in deficiencies of micronutrients, especially zinc, in small fruit crops and also contributes to eutrophication of waterways. Potassium moves into the fruit in relatively large quantities during ripening and, therefore, is readily lost through harvesting and by leaching through the soil beyond the root zone. Additional potassium amendments are often part of a fertility maintenance program. Potassium uptake can be negatively affected by high calcium and, especially, magne-
sium levels. Consequently, an excess of any one of these elements can cause the others to appear deficient. Soil calcium levels are generally sufficient for berry crops within the region, as long as the soil pH is in the correct range. Adjustments of pH through the use of lime provide additional calcium beyond that already present in the soil. Calcium deficiencieswhen they do occurare often more likely due to dry soil conditions or an uneven moisture supply, especially when plants are growing rapidly, rather than a true calcium deficiency in the soil. Calcium deficiency symptoms on strawberry leaves (appearing as a tipburn), for example, most frequently appear during dry spells in the spring. This problem can be made worse by high relative humidity. This is because calcium moves into the plant with moisture flow, and when water isnt moving evenly into the plant, calcium uptake is negatively affected. In the unusual situation where calcium needs to be added without raising the soil pH, gypsum (calcium sulfate) can be used. Magnesium levels are generally sufficient in the soil for strawberry and bramble production within the MidAtlantic region. However, magnesium is frequently deficient for blueberries in upland soils where soil calcium levels are often too high for optimum blueberry production. In situations where magnesium needs to be added and the soil pH is sufficient or shouldnt be raised, Epsom salts (magnesium sulfate) or Mag-Ox can be used. Boron levels should be above 1 pounds per acre ( ppm in the soil) in sandy soils for any berry crop, or in any soil planted to strawberries. Ten pounds of boron per acre (5 ppm in the soil) is
table 2.1. pounds of lime with a CCe (calcium carbonate equivalent) of 100 needed per acre to raise the soil pH to 6.5 or maintain the pH at 6.5.
Initial Soil pH 4.14.4 4.54.8 4.95.2 5.35.6 5.76.0 6.16.4 Above 6.5 Loamy Sand 4,500 3,600 2,700 1,800 900 500 0 Sandy Loam 5,400 4,500 3,600 2,700 1,800 900 0 Soil Texture Loam Silt Loam 9,800 11,600 8,100 9,800 6,300 8,100 4,500 6,300 3,600 4,500 1,800 3,600 0 0 Clay Loam 23,300 18,800 15,200 12,500 8,100 5,400 2,700
toxic to most fruit plants. If boron is deficient, mix boron with your fertilizer, and soil incorporate the mixture before planting. There is a very narrow range between boron deficiency and boron toxicity, so when applying boron, be sure that the rate applied is accurate across the entire field. If boron deficiency is suspected after planting and a tissue test confirms the diagnosis, correct the deficiency with either a Solubor foliar spray at bloom or a topdressing to the soil in the fall. A foliar spray is preferred, as the likelihood of inaccurate application is less. Very small amounts (4/5 pound of actual boron (B) per acre to the soil, or 1/3 pound per acre to the foliage) are sufficient to correct most deficiencies. Maintain healthy root growth through the summer to facilitate boron uptake. Note, too, that boron is less available to plants at soil pH levels above 6.0 to 6.5. Under marginally deficient conditions, foliar applications of phosphorus can precipitate boron in the tissues, causing a deficiency, which in turn can result in significant crop loss.
fields, check state regulations because some states have implemented or are in the process of implementing nutrient management legislation to address nutrient pollution problems. Depending on the state in which you reside and your type of farming operation, you may be required to develop and follow a nutrient management plan. Timing the application of compost is different from that of adding chemical fertilizers because nutrients are generally slowly made available to plants, and timing must be adjusted to account for decomposition and the subsequent release of nutrients. Applying compost too late can result in vigorous plant growth late in the season, which can delay hardening off of the plant and lead to winter injury.
Compost
The nutrient content of compost varies depending on source materials and composting protocols used. As a result, compost should be tested to determine the amount of nutrients it contains, as failure to do so may result in under- or overapplication of certain nutrients. When a nutrient is overapplied, imbalances that are frequently difficult to correct result. Various university and private laboratories offer a compost analysis. The types of tests available and costs vary considerably with each laboratory and are subject to change. See Appendix B for contact information of laboratories in the region. Finished compost typically contains 0.5 to 2.5 percent total nitrogen. Most of the nitrogen is in an organic or slow-release form. As a general rule, about 10 percent of the organic nitrogen in the compost will be available to the plant per year. Phosphorus in composts, like nitrogen, is largely in a form not available for plant use. As phosphorus is changed to a form useable by plants, some of it binds to soil particles and is again unavailable for plant use. Because of this, compost generally contains very little phosphorus for plant use, and phosphorus from other sources is typically needed to meet plant requirements. The plant-unavailable phosphorus forms can, however, tie up micronutrients. Potassium in compost is readily available for plant use, but it is water soluble and can leach out of compost piles. Placing
a cover over a compost pile can help reduce the amount on potassium lost to leaching. In addition to determining the nutrient content of compost, its pH should be determined, particularly if it is intended for use in blueberry production, as the pH is usually between 6.5 and 7.5. When using compost, applying it based on crop needs rather than on a depth basis is best for long-term soil health. Studies have shown that this is especially the case when growing in high tunnels, which exclude rain. The rain assists in the breakdown of compost but also leaches some nutrients and salts. Applying compost on a depth basis in high tunnels (or other production systems to a lesser extent) can increase soil nutrient and soluble salts to well above optimum levels, thereby compromising yields. Compost can be applied based on the amount of nitrogen, phosphorus, or potassium needs of the crop, of which nitrogen is often most limiting. To calculate how much compost to apply based on the nitrogen needs of a crop, first determine the amount of organic and ammonium nitrogen contained in the compost and convert these values to pounds per ton (see the example below). Generally, these values are given in units of pounds per ton, milligrams per kilogram (which is equivalent to parts per million), or as a percentage. Multiply milligrams per kilogram by 0.002 to convert to pounds per ton. If these values are given as a percentage, multiply the numeral of the percentage by 20 to convert to pounds per ton. Next, determine how much nitrogen will be available from the compost in the first year after application by multiplying the organic nitrogen by a mineralization rate and adding that to the amount of ammonium. Compost must be decomposed for organic nitrogen to be converted to plant available nitrogen. The mineralization rate accounts for this conversion. Mineralization rates can range from 10 to 40 percent. The range is wide because many factors affect mineralization rates, including soil moisture, the population of soil microbes decomposing the compost, soil temperature, compost particle size, the makeup of the compost, depth of incorporation of the compost, and so forth. A conservative mineralization estimate is 10 percent.
However, using 10 percent can result in excess nitrogen in the soil relative to plant demand, which can result in the plant sacrificing fruit production for vegetative growth, among other problems. When a higher rate of mineralization is expectedfor example, if growing in a hot climate, when using certain plastic mulches (soil temperatures may be higher), or when using drip irrigation (soil moisture may be more uniform) consider using a higher mineralization rate. The final step is to determine the amount of compost to apply by dividing the amount of nitrogen needed by the amount of nitrogen available in the compost. Remember to subtract nitrogen added from other sources (e.g., green manures or fertilizers) from the nitrogen needed. Example: A compost has 1.1 percent organic nitrogen and 451.6 mg/kg ammonium nitrogen on a wet-weight basis, and a planting needs 30 pounds of nitrogen per acre. Step 1: Convert the organic and ammonium nitrogen levels to pounds per ton. Convert the percent organic nitrogen to pounds per ton by multiplying 1.1 by 20 = 22 pounds of organic nitrogen contained per ton of compost. Convert 451.6 mg/kg ammonium N to lbs per ton by multiplying by 0.002 = 0.9 pounds ammonium per ton. Step 2: Determine how much nitrogen will be made available to the plant by multiplying 22 pounds of total nitrogen per ton by a 10 percent mineralization rate = 2.2 pounds of available nitrogen per ton of compost. Add to that the amount of ammonium available; 2.2 + 0.9 = 3.1 pounds per ton available nitrogen in the compost. Step 3: Determine how much compost to apply. Thirty pounds of nitrogen needed per acre divided by 3.1 pounds of nitrogen available per ton = 9.7 tons of compost needed per acre. Accepted values of plant availability of phosphorus and potassium from compost are not established, but keep in mind that little phosphorus is readily available to plants, while much of the
potassium is in plant-available forms and is probably available within the first year.
Raw manures
Tables listing the nutrient content of different manures are available for use. Nutrient content varies depending on several factors including the feed the source animal was provided, presence of bedding in the manure, and manure handling procedures. Also, nutrient availability decreases as the manure ages. As with composts, manures should be tested for nutrient content to avoid over- or underapplying various nutrients. Manure is typically applied based on the nitrogen needs of the crop. Fact sheets are available through cooperative extension with detailed calculations for determining application rates for manures. Nitrogen contained in manures is in the form of ammonia or ammonium, which can be quickly lost through volatilization to the atmosphere. To avoid this nitrogen loss, raw manures should be soil incorporated when possible. Soil incorporating manures can be a challenge for small fruit crops because the plants are perennial and have shallow root systems that can be damaged during incorporation. Applying raw manures to the small fruit crop can also damage the plants because of potentially
high nitrogen and salt levels. Additionally, raw manures can be contaminated with microorganisms that cause human disease, which can be transferred to fruit. Applying manure well in advance of fruit production (e.g., in the fall) or as mandated for organic growers (see section below) is recommended. Manures often have high weed seed levels, which complicate production. It has been documented on vegetable crops that as manures decompose they can release compounds, which, when taken up, can lead to off-flavors and odors, though this has not been investigated with small fruit crops. For these reasons, raw manures are better suited for incorporation during soil preparation prior to planting rather than after the crop has been planted. Composted manures are a better option for application after the crop has been planted. Using sewage sludge is not recommended. Individual state regulations may require a permit for application, and state guidelines for application must be strictly followed. However, the use of sewage sludge is permitted by federal and some state regulations for production of certain crops. If opting to use sewage sludge, carefully follow established guidelines and consult your local county extension educator. Some labs offer a soil amendment test to assist growers in making sound management decisions when considering use of alternative soil amendments such as sewage sludge (see Appendix B for a list of laboratories). This test includes analyses for standard nutrients plus potential metal and heavy metal contaminants. In addition, the facility producing the sludge may have test results available to those obtaining sludge.
days before harvest. When raw manures are applied to fields with a crop for human consumption and the edible part of the crop is in contact with the soil (e.g., strawberries), the manure must be soil incorporated a minimum of 120 days before harvest. The use of sewage sludge is prohibited in certified organic production.
be plowed under in the fall. This allows adequate time for them to break down and prevents soil nitrogen tie-up. Green manures in the legume (clovers and vetches) family contain more nitrogen than other green manures and can be turned under in early spring, a month or so before small fruit crops are planted.
organic matter with 5 percent preferred. Results of this assessment of the current condition of the planting area will be used to decide on the primary purpose of the green manure. (2) Identifying the primary purpose of a green manure. Many green manure crops are available for meeting sitespecific soil-improvement goals. Green manures can be used to provide nitrogen, increase the organic matter content, suppress weeds, scavenge nutrients in the soil, and/or manage plant-parasitic nematodes. It is likely that more than one goal will be identified for a site. Goals will need to be prioritized, and some may need to be addressed by other means, as one green manure generally cannot fulfill all needs. Providing nitrogen. If, based on your assessment of prior growth on the site or expected subsequent crop needs, nitrogen is of primary concern, legumes are the best choice. They are able to establish relationships with soilborne nitrogen-fixing bacteria that remove nitrogen from the atmosphere and change it into a form that the plant can use. As a result, the tissues of leguminous crops have a lot of nitrogen relative to the amount of carbon, which results in their rapid decomposition when incorporated into the soil. This results in a relatively quick release of nitrogen, but the amount of organic matter retained in the soil is limited over the long term. Each leguminous crop differs in the amount of nitrogen added to the soil. Information is available on amount of nitrogen added by various cover crops (see Appendix E). Increasing organic matter. On sites with an organic matter content below 2 percent, increasing the soil organic matter content should be a priority. When growing a green manure to increase the organic matter content in the soil, nonleguminous crops or mixtures of grasses and leguminous crops are good options. The best crops for this purpose are generally those with large aboveground plant canopies and include annual ryegrass, cereal rye, triticale, sorghum/sudangrass, and hairy vetch. These green manures can suppress weeds through direct competition.
10
Suppressing weeds. On sites with high weed densities, the primary purpose of a green manure would be to suppress weeds. Green manures that establish quickly and have large aboveground canopies are the best options for this goal. Buckwheat, in particular, is especially valuable for this purpose due to its ability to establish quickly. In general, green manures that suppress weeds are also more effective for increasing the soil organic matter content (see preceding paragraph). Scavenging nutrients. The primary purpose of growing green manure may be to efficiently use nutrients by recycling excess nutrients from deep in the soil, or to scavenge nutrients remaining in the soil after the previous crop is harvested, thereby preventing these nutrients from leaching out of the root zone. These nutrients will then be made available to subsequent crops as the green manure breaks down. For this purpose, select green manures with large, deep root systems that develop quickly. Options include small grains, cereal rye, triticale, rapeseed, annual ryegrass, oil seed radish, mustard, and some leguminous crops. Managing dagger nematodes. If dagger nematodes have been a problem on your site in the past, and/or a nematode test indicates the presence of high populations, green manures can be used for management. As an alternative to chemical fumigation, a variety of novel rotations and green manures for nematode management have been evaluated. This work has shown that some plants can naturally reduce populations of dagger nematodes and improve soil structure. Based on these results, using selected rapeseed cultivars can help manage dagger nematodes; however, the treatment is not very effective against other nematode populations. Specific suggestions and additional information on this subject is discussed below and in Appendix A. (3) Determining the time of year and length of time the green manure will be grown. Once the primary purpose for growing the green manure is identified, the next step is to identify the time of year and length of time the green manure will be grown. Ideally, the planting
area should be devoted to soil improvement, including using green manures, for the year prior to planting small fruit. However, this may not be an option on some farms. Another opportunity for planting green manures is between cash crops, in the late fall and/or early spring. For fall-planted green manures, coolseason crops including vetches, peas, annual and perennial clovers, wheat, ryegrass, rye, winter rapeseed, or barley are good choices. For green manures planted in the late spring or summer, warm-season crops including sorghum/ sudangrass, cowpeas, or buckwheat should be grown. Consider growing multiple green manures in both the cool and warm seasons. (4) Other considerations. Here are some final questions to consider when selecting a green manure. What equipment do you have available for managing the green manure? Will you be able to manage a crop with a large canopy with the equipment that you have avail-
able? How much are you willing to pay for cover crop seed, and what type of seed is available? (Suppliers of cover crop seed are listed in Appendix D.) What crop will you be growing next? If blueberries, you should choose a green manure that grows well in soils with a pH similar to blueberry plants (4.5 to 5.0)for example, buckwheat. Once these factors have been considered, a green manure crop can be chosen. Table 2.2 categorizes several green manures by use, life cycle, and season.
table 2.2. green manure crops categorized by use, life cycle, and season.
Nitrogen Building Long-Term Organic Matter Building and Weed Management Nutrient Scavenging
PeReNNIALS Legumes generally are planted from late April to early May or from late July to early August.* Nonlegumes are generally planted from early April to early June. Alfalfa Alsike, ladino, white clover, sweet clover Red clover Alfalfa Perennial ryegrass Red clover Perennial ryegrass
WARM-SeASON ANNUALS Generally planted from late May to mid-July. Buckwheat Japanese millet Sorghum/sudangrass Sudangrass COOL-SeASON ANNUALS Generally planted from late April to early May or from August to early September. Hairy vetch Annual ryegrass Hairy vetch Rapeseed Spring oats Winter rye Annual field brome Annual ryegrass Buckwheat Sorghum/sudangrass
*Planting dates are only intended as general guides for groups of crops. Specific crops will vary in ideal planting time. See Appendix E for additional sources of information on growing cover crops.
11
acre and adjust the soil pH, potassium, and phosphorus. These practices help establish the green manure and promote more rapid breakdown when it is incorporated, preventing nitrogen drag (a lack of available N) when small fruit crops are planted. Since preplant green manures are not intended to become permanently established, suppliers usually recommend minimum seeding rates to produce an acceptable stand. If a dense and fast-growing cover is needed for weed management, higher seeding rates of green manures such as buckwheat, rye, annual ryegrass, or sudangrass are recommended. Many other sources are available to further detail the benefits and cultural requirements of various green manure crops. For sources of further information on green manures and cover crops, see Appendix E.
Prepare seedbed and plant rapeseed by late April or early May. (Plant only recommended winter rapeseed cultivars. See below.) Incorporate (i.e., turn under) green rapeseed by early September. Prepare seedbed and plant second crop by mid-September. Turn under the second crop in late spring after soil temperatures reach 45F or higher. Ideal conditions for incorporating rapeseed are similar to those required for obtaining the maximum benefit from fumigation (i.e., the soil temperature should be above 45F and moist). Alternatively, planting dates may be reversed so that the first planting is in the fall followed by a second crop planted in the spring. This would end the rotation cycle in fall of the following year.
Although agricultural soil is not usually deficient in sulfur, soil testing to assess the availability of this element may be beneficial.
adding organic matter from sources other than green manure Crops
Sources of organic matter such as composts or animal manures can also be added to increase organic matter content. As a general rule of thumb, 10 tons of manure per acre is considered a reasonable rate for improving organic matter content. If berry plants will be planted before the material has time to decompose, using composts is preferred over using fresh materials. See considerations discussed above concerning using these materials for nutrient addition.
12
these reasons, samples for berry crops should only be collected when specified (see exception below), as samples collected at other times may produce nearly meaningless results. For mattedrow strawberries, sample the first fully expanded leaves after renovation, about July 15 to August 1. For plasticulture strawberries, sample the first fully expanded leaves in spring after plants have resumed growth but before early fruit set for first harvest-year plantings, or after renovation for carry-over plantings. In summer-bearing brambles, the most recently fully expanded leaves should be sampled on nonfruiting canes between August 1 and 20. With primocane-bearing brambles, the most recently fully expanded leaves should be sampled when flower buds are emerging. Blueberry leaves (most recently fully expanded) should be sampled as soon as harvest is finished. An exception to the rule of only sampling at certain times exists. When plants that are performing poorly can be compared to healthy plants of the same cultivar, age, and otherwise same growing conditions, samples can be collected at almost any time of the year, and results of these samples can be compared to each other. This is especially useful if you suspect that soil conditions are causing localized nutrient deficiencies. In this case, obtain separate samples from both poor and good plants of most recently fully expanded leaves and submit them for separate analysis. Select a minimum of 30 leaves (strawberries and brambles) or 60 leaves (blueberries) for each analysis. All leaves within each kit should be from the same cultivar, although they should be taken from several plants. Detach the leaves from the plant and remove the petioles. Place leaves in a dry paper bag and label immediately. Critical values for tissue analysis results for each berry crop and recommendations for changes in programs based on these results are presented in Appendix B. Petiole sap testers (Cardy meters) are sometimes used to determine nitrate-nitrogen and potassium levels in the petioles of strawberry plants. These
results are useful as a rough guide for determining the nitrogen and potassium status of plants, but they should not be used as the sole source of information for guiding nutrient programs.
13
contEnts
Effect of Pesticides on Nontarget Organisms ........ 13 Crop GroupingsHow Crops Are Listed on the Label ........................................................ 13 Pesticide Activity Groups and Resistance Management ....................................................... 13 Spray Application ................................................ 13 Herbicide Equipment ...................................... 15 Fungicide and Insecticide Equipment.............. 15 Spray Water pH ............................................... 15 Pesticide Safety ................................................... 15 Using Pesticides Safely ................................... 15 Pesticide Toxicity ............................................ 16 Symptoms of Pesticide Poisoning.................... 17 Responding to Pesticide Poisoning Symptoms ...................................................... 17 First Aid for Pesticide Poisoning ...................... 17 Safe Storage of Pesticides ............................... 18 Safe Disposal of Pesticides .............................. 19 Current Status of Restricted-Use Pesticides ....................................................... 19 Worker Protection Standard for Agricultural Pesticides .................................... 19 Chemical Fumigation ........................................... 23 Soil Fumigation Chemicals .............................. 23 Site Preparation for Chemical Fumigation and Treatment Guidelines ............ 24
the Berry and Small Fruit group. Thus, if a pesticide is labeled for this entire group, it can be used on any berry or small fruit crop. Subgroups that may appear on a label include subgroup 1307A: the caneberry subgroup, subgroup 13-07B: the bushberry subgroup, and 1307G: the low-growing berry subgroup. The caneberry subgroup includes raspberries, blackberries, and any hybrids of the two (boysenberries, tayberries, etc.). The bushberry subgroup includes highbush and lowbush blueberries, gooseberry, currants, jostaberries, plus many others. The low-growing berry subgroup includes strawberries, as well as lowbush blueberries. Any crop may also appear individually on a label, as frequently occurs with strawberries. This is a revision of this crop group. Modifications may continue to be made if necessary.
sPray aPPLication
There is no substitute for choosing the correct equipment and calibrating it correctly. Problems from over- or underapplication range from crop phytotoxicity and unnecessary environmental contamination to a lack of pest control. A poorly calibrated sprayer also wastes pesticides
14
Table 3.1. Toxicity of pesticides to birds, fish, honey bees, and beneficial predators.
Toxicity to: Pesticide INSECTICIDES Actara Admire Asana Assail Avaunt Aza-Direct Brigade, Capture Confirm Danitol Delegate Diazinon Dibrom Dipel, other Bt products Entrust, Success, Spintor Esteem Guthion (Use only in NJ) Imidan Intrepid Lannate Lorsban Malathion M-Pede Mustang Max Platinum Provado Pyganic Radiant Sevin XLR Surround Thionex MITICIDES Acramite AgriMek Kanemite Kelthane, Dicofold Oberon Savey Vendex Zeal Birds
STa M ST N M NST ST S N H M N ST N H M N H H M N ST ST M N N N MH N N N ST N N N ST
Fish
N M H N H H H M H M H H N M H H H MT M H H N H N M H M H H H M Hc H ST H H H
Honey Bees
H H H M ST ST H M H M H H N M N H H N H H Hb N H H H ST M Hb Mb ST Hb N N N N N N
Ladybugs
H STM H M M ST H N H ST M H N N H M M N H M M ST H H M M ST H M M N ST ST ST N ST
Lacewings
M ST H M ST ST H N H ST M H N N H M M N H ST ST ST H M M ST ST M M N ST ST ST N ST
a. N = practically nontoxic (for bees, apply anytime); ST = slight toxicity (for bees, apply in evening after bees have stopped foraging until early morning before they start foraging); M = moderately toxic (for bees, apply in evening after bees have stopped foraging); H = highly toxic (for bees, do not apply to blooming plants); = insufficient data b. Depending on rate and formulation, different products containing abamectin, malathion, endosulfan, or carbaryl as the active ingredient have different lengths of time of toxicity to honey bees. c. Toxic to invertebrate aquatic organisms such as oysters. d. Kelthane use is being discontinued. Growers may continue to use existing stocks for strawberries. Virginias 24C label for Kelthane on brambles is no longer in effect. NoTe: Information on toxicity to birds, fish, and honey bees was drawn from numerous sources such as Material Safety Data Sheets, EPA rulings, and EXTOXNET PIPs. Information on toxicity to beneficial predators is largely drawn from that contained in Penn States Tree Fruit Production Guide, which draws on other sources as well. For additional information on this subject, and additional sources of information used in this table, see Appendix E. When scientifically substantiated differences existed in ratings among data sources or species tested, the more conservative ratings were chosen.
15
by applying too much or too little material, both of which are costly. Close attention to detail in choosing the right equipment and in the calibration and adjustments required for maximum performance and efficiency are important.
Herbicide equipmeNT
See discussion in Chapter 4: Weed Management.
specifically for low-volume applications of less than 50 gallons per acre. Exceeding this rate overloads the nozzles and can result in poor coverage. For airblast sprayers using standard, hollow-cone type nozzles, delivery rates of 30 to 200 gallons of water per acre will provide good coverage in most plantings. Note that regardless of the sprayer type, if the spray volume used results in wetting the foliage to the drip point, the concentration of the spray mixture in the sprayer tank should never exceed the poundsper-100-gallon recommendation on the product label. Do not operate horizontalboom sprayers at more than 3 mph, airblast sprayers at more than 2 mph, and vertical-boom sprayers at more than 2 mph. On strawberries, apply fungicides and insecticides at an operating pressure of 200 to 300 psi for the delivery of at least 100 gallons of diluted pesticide mixture per acre. This is done to ensure thorough coverage of all foliage and fruit and the penetration of spray droplets through the foliar canopy to the crowns. Operate vertical-boom sprayers at 200 to 400 psi for good penetration of the foliar canopy and adequate breakup of spray droplets. Operating pressures for airblast equipment vary with the type of nozzle used; follow the manufacturers recommendations. Regardless of the spraying method used, spray coverage within the treated crop should be checked several times during the course of the season as the foliar canopy changes. This is best done with water-sensitive paper spray targets that can be hung on hooks in the canopy structure or stapled directly to leaves. These spray targets are relatively inexpensive and are available from sources listed in Appendix D.
is particularly important where low-volume sprays are used on larger acreages since emptying the spray tank may take several hours. See Appendix D for suppliers of pH-testing equipment. Where the pH of the spray water needs to be adjusted, special spray water buffering agents are available from most pesticide suppliers.
PEsticidE safEty
Many growers practice IPM, in which pesticides play a vital role. Applicators must realize their legal obligations when using pesticides. Furthermore, applicators who implement pesticide safety practices and take proper precautions will greatly reduce the possibility of accidents.
sprAy WATer pH
For maximum effectiveness, the pH of the spray water should be in the 6.5 to 7.0 range. Although extremely acidic water is uncommon in this area, the limestone and surface runoff in parts of the region can make spray water alkaline. In general, alkaline spray water should not be used with many pesticides, primarily carbamates and organophosphates, because it promotes the hydrolysis or destruction of the pesticides. This
16
tor should wear chemically resistant gloves (nitrile, butyl, or neoprene) and unlined rubber boots. Be careful when handling pesticide materials to avoid spilling on skin or clothing. Never eat, drink, smoke, or use tobacco products while applying pesticides. When selecting pesticides, consider type of formulation and the application equipment required. Avoid drift to nontarget areas, which may endanger other plants or animals. Dusts drift more than sprays, and airblast sprayers create more drift than boom sprayers. For record-keeping requirements, record the date, time, location, amount of each pesticide used, and any other required information as soon as possible. Bathe or shower in hot, soapy water after applying pesticides. Wash clothing worn while applying pesticides separately from other laundry in hot, soapy water. Contaminated clothing must be handled with the same precautions as the pesticide itself.
Toxicity is a measure of a pesticides ability to cause injury, which is a property of the chemical itself. Pesticide toxicity is determined by exposing test animals to different dosages of the active ingredient. Tests are also done with each different formulation of the product (e.g., liquids, dusts, and granulars). By understanding the difference in toxicity levels of pesticides, a user can minimize the potential hazard by selecting the pesticide with the lowest toxicity that will control the pest. Applicators may have little or no control over the availability of low-toxicity products or the toxicity of specific formulated products. However, exposure can be significantly reduced or nearly eliminated by using PPE. For example, more than 90 percent of all pesticide exposure comes from dermal exposure, primarily to the hands and forearms. By wearing a pair of chemically resistant gloves, this exposure can be reduced by at least 90 percent. Therefore, by wearing the correct PPE, the hazard of pesticide use can be reduced significantly for the applicator.
Sheets (MSDS), which are available from the supplier or product manufacturer when pesticide products are purchased. Most are also available from various online sources including the manufacturers Web site or through various search engines as listed on pesticide education Web sites of universities within the region (see Appendix E: Additional Sources of Information). For many reasons, especially in an emergency situation, maintaining a file with copies of the label and MSDS for each pesticide product used is highly recommended. The LD50 and LC50 values are useful in comparing the toxicity of different active ingredients as well as different formulations of the same active ingredient. The lower the LD50 value of a pesticide, the less it takes to kill 50 percent of the test population and, therefore, the greater the acute toxicity of the chemical. Pesticides with high LD50 values are considered the least acutely toxic to humans when used according to the directions on the product label.
Signal Words
Acute toxicities are the basis for assigning pesticides to a toxicity category and selecting the appropriate signal word for the product label. Pesticides that are classified as highly toxic on the basis of either oral, dermal, or inhalation toxicity must have the signal words DANGER and POISON (in red letters) and a graphic of a skull and crossbones prominently displayed on the package label. PELIGRO, the Spanish word for danger, must also appear on the label of highly toxic chemicals. Acute oral LD50 values for pesticide products in this group range from a trace amount to 50 mg/kg. An exposure of a few drops of a highly toxic material taken orally could be fatal to a 150-pound person. Some pesticide products are labeled with the signal word DANGER without the skull and crossbones symbol. A DANGER signal word in this instance does not provide information about the LD50 value of the chemical. Instead, this signal word means that potentially damaging skin or eye effects (due to irritant or corrosive properties of the pesticide) are more severe than the acute toxicity (LD50) of the product would indicate.
pesTicide ToxiciTy
For all pesticides to be effective against the pests they are intended to control, they must be biologically active, or toxic. Because pesticides are toxic, they are also potentially hazardous to humans and animals. Any pesticide can be poisonous or toxic if absorbed in excessive amounts. Pesticides can cause skin or eye damage (topical effects) and can also induce allergic responses. However, if used according to label directions and with the proper personal protective equipment (PPE), pesticides can be used safely. For this reason, people who use pesticides or regularly come in contact with them must understand the relative toxicity and the potential health effects of the products they use. The risk of exposure to pesticides can be illustrated with the following simple equation:
17
Pesticide products considered moderately toxic must have the signal words WARNING and AVISO (Spanish) displayed on the label. Acute oral LD50 values range from 50 to 500 mg/ kg. An exposure of 1 teaspoon to 1 ounce could be fatal to a 150-pound person. Pesticide products classified as either slightly toxic or relatively nontoxic are required to have the signal word CAUTION on the pesticide label. Acute oral LD50 values are greater than 500 mg/kg.
effects generally develop at the site of pesticide contact and are a result of either the pesticides irritant properties (either the active and/or inert ingredient) or an allergic response by the victim. Dermatitis, or inflammation of the skin, is accepted as the most commonly reported topical effect associated with pesticide exposure. Symptoms range from reddening of the skin to rashes and/or blisters. Some individuals exhibit allergic reactions when using pesticides or when these materials are applied in or around their homes or places of work. Symptoms of allergic reactions range from reddening and itching of the skin and eyes to respiratory discomfort that often resembles an asthmatic condition. Systemic effects are quite different from topical effects. They often occur away from the original point of contact as a result of the pesticide being absorbed into and distributed throughout the body. Systemic effects often include nausea, vomiting, fatigue, headache, and intestinal disorders. Seeking prompt medical attention is important; however, the development of certain symptoms is not always the result of exposure to a pesticide. Common illnesses such as the flu, heat exhaustion or heat stroke, pneumonia, asthma, respiratory and intestinal infections, and even a hangover can cause symptoms similar to pesticide exposure. Carefully consider all possible causes of your symptoms.
if the pesticide container is contaminated, write down the product name and percentage of active ingredients, and take that information to the phone.) The product label provides medical personnel information such as active ingredients, an antidote, and an emergency contact number for the manufacturer of the product. If you must go to the hospital or doctors office, take the entire container, including the label, with you. In order to avoid inhaling fumes or spilling the contents, make sure the container is tightly sealed and never put it in the enclosed passenger section of a vehicle. If the MSDS is available, also take this with you because it frequently contains additional information for medical personnel. In addition to posting emergency numbers or having them readily available by a telephone, keep these numbers in all service vehicles involved in transporting pesticides. Additional pesticide information can also be obtained by contacting the National Pesticide Information Center (NPIC) located at Oregon State University at 1-800-8587378. The NPIC provides a variety of unbiased information about pesticides to anyone in the United States. (Medical professionals and government agencies can call NPIC at 1-800-858-7377.)
18
tering first aid or removing the victim from an enclosed area. Have current labels and MSDSs available. Have emergency response telephone numbers readily available. Assemble a first aid kit with necessary supplies. Always have a source of clean water available. In an extreme emergency, even water from a farm pond, clean water irrigation system, or watering trough could be used to dilute the pesticide. If oral or dermal exposure has occurred, the first objective is usually to dilute the pesticide and prevent absorption. If inhalation exposure occurs, first protect yourself, and then get the victim to fresh air immediately. Never give anything orally to an unconscious person. Become familiar with the proper techniques of artificial respiration; it may be necessary if a persons breathing has stopped or become impaired.
FourthCall the National Poison Center (1-800-222-1222). If the pesticide has been spilled on the skin or clothing, remove any contaminated clothing immediately and thoroughly wash the skin with soap and water. Avoid harsh scrubbing, as this enhances pesticide absorption. Rinse the affected area with water, wash again, and rinse. Gently dry the affected area and wrap it in a loose cloth or blanket, if necessary. If chemical burns of the skin have occurred, cover the area loosely with a clean, soft cloth. Avoid the use of ointments, greases, powders, and other medications unless instructed by medical personnel. Heavily contaminated clothing should be disposed of properly. If clothing is not heavily soiled, wash all contaminated clothing separately from any other laundry in hot water at a high water level with a heavy duty liquid detergent. Run the washer through a complete cycle with detergent and no clothes to remove pesticide residue before another wash. Store washed protective clothing separately from other clothes. Also, do not store protective clothing and equipment in pesticide storage areas. If the pesticide has entered into the eyes, hold the eyelid open and immediately begin gently washing the eye with clean, running water. Do not use chemicals or drugs in the eyewash water. Continue washing for 15 minutes. If only one eye is involved, avoid contaminating the other one. Flush under the eyelids with water to remove debris. Cover the eye with a clean piece of cloth and seek medical attention immediately. If contact lenses are worn, remove and discard the contacts, then wash the eyes as described above. If the pesticide has been inhaled, get the victim to fresh air immediately. However, do not attempt to rescue someone who is in an enclosed area unless you are wearing appropriate protective equipment. Have the victim lie down and loosen their clothing. Keep the victim warm and quiet. If the victim is convulsing, watch his or her breathing and protect his or her head. Keep the chin up to keep air passages free for breathing. If breathing stops, administer
artificial respiration and call 911. Call the National Poison Center (1-800-2221222) after the victim is stabilized for further advice. If the pesticide has been swallowed, contact the National Poison Center (1-800-222-1222) and provide them with the name and approximate amount of material that was ingested. Call 911 immediately if the victim has symptoms from the exposure. If the pesticide has entered the mouth but has not been swallowed, rinse the mouth with large amounts of water. Inducing vomiting is rarely advised for any poisoning, including pesticide poisonings. If a petroleum product (kerosene, gasoline, oil, lighter fluid, EC pesticides) has been swallowed, call the National Poison Center (1-800-222-1222) and 911 immediately for further instruction. If a corrosive poison (a strong acid or alkali) has been swallowed, dilute with water or milk immediately. Consult the National Poison Center (1-800-2221222) and 911 immediately. The victim may experience severe pain and have extensive mouth and throat burns. Fortunately, most commonly used pesticides are not corrosive, but some household disinfectants and germicides fall into this category.
19
Do not store pesticides where food, water, feed, seeds, fertilizers, or personal protective clothing and equipment (such as respirators) can become contaminated. Store pesticides in their original containers. Never store pesticides in any food or drink containers. Do not remove the labels. Keep lids tightly closed. Check containers frequently for leaks. Clean up spilled chemicals promptly and properly. Dispose of broken or damaged containers and any pesticide waste in an approved and safe manner as directed on the product label. Keep an inventory of all chemicals. Mark each container with the year of purchase. Inform your local fire department of any chemicals (including fertilizers) stored in large quantity.
these are sponsored by the states Department of Agriculture. Contact your state Department of Agriculture for further information. Otherwise, disposal in a sanitary landfill is desirable if conducted in accordance with local regulations. If stated on the label and permitted by local ordinances, combustible containers can be burned. However, do not burn pesticide containers near residential areas or where the smoke can contact humans. Avoid exposure to the smoke; it may contain toxic vapors. Bury the ashes since they also may be toxic. Send large metal drums to a reconditioning company. Before disposing of pesticide concentrates, check with your state, which may provide disposal options for unwanted and outdated pesticide concentrates free of charge (e.g., PDAs CHEMSWEEP program). Do not reuse empty pesticide containers for any purpose. Clean up thoroughly after handling and disposing of pesticides.
If a pesticide is restricted use, this status will be clearly marked on the label. Table 3.2 lists the status of pesticides currently labeled for use in small fruit production, along with preharvest and reentry intervals.
20
Table 3.2. general (g) and restricted-use (r) pesticides labeled for use on strawberries (sb), brambles (br), blueberries (bl), gooseberries, and currants.
Pesticides are legal for use in PA, WV, MD, DE, NJ, and VA except in these cases: Stinger herbicide (clopyralid) may be used on strawberries only in New Jersey, Maryland, Pennsylvania, and Virginia. Guthion may be used on blueberries only in New Jersey. Guthion may no longer be used on brambles. Karmex is labeled for blueberries only in New Jersey and Maryland. Preharvest Interval (Days) Trade Name HERBICIDES Aim Amine 4, Formula 40 Callisto Casoron Chateau Dacthal Devrinol Fusilade d Gallery d Gramoxone Inteon Karmex, NJ and MD Kerb Poast Princep Prowl H20 Rage Chemical Name Use Status G R(NJ), G G G G G G G G R G R G G G R G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G Strawberries Raspberries 0 not spec.a not spec.a prebloom prebloom 21 7 35 14 not spec.a 4 110 30 60 0 0.5 0 0 0 0 0 0 not spec.a 0 1 1 0 15 not spec.a not spec.a 365 365 not spec.a 45 prefruit 15 14 not spec.a 365 70 365 60 not spec.a 14 0 60 0 3 3 0 0 not spec.a 30 not spec.a 0 0 Other Brambles 15 not spec.a not spec.a 365 365 not spec.a 45 prefruit 15 14 not spec.a 365 70 365 60 not spec.a 14 0 60 0 3 0 0 not spec.a 30 not spec.a 0 0 Blueberries 0 prebloom not spec.a not spec.a not spec.a 365 365 not spec.a not spec.a not spec.a 30 prefruit 14 14 14 not spec.a 365 not spec.a 365 60 not spec.a,g 14 90, 450n 0 0.5 42 0 0 0 0 30 0 not spec.a 30 30 not spec.a 0 Gooseberries, REI (hr = hours Currants d = days) 0 not spec.a not spec.a,c 365 365 not spec.a 14 14 14 not spec.a,c 365 365 not spec.a 14 0 0 0 0 not spec.a 30 30 0 0 12 hr 48 hr 12 hr 12 hr/24 hr b 12 hr 12 hr 24 hr 12 hr 12 hr 24 hr 12 hr 24 hr 12 hr 12 hr 24 hr 12 hr 12 hr 4 hr, 12 hre 12 hr 24 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 24 hr 12 hr 48 hr 48 hr 4 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 24 hr sb/2-4 d br and bl h 24 hr sb/48 hr br and bl 12 hr 12 hr 24 hr 48 hr 48 hr, 3 ds 12 hr 4 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 24 hr
continued
carfentrazone-ethyl 2,4-D mesotrione dichlobenil flumioxazin DCPA napropamide fluazifop-P-butyl isoxaben paraquat diuron pronamide sethoxydim simazine pendimethalin carfentrazone + glyphosate Rely glufosinate Roundup glyphosate Scythe pelargonic acid Select clethodim Sinbar terbacil Snapshot trifluralin + isoxaben Solicam norflurazon Stingerf clopyralid Surflan oryzalin Touchdown glyphosate Ultra Blazer acifluorfen Velpar hexazinone FUNGICIDES / BACTERICIDES Abound azoxystrobin Aliette fosetyl-Al Bravo chlorothalonil Cabrio pyraclostrobin Captan captan Captevate captan + fenhexamid Elevate fenhexamid Indar fenbuconazole Kocide copper hydroxide Lime Sulfur calcium polysulfide Omega fluazinam Orbit propiconazole Phostrol, others phosphorous acid Pristine pyraclostrobin + boscalid Procure triflumizole Quintec quinoxyfen Rally myclobutanil
21
Table 3.2. general (g) and restricted-use (r) pesticides labeled for use on strawberries (sb), brambles (br), blueberries (bl), gooseberries, and currants, continued.
Preharvest Interval (Days) Trade Name Chemical Name Use Status Strawberries 0 prebloom 1 0 14 3 0 1 3 14 1 0 0 2 not spec.j 5 1 0v 1 2 3 prebloom 3 0 50 7 0 1 7 0 1 0 4 Raspberries 45 0 0 0 30 3 7 7 1 0 3 14 not spec.j 1 0v 1 1 0 1 1 3 0 7 0 1 0 Other Brambles 0 0 0 30 3 7 7 1 0 3 14 not spec.j 1 0v 1 1 0 1 1 3 0 7 0 1 0 Blueberries 0 t 0 30 not spec.a,i, 14 3 7 14 1 7 0 1 14 3 not spec.j 3 7 0v 3 7 7 (NJ only) 3 7 3 1 0 1 1 75 3 0 7 0 3 0 before buds form Gooseberries, Currants 0 0 30 3 7 1 7 0 1 14 3, 21q 3 0v 3 7 7 3, 1r 0 1 1 75 3 0 0 3 0 REI (hr = hours d = days) 48 hr 24 hr 12 hr 12 hr 48 hr 12 hr 24 hr 12 hr 12 hr 48 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 4 hr 12 hr 4 hr 24 hr 12 hr 4 hr 3 d sb, 5 d ble 48 hr m 4 hr 4 hr 12 hr 7 dl 24 hr 4 hr 48 hr 24 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 4 hr 12 hr 0 hr 4 hr 4 hr 5 d sbe, 9 d ble
continued
Ridomil Gold SL mefenoxam G Rovral iprodione G Scala pyrimethanil G Switch cyprodinil + fludioxinil G Syllit dodine G Tanos famoxadone + cymoxanil G Thiram thiram G Tilt propiconazole G Topsin M thiophanate-methyl G Ziram ziram G INSECTICIDES / MOLLUSCIDES Actara thiamethoxam G Admire Pro imidacloprid G Asana XL esfenvalerate R Assail acetamiprid G Avaunt indoxacarb G Aza-Direct azadirachtin G Brigade bifenthrin R Confirm tebufenozide G Danitol fenpropathrin R Deadline metaldehyde G Delegate spinetoram G Diazinon diazinon R Dibrom naled G, Ru Dipel, others Bt G Entrust spinosad G Esteem pyriproxyfen G Guthion (see heading) azinphos-methyl R Imidan phosmet R(NJ), G Intrepid methoxyfenozide G Lannate methomyl R Lorsban chlorpyrifos R Malathion, Cythion malathion G M-Pede insecticidal soap G Mustang cypermethrin R Mustang Max zeta-cypermethrin R Platinum thiamethoxam G Provado imidacloprid G Pyganic pyrethrins G Radiant spinetoram G Sevin carbaryl G Sluggo iron phosphate G Spintor/Success spinosad G Surround kaolin clay G Thionex endosulfan R
22
Table 3.2. general (g) and restricted-use (r) pesticides labeled for use on strawberries (sb), brambles (br), blueberries (bl), gooseberries, and currants, continued.
Trade Name MITICIDES Acramite Agri-Mek Kanemite Kelthane Oberon Savey Vendex Zeal Chemical Name bifenazate abamectin acequinocyl dicofol spiromesifen hexythiazox fenbutatin oxide etoxazole Use Status G R G G G G R G Preharvest Interval (Days) Other Strawberries Raspberries Brambles Blueberries 1 3 1 3k 3 3 1 1 1 k 3 1 3 365 Gooseberries, Currants 365 REI (hr = hours d = days) 12 hr 12 hr 12 hr 48 hre 12 hr 12 hr 48 hr 12 hr
= not labeled for use on the crop. a. Not spec. indicates that a specific preharvest or reentry interval is not specified in terms of days or hours; however, use may be limited to certain times of the year or crop development stages. b. The REI is 12 hours for granular formulations but 24 hours for the CS formulation in horticultural operations. c. Currants are the only Ribes crop on which Devrinol and Scythe can legally be used. d. For use only on nonbearing plantings. e. Different formulations containing the same active ingredient have different reentry intervals. f. MD, NJ, PA, and VA have Special Local Needs (Section 24C) labels for the use of Stinger on strawberries. g. Not for use in lowbush blueberries. h. Various formulations of captan have different REIs, ranging from 48 hr to 4 days. i. The general label states that applications should be made no later than three weeks after full bloom, but NJs 24c label specifies a 14-day PHI. j. No preharvest interval is specified. This material is not to come in direct contact with the crop. k. Kelthane use is being discontinued. Growers may continue to use existing stocks for strawberries. VAs 24C label for Kelthane on brambles is no longer in effect. l. In addition to the REI for workers protected by the worker protection standard, there is 30- to 42-day REI for the general public such as those who might be involved in pick-your-own operations. m. The REI for Dibrom is 48 hours for rates listed for strawberries, but 72 hours for rates that are higher. n. Velpar has a 90-day PHI for highbush blueberries and a 450-day PHI for lowbush blueberries. o. For use before transplanting only. p. Labeled for postharvest use only. Not registered for use on raspberries in MD. q. The PHI is 3 days for gooseberries and 21 days for currants. r. The PHI is 3 days for gooseberries and 1 day or 3 days for currants, depending on the formulation. s. Different REIs are listed for different activities. t. Certain formulations of the active ingredient iprodione are labeled for use on blueberries but are not included in this guide due to issues with phytotoxicity. u. May be general or restricted use depending on the formulation. v. Individual state regulations may vary.
23
Notification of pesticide applications and information about the pesticide(s) used Maintained contact with handlers when applying highly toxic pesticides Emergency assistance when required A pesticide safety poster placed in an area where it can be seen easily by all workers and handlers Information for pesticide handlers and early entry workers about pesticide label safety information
A centrally located listing of recent pesticide applications on the premises Under WPS, labels now include statements specifying personal protective equipment, restricted-entry intervals, and (on some pesticide labels) a requirement to provide both oral warnings and posting of treated areas. EPA developed these regulations with the non-English-speaking worker specifically in mind. Safety warnings, information, and training must be given in a manner the worker can understand.
The Pesticide Safety Fact Sheet EPA Worker Protection Standard for Agricultural Pesticides from Penn State describes these requirements in some detail. See Appendix E to obtain info on availability of this publication. Other states may have similar publications.
cHEmicaL fumigation
Where certain soilborne fungal pathogens or weeds are a problem in addition to nematodes, chemical fumigation is a short-term solution. Soil fumigants are generally highly toxic chemical liquids that volatilize quickly upon exposure to air when applied to soil. The cost of these chemical applications, which often require custom applicators, can range from about $750 to $2,000 per acre. Despite the cost and availability drawbacks to soil fumigation, these treatments are extremely effective and have a distinct advantage in being able to quickly return old sites to their full productive potential. Most failures with soil fumigation can be traced to errors in site preparation and application.
meTAm-sodium Vapam HL 37.575.0 gal Yes Yes Yes Comments: Water-soluble liquid that decomposes to a gaseous fumigant. Efficacy affected by soil moisture, temperature, texture, and organic matter content. dAzomeT Basamid G 220350 lb Yes Yes Yes Comments: Not for bearing crops. Granular product. Incorporate thoroughly in soil. Toxic gases released following absorption of soil moisture by product. Affected by same factors as metam-sodium. 365 days-toharvest limitation. Higher rates than those listed above may be required for fumigation to depths greater than 6 inches. 1,3-dicHloropropeNe Telone II 1527 gal Yes No No (annual plantings) 2735 gal (perennial plantings) Comments: Liquid that diffuses as a gas through soil. Effective against nematodes and insects. Rates vary with soil texture; efficacy strongly affected by soil moisture and temperature.
1,3-dicHloropropeNe Telone C17 32.442.0 gal Yes Yes Noa Telone C35 3950 gal Yes Yes Noa + cHloropicriN Comments: Liquid that diffuses as a gas through soil. Added chloropicrin increases efficacy against soilborne fungi. Affected by same factors as Telone II. Midas 25:75 2446.4 gal Yes Yes Yes Midas 33:67 19.935.1 gal Yes Yes Yes Midas 50:50 12.622.0 gal Yes Yes Yes Midas 98:2 5.39.3 gal Yes Yes Yes Midas EC Bronze 12.622.0 gal Yes Yes Yes Midas EC Gold 19.835.1 gal Yes Yes Yes Comments: Liquid that diffuses as a gas through soil. Added chloropicrin increases efficacy against soilborne fungi. Allowable methods of application vary with the formulation. meTHyl bromide In the past, critical use exemptions have been granted for methyl bromide purchase by strawberry growers in Maryland, New Jersey, and Virginia on a year-by-year basis. Growers in all states may use existing stocks. Strawberry growers should check with state authorities to determine the current status for methyl bromide purchase, usage, and application.
a. Sealing with plastic and/or using higher rates may also result in good weed control.
iodomeTHANe + cHloropicriN
24
preparation prior to their arrival and may require payment for a minimum area.
fumigant you are using for its specific temperature requirements. 4. Chisel fumigants in at least 10 to 12 inches deep with the shanks set 8 to 12 inches apart for broadcast treatments over the whole planting site. Strip or row fumigation uses less chemical per field acre, but it is a poor option because treated strips are readily recolonized by nematodes and fungi from the intervening nonfumigated strips. Thus, strip fumigation, especially for small fruit crops in narrow rows, is specifically not recommended. 5. Where Telone C-17, Telone C-35, or Telone II is used, seal the soil immediately behind the injection shanks with a drag bar, roller, or cultipacker. Vapam is usually applied through a sprinkler irrigation system, followed by a flushing irrigation of to inch that will seal the soil surface. Leave treated sites undisturbed for at least 4 to 7 days. 6. Aerate treated sites to allow any residual fumigant and ammonia (a temporary side effect of fumigation) to escape before planting. Aeration times vary with the type of material used, soil type, temperature, and moisture level. Check the label for details. At least 2 to 3 weeks should pass between the application of most soil fumigants and the time a crop is planted. Details are available on the manufacturers label. A simple lettuce quick test can be done to determine whether planting in fumigated soil is safe. Collect a soil sample from the treated field (do not go below the treated depth). Place the sample in a glass jar with a screw-on lid. Firmly press numerous seeds of a smallseeded vegetable crop (lettuce, radish, etc.) on top of the soil (moisten if necessary) and tighten the lid securely. Repeat the process in another jar with nonfumigated soil to serve as a check. Observe the jars within 1 to 2 days. If the seeds have germinated, planting in the field is safe. If the seeds have not germinated in the fumigated sample and have germinated in the nontreated sample, then the field is not safe to plant. Wait and retest.
7. Fumigation kills most weed seeds, but it can also stimulate the germination of some species, such as Carolina geranium, velvetleaf, and morning glories. Treat these problem weeds with herbicides before they become established. 8. In the Mid-Atlantic region, because of usually wet and often prolonged, cool springs, the best timing for fumigation treatments with their specific temperature and moisture requirements is in early fall. If fumigation is done at this time, a winter cover crop of small grains or a permanent sod cover can be seeded after aeration. 9. After fumigation, certain pathogens such as Rhizoctonia spp. and Pythium spp. can be quite virulent when introduced if conditions are right, so make sure to plant disease-free crops and use good management practices to avoid bringing in pathogens on equipment.
25
IntroductIon
Weeds harm crops by 1. competing for light, water, nutrients, and space; 2. acting as hosts for harmful insects, diseases, and nematodes, and as cover for undesirable animals; 3. reducing air circulation within a planting which can promote certain diseases; 4. reducing quality and/or yield; and 5. impeding harvest.
Weed Management
contents
Introduction ........................................................25 Weed Control Measures .......................................25 Weed Identification ........................................25 Cultural Practices for Weed Management .......26 Site Selection and Preparation ...................26 Crop Rotation .............................................26 Mechanical Management ...........................26 Importance of Timing.................................26 Mulches .....................................................27 Alleyway Management...............................27 Herbicides for Weed Control............................27 Terminology...............................................30 Determining the Correct Rate .....................30 Application Pointers ...................................30 Influence of Soil and Water (Rainfall and Irrigation) on Herbicides.............................31 Problem Weeds ...................................................33
Weed IdentIfIcatIon
Weed identification is the first step in a successful weed control program. In addition, knowledge of the life cycle of problem weeds is extremely valuable, as it allows us to use control measures in ways and at timings that will provide maximum effectiveness. Conversely, using control measures in a more hit-ormiss fashion can waste time and money and, perhaps worst of all, may allow problems with weeds to become worse. Use control measures that are a match with targeted susceptible stages in the weeds life cycle. Weeds can be divided into three groups based on life cycle. Annuals are weeds that live less than one year. There are summer annuals and winter annuals. Summer annuals germinate in the late spring and early summer, flower and set seed in late summer or early fall, and die when it gets cool. Winter annuals germinate in the fall or early spring, flower and set seed in late spring, and die when it gets hot. Annual weeds are easier to manage than perennial or biennial weeds using cultural strategies because they reproduce only by seeds. For example, timely cultivation or preventing annual weeds from producing seeds can be very effective management strategies.
Biennials are weeds that live longer than one year but less than two full years. Biennials often grow vegetatively during the first year, then flower and die during the second year. There are relatively few biennial weeds in our area. Yellow rocket and bull thistle are two of our more common ones. Perennials are weeds that live longer than two years, often reproducing vegetatively by horizontal shoots, roots, nutlets, or rhizomes, as well as by seed. They may be herbaceous or woody. Because of their perennial life cycle and ability to reproduce by multiple means, perennial weeds are the most difficult to manage. Perennial production, as for blueberries, raspberries, gooseberries, currants, and jostaberries, tends to favor the establishment of perennial weeds because minimal soil disruption allows plants to grow undisturbed. Strawberries, when grown in a perennial system, also can favor the establishment of perennial weeds. It can be extremely difficult to control perennial weeds once the berry planting is established, so controlling them before planting is the best approach by far. Weeds also can be divided into three botanical groups. Differences in various characteristics of these three groups affect the effectiveness of weed management measures and how and when they should be used. Grasses are in a single botanical plant family (Poaceae) and have jointed stems and leaves with parallel veins that are divided into a blade and a sheath that wraps around the stem. The seedhead forms from a flower cluster called a spike which can be further branched into a panicle consisting of many spikelets. Grasses can be annuals or perennials depending on species. Sedges appear similar to grasses at a glance, but they can be differentiated from grasses by their distinctly triangular stem. Leaves are narrow with parallel veins, but they are not divided into a blade and sheath. The seedhead is in the form of a spike or many-branched spikelets. Sedges can be annuals or perennials. Yellow nutsedge, a perennial sedge, is probably the most well-known weed in this category within the MidAtlantic area.
26
Broadleaf weeds are in a large collection of diverse plant families and have wide leaves. They have seeds that easily split into two halves since they are dicots (will produce seedlings with two cotyledons), as opposed to grass seeds that will remain in one portion when opened. Broadleaf weeds can be annuals, biennials, or perennials.
crop rotation
Many difficult perennial weeds such as Canada thistle, bindweed, and yellow nutsedge can be controlled by growing a row crop such as corn or soybeans one or two years prior to the small fruit crop. Herbicides labeled for use in these crops, as well as the intense competition that they provide, can produce excellent control of many perennials. Be sure to double-check replant restrictions for herbicides used on any crop preceding the small fruit crop. Glyphosate-tolerant corn and soybeans in rotation would present no potential herbicide carryover. Metolachlor (Dual, other formulations) can be used in corn and soybeans and provides excellent control of yellow nutsedge. Stinger (clopyralid) can be used in corn and small grains to control Canada thistle. Many other examples of crop/herbicide combinations that will result in perennial weed control exist. In many annual vegetable crops, practicing continuous cultivation can provide a level of weed control that will have benefits in small fruit plantings that follow.
Mechanical Management
Timely cultivation can be used to manage most weeds, though there are a few cautionary notes. It is important to identify the weeds in an area before using tillage. In one trial, repeated tillage was very effective for managing Canada thistle, while in minimally tilled plots, Canada thistle became dominant. However, in some instances, tillage can actually make a weed problem worse by spreading the weed if care isnt taken, as is the case with yellow nutsedge. Another factor to consider when using cultivation is the location of crop roots. Avoid damaging crop roots with cultivation. Strawberry and blueberry roots are especially shallow. Perennial weeds can be controlled without herbicides, but success requires diligence and an understanding of the weeds reproductive cycle. Primary tillage can be used for suppressing perennial weeds, including Canada thistle and field bindweed. Repeated tillage can be useful for suppressing all weed types (annual, biennial, perennial, grasses, sedges, and broadleaf weeds). Most perennial weeds reproduce vegetatively
as well as by seed with vegetative reproductive structures such as nutlets, bulbs, rhizomes, or tubers. Repeated tillage drags perennial weeds vegetative reproductive structures to the soil surface and exposes them to drying in midsummer and freezing in winter. However, you must take into account that tillage generally has a negative effect on soil health, including decreasing the organic matter content of the soil. Weeds with extensively spreading root systems can starve. Emerging shoots use food stored in the roots to grow leaves. The shoot uses food from the root for the first 7 to 10 days after emergence, and begins to send food back to the root after 10 to 14 days. Till the field within 10 days of emergence of the weed to prevent the food supply in the root from being replaced. Continue to repeat the tillage until no regrowth occurs. Be diligent. The control of established perennial weeds using tillage will require months of regular, timely tillage operations. A single missed tillage can nullify months of effort. Cropping options are limited during the tillage period, and the field is exposed to erosion by wind and water during the entire period. Repeated mowing is another cultural tool for managing weeds. Mowing works by decreasing the competitive ability of weeds and also can prevent weeds from producing seeds when timed correctly. Mowing should take place before weeds set seed, or much of the benefit of mowing will have been lost.
Importance of timing
Critical Times for Weeds
Mechanical means for managing weeds are almost always more effective when weeds are small. Managing weeds at this time is valuable because they do not have the chance to become established, thus avoiding future problems. With perennial weeds that have vegetative reproductive structures, weed control measures must be taken during the period of the year when these structures are produced. In no case should weeds be allowed to go to seed. Many weeds can produce 10,000 to more than 100,000 seeds per
27
plant. Most will be hard seed that will not germinate for several years. The weed seeds from one prolific year of weed seed production will take many years to be depleted. Preventing seed production of new and hard-to-control weeds is very important. Also, suppress perennial weeds, regardless of the time of year, to prevent them from establishing.
Mulches
Mulches control annual weeds and provide additional horticultural benefits in many fields. When using mulch for weed control, apply the mulch 3 to 4 inches thick when the rows are weed
free. Thinner layers of mulch may not smother emerging weeds. All organic mulches break down over and time tie up important nutrients, so the use of mulch may require additional fertilizer. Reapply mulches annually or when needed to maintain weed suppression. Choose mulch products such as sawdust or wood chips. Avoid mulches such as straw that provide a favorable environment for rodents such as field mice and voles that may damage blueberries. In one study, commercially available planters paper was found to be effective for suppressing weeds during the establishment year of matted-row strawberries as compared to not using mulch. The plastic used in plasticulture strawberry production can be effective for managing weeds within the strawberry row. Be aware that lighttransmitting plastics are not effective for managing weeds without the use of fumigant prior to laying the plastic. In a trial using a semitransparent blue plastic, weeds grew so well that they levitated the plastic, resulting in the strawberry plants being swallowed underneath the plastic. Fabric weed barriers also are a good option for suppressing weeds and are used by a number of black raspberry and blackberry growers. Plastic mulches could be used similarly. Use of plastic mulches and weed barriers in bramble plantings is discussed further in Chapter 8: Brambles. Whether or not straw mulch is used for winter protection in strawberry fields, straw may be placed in the alleyways of strawberries in the spring in order to offer some weed control. Straw is also commonly used in bramble plantings during the establishment year to suppress weeds. Straw should be removed from these plantings after the first year because it can promote moisture around the roots, which in turn can promote root rots. Applying 4 to 6 inches of an organic mulch (for example, rotted sawdust) at the base of the plants is a common practice in blueberry production. In addition to regulating fluctuating soil moisture, the mulch suppresses weeds.
created when a plant is broadcast seeded in the alleyways. When selecting what species to use as a living mulch, choose a plant that will outcompete weeds but will not creep or spread into the row of small fruit plants. Some grass species, such as hard fescue, meet these criteria and have been used successfully as living mulches in bramble and blueberry production. Living mulches may be used between rows of plasticulture strawberries. Living mulches have also been tried between rows of matted-row strawberries in research trials and on grower farms. However, the strawberries were poor competitors with the mulch, and there were other disadvantages such as increased clipper damage. For more information on recommended practices for alleyway management, see the individual crop chapters.
alleyway Management
The alleys between rows of plants are well suited to the use of a living mulch for managing weeds. A living mulch is
28
relyb
dacthal
2,4-d
Karmex
roundup
callisto
casoron
chateau
Princep
devrinol
solicam
surflan
gallery
cultivation
stinger
(nonbearing b, br, r)
(b in nJ & Md)
(b, br, s, c)
fusilade
ANNUAL AND BIENNIAL WEEDS Broadleaves (sa = summer annual, wa = winter annual, b = biennial)
Bedstraw, catchweed (sa, wa) Gc G Bittercress (sa, wa) G G Buckwheat, wild (sa) G G Carpetweed (sa) F G G Chickweed, common (wa) G G G Common cocklebur (sa) G Common mallow (wa, sa, b) F G Filaree, redstem (wa,b) G G Galinsoga, hairy (sa) G G F Geranium, wild or cranesbill (b) G G Groundsel, common (sa, wa) G G Henbit (wa) G G Horseweed (sa) F G G Jimsonweed (sa) G Knotweed, prostrate (sa) F G Lambsquarters (sa) G G G Morning glory spp. (sa) F G Mustard, wild (wa) G G G Nightshade, black (sa) G G G Pepperweed, Virginia (sa) G G Pigweeds (sa) G F G Pineappleweed (sa, wa) G G Prickly lettuce (sa, wa, b) G G Purslane (sa) F G Ragweed (sa) F F G Shepherds purse (wa) G G G Smartweed, Pennsylvania (sa) G FG G Sowthistle, annual (sa) G Tansy ragwort (sa) F G Thistle, bull (b) G G Velvetleaf (sa) G G G Wild or field pansy (wa, sa) G Yellow rocket (wa, b) G G Barnyardgrass (sa) Bluegrass, annual (wa) Bromegrass, annual (wa) Cheat (wa) Crabgrass, large (sa) Fall panicum (sa) Foxtail (sa) Goosegrass (sa) Annual sedge (sa) G G G G G G G G P P P P P P P F G G G G G F F F G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G P P G N N P P G N G G N N N F P G N P N N N G N G G G N N G PF G G F N N FG FG N F P F G G G G F F P G P N N N N F G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G N F G P G G G FG G G G G G G G G G G FG PF FG P P F P F G P G G G G G G G G G G G G G G G N G G P G G G G P G N N FG N P N G G G N N G P P G G P G P G N G G N G F G G P G G G P P F F F P FG G G F G F FG G FG G F G N P P FG FG F FG G G G N G P F N G G F G P G G G F G G G FG G F G G G G P G P N F N G G F F G P G G F G G G N F G P G G P G G F P G FG FG G G N G G P P G G G G G P P G FG G G P G G G P G G P F P G G G G FG G G G G G G P P G N G G P G G F G P G P G F F G G G N F G F G G PF G F G P P F G F P G P P P G P G F F FG G P G G G F P G G G P P N P Ge P P N N N F N PF G P G F G G G G G G N F G F G G P F G F G G G FG FG G F G F G G G G G F G G G F G FG FG G G G G G G G G N G N G N G N N G N G N G N G N G G G G G G G G G F N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N G G G G G G G N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N G P G G G G G G N N P P N G F N G G F N G F N FG G F N G N F P P N F F F N F G F N G F N G F N FG G F N FG P P N G N N N N G G F N F FG F N FG F F N G G F N N G G F N F Gd F N G G F N FG G F N G G F N FG G F N G F F N G F N Gd F N F P P N G G F N P P N P P G F G G G G G G N G G F G G F G G G F G G F G G F G G F G
continued
(s, b, br, c)
(b, br, r)
(b, br, r)
any crop
(b, br, s)
(b, br, s)
(b, br)
(b, br)
(b, br)
(b, br)
(b, r)
(s, b)
(s, r)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(s)
(s)
(s)
scythe
Kerb
Poast
sinbar
Velpar
select
Prowl
29
relyb
dacthal
2,4-d
Karmex
roundup
callisto
casoron
chateau
Princep
devrinol
solicam
surflan
gallery
cultivation
stinger
(nonbearing b, br, r)
(b in nJ & Md)
(b, br, s, c)
fusilade
S = strawberries; Br = brambles; B = blueberries; R = Ribes; C = currants Rely is partially translocated. G = good; F = fair; P = poor; N = no control; = insufficient data Seedling state only Sinbar does not control pansy postemergence.
(s, b, br, c)
(b, br, r)
(b, br, r)
any crop
(b, br, s)
(b, br, s)
(b, br)
(b, br)
(b, br)
(b, br)
(b, r)
(s, b)
(s, r)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(s)
(s)
(s)
scythe
Kerb
Poast
sinbar
Velpar
select
Prowl
30
which will allow other weed species to take over. Use herbicide combinations, herbicide rotations, and sequential or spot treatments in a well-managed weed control program to eliminate or minimize problems. The recommended herbicides in this guide have been evaluated for crop safety and effectiveness. Information on all varieties is incomplete. Use herbicides with care on new varieties.
terminology
Residual
Residual herbicides remain in the soil and kill weeds through their roots for several weeks or up to several months. Most frequently, they are effective only on germinating seeds, so they must be applied before weeds germinate. Some, however, have kickback activity on small weeds. Weeds begin to compete with most crops within 2 to 4 weeks of planting without application of a residual herbicide. If weeds are present, a postemergence herbicide can be combined with a residual herbicide to burn down weeds and then provide control of new weeds that may germinate. Residual herbicides can be used to control both grasses and broadleaves.
Incorporated
Incorporated herbicides are mechanically mixed with the soil. This application method is not well suited to crops with shallow roots such as strawberries and blueberries. It is difficult or impossible to incorporate herbicides near the crown of the blueberry plant, and shallow roots may be pruned by the incorporation equipment.
without allowing the herbicides to contact the crop plants. The best time to apply postemergence herbicides is when weeds are growing rapidly. Do not treat weeds that are dormant or under stress, as the herbicide will be absorbed to a lesser extent. Most herbicides that enter the plant through the leaves need a minimum rain-free period of at least 1 to 8 hours after application for maximum effectiveness. Postemergence herbicides may be selective or nonselective. They may work only where they contact the weed, or they may translocate and work systemically throughout the plant. Selective postemergence herbicides kill only certain susceptible weeds. Poast, Select, and Fusilade DX are examples that kill only grasses and will not have any effect on broadleaf weeds or harm broadleaf plants. 2,4-D selectively controls many broadleaved weeds at certain times in strawberries. Nonselective postemergence herbicides kill or injure any treated plant. They may be contact or translocated. Contact herbicides work only where they are placed. Thorough spray coverage is essential for good results. Roots of established annual weeds and perennial weeds often survive. Gramoxone Inteon and Scythe are examples of nonselective contact herbicides. Translocated herbicides move systemically in the weed after treatment. Application at the proper growth stage will often result in injury to or destruction of the roots as well as tops of established annuals and perennial weeds. Results of translocated herbicides may not be evident for several days or weeks. Roundup and other glyphosate products are examples of nonselective translocated herbicides.
Be aware that most herbicide labels are written for typical agricultural soils and that many common blueberry fields are not typical. Most coarsetextured soils, such as loamy sands and sandy loams, are low in organic matteroften less than 2 percent. Mediumtextured soils, such as loams, may have 2 to 4 percent organic matter. Soils with a high clay content have varying levels of organic matter but always have a high CEC. See the section below on soil properties for further details. Many traditional black blueberry soils may be classified as loamy sands, but they may have organic matter contents over 8 percent. Have your soil analyzed for percent organic matter. This is a separate test that must be requested from most soils laboratories. If your soil has an organic matter content higher than the choices listed on the herbicide label for your soil texture, choosing the correct rate may be difficult. Consult your local Cooperative Extension service for assistance in determining the correct herbicide rate to use on your soil if needed.
application Pointers
Herbicide application should be accomplished with a conventional fixedboom sprayer calibrated to accurately deliver the intended gallonage of water per acre using flat fan nozzles at 30 to 40 psi, unless otherwise stated. Herbicide rate recommendations are made on a broadcast basis (amount of herbicide applied per sprayed acre, or 43,560 sq ft). Good agitation is needed for uniform distribution of the chemical in the spray solution. It is most important when wettable powder, flowable, or water-dispersible granules/dry flowable formulations are sprayed. Good agitation can be achieved mechanically with paddles or hydraulically with spray material from a bypass line. Do not use the pressure regulator bypass for agitation. If hydraulic agitation is used, be sure the pump has the capacity to spray and agitate at the same time. Tank shape also affects agitation. Corners and edges in tanks increase the agitation requirement. The boom should be modified to reach under the crop canopy. The outside nozzle may be of the offset type to reach into the middle of the row.
Preemergence
Preemergence herbicides are applied to the soil surface. Rainfall or overhead irrigation before weeds emerge is needed to move the herbicide into the soil. Use a preemergence herbicide in combination with a postemergence herbicide if weeds have emerged, unless the preemergence herbicide also is effective postemergence.
Postemergence
Postemergence herbicides kill weeds through their leaves. Carefully apply those that are nonselective to the weeds
31
Nozzle tips may be made from many materials. Plastic and brass tips wear more rapidly and should be replaced annually. Use only stainless steel or tungsten carbide nozzles with wettable powder, flowable, or water-dispersible granules/dry flowable formulations. These products are abrasive and wear other tips too quickly. Flat fan nozzle tips are designed for herbicide application. Most herbicides should be applied with a TeeJet 8002 to 8004 nozzle or equivalent. Most herbicides can be applied effectively with flat fan nozzles applying between 15 and 50 gallons of water per acre. Nozzles that are designed to reduce drift are available.
Soil Properties
Soil can have a strong influence on weed growth and residual herbicide effectiveness. The soil characteristics that influence herbicide effectiveness include texture, percent organic matter, and pH. Soil maps list soil texture. Soil tests that employ the feel method may be inaccurate. A mechanical analysis of your soil will determine the amounts of sand, silt, and clay in the mineral portion of the soil. Have soil texture determined by mechanical analysis one time. The texture will not change unless soil is lost by erosion or other means. Sand particles are the largest, silt is medium in size, and clay particles are the smallest. Soils with a large percentage of sand particles are considered to be coarse in texture and are called sand, loamy sand, or sandy loam. Soils with a moderate amount of each size soil particle are considered to be medium in texture and are called loams. Soils with a large percentage of clay particles are considered to be fine in texture and are called clay loam or clay. Soil particles are negatively (-) charged. The negative charge of soil particles attracts positively (+) charged fertilizer molecules such as H2PO4+, K+, Ca++, Mg++, and many herbicides. The attraction of the positive charge to the negative charge of the soil particles slows leaching. Other fertilizer molecules, such as NO3- and a few herbicides, have a negative charge. Negatively (-) charged molecules are not bound to the soil and are more subject to leaching, especially if they are highly soluble in water. Since substances that are positively charged are called cations, the measure of a soils ability to hold onto cations is called the cation exchange capacity (CEC). Sand is the largest particle in size and has the lowest CEC value, less than 1. Silt is intermediate in size and has an intermediate CEC value, near 5. Clays are the smallest soil particles and have the highest CEC value of the mineral component of soilnear 35depending on the type of clay. Organic matter makes up only a small part of most soils, usually between 0.5 and 5.0 percent in soils across the northeastern United States, but it has the highest CEC value, near 200. Traditional black blueberry soils may have
organic matter contents well over 5 percent. Even small changes in the percent organic matter in soils, especially sandy soils, can have a strong influence on herbicide performance. That is the reason small changes in percent organic matter may require herbicide rate changes. Rate tables may have several columns with different herbicide rates for different levels of organic matter in each soil type. Soil pH also affects the performance of some herbicides by influencing the degree of attraction to soil particles. The pH of soils suited to blueberry production is lower than the recommended soil pH levels for other small fruit crops, which range between 6.0 and 6.5, and vegetable crops, which range between 6.0 and 7.0. Low pH (below 6.0) or high pH (above 7.0) may affect the availability of certain herbicides by changing the positive charge of the molecule. Effectiveness may be reduced and/or herbicide carryover may be increased if the herbicide is more tightly bound to the soil. The risk of crop injury may increase if a herbicide is less tightly bound to the soil and more available. Herbicides that are affected by pH may have Do Not Use warnings on the label if the soil pH is above or below a value that increases the risk of crop injury, herbicide carryover, or poor weed control.
32
soils with a low CEC. Plant nutrients, such as NO3-, and herbicides with a negative charge are not held by the soil, leach more rapidly, and are less affected by soil texture than those with a positive charge. Nonresidual postemergence herbicides have no activity after application for one of two reasons. Some herbicides are too tightly bound to the soil to be available to plants after application. Care must be exercised in soilless growing environments, where surprising residual activity can be observed from these herbicides. Other herbicides are highly soluble in water and are not bound to soil particles. Residual activity from these herbicides can be observed in the soil, but it often lasts only a few days. They are rapidly leached out of the zone of weed seed germination and degraded by soil microorganisms.
Glyphosate productsincluding Roundup products, Touchdown products, Glyphomax Plus, and other labeled glyphosate formulationsand paraquat products, including Gramoxone Inteon, Firestorm, and other labeled paraquat products, are too tightly bound to the soil to have residual activity. These herbicides are completely unavailable to plants after application. They remain tightly bound to the soil until broken down. Glyphosate is degraded or digested by soil microorganisms. Residual activity from glyphosate has been observed when used in greenhouses, on plastic mulch, and near hydroponic growing systems. Paraquat is degraded by sunlight and is less likely to cause problems when used on plastic mulch, in greenhouses, or near soilless growing systems.
Source: Weed Science Society of America. 2002. Herbicide Handbook, 8th ed. Controlling Weeds in Nursery and Landscape Plantings. 2007. Penn State College of Agricultural Sciences. a. pH dependent
33
When trickle irrigation will be used for the residual herbicide weed control program, during the irrigation season choose herbicides that are least soluble in water and most tightly adsorbed by the soil (see Table 4.2). Adjust the application timing in the spring so the herbicides can be activated by 1 to 2 inches of rainfall or overhead irrigation before the trickle irrigation is used. This will allow the herbicides to move into and be attached to the soil before being subjected to the intense leaching of the trickle irrigation. Remember that choosing the herbicide(s) that is least soluble in water and most strongly adsorbed to the soil will delay, but not prevent, herbicide failure and weed breakthroughs in trickle irrigated crops. Coarse-textured sandy soils and soils low in organic matter that require frequent irrigation increase the likelihood of weed control failure, especially during prolonged periods of heat and drought stress. Plan to use repeated applications of nonresidual postemergence herbicides on a regular schedule to manage weeds in trickle irrigated crops. Do not exceed maximum annual use rates. Time the application of residual herbicides to derive the maximum benefit from their use when harvest approaches and preharvest interval (PHI) restrictions will not permit the continued use of the nonresidual postemergence herbicides.
probleM Weeds
Troublesome species tend to become well entrenched in perennial plantings such as blueberries, brambles, and Ribes. In Chapter 7: Blueberries, these weeds biological features that make them difficult to manage are discussed, as well as cultural and chemical strategies, when known, that have been found to be effective. Yellow nutsedge, field and hedge bindweed, Canada thistle, dandelion, goldenrod species, horsetail, poison ivy, quackgrass, Virginia creeper, and white heath aster are covered in detail in Chapter 7.
34
35
IntroductIon
To the passing robin or deer, your fruit planting appears to be a grocery store. In most cases, growers can tolerate a little damage from wildlife, but losses may become excessive if measures are not taken to control wildlife damage. In general, fruit-eating birds, such as robins and starlings, and browsing mammals, such as deer, voles, and rabbits, are the most common wildlife problems. Effective management begins by anticipating the extent of damage and responding with the appropriate control. Before deciding on a control method, if any, you should consider the cost and benefits. Economic costs are not the only costs that should be taken into consideration. Time constraints and the impacts of the control methods on other nontarget wildlife should also be considered. In many instances, an integrated pest management (IPM) plan is the best approach.
crow
The American crow, Corvus brachyrhynchos, while primarily a problem in apple production, may be found in other fruit crops. It pecks deep, triangular holes in the fruit.
Grackle
The common grackle, Quiscalus quisula, has a black body, an iridescent head, and a keel-shaped tail. Grackles consume small fruit, such as blueberries, whole. They often slash large fruit, such as cherries and apples, and leave it damaged.
Starling
The European starling, Sturnus vulgaris, is an exotic (nonnative) species introduced into North America from Europe. It has a black-speckled appearance, short taila feature that differentiates it from gracklesand wings that appear triangular when the bird is in flight. Starlings are not protected by law. They can cause extensive damage to fruit because they often descend on plantings in huge flocks. At roost sites, starlings have been known to come in at 1,000 birds per minute. Starlings eat small fruit such as grapes and blueberries whole, and slash large fruit such as cherries. They peck holes in apples, consume the inside of the fruit, and leave the apple hollowed out.
BIrds
On many farms, bird damage is minimal and growers choose to ignore the problem or just take the loss from birds into account as a management cost. For others, problems from birds can be substantial, resulting in the consumption of or damage to large portions of the fruit crop. Frequently, the amount of lost fruit is not apparent until after control measures are implemented. The type and amount of damage caused, effective control methods, and legal protection vary among bird species. As a result, it is very important for a grower to be able to identify the birds causing damage. A number of field guides for identifying birds are available at bookstores or libraries. Listed below are the species that most often cause damage to fruit, along with a brief description of each bird and the type of damage it causes.
House finch
The house finch, Carpodacus mexicanus, is a relative newcomer to the eastern United Statesits historic range is in the western part of the country. In the 1940s, it was released on Long Island, New York, and has been spreading in numbers and distribution since that time. The house finch has brown streaks and looks like a sparrow. The male has patches of orange or red under its chin and on its sides. The house finch starts at the top of a blueberry bush and pecks berries in rapid succession. Many are left damaged. It also pecks grapes open and feeds on the juice and pulp within. It leaves small, irregular nicks on apples, which often make the fruit susceptible to disease. The house finch causes extensive damage to fruit in the western United States. In the eastern United States, it is not a major problem but may become one in the future.
SpecieS of BirdS
All the species listed below can be problems on various fruit crops. Descriptions of damage to crops other than berry crops are included to aid in identification of causes of damage.
36
House Sparrow
The house sparrow, Passer domesticus, is also an exotic species introduced from Europe. The male can be recognized by his black bib and white cheeks. The female is drab brown. House sparrows damage grapes, cherries, and other small-sized fruit, generally by pecking holes. The house sparrow is not protected by law.
age. For strawberries, bird damage is highest on early maturing varieties. Bird damage to cherries and grapes is also greatest to early ripening varieties. Early ripening fruit may be damaged more frequently because it matures at a time when other fruits are not available.
Netting should be applied before berries color in order to minimize the number of birds attempting to circumvent the netting. Although netting is the most effective means of bird control for small fruits and isolated trees, other methods are available.
LeGaL StatuS
Federal law protects all species of birds except starlings, house sparrows, and pigeons. All other species are protected and cannot be trapped or shot without a permit. The only exceptions to this rule are blackbirds, cowbirds, and grackles, which may be killed without a permit when they are observed committing or about to commit damage. When controlling birds through lethal methods, use extreme care in identifying the species causing damage.
robin
The American robin, Turdus migratorius, is a common and well-known bird. It is probably the species most frequently reported as consuming small fruits and cherries. Robins consume whole cherries, grapes, blueberries, and other small fruit and frequently cause substantial damage.
others
A number of other species might cause similar problems, depending on the time of year and the habitat surrounding the orchard. Species include the cedar waxwing (Bombycilla cedrorum), gray catbird (Dumetella carolinensis), northern mockingbird (Mimus polyglottos), and Baltimore oriole (Icterus galbula).
damaGe controL
The type of control you choose will depend on a number of factors. Use your knowledge of damage patterns and species behavior to decide when and where to use control methods and the types of control methods to use.
damaGe
Damage to fruit does not occur randomly. By being familiar with patterns of damage, a grower may be able to reduce damage or the cost of control by concentrating control methods in particular areas and at times of the season when damage is most severe. Although all farms and orchards are susceptible to damage, it usually is greatest on farms in close proximity to town environments where birds such as robins and starlings are abundant. Damage is generally higher in isolated plantings. In large areas of fruit production, so much fruit is available that the amount of damage on any one site is fairly low. The size of the planting also influences the amount of damage. As a pattern, small plantings generally experience a greater degree of damage than large plantings. Thus, damage can be an important problem for small-scale producers. The time at which the fruit matures appears to influence the amount of dam-
netting
For many types of fruit, netting is the most effective way to reduce bird damage. Netting can be placed directly over the plants or bushes, but for some fruits, such as highbush blueberry, a framework is built and the netting is suspended over the frame. If placed on a framework of trellis wire strung across posts that are taller than implements and workers, inconveniences associated with netting are minimized. The major disadvantages of netting include the high initial cost, the time necessary to apply it, and the inconvenience of working around it. Although netting is expensive, it can be reused for a number of years if it is removed carefully and stored over winter. When deciding whether to use netting, growers should consider the costs of purchasing and installing it relative to the losses from bird damage. In many cases, it is likely that netting will be more economically viable in smaller plantings, both because of the greater percentage of losses and smaller area.
chemical repellents
One chemical repellent, methyl anthranilate (MA), currently is registered for use on small fruits in Pennsylvania. Methyl anthranilate is a colorless to pale-yellow liquid with a grape-like odor. It has been used as a food and drug flavoring for humans for years. In preliminary tests, fruit treated with MA were consumed significantly less than untreated fruit. In addition, human consumers could not detect a difference in taste between fruit that had been treated earlier in the season and fruit that had not been treated. MA should not be applied to blueberry plants, however, because it has been known to cause foliar burns in field studies and has not
37
been cost effective. Methyl anthranilate is currently registered for use on fruits and turf. In the past, the repellent methiocarb (Mesurol) was registered for use on cherries and blueberries; however, this product is no longer registered in Pennsylvania.
Summary
For best results in reducing bird damage, growers should use a variety of simultaneous techniques and start the control program before birds have established a habit of feeding on the fruit. Control is much more difficult after feeding patterns have become established. Growers should also keep records of attempted control methods and their success rates. The methods listed above are only suggestions.
MaMMals
Various mammal species can cause damage to fruit trees and shrubs. Rabbits and rodents such as mice and voles will damage the twigs, bark, and roots of plants if given the opportunity. Deer will browse on foliage and twigs and can damage the bark.
both day and night, with peak activity at dawn and dusk. Meadow voles create surface runways in the grass; in winter, they are active in these runways beneath the snow. Woodland voles build underground tunnels in loose, crumbly soil. As they build the tunnels, they push out dirt, producing small, conical piles of soil on the ground surface. Both types of voles build large globular nests of dry grasses and leaves. The nests are located close to tree trunks, in tussocks of grass, and at the end of burrows. Voles are extremely prolific. Their peak breeding activity occurs between March and October, but when winters are mild, voles may breed all year long. A female meadow vole could potentially produce over 70 young in a year, and the young voles become sexually mature at the age of 1 month. As a result, under ideal conditions vole populations can reach densities as high as 270 voles per acre. Scientists have found that voles exhibit regular population fluctuations at approximately four-year intervals. Populations apparently crash to levels as low as 10 voles per acre after peak years and then begin to build up again. Voles can cause extensive damage to fruit plantings, particularly during peak population years.
girdle large roots, and eat bark from the base of trees and other plants. By the time growers note weak, unhealthy plants, the damage already is extensive.
Signs of Voles
The most identifiable sign of meadow vole presence is a system of surface runways in the grass. Meadow voles create these runways by their feeding activities and keep them free of vegetation. The runways are generally about 1.5 inches wide. Bits of freshly cut vegetation and accumulations of vole droppings (brown or green in color and shaped like rice grains) in the runway are positive evidence they are being used. Vegetation, small roots, or mold in the runways indicate that the voles are no longer using them. Pine voles do not use surface runways, so their presence is much harder to detect. Tiny, elongated tooth marks on fruit on the ground are signs of both meadow voles and woodland voles.
Legal Status
Voles are classified as nongame mammals and can be controlled when causing damage.
damage control
Natural Controls
Hawks, owls, snakes, weasels, raccoons, foxes, opossums, and house cats all feed on voles. These predators are beneficial because they help keep vole populations under control. Whenever possible, growers should encourage these predators, or at least not harass or kill them. When natural controls are inadequate, artificial methods must be used to control vole populations. The fall is the best time for initiating control programs. A number of different control methods are listed below. The greatest success is usually achieved by using a variety of techniques at once.
VoLeS
Voles are small rodents with short legs, stocky bodies, small eyes and ears, and short tails. Two species, the meadow vole (Microtus pennsylvanicus) and the woodland vole, formerly called the pine vole (Microtus pinetorum), can damage any of the small fruit crops and become serious pests. The meadow vole is approximately 5.5 to 7.5 inches long. It has brown fur mixed with black, and its tail is approximately twice the length of its hind foot. The woodland vole is Pennsylvanias smallest vole. It is 4 to 5 inches long and has chestnut or auburn fur and a short tail approximately as long as the hind foot. Voles are vegetarians, feeding on grasses, tubers, and seeds. They also consume the bark of young trees and bushes. Unlike many other small mammals, voles do not hibernate. Instead, they are active throughout the year, at
damage
Voles can cause extensive damage to plants by girdling canes and damaging roots. Damage occurs primarily during winter when other types of food are scarce. The most common form of injury caused by meadow voles is cane girdling at or near the ground surface. Since voles burrow in the snow, they might damage trunks as high as the accumulated snow. Young plants are especially susceptible to attack. Occasionally, meadow voles will burrow in the soil and damage roots, resulting in weak, unhealthy plants. Voles frequently become problems any time cover is present, such as in plasticmulched and straw-mulched strawberries, mulched blueberry plantings, or when landscape fabric is used (e.g., in bramble plantings). They also can cause extensive damage to trickle irrigation tape, especially when it is not buried. Damage from woodland voles is harder to detect because it occurs underground as voles consume small roots,
Habitat Modification
In plantings, the major food sources for voles are normally not the crop plants, but roots and stems of grasses and other groundcover. As a result, habitat modification (e.g., reducing or eliminating grasses and cover) is one of the best long-term methods of controlling
38
voles. Repeated mowings that maintain groundcover at a low height both limit food and cover and expose voles to predators. Where possible, mow wherever grass is present in the planting. Delays between mowings result in excessive vegetation, which, when cut (especially with a sickle-bar mower) forms a thatch layer that protects voles. A flail or rotary mower is preferred to reduce thatch. Establishing vegetation-free zones that extend at least 2 feet from the plants will discourage voles from living near the bases of plants, where they cause the most damage. Vegetation-free zones can be established by mowing, applying herbicides, or cultivating shallowly. Do not allow mulch, prunings, or decaying vegetation to accumulate around the bases of plants or within the rows.
Trapping
Trapping is not an efficient way of controlling voles in large plantings, but it is an effective and safe control method in small plantings or around selected plants. Use standard, wooden-base snap traps (mouse size) and bait them with peanut butter, oatmeal, or apple slices. For meadow voles, place the traps in runways, flush with the ground and perpendicular to the runway. Place the trigger end directly in the runway. For pine voles, locate a tunnel and place the trap within the tunnel and perpendicular to it.
Toxicants
Used in conjunction with habitat modification, rodenticides are an important component of most control programs because they provide the quickest and most practical means of bringing large populations of voles under control. To determine if a specific rodenticide can still be used, read the label very carefully. The label will provide information on rates and applications and list legal uses for the product. Note any restrictions placed on the product. Bait type is an important consideration in vole control programs. Acute rodenticides, such as those containing zinc phosphide, are fast-acting poisons that usually require only a single feeding to achieve a lethal dose. In contrast, chronic rodenticides, which include anticoagulants such as those found in Rozol pellets, require multiple feedings over a period of several days before a lethal dose is achieved. Both acute and chronic rodenticides are available in pelletted bait formulations, which are superior to grain baits because they are more effective against voles and are not as hazardous to ground-feeding birds and other nontarget wildlife. Bait placement is critical to the success of a control program. Broadcast distribution and hand placing of pellets at recommended rates will work, but the best results are achieved by using bait stations. In addition, bait in stations is less available to nontarget wildlife. Timing also influences the success of control programs. Wet weather reduces
Repellents
Repellents containing thiram (a fungicide) or capsaicin (the ingredient that makes chili peppers hot) are registered for vole control. Little data is available on the effectiveness of repellents to deter vole damage; therefore, repellents should not be used as the sole method of vole control. A food-grade product certified as organic is being marketed as a repellent and is not labeled as a pesticide. Thiram-based repellents are labeled for use only on nonbearing trees and shrubs (i.e., those that wont produce fruit for at least one year). Capsaicinbased products are labeled for use on ornamental trees, fruit and nut trees, fruit bushes and vines, nursery stock, shrubs, and lawns. Capsaicin should be applied only before the fruit sets or after the harvest. Capsaicin is registered for use on vegetable plants and agricultural crops only before edible portions and/or heads begin to form. This is an area in which control measures are evolving, and available materials vary. However, to prevent a feeding pattern from developing, apply repellents before damage becomes significant or, in the case of monitored populations, before damage occurs. They must be reapplied frequently after a rain, heavy dew, or new plant growth. Always follow label directions for the repellent being used. Never apply repellents to any portion of a plant likely to
the effectiveness of rodenticides, so apply baits when weather is likely to be fair and dry for at least 3 days. Baits are most effective when naturally occurring foods, such as green vegetation and fruit drops, are limited. Late fall is an important time to bait voles because it serves to reduce populations before the onset of winter, when vole damage is most severe and snow cover precludes rodenticide use. When winter survival is high, baits should be applied in the spring before the breeding season and before renewed growth of groundcover diminishes bait acceptance. Most rodenticide labels stipulate that bait can only be applied during the dormant season, after harvest, and before bud burst in the spring. For additional information on controlling voles, see Penn States Wildlife Damage Control 9: Voles fact sheet, available as listed in Appendix E.
Summary
Keep the grass mowed as if it were your front lawn. This is an excellent way to control rodents. Rodents require lots of cover to keep their natural predators hawks and catsfrom finding them. If the cover is removed, voles wont stay in the area. Use snap traps to help maintain populations at low levels.
cottontaiL raBBitS
Cottontails are active year round and can been seen at dawn and dusk. They tend to concentrate in favorable habitat such as brushy fencerows or field edges, brush piles, or landscaped backyards where food and cover are suitable. They need cover such as burrows or brush piles to escape predators. Cottontails are rarely found in thick shrubbery or dense forests; they generally spend their entire lives in a 10-acre or smaller area. Lack of food or cover is usually enough motivation for a rabbit to relocate. Population density varies with habitat quality, but an average of three to five rabbits per acre is reasonable.
description of damage
Rabbits can feed on plants year round. Rabbits damage woody plants by gnawing bark or clipping off branches, stems, and buds. In winter, when the ground
39
is covered with snow for long periods, rabbits can severely damage trees and shrubs. Some young plants are clipped off at snow height, and larger trees and shrubs can be completely girdled. In addition, the character of the bark on woody plants influences rabbit browsing. Young canes have smooth, thin bark with green food material just beneath it. Such bark provides an easy food source for rabbits. The thick, rough bark of older canes often discourages gnawing. Even on the same plant, rabbits avoid the rough bark but girdle the young sprouts that have smooth bark.
Exclusion
One of the best ways to protect a small berry patch is to put up a fence. A fence of 2- to 4-foot chicken wire, with the bottom tight to the ground or buried a few inches, is sufficient to prevent young rabbits from getting through. The lower 1.5 to 2 feet should be covered with small-mesh wire. A fence might seem costly, but with proper care it will last many years and reduce damage caused by rabbits and other animals. Cylinders of 0.25-inch wire hardware cloth will protect young plants. Due to economic considerations, use is more likely in small plantings. The cylinders should be placed 1 to 2 inches out from the trunk and should extend higher than a rabbits reach when it stands on the expected snow depth. Small-mesh (0.25-inch) hardware cloth also protects against vole damage. Rabbits commonly damage vegetation at a height of 2 to 3 feet, depending on the snow depth in winter. You can use larger mesh sizes, 0.5 to 0.75 inch, to reduce cost, but be sure the cylinder stands far enough away from the trunk that rabbits cannot eat through the holes. Commercial tree guards or tree wraps are other alternatives. When rabbits are abundant and food is in short supply, only hardware cloth will guarantee protection.
damage identification
Rabbit damage can be identified by the characteristic appearance of gnawing on older woody growth and the clean-cut, angled clipping of young stems. Damage occurs primarily within 2.5 feet of the ground. The clipping of small twigs and buds appears as a knifelike slanting cut with no apparent tooth marks. When rabbits gnaw bark, they gnaw in patches. The average width of a cottontails incisor is 0.1 inch. Squirrels and voles also gnaw bark, but their tooth marks are much narrower. Distinctive round droppings or rabbit tracks in the immediate area also are good signs of their presence.
is highly variable, depending on the behavior and number of rabbits and the availability of alternative food sources. When rabbits are abundant, use other control techniques along with chemical repellents. Hinder and Deer-off are available for use on consumable plants such as fruits. Hinder consists of ammonium soaps of higher fatty acids. It is an odor repellent that may be sprayed or painted on the foliage. Hinder has been found to be effective in repelling rabbits and deer from crops and ornamental plants. Deeroff consists of garlic oil, capsaicin, and putrescent whole egg solids. It is an odor and taste repellent that can be applied to foliage, but edible fruits should be cleansed prior to consuming. Hot Sauce Animal Repellent, by Millers, which contains capsaicin (the heat source in hot sauce), can also be applied to fruit trees; however, it must be applied either before the fruit is on the plant or after it has been removed. Capsaicin is a taste repellent. The warm sensation it leaves in the throat of the animal is believed to cause the animal to avoid eating that plant again. The effectiveness of capsaicincontaining repellents varies depending on the availability of other food sources.
Trapping
Trapping can be used to remove rabbits from problem areas. Several excellent styles of commercial live traps are available from garden centers, hardware stores, and seed catalogs. Most commercial traps are made of wire and last indefinitely with proper care. Live traps can often be rented from animal control offices or pest control companies. Dry corn and dried apples make very good year-round bait. Dried leafy alfalfa and clover are good cold-weather baits. Apples, carrots, cabbage, and other fresh, green vegetables are good baits in warmer weather, but these soft baits become mushy and ineffective once frozen. For best results, use baits similar to the fruit on which the target rabbits are feeding. Position the bait at the rear of the trap. Placing a trap involves the following easy steps: 1. Place traps where you know rabbits feed or rest. Check for runways along the edge of cover. To locate an active runway, look for rabbit droppings
Legal Status
Rabbits are classified as game animals and are protected as such. Exceptions may be granted to property owners by their states game commissions, allowing them to trap or shoot rabbits outside the normal hunting season on their own properties if damage is occurring.
Repellents
Several chemical repellents discourage rabbit browsing. For best results, use repellents and other damage-control methods at the first sign of damage. Always follow the application directions exactly. Since pesticide registrations change frequently, check with your local Cooperative Extension service for information on repellents or other new products available for use in your area. Remember that some repellents are poisonous and require safe storage and use. Most rabbit repellents are contact or taste repellents that render the treated plant parts distasteful. Taste repellents protect only the parts of the plant they contact; new growth that emerges after application is not protected, and heavy rains may necessitate reapplication. Odor repellents protect plants within a limited area and do not need to be touching the plant. The degree of efficacy
damage control
Many methods can be used to control damage by cottontail rabbits. Exclusion techniques, such as fences and tree wraps, offer the most effective damage control. Such techniques are the only methods to control damage in areas where rabbit populations are high. In areas with moderate damage, repellents have been used to successfully reduce damage. Because of the cottontails high reproductive potential, trapping and other lethal techniques are not effective over long time periods.
40
and clipped twigs. Place sticks in the ground in front of the trap to guide the rabbit into the trap. 2. In winter, face traps away from prevailing winds to keep snow and dry leaves from interfering with the door. Move traps if they fail to make a catch within a week. 3. Check traps twice a day to replenish bait or remove the catch. Laws exist in various states that define the minimum amount of time between trap checks. Legally, in Pennsylvania, traps must be checked every 36 hours; however, they should be checked every 12 hours, particularly in suburban areas where neighborhood pets may be caught. A commercial wire trap can be made more effective by covering it with canvas or some other dark material. This will cause the trap to resemble a safe, secure environment. Be sure that the covering does not interfere with the traps mechanism.
Habitat Modification
Although frequently overlooked, removing brush piles, weed patches, dumps, and other debris near fruit plantings can be a useful way to manage rabbits. Keeping your grass mowed will remove potential cover that might attract cottontails. Filling old woodchuck or skunk burrows will remove their potential as rabbit homes. Encouraging the rabbits natural enemiesor at least not interfering with themmay aid in reducing rabbit damage. Hawks, owls, foxes, mink, weasels, and snakes all help control rabbits.
stage. They are also abundant in agricultural areas where field crops and orchards are interspersed with forest habitat. Deer are most active during early morning and evening hours. They can have a home range of several square miles, but this varies with season, habitat, sex, and even individual characteristics. Whitetails are creatures of habitmost use the same home range year after year. They also tend to establish one part of their home range for feeding and another part for resting. For instance, if deer establish an orchard as a source of food, they will habitually move into the area a little before sunset to feed, and move back to the woods before dawn to rest. The natural food habits of deer depend on the time of year and the plant species available. During the winter months, deer consume evergreen and dry leaves, as well as dormant buds. In the spring and summer, they eat new growth on woody and herbaceous plants. From late summer to early winter, fruits and nuts comprise a large part of a deers diet.
browsed canes. In comparison, browsing by rodents and rabbits leaves a cleancut surface. The height of the damage, however, might be the only factor necessary to eliminate any mammal other than deer. Another method for determining the source of damage is to search for tracks. Deer leave a distinctive splithoofed track that can easily be seen in damp soil or snow. Monitoring your fruit plantings for damage is an important, ongoing process and the first step in a successful management plan.
Legal Status
White-tailed deer are classified by most states game commissions as a game mammal. As such, they are protected. Deer may be harassed throughout the year, but harming deer is prohibited outside of the legal hunting season, unless your livelihood comes from growing crops or fruit.
damage control
Hunting
The white-tailed deer is a protected game species and the size of the deer herd is managed through regulated hunting of antlered and antlerless deer. As a landowner, you should encourage hunting in your area, especially if your fruit plantings are subject to heavy deer damage. Posted areas serve as refuges for deer during the hunting season and might compound the damage to a planting by concentrating the deer population. Before opening the area to hunters, make sure the orchard is a safe area for hunting. Consult your local wildlife conservation officer for information on opening your land to hunters or on eligibility requirements for hunting.
damage
Deer cause damage to fruit plants year round, but the most serious damage occurs on plasticulture strawberry plantings in the fall before row cover application and on any planting in the winter months when the availability of natural foods is limited. In winter, browsing on canes and dormant terminal buds may lead to stunted or misshapen growth and lower fruit production. Severe winter browsing can reduce plant vitality and even cause death. During the spring and summer, natural sources of forage are readily available to whitetails; however, they still might browse new growth and eat ripening fruit. In autumn, deer might continue to browse and eat fruit within the planting.
Summary
The most effective method of reducing rabbit damage to your planting is fencing or other forms of exclusion along with habitat modification. If numbers of rabbits are low and alternative food sources are available, repellents also might be useful in reducing damage.
Shooting
Even though your land is open for hunting, you may still experience problems with deer when they are no longer in season. Many states allow taking deer for crop damage. Contact the local wildlife conservation officer before you act to ensure complete understanding of all the regulations.
Monitoring
The extent of deer damage can be monitored through direct and indirect observation. Deer might be caught in the act during their active periods in the evening and early morning. Indirect observation involves recognizing signs that deer leave behind. Lacking upper incisor teeth, deer characteristically tear off vegetation, leaving jagged edges that identify
WHite-taiLed deer
The white-tailed deer is one of the most widely distributed and well-known mammals of North America, and it is a common species throughout the MidAtlantic. Deer prefer early successional forests that are in the shrub-tree sapling
Repellents
Repellents are most effective when integrated into a damage-control pro-
41
gram that includes fencing, hunting, and several types of repellents. Apply repellents at the first sign of damage to prevent deer from establishing a feeding pattern at the site. Area repellents include tankage (putrefied meat scraps), ammonium soaps, bone tar oil, blood meal, and human hair. Contact repellents work by taste and must be applied directly to the plant. These repellents work best if you apply them in the dormant season on dry days when temperatures are above freezing. Examples of contact repellents are putrescent egg solids, thiram, and hot pepper sauce (capsaicin). Remember that whenever you apply a commercial repellent, you are required by law to comply strictly with the label. Home remedies often have limited success. Human hair can be obtained from a local barber shop and placed in small bags (cloth or plasticif plastic is used, punch three to four holes in the bottom). Tie up the tops and hang them around the planting or individually in trees. Soap bars can be placed in individual plants. Blood meal and tankage can be hung around the perimeter of the planting, initially 20 feet apart and then closer together if needed. Place these items about 30 inches off the ground, about the average height of a deer. Remember, success depends on early preventative monitoring and alternation of materials. Repellents containing thymol and benzyidlethyl ammonium saccharide, such as Ro-Pel, have been found to be less effective. These products may only be applied to plants during the dormant season or to young, nonbearing plantings. When applied to dormant plants, the new growth in the spring is not protected. Repellents have variable results what works for one grower might not work for another, and success differs from year to year. Some repellents do not weather well and require repeated applications during the season. Also, if deer are very hungry and the area lacks other more palatable food resources, they might ignore the repellents. Success must be measured by how much the damage has been reduced since it is rarely eliminated. In areas where deer density is low and damage is light, repellents may be a cost-effective part of your IPM strategy.
Fencing
Fencing deer out of the orchard is the most efficient way to reduce damage when deer density is high and damage is extensive. The conventional 8-foot, woven-wire fence effectively excludes deer by forming a barrier around the orchard. The fence consists of two widths of 4-foot woven wire and 12-foot posts. To prevent deer from crawling under the fence, keep the wire close to ground level. Unfortunately, deer-proof fencing is expensive, but it is effective, long lasting, and requires little maintenance. An alternative to barrier fencing is an electric fence. This type of fence is designed to change the deers behavior. Although deer can easily jump an electric fence, they will instead try to go through or under it. An electric fence takes advantage of this behavior and successfully trains the deer to stay 3 to 4 feet away from the wires. Researchers at Penn State have developed a low-cost, five-wire electric fence. Through tests conducted statewide, the design has shown to be an adequate means of deer control. The fence incorporates high-tensile steel wire; in-line wire strainers; and high-voltage, low-impedance energizers. High-tensile fence can absorb the impact of deer and tree limbs, thereby eliminating some of the problems associated with soft-wire fences. In addition to Penn States five-wire fence, other high-tensile electric fence designs are available. See Managing Deer Damage in Maryland by Jonathan Kays (Appendix E) for details on design. The disadvantages of electric fences include required high maintenance and regular inspections. You must maintain a 6- to 8-foot-wide mowed strip along the fence perimeter to discourage deer from jumping and to decrease the weed load on the fence. You must also regularly check the electric current to ensure that the shocking power is sufficient for turning the deer. The advantages include a relatively low cost and, when properly maintained, a long life.
the planting. An electronic containment fence can be buried or placed on an existing fence. This will keep the dogs in the orchard but allow them free access to all areas. Most dogs will patrol the edge of their territory; therefore, a closely mowed strip along the fence line will enable them to patrol the entire area. Herding breeds are the most effective because of their natural tendencies to chase animals. Long-haired breeds may be more apt to patrol in colder weather and therefore come in contact with deer in more conditions than the shorter-haired breeds. Place doghouses and feeders near established deer trails if they exist on your farm. This will increase the likelihood of the deer coming in contact with the dog. Place dogs in the containment approximately one month before damage is anticipated. This will allow the dogs to get used to the containment system and the area.
Summary
Deer damage management is a complicated issue with many alternatives that depend on financial considerations and the amount of damage that can be tolerated. A combination of control methods such as fencing and repellents is most effective. If possible, opening your farm to hunters after considering safety and zoning regulations is a good way to reduce the deer herd on your property.
conclusIon
Wildlife damage can be reduced and maintained at a tolerable level if the species causing damage is properly identified and control methods are implemented before a damage pattern is established. Anticipation of potential problems is the key to effective damage control. The use of a variety of control techniques is essential since the offending species can become accustomed to a single method. Wildlife damage to fruit is a seasonal problem. In many instances, damage will occur only over a short time period of days or weeks. Control methods might be necessary only during those short time periods. Observation of damage and damage trends can reduce the time and money allocated to damagecontrol techniques.
Scare Tactics
Another method of deer control in plantings is the use of guard dogs. Deer quickly learn the extent of a dogs range if it is chained. But free-ranging dogs can deter deer from feeding in any part of
42
43
IntroductIon
Strawberry growers in the Mid-Atlantic region are geographically well positioned to reach many major markets. While consumers have become accustomed to seeing strawberries year-round from other production areas, MidAtlantic producers should realize that they have a competitive advantage in being able to provide top-quality fruit (i.e., fully ripe when harvested) to this large consumer base, rather than attempting to compete with berries in the supermarket on the basis of price. Most growers in the cooler and mountainous areas of the region utilize matted-row field production, while plasticulture production is more common in warmer areas. Both ribbon-row production and high tunnel production are also used, but to a lesser extent. In general, there appears to be increased interest in day-neutral production as consumers become more accustomed to the availability of off-season strawberries. Cultural information pertinent to all of these systems is described below, with information specific to each system described later in this chapter.
Strawberries
contents
Introduction ........................................................43 Types of Plants.....................................................43 The Strawberry Plant ...........................................43 Anatomy and Morphology ..............................43 Pollination..................................................... 44 General Considerations in Choosing a Site ...........45 Topography ....................................................45 Crop History and Fumigation ..........................45 Soil Characteristics .........................................45 Irrigation Availability .....................................45 Obtaining Plants................................................. 46 Cultural Systems ................................................. 46 June-Bearers: Matted-Row Production .......... 46 June-Bearers: Plasticulture Production ...........51 June-Bearers: Ribbon-Row Production ...........57 Day-Neutrals: Matted-Row Production ...........57 Day-Neutrals: Plasticulture Production ...........58 Considerations for Organic Production ............60 Protected Culture ...........................................60 Harvest and Postharvest Handling .......................61 Economics ...........................................................61 Pests ...................................................................68 Diseases .........................................................68 Nematodes .....................................................71 Insects, Mites, and Molluscs ............................72 Weeds .................................................................95 Site Preparation .............................................95 Weed Control After Planting ...........................95 Plasticulture Weed Control .............................98 Matted-Row Weed Control with Herbicides ......................................................98 Sample Weed Control Program for Matted-Row Strawberries ..........................98
Day-neutral or everbearer types are less widely grown, performing better in the cooler regions of the area (zones 6a or cooler, and higher elevations) since they are sensitive to high temperatures. They produce branch crowns and flower buds throughout the season; however, initiation can be inhibited when temperatures are high. Plants will begin fruiting in mid-May to mid-June, producinging an average-sized crop compared to short-day types. In most locations in this region, a second small crop is produced in midsummer. The third and heaviest crop is produced in late summer and early fall, usually beginning in August and ending with the first hard frost. However, in high-elevation locations, such as in western Maryland, the heaviest crop is produced in mid- to late summer.
types of plants
Two main types of strawberry plants are grown commercially. They are defined primarily by the time of flower bud initiation and therefore fruiting. Short-day or June-bearing types initiate flowers when days are short, less than 14 hours. Dayneutral types initiate flowers season-long within certain temperature ranges. Short-day or June-bearing types are widely grown in the Mid-Atlantic region, producing most of the fruit harvested during the main MayJune season. With this type of plant, flower buds are mainly initiated when days are short in the fall (late August through early November); however, short days in spring (March) also stimulate some flower bud initiation. Short-day types are actually facultative short-day plants they will initiate flower buds either when days are shorter than 14 hours or when temperatures are below 60F.
44
and last more than one season. In successive years, primary roots are produced higher on the crown, so about an inch of soil should be thrown over the plants during renovation to encourage new primary root development. With good care, plants are able to produce new healthy primary roots above the old ones, thus allowing plants that have had a poor root system in the past to recover. Feeder roots branch off from the primary roots and live only for a few days or weeks. Their function is water and nutrient absorption. Strawberry plants have shallow root systems, which result in sensitivity to deficient or excess water and high salt levels in the soil. Those issues should be addressed when choosing and preparing a planting site. In light sandy soils, the roots penetrate the soil to 12 inches deep with half of the roots located in the lower 6 inches. In heavy soils, roots only grow about 6 inches deep. Runners (stolons) are the plants means of vegetative propagation, as daughter plants arise from them. Runners form during long days with warm temperatures, beginning in late spring and continuing until fall. For short-day or June-bearing types, runners form when days are more than 10 hours long and temperatures are at least 70F. Formation stops when days are less than 10 hours long and temperatures are freezing. In day-neutral types, the majority of runners are formed when days are long and temperatures are moderate. Runner formation is more sporadic for day-neutral types than short-day types. After the development of numerous lateral roots, the daughter plants become independent of the mother plant, usually after 2 to 3 weeks of attachment. In matted-row production, daughter plants will be responsible for producing most of the fruit. Dormant plants in mattedrow production should be planted as early as possible to allow time for them to establish and form runners and daughter plants. Daughter plants that have had more time to develop have larger crowns and more flower buds, which result in higher yields. In later years, taking good care of renovated plantings during the summer encourages earlier production of runners, early establishment of daughter plants, and higher yields the following year.
Flowers are borne in clusters (Figure 6.2). The terminal flower opens first and is referred to as the king or primary flower. The king flower yields the largest fruit, but because it opens first, it is more susceptible to frost than later-formed flowers. The secondary flowers open 1 to 2 days after the king flower, followed by tertiary flowers. Successive flowers produce smaller fruit.
pollinAtion
Strawberry flowers usually have five or more petals surrounding 20 to 35 stamens that differ in size and length within the same flower. Each stamen consists of the filament and the pollen-producing anther. Anthers are a deep golden yellow
when they contain pollen, but they turn pale as pollen is released. Inside the circle of stamens is a coneshaped structure called the receptacle, which is an extension of the flower stem or pedicel. This portion develops into the berry. Each receptacle is covered with as many as 500 pistils arranged in a spiral pattern. At the base of each pistil is an ovary containing an ovule (potential seed). Pollination is achieved when pollen from the anthers reaches the stigmas self-pollination occurs when the pollen is from the same flower; cross-pollination occurs when pollen comes from a different flower. Following fertilization and achene (seed) development, receptacle tissue around the achenes swells to form the berry.
Leaves
Fruit truss
Daughter plant
Crown
Runner (stolon)
Young roots
Branch crown
Mature roots
45
Chapter 6: Strawberries
Some self-pollination is accomplished in strawberry flowers as the pollen matures and is released from the anthers when they split open. The shaking of flowers by the wind and raindrops serves to transfer pollen within the flower. Wind and self-pollination, however, seldom provide complete pollination of all pistils of a flower. Sometimes even flowers that have pollen-laden anthers seem to set fruit far better when cross-pollinated than when fertilized with their own pollen. Incomplete pollination results in small or misshapen fruits, thus pollen transfer by insects is recommended. Honey bees and many species of wild bees visit strawberries for nectar and pollen, though strawberries are not especially attractive as pollen or nectar sources. Even though many types of insects visit strawberry flowers, only bees are of real consequence in transferring pollen effectively. Most growers would benefit from the consistent use of one colony of honey bees per acre, especially if wild bees are not plentiful enough for the flower to receive the recommended 16 to 25 bee visits. King blossoms, besides being the first to open, are the largest, have the shortest stamens, possess the most pistils, and, if fully pollinated, produce the largest berries of greatest value. These flowers benefit the most from insect visits. As flowering continues down the cluster, pollen becomes plentiful, receptacles are smaller with fewer pistils, stamens are taller, and flowers are less likely to set fruit and more likely to produce smaller berries, thus requiring less pollinator activity. Cool temperatures decrease the number of insect visits to flowers and slow down flower development. More malformed berries can be observed in cool, wet weather, with wind exposure, and during periods of heavy rainfall.
Secondary Tertiary
King or primary
best yields achieved in deep fertile soils with high organic matter and good internal drainage. Black root rot is commonly diagnosed in strawberry plantings with compacted heavy soils. Organic matter can be improved before planting by adding manure, or by planting cover crops or green manure crops. For a complete discussion of these topics, see Chapter 2.
irrigAtion AvAilAbility
Irrigation is highly recommended for growing matted-row strawberries and is a necessity for plasticulture berries. Therefore, sites should be chosen where an ample water source is accessible. Trickle irrigation applies water only where it is needed, thereby using water efficiently and minimizing weed germination between the rows. It also serves double-duty as a way to apply nutrients quickly and efficiently through fertigation. However, because overhead irrigation also is necessary to protect blossoms from frost, relatively few matted-row growers install trickle irrigation. Plasticulture growers need both trickle and overhead irrigation. Because strawberry plants are shallowly rooted, they need water in the form of rainfall or irrigation many times during the growing season. Water must be available during establishment, when runners are forming and daughter plants are rooting, and during flower bud formation. Plants first respond to severe moisture stress by decreasing runner production, thereby decreasing the number of daughter plants and the yield for the following season. Flower bud formation occurs in the fall preceding the fruit season (August 20 to October 30), during which sufficient water and fertilizer are important for producing the optimum number and size of berries. Plants should receive about 1 to 2 inches of water per week. Plantings on sandy soils will need to be watered more frequently than those on heavier soil types. Tensiometers can assist in determining when irrigation is needed, though they work best on lighter soils. See Appendix E: Sources of Additional Information to obtain information on their correct use and interpretation.
topogrAphy
A slope of 5 to 7 percent will allow for adequate air drainage for frost avoidance, while slopes over 12 percent should be avoided due to erosion and tillage concerns. If steeply sloping sites must be used, plant wider rows across the slope or on the contour.
soil ChArACteristiCs
Strawberries grow and produce satisfactorily in a wide range of soil types, with
46
table 6.1. number of strawberry plants per acre for different in-row and between-row spacings.
mAtted row/ribbon row In-Row Spacing 3 inches 6 inches 12 inches 18 inches 24 inches plAstiCulture In-Row Spacing 48 inches bed spacing 54 inches 60 inches 66 inches 72 inches 36 inches 58,080 29,040 14,520 9,680 7,260 between-row spacing 42 inches 48 inches 49,783 24,891 12,446 8,297 6,223 43,560 21,780 10,890 7,260 5,445
12 inches D* 21,780 19,360 17,424 15,840 14,520 14 inches D 18,669 16,594 14,935 13,577 12,446 16 inches D 16,335 14,520 13,068 11,880 10,890 18 inches D 14,520 12,907 11,616 10,560 9,680 *Signifies spacing between plants within each row of a staggered double row. Spacing between double rows does not change number of plants needed.
obtaInInG plants
Purchase plants from a reputable nursery. See Appendix C for a listing of nurseries carrying small fruit nursery stock. Certified (disease- and insectfree), virus-tested plants that are true to name are essential for a successful operation. For the number of plants required per acre, consult Table 6.1. Dormant crown plants should be ordered no later than the December before planting since cultivars in high demand often sell out rapidly. Request a shipping date that will allow you to have the plants as soon as the soil can normally be prepared. When plants arrive, check the roots for moisture and moisten if necessary. Plug plants for use in plasticulture (see Cultural Systems) should be ordered 6 months or more before planting. Call the producers to obtain information on cultivar availability.
try. Matted-row production, as the name implies, relies on the establishment of a filled-in row of strawberries from plants that are planted on a relatively wide spacing and is a relatively low-cost way of producing strawberries. Plasticulture production is more intensive and has a higher cost and, thus, is somewhat higher risk, but it may result in higher returns. Both June-bearing and day-neutral cultivars can be used in either system with modifications. Information is provided on each of these options below, as well as on less frequently used options such as ribbon-row production, protected culture (high-tunnel or greenhouse production), and organic production.
Testing during this timeframe allows the grower to apply lime and phosphorus during the fall before planting and to disk them down into the top 6 inches of soil. The optimum pH for strawberries is 6.0 to 6.5. After the initial soil fertility adjustment, only nitrogen is applied annually, unless tissue (leaf) analysis recommends other nutrients. Nitrogen, phosphorus, and potassium rates and timings are listed in Table 6.2. Rates are given as a general guide. Soil tests, leaf analyses, history, and plant vigor should be used as guides specific to your site, especially concerning nitrogen rates. Strawberry matted rows should be vigorous enough to reach 12 to 18 inches in width by mid-August. If the beds become wider and runners develop late into the fall, then nitrogen use is probably excessive, and rates should be reduced. If compost is used for nutrient addition, timing should be adjusted to allow time for breakdown and nutrient release in time for needs to be met. For example, since June-bearing strawberries have a high nutrient demand in the fall as they produce flower buds for the crop the following season, compost will need to be applied in midsummer.
cultural systems
Variation in cultivars, growing conditions, and available marketing channels make many different production systems feasible for strawberry producers in this region. Growers new to strawberry production may wish to contact local extension personnel or simply observe production methods used locally to help determine which production system(s) to
planting
Planting should take place as early in the spring as possible after the ground will no longer freeze and as soon as possible after delivery of plants. If planting must be delayed, keep plants at 30 to 32F in plastic bags in a refrigerator or walk-in
Fertility
A soil sample should be tested during the summer or fall before planting.
47
Chapter 6: Strawberries
table 6.2. recommended fertilizer amounts for June-bearing matted-row strawberry plantings. Rates are intended as approximations. Soil testing, leaf analysis, and plant vigor should be used to fine tune rates for your site. If phosphorus levels are above optimum, no additional phosphorus is typically recommended other than strategically placed low starter rates for spring planting.
Soil estAblishment yeAr Clays and clay loams Nitrogen (N) (lbs/acre) Soil Phosphorus Level (P2O5) Low Med Opt Soil Potassium Level (K2O) Low Med Opt Suggested Application Methods
30 100 70 40 150 100 50 Broadcast and plow down or disk in 2030 0 0 0 0 0 0 Sidedress when first runners start 2030 0 0 0 0 0 0 Topdress in mid-August 7090 100 70 40 150 100 50 Total recommendations for season 30 100 70 40 150 100 50 Broadcast and plow down or disk in 3040 0 0 0 0 0 0 Sidedress when first runners start 3050 0 0 0 0 0 0 Topdress in mid-August 90120 100 70 0 150 100 50 Total recommendations for season 30 100 70 40 165 115 65 Broadcast and disk in deep 2030 0 0 0 0 0 0 Sidedress 2 weeks after planting 2030 0 0 0 0 0 0 Sidedress when runners start 3040 0 0 0 0 0 0 Topdress in mid-August 1020 0 0 0 0 0 0 Topdress in February or March 110150 100 70 40 165 115 65 Total recommendations for season Apply 12 pounds of boron (B) per acre with broadcast fertilizer unless tissue or soil test indicates above-normal levels. 100 0 100 0 100 0 0 70 0 70 0 70 0 0 40 0 40 0 40 0 0 150 0 150 0 165 0 0 100 0 100 0 115 0 0 50 0 50 0 65 0 0 Topdress at renovation Topdress in mid August Topdress at renovation Topdress in mid August Topdress at renovation Topdress in mid August Topdress in February or March*
First hArvest yeAr And lAter Clays and clay loams 30 1520 Sandy loams, loams, and silt loams Loamy sands and sands 30 2030
4050 2030 All except for heavier soils in northern 2030* locations*
*Growers on heavier soils in more northern locations do not need this application unless irrigation or rainfall has been excessive, and may experience soft fruit if excess nitrogen is spring applied.
cooler free from apples or other ethyleneproducing harvest. If cold storage is not available, keep the plants in a shady area, heeled-in if possible, until they are planted. Place roots in water about half an hour before planting and do not allow them to dry out during the planting process. Mother plants are set 18 to 24 inches apart in the row, with rows on approximately 3- to 4-foot centers, depending on equipment constraints. Place the plants in the soil with the roots spread out. The center of the crown must be level with the soil surfacenot too low that it is covered by the soil, nor too high that the roots are left exposed. Planting strawberries too deep can result in poor plant performance and even death. Overhead irrigate
strawberries immediately after planting to settle the soil next to the roots, reduce transplant shock, and promote establishment. A starter fertilizer used according to package directions helps plant growth.
flowering and fruiting stress on the young plant. Removing the flowers allows plants to direct their resources into establishing a strong root system and developing a healthy leaf canopy that will fuel the following years crop. Most blossoms can be removed in two passes two weeks apart. Weeds should be kept under control. Equipment that cultivates shallowly (rotary hoes or finger weeders) and that is equipped with shoes to sweep runners into the row is especially useful. Several herbicides are now labeled for use during the planting year (see section on weed management in this chapter), but pay close attention to following the labeled directions. Sinbar can also be used in early fall of the planting year to control winter annuals, while
48
Susceptibility to:*
Powdery Leaf Vert. Wilt Red Stele Mildew Spot Leaf Scorch Description
Annapolis
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
No
Early
Avalon
Trial
No
No
No
No
No
Early
Earliglow
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Early
Evangeline
No
No
No
No
No
No
Early
Itasca
Trial
Trial
Trial Trial
Trial Trial
Early
Northeaster Yes
Yes
Trial Yes
No
Trial
Early
Sable
No
No
No
No
No
No
Early
Wendy
Trial
Trial
Trial Yes
Trial Trial
Early
MR
Bish
Trial
Trial
Trial Trial
Trial Trial
Earlymid U
Brunswick
No
No
No
No
No
Trial
Earlymid U
Cavendish Honeoye
Yes No
Yes Yes
Earlymid I Earlymid S
R S
S T
R R
R R
LAmour
Trial
No
Trial No
No
Trial
Earlymid U
Medium to large fruit with good flavor. Produces many runners and dense beds, increasing botrytis incidence. Large berry with good flavor and color, but average productivity. May be difficult to find a source of plants. Still a great early season cultivar for flavor and disease resistance. Moderately productive; size runs down quickly. Dark-red fruit with good flavor and uniform size and shape. Resistant to leaf diseases, so caps remain green. However, fruit is very small. Medium to large fruit, bright red with good size but somewhat soft. Flavor is average. First harvest begins with Earliglow, but long season results in high yields. Large aromatic fruit; may have a perfumy flavor. Similar yields and season to Earliglow. Early berries start out large, but still run down quickly. Dense foliage low to ground, results in susceptibility to Botrytis and angular leaf spot. Yields are high, but even the primary berries are small. Medium red fruit with sweet flavor. Has color and firmness similar to Evangeline, one of its parents, but has improved size and excellent flavor. Productive. Developed for plasticulture in North Carolina, but runners well in matted-row. Excellent flavor. In PA, many blossoms opened black resulting in low yields. Resistant to anthracnose fruit rot. Yields well, but has average flavor. More likely to perform better in cooler locations. Susceptible to phytophthora crown rot. Large fruit with good flavor. Productive, but ripens unevenly in some years. Very productive, with a perfumy flavor, but becomes very dark, soft, and bland in hot weather. Better in cooler locations. Susceptible to twospotted spider mites. Nicely shaped fruit with good size, medium-red color and above-average flavor.
continued
49
Chapter 6: Strawberries
Susceptibility to:*
Powdery Leaf Vert. Wilt Red Stele Mildew Spot Leaf Scorch Description
Primetime
Trial
Yes
Trial No
No
No
Earlymid R
Allstar
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Mid
RT
Clancy
No
No
No
No
No
No
Mid
Darselect
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Trial
Mid
Delmarvel
No
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
No
Mid
Eros
Trial
Yes
No
No
No
Trial
Mid
Kent
Trial
No
No
No
No
Trial
Mid
Lester
Trial
No
No
Yes
No
No
Mid
Mesabi
Trial
No
Trial Yes
No
Trial
Mid
Mira
Trial
No
Trial No
No
Trial
Mid
Raritan
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
No
Mid
Cabot
Trial
No
No
Yes
No
Trial
Midlate
Large, light-colored berries with very good flavor and productivity. Prone to fruit rots due to softness of fruit. Productive, with good flavor. Performs well across the region. Drawback is its light orange-red color when ripe. Very susceptible to angular leaf spot. Deep red color with good size, but yields were low in PA. Produces few runners. Growers in cooler locations may want to trial small amounts. Nice size, shape, and flavor. Yields are typically good but somewhat lower than expected. Quite susceptible to anthracnose fruit rot and powdery mildew. Fungicides required for successful production due to multiple disease susceptibilities. Performed well in the Delmarva peninsula, with high yields and vigorous plants. Somewhat less impressive in PA. Allstar hybrid. Productive. Good size and flavor, but light color is disappointing. Fruit can be very soft and prone to botrytis infection. Cold hardy and vigorous. Fruit is large but borne on short pedicels, so fruit rots can be a problem, especially anthracnose fruit rot and Botrytis. Average flavor. Productive berry with good flavor. Size starts out good, but runs down quickly. Fruit is susceptible to botrytis. Productive, but fruit can dark, soft, and flavorless in hot weather. Susceptible to twospotted spider mite damage. Nice fruit, medium-red color, good flavor. Has produced very high yields in some PA locations. Flavorful. First fruits are large but size runs down quickly. Very susceptible to anthracnose fruit rot. Huge fruit, high yields. Produces few runners. Primary berries are oddly shaped. Good flavor, but fruit center may be hollow. For pick-your-own. Sell by volume rather than weight. Susceptible to Phytophthora crown rot and cyclamen mites. Heavy foliage encourages problems with gray mold.
continued
50
Susceptibility to:*
Powdery Leaf Vert. Wilt Red Stele Mildew Spot Leaf Scorch Description
Canoga
No
No
No
No
No
Trial
Midlate
Jewel
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Midlate
Lateglow
No
No
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Midlate
Seneca
Yes
Yes
Trial Yes
No
Trial
Midlate
Sparkle
No
Yes
No
No
No
No
Midlate
Winona
No
No
No
No
No
No
Midlate
Idea
No
No
No
No
No
No
Late
Ovation
Yes
Yes
Trial No
Trial Trial
Late
Older cultivar that has been resurrected mainly for use in plasticulture due to low runnering. May be of interest to some matted-row growers. All-around good performer. Nice size and shape with good color and flavor. Productive. Large fruit, but light colored and somewhat soft. Good flavor. Plants are very vigorous. Firm berry with good size, round shape, and medium-red color. Flavor is mild. Good for shipping. Soft berry with good flavor. Better suited for home gardens than for commercial production. Berries may color unevenly and have short pedicels, so fruit is in close contact with the ground and is prone to various rots. Conical berries of average flavor. Late, but fruit has orange color and is poorly shaped with bumpy appearance. Flavor is good. Extremely susceptible to leaf scorch. Gives new meaning to late season. Nicely shaped berries with medium-red color. Good flavor. Yields are low for the amount of foliage, but the best late season berry.
several herbicides can be used in late fall prior to mulch application. More specific information on weed management is presented at the end of this chapter and in Chapter 4.
pearance. With most cultivars, leaves develop a red tinge, indicating that nutrients have been translocated to the roots for winter storage. At this time, soil temperature at a 4-inch depth is at about 40F. A soil thermometer inserted to this depth can be monitored as a guide for the correct time for mulch application. Apply 1 to 2 tons of wheat or rye straw per acre. Straw should be free of weed seed. The mulch should be thin enough for part of the strawberry leaves to be visible in warmer (zones 6b and warmer) locations such as Maryland, New Jersey, Delaware, and Virginia. In cooler locations in Pennsylvania and West Virginia (zones 6a and cooler), a 4- to 6-inch layer of fluffed straw is recommended. Scatter any dense piles of mulch.
When new leaves start to develop, usually in mid-March to early April (soil temperatures will have risen to 40F), pull the mulch back and leave it between the rows. Remove only enough to allow the plants to develop. Keep some mulch close to the plants to prevent rain from splashing soil on the fruit. If mulch was not applied in the winter, putting it between the rows before harvest is a good practice. Mulch protects the berries from waterborne fungal spores, such as those that cause leather rot, and provides a hospitable environment for harvesters, but increases slug populations.
Frost protection
There is no one temperature at which frost damage occurs uniformly. Appendix A discusses the critical temperatures
51
Chapter 6: Strawberries
associated with frost and freeze damage to strawberries. The duration of temperature for damage can be 20 minutes to 2 hours, depending on wind, humidity, and cultivar. Overhead irrigation is recommended, but if it is not available, late varieties can be planted to decrease the chances of blossom injury from frost. Row covers are often sufficient protection for the light frosts that occur near the last expected frost date. Additional information on frost protection is presented in Appendix A and in the plasticulture production section of this chapter.
soil Characteristics
As with any strawberry system, soil with a high organic matter content and in a proper rotation will produce the healthiest crop. Light- to medium-textured soils with medium (2 percent) to high (6 percent) organic matter levels are best for bed preparation, nutrition management, and plant development in strawberry plasticulture. If organic matter is too low (less than 1 percent), a cover crop should be grown for the season before planting. Since beds are typically formed in August, the cover crop can be grown earlier in the season the year of planting. Soil should be well worked prior to planting, as this is a prerequisite for making wellformed beds.
renovation
Strawberry beds must be renovated annually (immediately after harvest) to thin the plants, reinitiate root growth, retain vigor, and maintain berry size in subsequent years. Follow the steps below when renovating the beds. 1. Apply a postemergence herbicide for weed control. Most commonly, 2,4-D (Formula 40) herbicide is applied for broadleaf weed control. However, Stinger or a postemergence grass herbicide can also be used, depending on the target weed species. Wait 7 to 8 days for weeds to translocate the herbicide. 2. Mow off the leaves as close to the ground as possible without damaging the crowns. 3. Narrow the row widths to 6 to 12 inches using a cultivator or rototiller. Allow inch of heavier soils and 1 inch of lighter soils to cover the crowns to stimulate new root growth. 4. Topdress older plantings at renovation with nitrogen (N), phosphorus (P), and potassium (K) as indicated in Table 6.2. Omit P or K if high. 5. Apply preemergent herbicides, most commonly Sinbar. 6. Irrigate to incorporate fertilizer and herbicide. 7. Continue to irrigate with 1 to 2 inches of water per week through August and into September, especially during dry spells. Neglecting the planting will decrease runner production and the number of flower buds initiated, resulting in lower yields next year.
Fumigation
If needed, a fumigant such as Vapam can be injected through the trickle system at least 2 weeks before planting. Alternatively, other fumigation options can be employed as outlined in Chapter 3.
Fertility
The soil should be tested the spring prior to planting. The soil pH, phosphorus, potassium, calcium, and magnesium should be adjusted according to the soil test recommendations prior to planting. Depending on soil type and climate, the plants will need a total of 90 to 120 pounds of nitrogen per acre per season, with 120 pounds per acre needed on sandier soils in warm climates, and 90 pounds per acre needed on heavier soils with an early frost date. Apply two-thirds of the nitrogen (60 to 70 pounds per acre) prior to planting and the remaining 30 to 50 pounds per acre (higher end of range on sandier soils) in the spring through fertigation. Most or all of the nitrogen should be applied by early bloom for optimal yields, with split applications making more efficient use of applied nutrients. Timing and amounts are presented in Table 6.4. Alternatively, organic sources of nitrogen (e.g., poultry manure) can be incorporated prior to bed forming, thereby providing nutrients in a slow-release form and eliminating the need for spring fertigation. Boron, often deficient on deep sandy soils, is an important minor element for strawberry produc-
52
table 6.4. recommended nutrients for annual plasticulture strawberry plantings. Rates are intended as approximations. Soil testing, leaf analysis, and plant vigor should be used to fine tune rates for your site. Preplant applications are applied to the entire area to be planted. Post-bedding application rates are on a mulched-area basis. If phosphorus levels are above optimum, no additional phosphorus is typically recommended.
Soil Phosphorus Level (P2O5) Soil Potassium Level (K2O) Low Med Opt Low Med Opt lbs/acre Suggested Application Methods 5060 100 70 40 150 100 50 Disc in before bedding 2030 0 0 0 0 0 0 Inject through drip at first flowering* 7090 100 70 40 150 100 50 total recommended 6075 100 70 40 165 115 65 Disc in before bedding 1520 0 0 0 0 0 0 Inject at first flowering* 1525 0 0 0 0 0 0 Inject at fruit enlargment (2 weeks later)* 90120 100 70 40 165 115 65 total recommended Apply 12 pounds of boron (B) per acre with broadcast fertilizer unless tissue or soil test indicates above-normal levels. N
Soil Clays, clay loams, loams, and silt loams Sandy loams, loamy sands, and sands
*Ideally, spring N applications in the amounts listed above can be split into multiple applications calculated at 0.5 lb of N per acre per day, applied starting at green-up.
tion. Once visible deficiency symptoms (bumpy fruit and small crinkled new leaves) are noticeable, yield losses have already occurred. It is important to monitor boron tissue levels in the spring because they begin to decrease markedly as spring growth commences. If tissue levels fall below 20 ppm, an application of 1/8 pound of boron per acre (10 ounces of Solubor, 20 percent boron) injected through the drip irrigation system is recommended. Care must be taken to apply boron accurately because it is extremely toxic if applied in excess. The difference between enough boron and too much boron is small. Plant nutrition is always important in any system. However, in plasticulture strawberry production, the short time available for plant growth, the large quantity of fruit produced and, hence, high plant demand for nutrients, and the critical role of top quality fruit in the economics of this system make optimum nutrition essential. Nitrogen is important for quantity and quality of fruit production. Potassium is important in flavor development and is transported into the fruit in large quantities during ripening. Calcium is important for firmness, and boron is needed for good fruit set. Petiole sap testers can be used to monitor the plants current nitrogen or potassium status in the field, and adjustments to the nitrogen rate can be made immediately. (See Appendix D for sources of petiole sap testers.) Current values were established in Florida (see Appendix E for the source of this infor-
mation) and may need to be adjusted downward if plants appear too vigorous. Values between 600 and 800 ppm NO3N when plants resume growth and prior to bloom, falling to 300 to 500 during bloom and 200 to 500 during harvest, are considered sufficient. Values are expressed as either NO3 (nitrate) or NO3-N (nitrogen in the nitrate form), depending on the brand of sap tester. If the meter readout is given as NO3, values will need to be divided by 4.43 to compare to the values presented above. Tissue analysis kits should be used to submit samples of the most recently fully expanded leaves in the spring at early bloom. Values for interpretation at this time of the year are given in Appendix B.
bed preparation
A center-crowned firm bed with tight plastic is the goal. Soil should be well worked and free from clods before attempting to form the beds. Depending on the equipment, the steps of bed forming, fertilizer incorporation, fumigation shanking, installation of drip tubing, and plastic laying may be combined into one operation. However, on heavier soils, it is often best to shape the beds with the fertilizer incorporated, then lay the plastic and drip tube. High beds promote warmer soil temperatures, which increase plant growth in the fall and spring. They also improve soil and air drainage and make harvest easier and faster. Wide beds allow better sunlight penetration into the plants, which results in higher yields. Embossed
black plastic 1 mil thick and 54 or 60 inches wide is generally used, with beds 30 to 40 inches wide at the top and 6 to 10 inches high. Beds are usually on 4- to 5-foot centers. They should be oriented north to south, if possible. With east-to-west beds, the plants in the southern row on each bed grow larger, and fruit on the southern edge of the bed is more likely to be sunscalded. Water drainage from the field must be taken into account since beds will act as small dams if they block the areas of water flow from the field. No herbicide with residual activity should be broadcast onto the plastic after it is laid since rainfall can concentrate these chemicals at the planting holes and cause crop injury.
irrigation
Drip irrigation should be hooked up in the fall and functional before planting. Plants that are well watered during the fall will make the most growth and will produce the highest yields the following spring. Overhead irrigation may be needed after planting to cool the plants and will almost definitely be needed in the spring for frost protection. Drip irrigation will be needed again in the spring since adequate moisture is critical for maintaining large fruit size, important for high value.
53
Chapter 6: Strawberries
(frigo) plants, or fresh-dug plants. Clean, virus-tested planting stock should be used regardless of the type of plant. Plugs are the standard for the region; if they are available for planting early enough, they result in the most consistent yields and stands. However, in recent years plug plants have not been available as early as needed due to excessive demand that exceeds supply. If you plan on using plug plants, place orders early. Contact nurseries during the winter to ask when they begin accepting orders. Alternatively, runner tips are relatively easy to root into plugs if you have a mist system. It will take about 35 days from tip to plug plant. To root your own tips, first obtain tips from a reputable nursery (see Appendix C for nursery sources of tips). After you obtain the tips, inspect them and discard any tips that are of questionable quality. Trim the runner stubs to inch, sort the tips by size, and plant similarly sized tips in the same tray. Trays with 50 cells are standard, and any standard soilless mix can be used. Because cleanliness is essential, use new media and make sure the trays have been disinfected if they are being reused. Place the hook of the tip in the media, making sure the crown is not buried. Place the trays under mist in an enclosed structure such as a greenhouse or high tunnel, setting the misting to keep the leaves wet for the first 7 days using fogger nozzles of an intermediate discharge rate. Using shade cloth is recommended when temperatures are hot. The time for misting will vary with degree of cloudiness, but 5 seconds of actual misting time every 15 minutes is a reasonable starting point. Only mist during the day. After the first week, gradually reduce the misting time until no mist is applied around day 12. The plants should have roots by this time. Be sure not to let the media dry out. When the plants are 2 weeks old, fertilize them with 100 ppm of nitrogen with calcium nitrate as the nitrogen source. At 3 weeks, place the trays outside, but not on bare soil, to start hardening off the plants. An area covered with landscape fabric works well. Trays can also be kept in the structure if air flow is good. A broad-spectrum fungicide can be applied prior to planting. Also, plants should
be inspected and treated for twospotted spider mites before planting. As always, growers should follow label restrictions and requirements closely. Producing plug plants outside is also possible (see Appendix E for sources of information). Be sure to put down a layer of groundcover fabric before beginning outdoor plug production. Dormant plants, used primarily in more northern locations, are less expensive than plugs, are available in a greater choice of varieties, and allow for earlier planting and plant establishment. However, planting, blossom removal, and runner removal require increased labor costs, and decreased viability of plants due to prolonged storage may require some replanting of the plants that fail to establish. Fresh-dug plants, used in the southeastern states, are dug and shipped just prior to planting, which takes place in mid-October in Florida. Due to the late availability of plants, this option is of limited value for growers in the MidAtlantic region. Chandler is the most widely available plug plant cultivar and the most consistent performer. Sweet Charlie, also available as plugs, is valuable for an early crop but produces relatively low yields and is decreasing in popularity within the region. Allstar, Earliglow, and Seneca have performed well in trials as dormant plants, while Wendy, Cabot, and Darselect, as well as Festival in warmer areas, appear to have some potential based on grower observation. Additional information on cultivars is available in Table 6.5.
tions and from mid-June to mid-July in cooler areas. This type of planting stock is probably most useful to growers in cooler areas of the region (zones 6a and cooler) or to those wishing to try cultivars not available as plug plants. On each bed, double rows 12 inches apart with plants 12 inches apart within each row in a staggered pattern are commonly used. However, increasing the distance to 18 inches between the rows on each bed may improve yields without increasing plant costs (a 36- to 40-inchwide bed is needed), while a closer spacing may compensate for late planting. Plant numbers needed per acre are given in Table 6.1. Beds should be thoroughly wetted a day to two prior to planting. A waterwheel transplanter can be used to plant plugs or to punch holes for planting dormant plants. However, actual planting of dormant plants should be done by hand. For dormant plants, a V-shaped tool is useful for inserting roots into the soil. If the weather is warm, overhead irrigation should be used to cool the plants and plastic after planting. Be sure to place the crown of the transplant at the soil level when planting (see Figure 6.1). Deep planting can promote decay of the plant, while shallow planting allows the plant to desiccate.
planting
In the plasticulture system, high yields are dependent on plants producing branch crowns. Therefore, for this system, strawberry plugs should be planted late enough in the season to discourage excessive runner formation and early enough to promote plant establishment and branch crown formation. Plugs should be planted during early to midSeptember in warmer locations of the region (zones 6b and warmer) and in mid- to late August for colder sites (zone 6a). Alternatively, dormant crowns can be used. Dormant crowns are planted during mid to late July in warmer loca-
54
Available as:
Cultivar
Sweet Charlie
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Wendy
No
No
Yes
No
Early
Trial Trial
Trial
Trial
Trial
Trial
MR
Bish
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Earlymid
Trial Trial
Trial
Trial
Trial
Trial
L'Amour
No
No
Yes
No
Earlymid
Trial Trial
Trial
Trial
Trial
Trial
Allstar
No
No
Yes
No
Mid
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Trial
RT
Camarosa
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Mid
Trial Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Trial
Carmine
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Mid
Trial Trial
Trial
Trial
Trial
No
Darselect
No
No
Yes
No
Mid
Trial Trial
Trial
Trial
Trial
Eros
No
No
Yes
No
Mid
Trial Trial
55
Available as:
Cultivar
Chapter 6: Strawberries
Festival
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Gaviota
No
No
No
Yes
Mid
No
Trial
No
No
Trial
No
PR
PR
No
No
Yes
No
Mid
Trial Trial
No
Yes
No
Trial
Ventana
No
No
Yes
No
Cabot
No
No
Yes
No
Midlate
Trial Trial
Trial
Trial
Trial
Trial
Canoga
No
No
Yes
No
Midlate
Trial No
No
Trial
No
Trial
Chandler
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Late
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Ovation
No
No
Yes
No
Late
Yes
Trial
56
when the planting holes are punched. The ryegrass will reduce soil washing in the aisles after heavy rains or irrigation for plant establishment. If a living mulch is grown for the fall and winter season, do not apply preemergence herbicides to the aisles until after the mulch is large enough to withstand potential injury or to accomplish its purpose even if injured. Floating row covers should be applied when daytime highs outside the cover are in the low 70s (mid-October for most areas). The planting may need to be uncovered if a warmer spell occurs. The young planting is extremely susceptible to deer grazing, but floating row covers typically deter the deer at this time of the year. Heavier row covers (0.9 to 1.4 ounces per square yard) can be used for more than one year, resulting in lower per-year costs despite the higher initial cost. Covers can be held down by a number of means; the most effective holders are stone or gravel in netted, oyster-bottom bags.
age since they will bloom earlier than plants grown in matted-row production. For this reason, plasticulture plantings should be grown on sites that have overhead irrigation capabilities. One layer of row cover alone will provide 2 to 6 degrees of frost protection on clear, still nights preceded by a sunny day, and 1 to 2 degrees of protection when the frost event is preceded by a cloudy day or if conditions are breezy. Pulling the covers on during midafternoon will allow heat to build up under the cover. Overhead irrigation alone or in addition to row covers can be used for frost protection. When used in conjunction with row covers, the irrigation system is set up on top of the covers, turned on when the temperature under the row cover drops below 33F and turned off when it rises above 33F. This typically cuts the time that irrigation must be run in half. A second option is to use a double layer of row cover, which provides additional protection. This technique is probably economically feasible only for small-acreage plantings and works best when a durable fabric is used that can be reused for multiple years. See the section on frost protection in Appendix A for additional information and operating guidelines concerning frost protection.
will be greatly shortened. The high quality of the fruit produced in this system results in premium prices. Other harvest advantages of this system are that the fruit is easier to reach, containers fill faster due to larger-sized fruit, and harvest can take place soon after a rain since the beds dry out quickly. Many growers market the fruit of first-harvest-year fields for direct sale or wholesale product and then allow u-pick on renovated second-year fields since berry size tends to decrease and damage to plastic is of less concern. Straw mulches can be laid in row middles prior to fruit ripening and harvest. See Harvest and Postharvest Handling below for additional points.
harvest
When raised beds, black plastic, and floating row covers are used, bloom and harvest are advanced by as much as a month compared to matted-row plantings. This early fruit commands a high price, but at the cost of the burden of protecting the planting from spring frosts. To keep bloom from starting too early, the row cover can be removed as soon as growth begins in the spring and replaced only when temperatures are expected to drop low enough to cause damage to the plant. This may, however, result in lower yields than if the row cover was kept on. To spread out harvest dates, cover removal from different areas of one cultivar can be staggered, or different cultivars can be used. Chandler will produce crops for a longer period of time than matted-row cultivars will, with 3 weeks common and 4 to 5 weeks of harvest possible. When insufficient growth and flower bud initiation has taken place, however, this harvest period
57
Chapter 6: Strawberries
6. Do not apply floating row covers for the fall since there should have been sufficient time for plant growth and flower bud initiation during August and September. 7. Cover the planting with row covers for the winter in cooler locations (optional for zones 7a and warmer) Double-cropping with another crop (replacing the strawberry plants using the same plastic) can be accomplished using warm-season crops in warmer areas and cool-season crops where the growing season is shorter. Growers are sometimes tempted to hold over plasticulture plantings for a third harvest season. However, this is not recommended. As discussed under The Strawberry PlantAnatomy and Morphology, as strawberry plants grow, the crown elongates and new roots are produced above the old ones. In mattedrow systems, the new roots establish in the soil that is thrown onto the plants during the renovation process, and younger daughter plants also help renew the planting. In plasticulture systems where only the original mother plants remain, the elongated crowns becomes more exposed to cold temperatures during the winter, increasing the likelihood of winter injury. The plant is also dependent on the original root system with few new roots able to establish since they are produced above the old roots but cannot root. These factors, together with a frequent buildup of insects and diseases in the planting, commonly results in poor plant stands, low yields, and numerous pest problems in older plasticulture plantings.
vive the winter very well under the row cover, and should be monitored in the spring. As mentioned briefly above, deer damage can be a major problem, though the deer are often deterred once row covers are applied in the fall. Apply a fungicide to control leaf spots after plants are established. Apply a fungicide plus insecticide or miticide to also control aphids and mites just before covering plants with floating row covers if needed. Aphids and mites should be monitored, and if present, insecticides and miticides should be applied during the late summer and early fall to prevent them from reaching damaging levels in the spring. Removing dead leaves before new growth starts can help reduce disease and mite problems, especially gray mold and twospotted spider mites.
4. Winter injury may be much more severe on raised beds as compared to matted rows, probably a result of the mulch settling in the aisles and heat dissipation from the beds. 5. Removing weeds manually may erode beds.
58
timing of operations
Plants are normally planted in April or May when low temperatures are not expected to drop below the mid to upper twenties with harvest beginning in mid to late June. In plasticulture day-neutral production, plants are usually grown and fruited for only one year. In areas that are cool throughout the summer such as high elevation areas (maximum temperatures typically reaching the low to mid-eighties), the highest yields will be obtained during the summer. In areas where the summer becomes hot (tem-
peratures typically reaching the high eighties or nineties), the highest yields will be obtained in the fall and little production will occur from late July to late August. Plantings may be held over for a second harvest season, but fruit size will drop off considerably. In warmer areas, by the time the second fall crop is produced, much of the fruit will be small as fruit size continues to decrease as the plants produce more branch crowns and grow larger.
Aromas Diamante Everest Evie 2 Evie 3 Fern Quinault Tribute Tristar Seascape
Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial No Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial No No Yes No Yes No No
S U S U U U U T R U
U U R U U U U R R S
I U R U U U U I R S
S U U U U U U T T I
U U U U U U U T T R
Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial No Trial Trial Trial Trial Trial No Yes No Yes No Yes Yes No Yes No Yes
Selva
*R = resistant; T = tolerant; S = susceptible; I = intermediate; U = unknown a. To date, day-neutral cultivars trialed in Delaware have not provided acceptable economic returns. Try new cultivars on a limited basis.
59
Chapter 6: Strawberries
bed preparation
Beds can be prepared and plastic should be laid as soon as the soil is workable in the spring. Beds are typically 4 to 10 inches high and should be a minimum of 24 inches wide at the top, preferably wider. An aluminized or white-on-black plastic (white side up) is recommended to reflect heat. This will keep soil temperatures cool and may shorten the length of time during midsummer that fruit production is suspended. Aluminized plastic is more expensive, but resultant higher yields have more than paid for the additional cost. Availability of aluminized plastic may be limited. Current suppliers of plastic are listed in Appendix E. Rows should be oriented north to south to minimize sunscald, unless other factors such as erosion potential are of greater concern.
Also due to low mineralization rates (as low as 10 percent of the total nitrogen may become available per year) you may need to add considerable amounts of the product. Commercial granular fertilizers should be incorporated into the soil just prior to forming beds and applying the plastic. If organic sources of nutrients are used, which tend to work as slow-release fertilizers, all of the nutrients can be applied prior to planting. If inorganic sources are used, either half can be worked in prior to planting with the remainder fertigated weekly, or all of the nutrients can be applied through fertigation one or two times per week during routine watering cycles.
development and prevent the plants from getting too tall. During this time, remove flower trusses as they emerge and any runners that may appear. Plants should be monitored for pests such as two-spotted spider mites and foliar diseases and be treated if necessary. The plugs should be ready for planting into the field in approximately 8 weeks. Dormant plants may also be planted directly through the plastic using a V-shaped planting tool after holes are punched. Production will not begin until 3 to 4 weeks after the time that plug plants would have begun producing, plus yield per harvest will be lower for an additional few weeks. Thus, yields will be somewhat reduced.
plant sources
As with June-bearer plasticulture production, plug plants allow for ease of planting and rapid establishment of the planting. With day-neutrals, however, because production will begin shortly after planting, a larger plug size is recommended. Few sources of plug plants of recommended day-neutral cultivars exist, and shipping the larger size plants recommended for this system (see below) is generally not economically feasible. Thus, growers intending to use plug plants should plan for growing plug plants on their own. Plugs can be established easily in a nonheated greenhouse as long as temperatures inside the greenhouse do not reach below freezing. Bare root day neutral plants should be obtained 8 to 10 weeks before the desired planting date. The plants roots should be trimmed sufficiently to allow them to be planted into 32- to 40-cell planting trays without being J-rooted. Using deep trays (3 inches) will allow for more roots to be retained and will encourage additional new root growth. The plants should be planted in a good quality soilless mix that is well drained. A slow-release fertilizer such as 2020-20 with micronutrients should be incorporated into the mix at a rate of 1.5 ounces per cubic foot or as recommended by the manufacturer. Alternatively, plants may be watered with a 100 ppm N solution of soluble fertilizer beginning 3 weeks after planting. The plants should be kept cool, preferably between 40 and 60F, as this will encourage root
variety selection
Seascape is the most widely used day neutral variety in the East. Seascape has a sweet flavor, desirable shaped fruit, and medium red color. Its shortcomings are only average fruit size, a strong tendency to soften and split during adverse weather conditions, and susceptibility to powdery mildew. Albion produces considerably lower total yields, but its large fruit are durable even during rainy spells, resulting in a very high proportion of marketable fruit. Flavor is good when fruit is fully ripe. Additional information on these cultivars and characteristics of other day-neutral cultivars are outlined in Table 6.6.
soil Fertility
A soil sample should be submitted during the fall prior to planting the strawberries. The pH should be between 6.0 and 6.5 for maximum availability of plant nutrients, so lime should be worked in well ahead of planting. Adequate nutrients must be available throughout the growing season to produce high yields. Because yields as high as 20,000 pounds of fruit per acre may be obtained from plants that are planted in the spring of the year, sufficient nutrient availability is important. Plant nutrient needs are thought to be similar to those of high-yielding June-bearing cultivars, which can produce similar per-acre yields. A soil test is recommended prior to planting, as some of the phosphorus and potassium may already be available from native or past added nutrients. Plant nutrients can be worked into the soil prior to making the bed and applying the plastic, or they can be applied through the drip tape. A number of different sources can be used to provide nutrients. Organic inputs such as composts and green manure crops can provide adequate nutrition. Mineralization of nutrients from organic sources into plant-available forms is a gradual process, so organic nutrient sources should be worked into the soil a minimum of two weeks prior to planting.
planting
Plants can take temperatures as low as 25F before damage will occur to the crown. Plants may be planted any time after lows are expected to be higher than 25F as long as air temperatures will remain above freezing for 2 to 3 days after planting. This will allow plants to become established. Be sure to thoroughly wet the beds a day or two before planting. On each bed, a double row of plants should be planted that are 12 inches apart in each row and 12 to 16 inches between rows. Stagger the plants in the double rows to utilize the entire plastic surface as the plants mature. The plugs should be planted so that the roots are covered, but also make sure the growing point is not covered. Water the plants shortly after planting.
60
Remove any blossoms at planting. A trial in Garrett County, MD, indicated that it is not necessary to remove blossoms from plug plants after the plants have been planted. While no recent studies have been done to determine the necessity of flower removal from dormant plants, it is recommended to remove the first flush of flower blossoms to allow the plants to become established without the additional stress of producing a crop.
irrigation
Adequate moisture is critical for producing large fruit at any time, but especially during the summer months. After the plants are established, apply sufficient trickle irrigation to supply a minimum of 1 inch of water to the bed each week, more during hot spells. For a bed that is wetted 2.5 feet wide using a trickle tape with a flow rate of 0.45 gallons per 100 ft per minute at 10 psi, this would require 5.8 hours of run time per week, or approximately three two-hour irrigation cyles. As discussed above, nutrients may be fertigated during irrigation cycles.
tle populations build as the summer progresses; hence, it is important to scout for these pests and take corrective measures if needed. Long-necked seed bug, which produces symptoms similar to tarnished plant bug damage, has also been problematic in day-neutral plantings. Japanese beetles, typically only a sporadic problem on strawberry foliage, can burrow into fruit that is produced during the summer. Powdery mildew can be problematic on Seascape, and some day-neutral cultivars are quite susceptible to fruit anthracnose. Disease susceptibilities specific to various day-neutral cultivars are covered in Table 6.6. Because of frequent and constant summer harvest in some locations, only pesticides that have a very short to zeroday harvest interval can be used. In addition, due to the nearly constant presence of flowers, care should be taken to protect pollinators. See Table 3.1 for ratings of pesticide safety to honey bees.
produced organically. The standards for planting plug plants and crowns are dependent on whether they will be used in an annual or perennial cropping system. Plug plants or crowns kept for only one year are considered annual seedlings or planting stock and must be organically produced (e.g., as with annual strawberry plasticulture, with day-neutral plantings harvested the first year, or if blossoms are not removed and berries are picked the first year in traditional matted rows). Berries picked more than one year from planting can be marketed as organic even if nonorganic plug plants and crowns were used, as long as the plants were managed organically for at least one year before berries were harvested in an organically certified system. According to the National Organic Standard, organic growers using plastic mulch must remove it from the field at the end of the first growing or harvest season. Interpretation of what this means for plasticulture production can vary by certifying agency.
Frost protection
Frost protection may be a concern for fall production. Production may be extended considerably if row covers are pulled on during early frost events. For spring frost protection of plantings that are being fruited for a second year, see frost protection information mentioned in earlier sections and Appendix A.
proteCted Culture
Some growers have expressed interest in alternative production systems, primarily with the intent of producing berries earlier in the year or during the off-season when production otherwise might not be possible. Both high tunnel and greenhouse production involve higher costs than field production, and recommendations may not yet exist for solving some potential problems. Production difficulties can be considerably different in type or magnitude from those encountered in field production. For these reasons, growers are advised to proceed with caution when embarking on a new enterprise in these areas. We expect, however, that interest in these systems will grow and that the amount of production under protected cultivation will increase as more information becomes available.
harvest Considerations
Because day-neutral strawberries produce fruit for a long period, conditions at harvest time will vary greatly during the season. Fruit quality will be greatest if the strawberries are harvested at least three times per week, but during wet or hot periods, even more frequent picking may be needed. See Harvest and Postharvest Handling below for additional details.
61
Chapter 6: Strawberries
than in the field if necessary. Of Junebearing cultivars normally recommended for strawberry plasticulture, Chandler seems especially adaptable to this system. Sweet Charlie is likely to break dormancy far too early in high tunnels, flowering in January. Soil preparation and planting are carried out as for field production, with the exception that narrower beds and/or closer bed spacing can be used to allow more strawberry plants to fit in the tunnel. Plants should be well watered during the fall. Row covers for winter protection are necessary in single-bay tunnels only in the coldest locations and will also be needed in multibay tunnels where the plastic is removed for the winter. Care during the spring is similar to that of field production, with the exception that pollinators may need to be introduced since resident pollinators are not likely to be active when the plants start to bloom. Bumble bees or mason bees have been used successfully for pollination, but care must be taken to keep temperatures in ranges within which they can survive. Honey bees can be used, but they tend to become disoriented in the tunnel. Yields can be easily advanced by 3 weeks over field plasticulture production and can be expected to be at least 25 percent higher. If day-neutrals are grown in high tunnels, it may make more sense to plant them in late summer and fruit them for the fall and spring, rather than plant in the spring and fruit for the summer and fall. The high temperatures reached in high tunnels during the summer in not conducive to strawberry production, making the amount of fruit produced relatively low for the effort and cost. Powdery mildew is likely to be a problem on either type of plant. Interpretation of which pesticides can be used in tunnels varies from state to state. In most cases, pesticides used in greenhouse production or those that dont specifically state that they are only for field production can be used. However, state regulations should be checked. Twospotted spider mites are very likely to problematic, so monitoring should be continual from the time of planting onward. Predatory mites have given good control when released while spider mite populations are still low (i.e., fewer than 20 mites on a few isolated leaves). In
situations where tunnels have been kept closed during the winter, thus resulting in mild soil conditions, soil-dwelling insects such as sowbugs and earwigs may build to high populations. On occasion, they become a fruit-feeding pest, causing losses of marketable fruit.
greenhouse production
Considerable work on greenhouse strawberry production has taken place at Cornell University and at USDAs Appalachian Fruit Research Station in Kearneysville, West Virginia. Production costs will be fairly high. At Cornell, a break-even price of $3.00 per pint was calculated. Growers interested in additional information should consult the NRAES Strawberry Production Guide or other sources of information (see Appendix E to obtain). Briefly described, in this system dormant crowns are planted in pots, grown outdoors until late fall, and then cold stored at 28 to 30F. Both June-bearing and day-neutral types have been used successfully. Plants are moved into the greenhouse at intervals for fruit production 10 to 13 weeks later. Supplemental light and a day/night temperature regime of 75/55F is used. Nutrients are provided both in the mix and with a complete fertilizer solution that supplies 50 to 100 ppm nitrogen. Bumble bees were found to work well as pollinators. Powdery mildew and twospotted spider mites are likely to be problems, as in high tunnel production. In addition, other insects that are common greenhouse pests (e.g., fungus gnats and thrips) and gray mold have been encountered as problems. Vigilant scouting and early release of biocontrol agents can prevent many of these pests from developing into significant problems.
convection to remove field heat. Strawberries should then be refrigerated at 32 to 33F. This is especially important if fruit is sold wholesale. However, since refrigeration may affect the sheen on the fruit, some growers who sell the fruit on their farms prefer avoiding refrigeration by picking only what they can sell the same day. Regardless of how fruit will be marketed, hiring enough labor to finish harvesting by noon is wise. This allows berries to be harvested before they build up field heat, which increases the rate of ripening and decay. This is of less concern with pick-your-own operations since the fruit is more likely to be used quickly.
economIcs
The strawberry budgets given here were prepared to provide general information and do not apply to any specific operation. Use them, with appropriate modifications, as guides for preparing budgets for individual situations. Budgets can be used: for general farm business planning purposes as a basis for obtaining credit to project cash flows to assess profitability Using these sample budgets as guides should help ensure that all costs and receipts are included in budgets you prepare for your farm. Costs are often difficult to estimate in budget preparation because they are numerous and variable. Therefore, you should think of these budgets as a first approximation and then make appropriate adjustments using the Your Farm column to add, delete, and adjust items to reflect your specific growing conditions and resource situation. The sample cost of production budgets were developed using a computerized budget generator. Input data reflect recommended production practices and current input costs. Major subheadings in the budgets are variable costs, fixed costs, and total specified costs. They are defined as follows: Variable costs are costs that vary depending on the level of production. These include such inputs as fertilizer, herbicides, insecticides, fungicides, and labor.
62
Fixed costs are costs that do not vary by level of production and are incurred by virtue of owning assets such as machinery and land. Depreciation and taxes are examples. Total specified costs are the sum of variable and fixed costs. Most landpreparation activities are assumed to be custom hired in these budgets because the small acreages for many berry farms do not justify the ownership of these implements. If you use your own tillage equipment, the variable costs for custom hire should be subtracted from the budgets and your labor variable costs and machinery fixed costs should be substituted. For matted-row production, costof-production budgets are presented for the years of land preparation (Table 6.7), planting (Table 6.8), and mature production (Table 6.9). For plasticulture production, cost-of-production budgets are presented for the year of land preparation and planting (Table 6.11) and the first harvest year (Table 6.12). Returns to risk and management is the estimated profit attributable to the acceptance of risk and the contribution of management expertise by the grower (Tables 6.10 and 6.13). The tables estimate the return to the grower for a range of prices and yields. Because yields, grades, and prices are so variable, growers should use representative values for their operations. It is important to account for cash flows over the life of the investment when assessing the overall profitability of the enterprise, so prorated land preparation and planting costs are subtracted in the estimates. Breakeven prices and yields are shown in the tables. Breakeven price is an estimate of the unit price required to cover all costs at a given yield; it is also the average cost per unit of production. Breakeven yield is an estimate of the yield required to cover all costs at a given price. Berry production involves large initial investments and can be very risky; weather- and animal-related crop losses are common and crop prices can be highly variable. Use of whole-farm risk management tools such as AGRLite crop insurance can help you reduce these risks.
A land charge of $150/acre has been included in the budgets, but this charge can vary greatly from location to location. If you own the land, you could include your principal, interest payments, and property taxes as a fixed cost. If you lease the land, then the annual rental cost could be included as a variable cost. Production assumptions used in generating the budgets in both systems include the following: Fumigation is not used in matted-row production, though under certain conditions, fumigation may be warranted. Fumigation is used for plasticulture production. Irrigation system costs are calculated assuming that water is applied to 5 acres. Fungicides are rotated to reduce the likelihood of disease resistance. The numbers of pesticide and irrigation applications are average. In any given year or location, growers will need to adjust these for their particular sets of circumstances. Berries are harvested and sold as ready picked in quart pulp containers.
63
Chapter 6: Strawberries
table 6.7. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year of land preparation for matted-row strawberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Soil test Custom apply lime Moldboard plowing Disking Grass seeding Herbicides Glyphosate 4 Seed Annual ryegrass seed Labor Hired Operator Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost* Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs acre acre acre 2.84 3.41 150.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 2.84 3.41 6.25 150.00 318.46 hour hour gal acre acre 13.50 15.00 3.25 2.32 1.65 0.50 0.60 1.63 1.00 1.00 6.75 9.06 5.30 2.32 1.65 3.47 162.21 lb 0.35 25.00 8.75 gal 35.00 0.50 17.50 each ton acre acre acre 10.00 24.00 19.10 18.50 11.90 1.00 2.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 10.00 48.00 19.10 18.50 11.90 Unit Price ($) Quantity Amount ($) Your Farm ($)
*Estimated fixed costs in this budget assume that all field operations for land preparation are done by custom operators. Ownership of tillage equipment, grain drills, and grass seeders is not economically justified for growers engaged solely in small fruit production. Fixed costs in this budget reflect the ownership of a sprayer and mower.
64
table 6.8. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: planting year for matted-row strawberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Moldboard plowing Spread dry fertilizer Disking Fertilizer 10-10-10 Urea Fungicides Captan 80W Nova 40W Herbicides Devrinol 50DF Sinbar 80WP Insecticides/Miticides Agri-Mek Brigade WSB Other Straw Strawberry plants* Overhead irrigation Overhead operating Labor Hired Operator Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs
*Shipping costs are included in the prices calculated.
Unit
Price ($)
Quantity
Amount ($)
acre acre acre lb lb lb oz lb lb oz lb ton each acre inch hour hour gal acre acre
19.10 9.20 18.50 0.12 0.48 6.29 3.80 11.20 39.41 3.16 19.25 150.00 0.14 200.00 30.00 13.50 15.00 3.25 6.66 8.44
1.00 2.00 1.00 300.00 130.00 6.00 5.00 8.00 0.50 16.00 1.00 1.20 6,500.00 1.00 12.00 54.00 8.01 7.61 1.00 1.00
19.10 18.40 18.50 36.00 63.57 37.74 19.00 89.60 19.70 50.56 19.25 180.00 910.00 200.00 360.00 729.00 120.18 24.75 6.66 8.44 122.66 3,053.12 12.63 17.43 30.06 150.00 3,233.18
65
Chapter 6: Strawberries
table 6.9. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: mature planting of matted-row strawberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Spread dry fertilizer Fertilizer Urea Fungicides Captan 80W Elevate 50WDG Switch62.5 WDG Herbicides 2,4-D amine Chateau WDG Devrinol 50DF Sinbar 80WP Insecticides Admire Pro Brigade WSB Endosulfan 50W Provado 1.6F Other Overhead irrigation Overhead operating Plant analysis kit Straw Pulp box, 1 qt* Tray, holds 8 qts* Labor Hired Operator Berry harvest Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs
*Shipping costs are included in the prices calculated.
Unit
Price ($)
Quantity
Amount ($)
acre lb lb lb oz gal oz lb lb oz lb lb oz acre inch each ton each each hour hour qt gal acre acre
9.20 0.48 6.29 43.55 4.80 15.48 6.74 11.20 35.71 9.79 19.25 7.68 1.66 200.00 30.00 24.00 150.00 0.17 1.20 3.50 5.00 0.60 3.25 13.08 16.04
1.00 90.00 18.00 3.00 14.00 0.25 3.00 8.00 0.50 24.00 1.00 2.00 3.75 1.00 16.00 1.00 2.00 7,000.00 875.00 34.50 4.98 7,000.00 12.79 1.00 1.00
9.20 44.01 113.22 130.65 67.20 3.87 20.22 89.60 17.86 234.96 19.25 15.36 6.23 200.00 480.00 24.00 300.00 1,190.00 1,050.00 465.75 74.67 4,200.00 41.59 13.08 16.04 311.51 9,130.26 27.01 30.50 57.51 150.00 9,337.77
66
table 6.10. returns to risk and management for matted-row strawberries, 2009.
Price ($/quart) $1.50 $2.00 $2.50 $3.00 $3.50 Breakeven price
5,000 -$1,182 $1,318 $3,818 $6,318 $8,818 $1.74 6,000 -$602 $2,398 $5,398 $8,398 $11,398 $1.60 Yield (qt/A) 7,000 8,000 -$22 $558 $3,478 $4,558 $6,978 $8,558 $10,478 $12,558 $13,978 $16,558 $1.50 $1.43 9,000 $1,138 $5,638 $10,138 $14,638 $19,138 $1.37
Prorated land preparation and planting costs included based on a productive life of three years. One quart of strawberries weighs approximately 1.4 pounds.
table 6.11. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: planting year for strawberry plasticulture.
Item Variable Cost Custom Soil test Custom apply lime Moldboard plowing Spread dry fertilizer Disking Plastic mulch laying Fertilizer 10-10-10 Urea Other Black plastic mulch Drip tape Trickle operating Strawberry plugs* Row covers Vapam Labor Hired Operator Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs
*Shipping costs are not included assuming plants will be picked up by grower.
Unit
Price ($)
Quantity
Amount ($)
each ton acre acre acre acre lb lb roll roll inch each acre gal hour hour gal acre acre
10.00 24.00 19.10 9.20 18.50 50.00 0.12 0.48 100.00 21.00 20.00 0.22 1,500.00 9.60 13.50 15.00 3.25 4.00 1.86
1.00 2.00 1.00 1.00 2.00 1.00 300.00 75.00 5.80 8.70 13.50 17,424.00 1.00 27.30 16.50 6.00 3.52 1.00 1.00
10.00 48.00 19.10 9.20 37.00 50.00 36.00 36.67 580.00 182.70 270.00 3,833.28 1,500.00 262.08 222.75 90.00 11.44 4.00 1.86 115.28 7,319.36 8.26 3.29 11.55 150.00 7,480.91
67
Chapter 6: Strawberries
table 6.12. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: mature planting for strawberry plasticulture.
Item Variable Cost Fertilizer Soluble 20-20-20 Fungicides Abound Captan 80W Elevate 50WDG Topsin-M 70WSB Switch 62.5 WDG Herbicides Gramoxone Max Insecticides Agri-Mek Brigade WSB Endosulfan 50WP Other Overhead irrigation Overhead operating Trickle operating Plant analysis kit Pulp box, 1 qt* Tray, holds 8 qts* Plastic mulch disposal Labor Hired Operator Berry harvest hour hour qt gal 13.50 15.00 0.60 3.25 3.29 4.20 26.50 1.65 8,000.00 2.90 1.00 1.00 357.75 24.78 4,800.00 9.45 3.29 4.20 198.47 9,030.88 6.79 8.40 15.19 150.00 9,196.07 acre inch inch acre each each acre 200.00 30.00 20.00 24.00 0.17 1.20 50.00 1.00 4.00 12.00 1.00 8,000.00* 1,000.00* 1.00 200.00 120.00 240.00 24.00 1,360.00 1,200.00 50.00 oz lb lb 3.16 19.25 7.68 16.00 1.00 2.00 50.56 19.25 15.36 gal 45.00 0.09 4.24 gal lb lb lb oz 229.85 6.29 43.55 17.33 4.80 0.09 6.00 3.00 1.00 14.00 20.69 37.74 130.65 17.33 67.20 lb 1.85 60.00 111.00 Unit Price ($) Quantity Amount ($) Your Farm ($)
Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors acre Implements acre Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs
*Shipping costs are included in the prices calculated.
68
table 6.13. returns to risk and management for plasticulture strawberries, 2009.
Price ($/quart) $2.50 $3.00 $3.50 $4.00 $4.50 Breakeven price 6,000 -$155 $2,845 $5,845 $8,845 $11,845 $2.53 7,000 $1,425 $4,925 $8,425 $11,925 $15,425 $2.30 Yield (qt/A) 8,000 9,000 $3,005 $4,585 $7,005 $9,085 $11,005 $13,585 $15,005 $18,085 $19,005 $22,585 $2.12 $1.99 10,000 $6,165 $11,165 $16,165 $21,165 $26,165 $1.88 Breakeven yield 6,098 4,632 3,735 3,128 2,691
Causal Agent: The fungus Botrytis cinerea. Epidemiology: Botrytis cinerea can live as a parasite as well as a saprophyte on decaying plant debris. This fungus is always present and the fruit rot starts with a blossom infection that eventually invades the developing fruits, causing them to rot. This is why timing bloom sprays appropriately (see below) is essential, particularly during a wet bloom season since this prevents the initial infection of the fungus into the flower parts. As the disease progresses, spores are produced and are easily blown or splashed onto healthy foliage. Once the fungus becomes established, it can produce spores continuously throughout the growing season. Controls: Moisture is necessary for the spores to germinate and infect plants, so the disease is favored by high humidity and relatively cool conditions. Therefore, practices that help reduce humidity and increase air movement, such as controlling weeds and utilizing wider spacing of rows and plants, help control gray mold. The fungus thrives on debris, so sanitation is essential for control. Dead plants and fallen leaves should be removed and burned or buried. Several fungicides are effective for controlling gray mold. Bloom sprays are especially important and should be applied at early (5 to 10 percent) bloom and full bloom 7 to 10 days later. A third spray may be needed if excessively rainy conditions or a prolonged season of bloom exists.
Prorated land preparation and planting costs included based on a productive life of one year. One quart of strawberries weighs approximately 1.4 pounds.
pests
Information on individual diseases and insects is presented below, with cultural controls discussed in the text. Pesticide information is presented in tables that follow. Because it is important to avoid buildup of resistant strains of fungi and insects, especially mites, activity groups (for rotational use to avoid buildup of resistant strains) of fungicides, and their efficacy on common diseases are presented in Table 6.14, and activity groups and efficacy of insecticides and miticides are listed in Table 6.15. Fungicides, insecticides, and miticides that can be used to assist in management are given in Table 6.16, arranged by various growth stages for the life cycle of the crop. Pests are listed at the stages where they are most likely to be problematic or when treatment is most effective. Information in Table 6.16 should be supplemented with the reading below. Table 6.17 presents additional restrictions beyond preharvest intervals and reentry intervals (REIs) that appear on the label.
associated with a number of pathogenic soil fungi (most commonly Rhizoctonia and Pythium species), lesion nematodes, environmental conditions (e.g., drought, winter injury to the root system, and the freezing or water logging of the soil), nutrient deficiencies, fertilizer burn, pesticide injury, or a combination of all of these factors. Epidemiology: Because this is a complex, a disease cycle is not as clear as that of other diseases. Rhizoctonia and Pythium are present in nearly all unfumigated soils, and poor plant health due to cultural or environmental conditions likely tips the balance, allowing these organisms to colonize the roots. Controls: Planting in well-drained and well-aerated soils such as those with a high organic matter content (greater than 6 percent) is strongly recommended. Research found that black root rot incidence was reduced by using raised beds. Avoid soil compaction and excessive irrigation. Mulching in order to lessen winter injury, purchasing disease-free plants, and rotating crops for a minimum of 3 to 5 years are also factors in controlling black root rot. No fungicides are currently recommended for control.
diseAses
black root rot
Symptoms: An uneven patchy appearance in the strawberry bed. Usually, older plantings or replanted fields are affected. Plants become stunted and produce few berries and runners. Feeder rootlets disintegrate and structural roots of the mother plant blacken and deteriorate, leaving a white core. Brown lesions may be apparent on the normally white or tan roots. Causal Agent: Several factors comprise this disease complex. This complex is
69
Chapter 6: Strawberries
Controls: Any practice that encourages drying of foliage is helpful, as is removal of dead plants and leaves and mowing at renovation. Several fungicides are effective for control.
only infects the foliage and fruit crops but can also invade the plants vascular system, causing a general decline. Causal Agent: A bacterium, Xanthomonas fragariae. Epidemiology: The disease originates in plant material from the nursery, but symptoms may never develop until the plants are exposed to prolonged cold, wet conditions. The bacteria that cause angular leaf spot are systemic (i.e., cannot be eliminated from the plant). This bacterium overwinters in infected plants and dead leaves. Exudate from infected leaves can be splashed to uninfected plants by water. Young tissue is easily infected. Temperatures just above freezing and moist conditions favor disease development. Thus, this disease is most problematic in years or on sites where frequent or prolonged overhead frost protection is needed. Controls: Avoidance of this disease is currently almost impossible, as it appears that nursery stock is largely infected. Since the bacteria prefer cool temperatures and wet conditions, such as those that occur when overhead irrigation is used for frost protection, any practice that minimizes the amount of frost protection needed (site and cultivar selection) and maximizes drying of foliage is recommended. Healthier leaf tissue replaces damaged tissue following renovation and periods of dry warm weather. Cultivars vary in susceptibility, but none are resistant. Because this disease is caused by a bacterium rather than a fungus, fungicides have no effect. Copper sprays applied early in the season at 7- to 10-day intervals or prior to expected wet spells may help, but phytotoxicity becomes a concern with multiple sprays. Discontinue use after four to five sprays or sooner if phytoxicity symptoms appear. There is some indication that copper hydroxide formulations may be more effective than copper sulfate formulations.
leaf scorch
Symptoms: Dark-red to purple spots on the leaves that gradually enlarge and may eventually merge to occupy large portions of the leaves. Unlike with common leaf spot, centers of the spots do not fall out and remain a similar shade as the rest of the spot, though dead leaf tissue may dry and turn brown (Figure 6.3). Lesions also develop on petioles and other aboveground portions, most noticeably the caps. Severe cases of scorch reduce plant vigor and yields. Cause: A fungus, Diplocarpon earlianum. Epidemiology: Leaf scorch is favored by long periods of leaf wetness and rain. The fungus can survive on both living and dead plant tissues and develops under a wide range of temperatures. However, extremely hot (greater than 86F), cold (less than 36F), or dry conditions slow its development. Controls: Mowing and removal of foliage at renovation interrupts disease progression. The disease is typically worse in older plantings. Some cultivars are resistant (see Tables 6.3, 6.5, and 6.6). Any practice that promotes drying of foliage is helpful. Fungicides applied for control of leaf spot may be effective on leaf scorch (see Tables 6.14 and 6.16).
cnose leaf spot), septoria leaf spot, cercospora leaf spot, and alternaria leaf spot. These leaf pathogens are caused by different fungi and more than one type of leaf spot is usually present. Usually, disease development is favored by rain and warm, humid weather conditions.
leather rot
Symptoms: Symptoms vary depending on fruit stage. On immature, green fruit, infected areas appear dark brown or normal green with a brown outline. On ripe, mature fruit, they appear bleached and range in color from light lilac to purple, or there may be no change in color. Infected fruits are characteristically tough and leathery, having a bitter taste. Fruit rot occurs when berries come in contact with the soil. A serious crown rot can develop along with the fruit rot. Causal Agent: The soil-inhabiting fungus Phytophthora cactorum.
70
Epidemiology: When weather conditions are warm and rainfall is abundant, the pathogen releases its spores into the soil. These infested soil particles are dispersed to the fruits by splashing rain or wind. The fungus attacks berries in the field at all stages of growth. Controls: Practices such as mulching with straw to keep the fruit off the ground aid in minimizing rain splash and help control leather rot.
powdery mildew
Symptoms: Powdery mildew is most often observed as a foliage disease, but it also occasionally causes a serious fruit rot. The pathogen can affect flowers and fruit in all stages of development. Flower parts may be invaded prior to pollination, resulting in poor fruit set, immature fruit becoming hard and not ripening normally, and mature, ripe fruit being soft and pulpy and maybe failing to color. When the fruit surface is affected, the mycelium may be seen primarily on seeds, which may loosen and easily rub off. In spring the fungus sporulates on leaves, causing leaflets to curl upwards along the edges. Lower leaf surfaces may turn reddish or purplish and a powdery, frosty growth of the fungus is often seen. Causal Agent: The fungus Sphaerotheca macularis. Epidemiology: The fungus causing this disease is an obligate parasite, meaning that it needs to reside in a living host for its survival. It can be found overwintering in old but living leaves. Powdery mildew occurs on a wide range of hosts and almost everywhere strawberries are grown. Disease development is more likely under conditions of high humidity and warm temperatures. Controls: Planting resistant cultivars and using adequate plant and row spacing aid in control. Removing overwintering leaves may be of some benefit. Several fungicides provide control.
root rotting. Severely diseased plants are stunted, the younger leaves turn a blue green and the older ones turn red, yellow, or orange. Plants eventually wilt and die. As the number of diseased roots increases, plant size, yield, and berry size decrease. When a young, infected root is cut open lengthwise, the stele or core above the rot is red. This diagnostic symptom occurs when the soil is cool. As the disease progresses, the lateral roots die, giving the main roots a rattail appearance. Causal Agent: The soil-inhabiting fungus Phytophthora fragariae. Epidemiology: Healthy roots are infected by spores produced on other infected roots. Spores move through the soil and penetrate the tips of roots, growing within the root system. A few days after infection, roots begin to rot, more spores are produced by the fungus within this rotted tissue, and eventually spores and rotted roots become incorporated into the soil. Controls: Red stele, or red core, is the most serious disease of strawberries in areas of cool, moist soil conditions, especially heavy clay soils saturated with water during cool weather. The spores of this pathogen can travel
long distances in surface water, so its important to maintain good drainage in strawberry bedsa practice that also minimizes runoff. In addition, soil compaction should be avoided. Purchasing planting stock that has been inspected and tested for P. fragariae, as well as planting disease-resistant cultivars, is recommended for control of this root rot. There are several different strains of red stele fungi, and not all cultivars of strawberries marketed as red stele resistant are equally resistant to all strains of the pathogen. Ridomil and Aliette or Phostrol aid in managing red stele (see Table 6.16).
verticillium wilt
Symptoms: Strawberry plants are most susceptible in their first year of growth. The first symptoms appear rapidly in late spring, especially after periods of environmental stress. The outer and older strawberry leaves wilt and dry, turning a reddish yellow to a dark brown at the margins and between the veins. The inner leaves remain green and turgid until the plant dies. This symptom helps to distinguish verticillium wilt from the root and crown diseases caused by Phytophthora species, in which both young and mature leaves wilt.
Leaf scorch
Leaf blight
red stele
Symptoms: Plants showing aboveground symptoms frequently occur in patches where the soil is wettest. Symptoms depend on the severity of
71
Chapter 6: Strawberries
Causal Agent: The soilborne fungus Verticillium alboatrum. Epidemiology: Disease intensity may depend on fertilization practices and the amount of residual field inoculum from previous crops. Plants with lush growth owing to high nitrogen applications are more severely affected than plants receiving moderate amounts of nitrogen. Previous crops consisting of solanaceous plants (e.g., tomatoes, potatoes, eggplant, peppers) may have harbored the pathogen and caused a buildup of soil inoculum. It is advisable not to plant a new strawberry bed following crops of this family. Controls: Planting resistant cultivars and disease-free plants will help control verticillium wilt. A rotation schedule of 3 to 5 years is also recommended.
in infected plants and plant debris. The inoculum is primarily disseminated by splashing water. This fungus needs plant tissue to survive, so the inoculum does not remain in the soil for long periods of time as with many other rots. Controls: Mulching with straw and using drip irrigation rather than overhead irrigation can decrease the spread of inoculum. The use of raised beds on plastic mulch seems to increase the incidence, possibly because of higher microenvironment temperatures or because water drops bounce and splash off the plastic. Immediate plowdown of infected areas of a field, if occurring only in certain areas, may keep infection from occurring throughout the entire field. Several fungicides aid in control.
can be expected, higher populations result in increased damage to the planting, causing stunted, weak plants that are predisposed to secondary root-rotting pathogens. This organism is implicated in the disease complex known as black root rot (see above). Causal Agent: While there are several species of root lesion nematodes, Pratylenchus penetrans is most often associated with black root rot of strawberries. Epidemiology: All stages of the life cycle of lesion nematodes can be found in strawberry roots. P. penetrans attacks nearly 400 species of plants including both weed and crop hosts. Besides directly causing damage to the plant by feeding, the injury sites on the roots serve as open entry points for fungi to invade the root tissue. Controls: Nematode problems, once well established, are difficult to control. Therefore, good nematode management should focus on preventative measures. In general, nematodes can be controlled by using fumigants (see Chapter 3). Decisions regarding chemical control options should be based on the sites history and the results of a nematode diagnostic test (see Appendix B).
Anthracnose
Symptoms: Anthracnose is a problem mainly in rainy, warm harvest seasons. It is especially troublesome in the plasticulture production system with susceptible cultivars such as Chandler. Symptoms of anthracnose fruit rot are light-brown spots on fruit that typically turn dark brown or black and then enlarge. Flowers and flower buds can also become infected and appear to dry out. Symptoms of anthracnose crown rot are rarely noticed until the plants collapse or die, usually in the fall or spring following transplanting during warm weather. When the crown is cut through lengthwise, a brownish, horizontal V shape can be found, originating near the base of a petiole. Leaf spots either resemble ink spots or appear as irregular lesions at the tips or margins of leaves, depending on the species causing the infection. On the runners and petioles, lesions begin as small red streaks and then turn dark, sunken, and elongated. Causal Agent: Several different Colletotrichum species cause the fruit rot, crown rot, and/or leaf spot, as well as lesions on petioles and runners. Epidemiology: The primary source of the disease inoculum is infected transplants from the nursery. The plants normally do not show symptoms until after being transplanted to the production field. Inoculum overwinters mainly
nemAtodes
Plant-parasitic nematodes are economically significant pathogens on small fruit and cause a variety of problems. The symptoms of nematode damage may not be immediately obvious in new plantings; therefore, by the time the symptoms are noticed, it is usually too late for corrective measures to be effective. Because of the insidious nature of nematode problems, growers must be aware of the risk to new plantings and the options available for nematode control. Parasitic nematodes have sometimes been called the hidden enemy in agriculture. Without diagnostic testing, their presence is often not evident until it is too late for corrective measures. Thus, the first step in nematode control should be a diagnostic test to determine which nematodes are present and what their population levels are. A properly collected soil sample can be sent to a nematode diagnostic lab for analysis. Results will determine if the site is at risk. See Chapter 1 and Appendix B for information on sampling for nematodes.
dagger nematodes
Symptoms: While dagger nematodes feed on the roots of plants, the main concern is their efficiency as vectors of tomato ringspot and tobacco ringspot viruses. Consequently, viral symptoms and/or poor growth are often the first symptoms noticed. Tomato ringspot and tobacco ringspot viruses cause serious problems in raspberries, blackberries, blueberries, and strawberries. As a vector of plant disease, dagger nematodes, even in low numbers, can cause major problems in susceptible crops. Causal Agent: Several species in the genus Xiphinema. Epidemiology: Dagger nematodes feed from outside of the roots, rather than living within them. These organisms use specialized feeding mouthparts known as stylets to penetrate the root, causing direct damage to the root and also transferring viruses from plant to plant. Survival and movement of the organism
lesion nematodes
Symptoms: Often, the first symptoms noticed are that the plants are small and fail to make expected growth. Plants should be checked for small, dark lesions present on the roots as a result of the damage caused by nematode feeding, hence the name lesion nematode. As
72
is dependent on soil conditions. Dagger nematodes survive best and move most easily in soils low in organic matter, while very wet or very dry soils are detrimental to them. Controls: Nematodes must be controlled before the crop is planted. Cover cropping with rapeseed as a biofumigant over two successive years as part of a rotation or growing two crops of rapeseed within one year can be effective (see Chapter 2 and Appendix A for additional information). Fumigation can also be used prior to planting.
young berries. Consequently, the tips do not expand, causing the injury known as button berry or apical seediness. Although feeding from several plant bugs and the long-necked seed bug causes similar symptoms, the tarnished plant bug appears to be the chief culprit. Small, underdeveloped berries may be caused by other factors, most notably poor pollination and cold injury. However, poorly pollinated fruits will not have developed seeds, while cold injury usually manifests itself as folding of the fruit, causing the seeds to be clumped on the side of the berry rather than at the tip. Identification: The adult tarnished plant bug, about inch long, is brownish marked with yellowish and black dashes and has a brassy appearance (Figure 6.4). These insects are very active, taking to flight with the slightest disturbance. This inconspicuous sucking plant bug is a general feeder that attacks a wide variety of cultivated and wild plants. Life Cycle: Adults overwinter in protected places. They return to fields about the time of bud burst and feed on all sorts of tender foliage and plant parts. Tarnished plant bugs often disperse into strawberry plantations when weeds, especially blooming broadleaves, or other crops (e.g., alfalfa) in surrounding areas are mowed or disked. Several generations occur each yearadults and nymphs of all stages are found from April until heavy frost in the fall. Monitoring and Controls: Growers should sample fruit clusters on a weekly schedule when fruit begins to form. Shaking flower and fruit clusters over a light-colored plate or sheet of paper will dislodge nymphs and allow them to be seen more easily. Sample 30 to 50 flower clusters throughout the field. Divide the number of trusses sampled by the number of plant bug nymphs found. When this number is 4 or less (i.e., if there is more than one nymph per four trusses on average), a spray is advisable. An insecticide application may also be necessary if nymphs are present just before bloom. For specific materials, see Table 6.16. Do not spray pesticides toxic to bees during bloom (see Table 3.1 in Chapter
3). According to research from New England, the varieties least susceptible to plant bug injury are Canoga, Catskill, Honeoye, Sparkle, and Veestar. Latermaturing cultivars are more severely affected.
73
Chapter 6: Strawberries
turbed, adult beetles quickly drop out of the fruit and disappear into the mulch layer or cracks in the ground, which makes them easily missed, except at high populations. Identification: The adult strawberry sap beetle is a small, brown, oval beetle less than inch long (Figure 6.5). In extremely overripe berries, another beetle, the picnic beetle (Glischrochilus quadrisignatus or G. fasciatus), may also be found. The picnic beetle is larger and usually has four orange blotches on its back (Figure 6.6). Life Cycle: Sap beetles lay eggs in the fruit, and their small ( to 3/8 inches long), white larvae may be seen in the fruit, hopefully not first by the consumer. As the berries begin to ripen in May and June, adult sap beetles are attracted from their overwintering sites in nearby woods to the patch. They bore into ripe, nearly ripe, or decaying fruit, and lay eggs. The larvae then feed on the fruit. Mature larvae leave the fruit and burrow into the soil to pupate briefly before emerging as a new generation of adults and moving to other crops. Monitoring and Controls: Sap beetles are huge problems on farms where large amounts of ripe fruit are left behind during harvest; therefore, they are often a larger problem in pick-your-own operations than in grower-harvested operations. Cultural controls consist of
harvesting as much fruit as possible from the field and collecting and destroying unmarketable fruit. Do not plant more strawberry acreage than can be properly managed during harvest. Renovating the field as soon as possible after harvest will destroy remaining uncollected fruit and disturb the pupating beetles in the ground. A heavy layer of mulch can also encourage sap beetle buildup. When other cultural practices encourage a buildup of the sap beetle population, heavy damage can occur even when there is not an abundance of overripe fruit. Sap beetles attack a succession of ripening fruits and vegetables such as sweet corn, brambles, cucumbers, peaches, melons, tomatoes, grapes, and apples, so minimizing and plowing down residue in these fields soon after harvest removes potential breeding sites. A pesticide may be used, but chemical control practices are not as effective against the hidden beetles and larvae as cultural control practices.
of their presence even after the trail has dried. Most of the feeding takes place at night or on dark, overcast days; however, the Arion slug is very aggressive and has been seen feeding on bright, sunny days. Most injury from slugs is encountered during damp, rainy, spring months. Identification: Slugs and snails, both of which are mollusks, look alike in the early stages, but slugs do not form a shell in their older stages. Slugs are to 8 inches long, depending on the species. They vary in color from cream to grayish black, with some species being spotted. Life Cycle: Slugs are favored by mulch in the field and are able to overwinter in protected places beneath the mulch. Eggs are laid in groups in cracks and holes in the soil. Thus, the entire life cycle may be completed in the strawberry field. Slugs require 3 to 7 months to attain adulthood. Monitoring and Controls: Slug control begins with removing nesting and breeding places, such as boards, stones, trash piles, and compost piles. Traps made of wet boards or burlap bags may be set in the evening. Remove and destroy the trapped slugs in the morning. If slug damage is severe, a pesticide application may be necessary. Bait formulations usually provide control where slugs are a problem. Diatomaceous earth, a desiccant, may also be applied. For smaller plantings, traps using beer in shallow
Slugs (Mollusca)
Symptoms of Damage: While slugs are not insects, they can cause considerable damage similar to insect damage. Slugs of all sizes make small, moderately deep holes in ripening berries, which can be almost anywhere on the fruit, although feeding usually takes place under the cap. As slugs move about they leave a trail of slime, which can be a tell-tale sign
Actual size Actual size (1/4 inch) Actual size (1/16 inch) (1/4 inch)
74
on strawberry fruit, typically where it is in contact with the ground. To date, there have been no reported problems of sowbugs girdling plants, though this has been reported with other crops. Identification: Sowbugs and pillbugs are up to inch long, and have an elongated oval shape and no wings. They are commonly a grayish brown, though the shade varies. Their bodies consist of a overlapping plates, and they have seven pairs of legs. They are frequently found in damp places hiding underneath mulch, dead foliage, or any object that provides cover. Pillbugs can roll up completely into a little ball when disturbed, while sowbugs can only partially curl up. Life Cycle: Individuals can live up to three years and reproduce at any time of the year but most commonly in the spring. There can be one or two generations per year. The female has a brood pouch on her underside in which she carries eggs for 3 to 7 weeks and young for an additional 6 to 8 weeks. Monitoring and Controls: Removal of hiding place and minimizing use of mulches may be necessary. Allowing the soil to dry out to the extent possible between plantings may help, as these creatures require high moisture levels because they are crusteaceans and breathe with gills. In high tunnels, removing the plastic covering for the winter may help, thus allowing the soil to freeze. Sluggo Plus, a bait with active ingredients of iron phosphate and spinosad, appears to give fairly good control.
Identification: This dark reddish-brown weevil is about 1/10 inch long, with the head prolonged into a slender, curved snout about half as long as the body. Its back has two large black spots. Life Cycle: Adults overwinter in fence rows and woodlots. They move into strawberry fields around the end of April and feed on immature pollen. The female deposits a single egg inside nearly mature flower buds, then girdles the bud and clips its stem so it hangs by a thread or falls to the ground. This process provides shelter for the egg and developing larvae. The eggs hatch in about a week into white, legless grubs, which mature in 3 or 4 weeks. Adult weevils emerge from the buds in June, feed on the pollen of various flowers, and then seek hibernating sites in midsummer. Weevils remain in these sites until the following spring. Only one brood appears each year. Monitoring and Controls: Mulches and full canopies may appeal to emerged adults, encouraging them to remain in the field, which causes successively more damage in succeeding years. Harvesting crops from a field for less than 3 years, mowing leaves at renovation, and plowing under old beds immediately after harvest help lessen the chances of clipper damage. Starting shortly after flower bud emergence when temperatures are above 65F, growers should check their fields carefully for the first signs of clipped buds and perforated flower petals. Scouting should continue at least weekly until most flower buds have opened. Pay particular attention to fields near woods and hedgerows. Sample five separate 10-foot sections. Count the number of clipped buds, noting whether they are still fresh and green or turned brown. Newly cut buds mean the weevils are still active. Divide the total number of freshly cut buds observed by the total number of linear row feet inspected. If more than one freshly cut bud per linear row foot is found, a pesticide treatment is justified (see Table 6.16 for specific recommendations). Treatment of only the field border rows may be sufficient in some instances. If a spray application is made, check again 7 days later. If one live clipper or one freshly cut bud per foot of row is found,
Sowbugs/Pillbugs (Arthropoda:Crustacea)
Symptoms of Damage: Sowbugs typically are not a problem in strawberry production, feeding on dead or decaying organic matter only. However, within the region sowbugs have been observed as pests in high tunnel culture or in field production where an organic matter source may have transported large populations of sowbugs into the planting. Sowbugs burrow into and feed
75
Chapter 6: Strawberries
a second application may be needed. Established fields with no history of clipper injury or new plantings may need either no clipper control or only one well-timed spray when the above threshold is reached.
be overlooked until the population is so large that serious damage has occurred. Identification: The eight-legged adult, about 1/50 inch in length, varies in color from pale greenish yellow to green and is usually marked with two dark spots. With the aid of a magnifying lens, nearly clear spherical mite eggs can also be seen. Life Cycle: These mites overwinter as mature, fertile females in protected places in the field. The length of the life cycle varies with seasonal and weather conditions but may be completed in about 2 weeks. Reproduction may be continuous from early spring until late fall. The female lays two to six eggs per day up to about 70 eggs per mite. Eggs hatch in about 4 days, so there can be 10 to 15 generations per year. Hot, dry weather favors rapid population increases. Monitoring and Controls: Starting in the spring as soon as mulch or row covers are removed, examine the undersides of leaves weekly for mites using a 10x hand lens. Overwintered twospotted spider mites will be reddish orange in color. Removing dead leaves early in the spring helps with control. Plasticulture plantings should also be checked before row covers are applied in the fall since the protected warm environment under the row covers allows spider mite populations to survive well over the winter. Spider mites have many natural enemies that often keep them in check, including insects and other mites. Insecticide treatments often cause spider mite outbreaks by destroying these natural enemies. Commercially available mite predators provide excellent control of twospotted mite populations if released while spider mite populations are low. Cultural practices such as annual renovation of strawberry beds reduces the potential for twospotted mite outbreaks. Cultivars vary in their tolerance or resistance to mites. Honeoye is especially susceptible, as is Mesabi. Local growing conditions greatly influence resistance. If more than 25 percent of inspected leaves have mites present, a sharp population rise is noted, or if plant symptoms worsen, then a miticide is needed. When applying miticides, thorough coverage is a must, so use plenty of water (at
Foliage Feeders
Leafhoppers (Homoptera: Cicadellidae)
Symptoms of Damage: Leafhoppers are sucking insects that remove nutrients from plants with their needlelike mouth parts. Potato leafhopper adults and nymphs feed along veins on the undersides of strawberry leaves. While feeding, they plug the sap-conducting vessels, causing the leaves to become curled, stunted, and yellowed. Young plants suffer the most, with injury resulting in short petioles and small, distorted leaves that bend down at right angles. With potato leafhopper damage, the leaves have roughly triangular, chlorotic (yellowed) blotches at the leaf edges.
76
least 100 gallons per acre) and pressure high enough to treat the undersides of the leaves. To help manage resistance, miticides with different modes of action should be alternated during subsequent applications. Because these mites can be borne by the wind in their silken webbing, newly planted fields can become quickly infested. In certain fields or areas within fields, hot spots of mite activity may develop. Early treatment of hot spots may be sufficient for control.
tions reduce plant growth and runner formation. Insect Identification: The strawberry rootworm is a shiny, oval beetle, usually brown varying to black, with four darker blotches on the wing covers. It is slightly more than 1/8 inch in length. Life Cycle: The beetles hibernate under mulch, in crevices in soil, or in other protected places. They begin feeding and laying eggs when warm weather arrives. Feeding punctures have been observed in May and gradually grow more numerous until mid-June. Eggs are laid during this period on older leaves near the ground. As the larvae hatch, they burrow into the ground up to 6 inches, where they feed on plant roots for about 2 months. Adults of the first generation have been observed in July, with continued emergence throughout August. The newly emerged beetles feed extensively on the foliage of strawberries in early fall. Monitoring and Controls: To be sure that this pest is the one causing leaf perforation, examine the field after dark with a flashlight. Populations are easier to detect from mid-July into the fall. Ten to twenty beetles per square foot is considered quite high. Foliar feeding in late summer and fall is usually more severe than that observed in spring.
Monitoring and Controls: Practicing clean culture is important because the beetles prefer to feed and breed on certain weeds.
Strawberry Leafroller, Ancylis comptana fragariae, and Other Leafrollers (Lepidoptera: Tortricidae)
Symptoms of Damage: In the early stages, a larva may feed on either side of a leaf. As the larva becomes larger, it usually feeds on the upper surface. Here, by means of fine, silken threads, it folds the leaflet at the midrib and feeds inside this enclosure. Only the epidermis of the leaf is eaten, but continuous feeding causes the entire leaflet to turn brown and die. Sometimes two adjacent leaflets are tied together and, in heavy infestations, an entire leaf or even several leaves may be webbed together. Sometimes newly formed leaves are attacked and webbed together before they unfold. This type of damage may be seen during late May and in June when first-generation larvae are abundant. The same damage is caused by larvae of the second generation in late July and August. Insect Identification: The adults are reddish-brown moths that have a wingspread of about inch. Strawberry leafrollers are the caterpillars (larvae) of moths. Young larvae are usually pale green but change to gray brown as they become fully grown, reaching about inch long. No special markings or distinguishing characteristics are present. Larvae change into yellowish-brown pupae, which remain inside the folded leaf until ready to emerge as moths. Other leafrollers such as the oblique-banded and the variegated leafroller may also be a problem. Life Cycle: Two or more generations may occur each year. The time required for the second generation to complete its development is somewhat shorter than that of the first generation because of higher daily temperatures. First-generation moths are active from about April to June, and second- and third-generation moths are present from July through late September. First-generation moths deposit small, translucent eggs on the foliage of strawberries, usually on the undersides, about mid-May.
77
Chapter 6: Strawberries
Monitoring and Controls: Strawberry leafrollers are very susceptible to attack by various hymenopterous and dipterous parasites, which usually keep their populations below economic levels. Although these parasites vary greatly in abundance from season to season, they have been responsible for controlling leafrollers when there are two or fewer larvae per plant. This insect rarely causes serious damage in the region. If insecticides are needed, apply during the early larval stages, usually mid- to late May. Products containing Bacillus thuringiensis (e.g., Dipel) provide good control of young larvae, do not disturb the natural enemy complex, and are safe for bees. Good coverage is critical for Bacillus thuringiensis products to be effective.
Monitoring and Controls: When numerous, adults can be controlled with the use of broad-spectrum insecticides, though growers should watch for spikes in twospotted spider mite populations following application. Entomopathogenic nematodes are effective for larvae, but they have a limited shelf life and must be applied strictly according to directions.
and malformed when they emerge. A damaged plant takes on a characteristically flat appearance. Foliar symptoms are sometimes mistaken for herbicide damage. Later, the mite feeds on the blossoms and causes a distortion of the fruits. Infested plants usually become unproductive within a season. Insect Identification: This mite is so tiny (1/100 of an inch) that it is nearly invisible to the unaided eye. Magnification at 20x or greater eases identification. The cyclamen mite is white to caramel colored in its adult stage and milky white in its immature stage. Eggs are clear and oval shaped. Life Cycle: Adult females overwinter in crowns and at the bases of petioles of leaves. Immature development may be completed in less than 2 weeks, making a rapid population increase possible. Populations begin to rise in April when blossoming starts and peak during fruiting. A sharp decline occurs during July and August, and a second lower peak occurs near the end of September. Monitoring and Controls: Cyclamen mites may be killed by hot, dry summers in some areas and may also be held in check by predators. In establishing a new planting, using plants free of cyclamen mites is important. After the mite becomes established, control is difficult and may be more of a problem in plantings maintained over longer periods of time. Localized populations of this pest can be spot treated with pesticides. Use high water volumes (200 gallons per acre) when spraying. Use of some broadspectrum insecticides may cause increases in cyclamen mite populations by killing their predators.
78
Life Cycle: Aphids pass the winter on the undersides of old leaves lying on the soil. Winged forms first appear in spring and may be found through May and June. Wingless females, the most common form, are white at first and later become greenish white to yellow. During the growing season most aphids are found feeding on new shoots and buds, the undersides of young leaves, and petioles. Monitoring and Controls: Because virus transmission is the main concern, eliminate all wild strawberries from fence rows and neighboring fields. Look for signs of aphid activity on the undersides of young leaves and new shoots in spring, after harvest, and in the fall. Where virus diseases are a problem, aphids should be controlled.
Development from egg to adult requires about 3 months. The adults remain in the upper 6 inches of soil until extreme dryness or cold weather drives them deeper into the soil. Their entire life cycle (1 to 2 years) is spent in the soil. Monitoring and Controls: Controlling symphylans before or at the time of planting is best. To check for symphylans, turn over at least 10 shovelfuls of soil. Sift the soil while looking for active symphylans. An average of one symphylan per shovelful signals that a treatment is necessary before planting. If symphylans are abundant, an insecticide should be broadcast and incorporated into the soil of the infested area before planting takes place.
also black and vary from 3/16 to 3/8 inch in length. Green leaf weevils, which are small and metallic green, differ from the species of root weevils listed above in that adults can fly and are active during the day. Root weevil larvae have no legs, distinguishing them from white grubs, which have three pairs. Life Cycle: Black vine weevils overwinter in the soil as immature, legless, - to -inch long, C-shaped white grubs. Mature grubs form resting (pupal) cells in the soil in early spring. Adults usually emerge during late May through midJune. Black vine weevils require 30 to 60 days to feed on foliage before producing as many as 500 eggs over a period of 14 to 21 days in July and August. Eggs are laid in the soil near the bases of host plants. They hatch in 10 to 14 days into small, white grubs that feed until fall temperatures drive them deeper into the soil, where they overwinter. Only one generation of the pest occurs per year in the region, though some adults may survive the winter and continue to lay eggs. Monitoring and Controls: Sprays may be directed toward adults while they are feeding aboveground but before egg laying commences; however, this is seldom completely effective. Evening sprays are more likely to be effective. Old plantings may be destroyed and plowed under, but to avoid mass migration of adults to new fields, leave a row or two of the old planting as a trap crop in which the adults can lay their eggs. Then plow under these rows in late fall or early winter and plant rye. Recently, thiamethoxam became available to control larvae, but control has varied, perhaps due to uncertainty concerning the most effective time to apply the material. Insecticidal nematodes may be used for controlling root weevils on strawberries. Heterorhabditis bacteriophora and Heterorhabditis marelatus have been used successfully against black vine weevil larvae feeding on strawberry crowns and roots. Insecticidal nematodes must be protected from extreme air and soil temperatures (soil temperatures should be between 60 and 85F) and they require moist soil (irrigate before and after applying) to obtain larval control. Failing to follow package recommendations may result in little or no control.
root Feeders
Garden Symphylan, Scutigerella immaculata (Symphyla)
Symptoms of Damage: Garden symphylans feed on the roots of strawberry plants, weakening or killing them. Infestations seldom encompass an entire field but rather involve one or more small areas. Usually, the first indication of a symphylan infestation is a small area of stunted, unhealthy plants. Crop losses continue in the same area of the field year after year, with the infected area increasing in size by about 10 to 20 feet each year. Insect Identification: Symphylans are not insects but are more closely related to centipedes and millipedes. Symphylans have 12 pairs of legs and 14 body segments. Mature symphylans are white, slightly less than inch in length, and have a pair of long, beaded antennae. Life Cycle: Symphylans overwinter in the soil as adults. In spring they move into the top 6 inches when the soil temperature rises above 45F. Eggs are deposited in soil crevices and tunnels in late April, May, and June. The eggs hatch 2 to 3 weeks later into tiny, white nymphs that resemble the adults in appearance except that they have only 6 pairs of legs. As the nymphs develop, they grow bigger and add a pair of legs at each molt until they have 12 pairs.
79
Chapter 6: Strawberries
80
table 6.14. Activity groups and effectiveness of fungicides for strawberry disease control. Not all fungicides listed below are labeled for all the diseases listed. This table is intended to provide information on effectiveness for diseases that appear on the label, plus additional diseases that may be controlled from application. See Table 6.16 for labeled uses.
Fungicide Abound Aliette Cabrio Captan Captevate Copper Elevate Orbit, Tilt Phostrol Pristine Procure Quintec Rally Ridomil Gold Rovral Scala Syllit Switch Thiram Topsin-M Activity Groupa 11 33 11 M 17+M M 17 3 33 7+11 3 13 3 4 2 9 M 9+12 M 1 Phomopsis Leaf Blight +b 0 ++ ++ + 0 0 0 ++ 0 +++ 0 + 0 ++ 0 ++ ++ Leaf Spot + 0 ++ ++ + 0 0 ++ 0 +++ 0 0 ++ 0 + 0 ++ + ++ ++ Leaf Scorch ++ ++ ++ 0 +++ +++ 0 + ++ ++ ++ +++ Angular Leaf Spot 0 0 0 0 0 + 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Powdery Mildew ++ 0 +++ 0 0 0 0 +++ 0 +++ +++ +++ +++ 0 0 0 0 0 +++ Gray Mold + 0 ++ ++ +++ 0 +++ 0 0 +++ 0 0 0 0 +++ +++ ++ ++ +++ Anthracnose Fruit Rot ++ 0 +++ ++ ++ 0 0 0 0 +++ 0 0 0 0 0 0 ++ + 0 Leather Rot ++ +++ +++ + + 0 0 0 +++ +++ 0 0 0 +++ 0 0 0 + 0
a. Chemistry of fungicides by activity groups: 1 = benzimidazoles and thiophanates; 2 = dicarboximides; 3 = demethylation inhibitors (includes triazoles); 4 = acylalanines; 7 = carboxamides; 9 = anilinopyrimidines; 11 = strobilurins; 12 = phenylpyrroles; 13 = quinolines; 17 = hydroxyanilides; 33 = unknown (phosphonates); M = chemical groups with multisite activity. Fungicides with two activity groups listed contain active ingredients from two activity groups. b. 0 = not effective; + = slight effectiveness; ++ = moderate effectiveness; +++ = very effective; = insufficient data This table is modified from Table 6, Fungicide Effectiveness for Strawberry Disease Control, in the 2009 Midwest Commercial Small Fruit and Grape Spray Guide.
81
Chapter 6: Strawberries
table 6.15. Activity groups and effectiveness of insecticides, miticides, and molluscides on strawberry pests. Not all insecticides listed below are labeled for all the insects listed. This table is intended to provide information on effectiveness against insects that appear on the label, plus additional insects that may be controlled from application. See Table 6.16 for labeled uses.
Activity Pesticide Groupa Acramite un Actara 4A Admire 4A AgriMek 6 Assail 4A Aza-Direct un Brigade 3 Danitol 3 Deadline Diazinon 1B Dibrom 1B Dipel 11 Esteem 7 Intrepid 18 Kanemite 20 Kelthane un Lorsban 1B Malathion 1B M-Pede Oberon 23 Platinum 4A Provado 4A Pyganic 3 Pyrellin 3 + 21 Radiant 5 Savey 10 Sevin 1A Sluggo Spintor, Entrust, Success 5 Thionex 2A Vendex 12B Zeal 10 Cyclamen Aphids Clipper Mite Leafhoppers b +++ +++ +++ ++ +++ ++ ++ ++ +++ +++ ++ ++ +++ ++ +++ + + ++ ++ ++ ++ ++ +++ +++ ++ ++ +++ +++ +++ ++ +++ + + +++ + ++ +++ 0 +++ ++ Adult Root Leafrollers Weevils ++ ++ ++ +++ ++ ++ + ++ +++ ++ + +++ + ++ + Sap Beetles + +++ ++ ++ ++ + ++ + Spider Mites Spittlebug +++ ++ ++ + +++ + +++ + ++ +++ ++ ++ + +++ +++d ++ +++ ++ +++ d Tarnished Plant Bug ++c ++ +++ +++ + ++ ++ ++ +++ White Grubs +++ ++ ++
a. Chemistry of insecticides by activity groups: 1A = carbamates; 1B = organophosphates; 2A = chlorinated cyclodienes; 3 = pyrethrins and synthetic pyrethroids; 4A = neonicotinoids; 5 = spinosyns; 6 = avermectins; 7 = juvenile hormone mimics; 10 = mite growth inhibitors with unknown or nonspecific sites of action; 11 = Bt microbials; 12B = organotin miticides; 18 = ecdysone agonists/molting disruptors; 20 = Site II electron transport inhibitors; 21 = Site I electron transport inhibitors; 23 = lipid synthesis inhibitors; un = unknown mode of action b. 0 = not effective; + = slight effectiveness; ++ = moderate effectiveness; +++ = very effective, indicates that insufficient data exists to rank effectiveness of this insecticide or miticide on these pests c. Moderate effect on nymphs, but little or no effect on adults d. Effective on eggs and immatures, but little or no effect on adults. This table is modified from Table 7, Effectiveness of Pesticides for Control of Strawberry Insects and Mites, in the 2009 Midwest Commercial Small Fruit and Grape Spray Guide.
82
table 6.16. pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control. Note: The recommendations below are correct to the best of our knowledge. Other formulations with the same active ingredient as some of the products listed below may exist and may or may not be labeled for the same uses. Always consult the label before making pesticide applications. Read the text for information on cultural practices to minimize pest incidence. If control cannot be achieved with a particular material, it is possible that resistant populations exist. Use a material in a different activity group, which will have a different mode of action. See Table 3.2 for use status, chemical names of active ingredients, and reentry intervals. See Table 3.1 for toxicity to nontarget organisms, and Tables 6.14 and 6.15 for activity groups and efficacy ratings to help determine products that best suit your situation. See Table 6.17 for other use restrictions such as quantity allowable per season. Information was current as of October 1, 2009.
Pest beFore plAnting Insects White grubs Timing of Treatment/Comments Product Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest)
These subterranean arthropod pests should be controlled before planting. Lorsban 4E, 2 qt (prebloom, 21) Never plant strawberries in newly turned earth, especially after sod. Before planting strawberries, plant nonpreferred cover crop for two years, or apply insecticide. Do not apply Lorsban after berries start to form or when berries are present. Parasitic nematodes (Heterorhabditis bacteriophora) should be applied during evening or early morning, and when soil is moist to increase likelihood of successful colonization. No nematicides are available for sale as of this writing. Sales of Nemacur were prohibited after May 31, 2008. Existing stock may be used until depleted. Fumigation can also be used for control. See Chapter 3 and discussion in this chapter for additional information. Parasitic nematodes, 12 billion per acre
At plAnting Diseases Red stele Insects Aphids and whiteflies Grubs, leafhoppers, strawberry root weevil estAblishment yeAr Diseases Leaf spot
As a preplant dip of the crowns and roots for 1530 minutes. Plant within 24 hours after dipping. Just prior to or during transplanting as a plant material or plant hole treatment. Admire is systemic. See label for additional information.
Aliette WDG, 2.5 lbs/100 gal of solution (0.5), or Phostrol, 2.5 pt/100 gal of solution () Admire Pro, 10.514 fl oz (14), or Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (50) Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (50)
As symptoms appear. Fungicides applied for common leaf spot may assist with control of other leaf spotting diseases such as scorch and blight. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides. Note that for products containing captan, the REI is 24 hr. As symptoms appear. Few fungicides are labeled for this use. Fungicides applied for leaf spot may give some control.
Captan 50W, 6 lb (0) or Captec 4L, 3 qt (0), or Rally 40W , 2.55.0 oz (0), or Syllit 3.4FL, 2.43.0 pt (14), or Cabrio EG, 1214 oz (0), or Pristinea, 18.523 oz (0) Nova 40W, 2.55.0 oz (0), or Syllit 3.4FL, 2.43.0 pt (14)
continued
Leaf blight
83
Chapter 6: Strawberries
table 6.16. pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Powdery mildew Timing of Treatment/Comments As symptoms appear. See footnote b below concerning severe toxicity of Abound to McIntosh, Gala, and related apple cultivars. Abound, Cabrio, and one of the active ingredients in Pristine are in the same chemical class, and cannot be rotated with each other for resistance management purposes. Do not make more than two sequential applications of fungicides from this activity group. See fungicide efficacy table for classes of fungicides. Product Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Aboundb, 6.215.4 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 1214 oz (0), or Rally 40W, 2.55.0 oz (0), or Pristinea, 18.523 oz (0), or Procure 50WS, 48 oz (1), or Quintec, 46 fl oz (1)
Insects and Mites (unless blossoms have not been removed and are open) Spider mites Savey and Zeal are effective on eggs and immatures, but not adults, and therefore must be used when mite populations are low. Brigade and Danitol must be used at high rates with good coverage when applied for spider mites, or they may decrease predatory mite numbers without controlling spider mites. Releases of predatory mites can also give good results. See text for additional information on this subject, and Table 3.1 for toxicity of insecticides to predatory mites. Registration of products containing dicofol (Kelthane) is being discontinued, but these materials can be used until existing stocks are depleted. Spittlebugs Spittlebugs are frequently a larger problem in weedy fields. Good weed control will discourage large populations of spittlebugs from establishing in the planting.
Agri-Mek 0.15EC, 16 fl oz (3), or Acramite 50WS, 0.751.0 lb (1), or Oberon 2SC, 1216 fl oz (3), or Kelthane 50W, 12 lb (3), or Vendex 50WP, 1.52.0 lb (1), or Kanemite 15SC, 2131 fl oz (1) or Savey 50DF, 6 oz (3), or Zeal, 23 oz (1), or Brigade WSB, 32 oz (0), or Danitol 2.4EC, 21.3 oz (2) Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Provado 1.6F, 3.8 oz (7), or Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0), or Dibrom 8, 1 pt (1), or Danitol 2.4 EC, 10.67 oz (2), or Sevin 4F, 12 qt or 80S, 1.252.5 lb (7), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Assail 70WP, 0.81.7 oz or 30SG, 1.94.0 oz (1) Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Dibrom 8, 1 pt (1), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0) or Danitol 2.4EC, 10.67 oz (2), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or Sevin 80S, 1.872.5 lb or 4F, 1.52 qt (7) Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Diazinon 50WP, 1 lb or AG500, 1 pt (5), or Dibrom 8, 1 pt (1), or Provado 1.6F, 3.8 oz (7), or Aza-Direct, 1656 fl oz (0), or Actara, 1.53.0 oz (3), or Assail 70WP, 0.81.7 oz or 30SG, 1.94.0 oz (1) Admire Pro, 10.514.0 fl oz (14) Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (50)
continued
Tarnished plant bugs are attracted to certain weed species for egg laying, and tend to be a larger problem with late-season cultivars. Do not apply Dibrom if temperature is above 90F.
Aphids
As needed. See labels of individual insecticides for additional information. Do not apply Dibrom if temperature is above 90F.
As a soil application through drip irrigation or as otherwise described on the label. Admire and Provado have the same active ingredient, as do Actara and Platinum. See labels for additional information.
84
table 6.16. pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Leafhoppers Timing of Treatment/Comments When injury appears. See text discussion. No cultural controls are effective. M-Pede is an insecticidal soap, and should be targeted against first-generation nymphs. Product Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Assail 70WP, 0.81.7 oz or 30SG, 1.94.0 oz (1), or Actara 1.53.0 oz (3), or Sevin 80S,1.252.5 lb or 4F, 12 qt (7), or M-Pede, 2.0% solution (0) Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Oberon 2SC, 1216 fl oz (3), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or Provado 1.6F, 3.8 oz (7), or Esteem 0.86EC, 10 fl oz (2), or Actara, 3.04.0 oz (3), or M-Pede, 12% solution (0), or Admire Pro, 10.514.0 fl oz (14), or Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (50) Brigade WSP, 832 oz (0), or Actara, 4.0 oz (3), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt (3) Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb, or 4F, 12 qt (7), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or Pyganic EC 1.4 II, 14 pt (0)
Whiteflies
As needed. See labels of individual insecticides for additional information. M-Pede is an insecticidal soap, and should be targeted against first-generation nymphs.
As a soil application through drip irrigation or as otherwise described on the label. Admire and Provado have the same active ingredient, as do Actara and Platinum. See labels for additional information. Strawberry root weevil (adults) When damage appears or adults are present. Adults feed at night.
Treatment is only necessary if feeding damage becomes severe. Activity of Pyganic is short in duration.
hArvest yeAr(s): leAF emergenCe Diseases Leaf spot As symptoms appear. Fungicides applied for common leaf spot may assist with control of other leaf spotting diseases such as scorch and blight. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides. Note that for products containing captan, the REI is 24 hr. Leaf blight As symptoms appear. Few fungicides are labeled for this use. Fungicides applied for leaf spot may give some control. As symptoms appear. See footnote b below concerning severe toxicity of Abound to McIntosh, Gala, and related apple cultivars. Abound, Cabrio, and one of the active ingredients in Pristine are in the same chemical class, and cannot be rotated with each other for resistance management purposes. Do not make more than two sequential applications of fungicides from this activity group. See fungicide efficacy table for classes of fungicides. After the ground thaws but before first bloom. Apply to soil as a band application or through drip irrigation.
Captan 50W, 6 lb (0) or Captec 4L, 3 qt (0), or Rally 40W, 2.55.0 oz (0), or Syllit 3.4FL, 2.43.0 pt (14), or Cabrio EG, 1214 oz (0), or Pristinea, 18.523 oz (0) Rally 40W, 2.55.0 oz (0), or Syllit 3.4FL, 2.43.0 pt (14) Aboundb, 6.215.4 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 1214 oz (0), or Rally 40W, 2.55.0 oz (0), or Pristinea, 18.523 oz (0), or Procure 50WS, 48 oz (1), or Orbit, 4 fl oz (0), or Tilt, 4 fl oz (0), or Quintec, 46 fl oz (1) Ridomil Gold SL, 1 pt/treated A ()
Powdery mildew
Leather rot
continued
85
Chapter 6: Strawberries
table 6.16. pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Red stele Timing of Treatment/Comments After the ground thaws but before first bloom. Apply to soil as a band application or through drip irrigation. When plants start active growth (foliar application). Repeat at 30- to 60-day intervals if disease persists. Insects and Mites Spider mites Twospotted spider mite females are ready to lay eggs now. Scout in early spring. Overwintered twospotted mites will be reddish orange in color. If 25% of leaflets have two-spotted mites, control is needed. Savey and Zeal are effective on eggs and nymphs, but not adults, so they must be used when mite populations are low. Brigade and Danitol must be used at high rates with good coverage for mite control, or they may decrease predatory mite numbers without controlling spider mites. Releases of predatory mites can give good results. See text for additional information and Table 3.1 for toxicity of insecticides to predatory mites. Product Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Ridomil Gold SL, 1 pt/treated A () Aliette WDG, 2.55.0 lb (0.5), or Phostrol, 2.55.0 pt () Agri-Mek 0.15EC, 16 fl oz (3), or Acramite 50WS, 0.751.0 lbs (1), or Oberon 2SC, 1216 fl oz (3), or Kelthane 50W, 12 lb (3), or Vendex 50WP, 1.52.0 lb (1), or Savey 50DF, 6 oz (3), or Zeal, 23 oz (1), or Brigade WSB, 32 oz (0), or Danitol 2.4EC, 21.3 oz (2), or Kanemite 15SC, 2131 fl oz (1)
Cyclamen mites
Miticides must penetrate into the crown for control. Therefore, apply when foliage is minimal. Use high water volume (200 gal/acre) and pressure. Avoid infested planting stock. As needed. See labels of individual insecticides for additional information. Do not apply Dibrom if temperature is above 90F.
Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Kelthane 50W, 3.04.0 lb (3) Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Diazinon 50WP, 1 lb or AG500, 1 pt (5), or Dibrom 8, 1 pt (1), or Provado, 3.8 fl oz (7), or Aza-Direct, 1656 fl oz (0), or Assail 70WP, 0.81.7 oz or 30SG, 1.94.0 oz (1) Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (50) Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Oberon 2SC, 1216 fl oz (3), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Provado, 3.8 fl oz (7), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or M-Pede, 12% solution (0), or Esteem 0.86EC, 10 fl oz (2) Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (50)
Aphids
As a soil application through drip irrigation. See label for additional information. Whiteflies As needed. See labels of individual insecticides for additional information. M-Pede is an insecticidal soap, and should be targeted against first-generation nymphs.
As a soil application through drip irrigation. See label for additional information. hArvest yeAr(s): Flower bud emergenCe Diseases Leaf spot, leaf blight, and See comments for materials applied at leaf emergence. powdery mildew Angular leaf spot See text discussion of angular leaf spot for details on application.
Same materials as at leaf emergence. Copper hydroxide or copper sulfate, various formulations and rates.
continued
86
table 6.16. pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Insects and Mites Spider mites Cyclamen mites Spittlebugs Timing of Treatment/Comments See management notes for at leaf emergence. See management notes for leaf emergence applications. Spittlebugs are frequently a larger problem in weedy fields. Good weed control will discourage large populations of spittlebugs from establishing in the planting. Product Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Same materials as at leaf emergence. Same materials as at leaf emergence. Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0), or Danitol 2.4 EC, 10.67 oz (2), or Dibrom 8, 1 pt (1), or Sevin 4F, 12 qt or 80S, 1.252.5 lb (7), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Assail 70WP, 0.81.7 oz or 30SG, 1.94.0 oz (1) Same materials as at leaf emergence. Lorsban 4E, 1 qt (prebloom, 21), or Sevin 4F, 12 qt or 80S, 1.252.5 lb (7), or Danitol 2.4EC, 1621.3 oz (2), or Brigade WSB 6.432 oz (0) Same materials as at leaf emergence.
See management notes for leaf emergence applications. Tend to be a larger problem in rows near woods. The threshold for treatment is one cut bud per linear foot of row. Only rows near woods may need to be treated. Do not apply Lorsban after berries start to form or when berries are present. See management notes for leaf emergence applications.
Whiteflies
hArvest yeAr(s): when blossoms in Cluster sepArAte Diseases Same as for flower bud emergence, if problematic Insects Spittlebugs Strawberry bud weevils (clippers) Plant bug (Lygus bugs)
See management notes for applications made at flower bud emergence. See management notes for applications made at flower bud emergence. Scout for tarnished plant bugs by tapping flower clusters over a white surface such as a plate or sheet of paper. Treatment threshold is one nymph per 4 flower clusters. Tarnished plant bugs are attracted to certain weed species for egg laying, and tend to be a larger problem with lateseason cultivars. Do not apply Dibrom if temperature is above 90F.
Same materials as at flower bud emergence. Same materials as at flower bud emergence. Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Dibrom 8, 1 pt (1), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0), or Danitol 2.4EC, 10.67 oz (2), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or Sevin 80S, 1.872.5 lb or 4F, 1.52 qt (7) Diazinon 50WP, 1 lb or AG500, 1 pt (5), or Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0), or Dibrom 8, 1 pt (1), or Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb or 4F, 12 qt (7), or Malathion 57EC, 1.53.0 pt or 8F, 1.52 pt (3), or Bt, various products and rates (0) Radiant SC, 610 fl oz (1), or Success, 46 fl oz (1), or SpinTor 2SC, 46 fl oz (1), or Entrust, 1.251.5 oz (1)
continued
Strawberry leafroller
Apply just before bloom. Insecticides rarely needed for control as parasitic wasps often provide sufficient control. Bt products can provide safe control, but good coverage is a must. Do not apply Dibrom if temperature is above 90F.
87
Chapter 6: Strawberries
table 6.16. pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Aphids Thrips Timing of Treatment/Comments See comments for applications made at leaf emergence. Do not apply Dibrom if temperature is above 90F. Product Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Same materials as at leaf emergence. Dibrom 8, 1 pt (1), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or SpinTor 2SC, 46 fl oz (1), or Success, 46 fl oz (1), or Entrust, 1.251.5 oz (1), or Radiant SC, 610 fl oz (1) Same materials as at leaf emergence.
Whiteflies
As needed.
hArvest yeAr(s): eArly (510% bloom) Diseases Botrytis fruit rot (gray mold) Blossom protection is critical for gray mold control. Unopened blossoms are not in danger, but newly opened and aging blossoms are. Research consistently has shown that excellent gray mold control can be achieved with just two fungicide sprays, applied at early bloom and full bloom. However, if the bloom period is prolonged or wet, an additional application at late bloom might be needed. Repeat at harvest, if wet conditions occur. Note that for products containing captan, the REI is 24 hr.
Elevate 50WDG, 1.5 lb (0), or Switch 62.5WDG, 1114 oz (0), or Captan 50W, 6 lb or Captec 4L, 3 qt (0), or Thiram 75WDG, 4.4 lb (3), or Topsin M 70WSB, 0.5 lb (1) plus Captan 50WP, 3 lb or Captec 4L, 1.5 qt (0), or Pristinea, 18.523 oz (0), or Captevate 68WDG, 3.55.25 lb (0), or Scala SC, 18 oz if used alone, or 9 oz in tank mixtures (1) Same materials as at leaf emergence, or Topsin M 70WP, 0.751.0 lb (1) Copper hydroxide or copper sulfate, various formulations and rates. Aliette WDG, 2.55.0 lb/A (0.5), or Phostrol, 2.55.0 pt ()
Leaf spot and leaf blight Angular leaf spot Leather rot
See comments for materials applied at leaf emergence. Topsin M is also labeled for leaf scorch. See text discussion of angular leaf spot for details on application. Begin foliar application between 10% bloom and early fruit set, and continue on a 7- to 14-day interval as long as conditions are favorable for disease development. When disease pressure is heavy, use the minimum time interval, high rates, and the maximum number of applications.
Insects Do not apply insecticides during bloom. hArvest yeAr(s): midbloom Diseases Botrytis fruit rot (gray mold) See comments for early bloom.
Same materials available as at early bloom. Alternate materials from different pesticide classes for resistance management. Same materials as at leaf emergence. Alternate materials from different pesticide classes for resistance management.
continued
88
table 6.16. pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Angular leaf spot Timing of Treatment/Comments See text discussion of angular leaf spot for details on application. Product Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Copper hydroxide or copper sulfate, various formulations and rates.
Insects Do not apply insecticides during bloom. hArvest yeAr(s): lAte bloom Diseases Botrytis fruit rot (gray mold) This fungicide application may not be necessary unless a prolonged bloom period or wet conditions occur. Leaf spot and leaf blight Same comments as at leaf emergence.
Same materials available as at early bloom. Remember to alternate or tank-mix materials for resistance management. Same materials available as at early bloom. Remember to alternate or combine materials for resistance management.
Insects Do not apply insecticides during bloom. hArvest yeAr(s): green Fruit Diseases Angular leaf spot See text discussion of angular leaf spot for details on application. Anthracnose Before disease develops, then on a 7- to 10-day schedule. Abound, Cabrio, and one of the active ingredients in Pristine are in the same chemical class, and cannot be rotated with each other for resistance management purposes. Do not make more than two sequential applications of fungicides from this activity group. See fungicide efficacy table for classes of fungicides. Note that for Captevate and products containing captan, the REI is 24 hr. At fruit set. Do not use more than 1.5 qt per treated acre per year.Apply to soil as a band application or through drip irrigation. Begin foliar application between 10% bloom and early fruit set, and continue on a 7- to 14-day interval as long as conditions are favorable for disease development. When disease pressure is heavy, use the minimum time interval, high rates, and the maximum number of applications. Insects and Mites Plant bugs (Lygus bugs) Spittlebugs
Copper hydroxide or copper sulfate, various formulations and rates. Aboundb, 6.215.4 oz (0), or Captan 50W, 6 lb (0), or Cabrio EG, 1214 oz (0), or Pristinea, 18.523 oz (0), or Captevate 68WDG, 5.25 lb (0), or Switch 62.5WDG, 1114 oz (0) Ridomil Gold SL, 1 pt/treated A () Aliette WDG, 2.55.0 lb/A (0.5), or Phostrol, 2.55.0 pt ()
Leather rot
Same comments as when flower buds in cluster separate. Spittlebugs are frequently a larger problem in weedy fields. Good weed control will discourage large populations of spittlebugs from establishing in the planting.
Same materials available as when flower buds in cluster separate. Thionex 3EC,1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Provado 1.6F, 3.8 oz (7), or Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0), or Danitol 2.4 EC, 10.67 oz (2), or Sevin 4F, 12 qt or 80S, 1.252.5 lb (7), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Assail 70WP, 0.81.7 oz or 30SG, 1.94.0 oz (1)
continued
89
Chapter 6: Strawberries
table 6.16. pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Strawberry leafroller Spider mites Timing of Treatment/Comments See comments for when flower buds in cluster separate. See comments made at leaf emergence concerning miticides. Product Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Same materials available as when flower buds in cluster separate. Same materials available for use as at leaf emergence. Remember to alternate activity groups for resistance management. Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Diazinon 50WP, 1 lb or AG500, 1 pt (5), or Dibrom 8, 1 pt (1), or Provado 1.6F, 3.8 oz (7), or Aza-Direct, 1656 fl oz (0), or Actara, 1.53.0 fl oz (3), or Assail 70WP, 0.81.7 oz or 30SG, 1.94.0 oz (1) Brigade WSP, 832 oz (0), or Actara, 4 oz (3), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt (3) or 57EC, 1.53 pt
Aphids
As necessary. Scout on new growth during the season. Do not apply Dibrom if temperature is above 90F.
Whiteflies
As needed. M-Pede is an insecticidal soap, and should be targeted against Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or first-generation nymphs. Esteem 0.86EC, 10 fl oz (2), or Oberon 2SC, 1216 fl oz (3), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or Provado 1.6F, 3.8 oz (7), or Actara, 1.53.0 fl oz (3), or M-Pede, 12% solution (0) When injury appears. See text discussion. No cultural controls are effective. M-Pede is an insecticidal soap and should be targeted against first-generation nymphs. Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb or 4F, 12 qt (7), or M-Pede, 2.0% solution (0), or Actara, 1.53.0 oz (3), or Assail 70WP, 0.81.7 oz or 30SG, 1.94.0 oz (1) Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb, or 4F, 12 qt (7), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or Pyganic EC 1.4 II, 14 pt (0)
Leafhoppers
hArvest yeAr(s): pinK Fruit through hArvest Diseases Anthracnose See comments made at green fruit stage.
Same materials available as at green fruit stage. Remember to use materials from different pesticide classes for resistance management. Same materials available as at early bloom. Note days-to-harvest limitations for all products. For products containing captan, note that the REI is 24 hours even though the PHI is 0 days.
continued
90
table 6.16. pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Angular leaf spot Timing of Treatment/Comments See text discussion of angular leaf spot for details on application. Product Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Copper hydroxide or copper sulfate, various formulations and rates.
Applied as a soil surface treatment. Most effective if applied in evening after rain or irrigation. Do not allow Deadline to contact fruit. Mechanical traps are effective. Scout by tapping flower clusters over a white surface. Treatment threshold is one nymph per 4 flower clusters. Tarnished plant bugs are attracted to certain weed species for egg laying, and tend to be a larger problem with late-season cultivars. Note that materials with long daysto-harvest limitations will not be usable closer to harvest. Do not apply Dibrom if temperature is above 90F. As necessary. Keep ripe fruit harvested. This cultural control is highly effective. Do not apply Dibrom if temperature is above 90F.
Deadline Bullets, 1040 lb (), or Sluggo, 2044 lb () Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Dibrom 8, 1 pt (1), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0), or Danitol 2.4EC, 10.67 oz (2), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or Sevin 80S, 1.872.5 lb or 4F, 1.52 qt (7) Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0), or Danitol 2.4EC, 1621.3 oz (2), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1) Dibrom 8, 1 pt (1), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or SpinTor 2SC, 46 fl oz (1), or Success, 46 fl oz (1), or Entrust, 1.251.5 oz (1), or Radiant SC, 610 fl oz (1) Thionex 3EC, 1.33 qt or 50WP, 2 lb (4), or Provado 1.6F, 3.8 oz (7), or Brigade WSB, 6.432 oz (0), or Danitol 2.4 EC, 10.67 oz (2), or Sevin 4F, 12 qt or 80S, 1.252.5 lb (7), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Assail 70WP, 0.81.7 oz 30SG, 1.94.0 oz (1) Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb or 4F, 12 qt (7), or Assail 70WP, 0.81.7 oz (1), or Actara, 1.53.0 oz (3), or M-Pede, 2.0% solution (0) Same materials available as at green fruit. Brigade WSP, 832 oz (0), or Actara, 4 oz (3), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt or 57EC, 1.53 pt (3)
continued
Sap beetles
Thrips
Spittlebugs
Spittlebugs are frequently a larger problem in weedy fields. Good weed control will discourage large populations of spittlebugs from establishing in the planting. Materials with long days-to-harvest limitations will not be usable closer to harvest.
Leafhoppers
When injury appears. No cultural controls are effective. Materials with long days-to-harvest limitations will not be usable closer to harvest. M-Pede is an insecticidal soap and should be targeted against firstgeneration nymphs. See comments for green fruit. Materials with long days-to-harvest limitations will not be usable closer to harvest. When damage appears or adults are present. Adults feed at night. Insecticide applications made at night may enhance control.
91
Chapter 6: Strawberries
table 6.16. pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Whiteflies Japanese beetles Timing of Treatment/Comments See comments for green fruit. Materials with long days-to-harvest limitations will not be usable near harvest. Feeding at this time is likely to be of concern only for day-neutral cultivars. Watch days-to-harvest limitations. Product Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Same materials available as at green fruit. Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb, or 4F, 12 qt (7), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz (1), or Pyganic EC 1.4 II, 14 pt (0)
hArvest yeAr(s): renovAtion Diseases Red stele After harvest as banded application. Apply to soil as a band application or through drip irrigation. For annual plantings, begin foliar applications 1421 days after planting and continue on a 30- to 60-day interval as long as conditions favor disease development. For perennial plantings, begin applications when plants start active growth in spring. If disease conditions persist or reoccur, make additional applications on a 30- to 60-day interval. When disease pressure is heavy, use the minimum time interval, high rates, and the maximum number of applications. Chemical treatment cannot compensate for an excessively wet site. Insects and Mites Cyclamen mites White grub complex
Ridomil Gold SL, 1 pt/treated A () Aliette WDG, 2.55.0 lb (0.5), or Phostrol, 2.55.0 pt ()
Same materials available as at leaf emergence. White grub complex refers to any or all of the grubs(larvae) of Asiatic garden beetle, European chafer, Japanese beetle, or Oriental beetle. Admire 2F must be soil incorporated with at least 0.25 inches of water within 2 hours of application. Admire may be applied in spring or at renovation, but not at both times in the same year. See comments made for pink fruit through harvest. Treatment is only necessary if feeding damage becomes severe. Activity of Pyganic is short in duration.
Same materials available as at leaf emergence. Admire Pro, 7.010.5 fl oz (14), or Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (50)
Same materials available as at pink fruit through harvest. Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb, or 4F, 12 qt (7), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or Pyganic EC 1.4 II, 14 pt (0)
hArvest yeAr(s): postrenovAtion Diseases Leaf spot, leaf blight, and See comments made at leaf emergence. Remember to alternate materials Same materials available as at leaf emergence. powdery mildew from different activity groups for resistance management. Leather rot Insects Strawberry root weevil (adults) In the fall in fields where a problem. Apply to soil as a band application or through drip irrigation. When damage appears or adults are present. Adults feed at night. Ridomil Gold SL, 1 pt/treated A ()
Brigade WSP, 832 oz (0), or Actara, 4 oz (3), or Malathion 8F, 1.52 pt, or 57EC, 1.53.0 pt (3) Platinum, 12 fl oz (50)
continued
Treat within one month after renovation when larvae are small and actively feeding.
92
table 6.16. pesticides for strawberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Strawberry leafroller Aphids Timing of Treatment/Comments See comments made for this insect at time flower buds in cluster separate. See comments made at green fruit. Actara and Platinum have the same active ingredient. When feeding damage is detected. Insecticide applications made at night may enhance control. As needed. Actara and Platinum have the same active ingredient. Product Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Same materials available as when flower buds in cluster separate. Same materials available as at green fruit, or Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (50), or Admire Pro, 10.514.0 fl oz (14) Pyganic EC 1.4 II, 14 pt (0) Same materials available as at green fruit, or Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (50), or Admire Pro, 10.514.0 fl oz (14) Same materials available as for pink fruit through harvest, or Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (50) Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb, or 4F, 12 qt (7), or Assail 70WP, 1.73.0 oz or 30SG, 4.06.9 oz (1), or Pyganic EC 1.4 II, 14 pt (0) Admire Pro, 7.010.5 fl oz (14), or Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (50)
Leafhoppers
Japanese beetles
Treatment is only necessary if feeding damage becomes severe. Activity of Pyganic is short in duration. For treatment of grubs of Asiatic garden beetle, European and masked chafer, Japanese beetle, and Oriental beetle in perennial systems only. Apply during egg-laying period.
note: () = days to harvest not specifically stated on label, though use pattern may otherwise define time frame for use. a. Pristine may cause injury to foliage of Concord or related grape varieties such as Worden and Fredonia. Do not use Pristine on these varieties and use special care when applying to prevent contact with these sensitive varieties. Thoroughly rinse spray equipment, including the inside of the tank, hoses, and nozzles after and before using the same equipment on these sensitive grape varieties. b. Do not allow Abound to drift to McIntosh, Gala, or related apple cultivars (Bancroft, Bromley, Cortland, Cox, Discover, Empire, Jonamac, Kent, McIntosh, Spartan, and Summared). Do not use the same spray equipment for other materials that will be applied to these cultivars, even if thoroughly cleaned.
93
Chapter 6: Strawberries
table 6.17. Additional restrictions on strawberry fungicides and insecticides. Note: The information below is correct to the best of our knowledge. Other formulations with the same active ingredient as some of the products listed below may exist and may be labeled for the same uses. Always consult the label before making pesticide applications. Information was current as of October 1, 2009.
Abound Do not apply more than two sequential applications of Abound before alternating with a fungicide with a different mode of action. See label for several additional resistance management strategies. See Table 6.14 for activity groups of fungicides labeled for use on strawberries. Do not allow to drift to McIntosh, Gala, or related apple cultivars (Bancroft, Bromley, Cortland, Cox, Discover, Empire, Jonamac, Kent, McIntosh, Spartan, and Summared). Do not use the same spray equipment for other materials that will be applied to these cultivars, even if thoroughly cleaned. Limited to two applications of Acramite per season. Applications must be at least 21 days apart. Do not exceed 12 oz of Actara or 0.188 lb ai of thiamethoxam-containing products per acre per growing season. Minimum interval between applications is 10 days. Do not apply more than 10.5 fl oz (0.38 lb ai) of Admire Pro per acre per season. See additional notes in Provado restrictions concerning use of Admire and Provado in the same season. Do not exceed 16 fl oz per acre per application or 64 fl oz per acre per season. Allow at least 21 days following second application before making another application. Do not exceed 30 lbs of product per acre per season. Do not exceed a total of 0.26 lb ai per acre per growing season, make more than 2 applications per season, or apply more often than once every 7 days. Do not apply more than 0.5 lb ai (80 oz of product) per acre per season. Do not apply more than two sequential applications of Cabrio before alternating with a fungicide with a different mode of action. See label for several additional resistance management strategies. See Table 6.14 for activity groups of fungicides labeled for use on strawberries. Do not apply more than 30 lb of 80WDG, or equivalent of a different formulation, per acre per season. Do not apply more than 24 qt per season. Do make more than two consecutive applications of Captevate. Do not apply more than 21.0 lb per acre per season. Do not make more than two applications of Danitol within 12 consecutive months. Do not apply more than one foliar and one soil application per crop. Do not apply more than 5 pts per acre per season. Do not apply more than 6 lbs of Elevate per acre per year. Do not make more than two Esteem 0.86EC applications per growing season. Do not exceed 20 fl oz Esteem 0.86EC per acre per season. Do not apply earlier than 30 days after the last Esteem application. Do not apply more than a total of 62 fl oz of Kanemite 15SC per acre per season. Do not make more than two applications of Kanemite 15SC per year. Allow a minimum of 21 days between applications of Kanemite 15SC. Do not make more than 2 applications per season. Note that Kelthane may now only be used for strawberries. Do not make more than 2 foliar applications of Lorsban or another product containing chlorpyrifos per year. Do not make a second application of any product containing chlorpyrifos within 10 days of the first application.
continued
Captan Captec Captevate Danitol Diazinon Dibrom 8E Elevate Esteem 0.86EC Kanemite Kelthane Lorsban
94
Procure Provado
Sevin Spintor, Entrust, Success Switch Thionex Tilt Topsin M 70WSB Vendex 50WP Zeal
95
Chapter 6: Strawberries
weeds
A general discussion of weed management options for small fruit plantings is presented in Chapter 4, and should be consulted for additional information. Topics covered include cultural practices such as site selection and preparation, mechanical management, and use of mulches (including plastic). Herbicides are discussed in detail as well. Weed management as it pertains specifically to strawberry plantings is discussed below.
site prepArAtion
Good weed control starts long before the field is planted. As discussed in Chapter 2, cover cropping with competitive crops for 1 to 2 years before planting reduces the number of weed species in a given field. This practice also increases organic matter if plowed in at the end of the year. Weeds can also be controlled before planting by growing other row crops such as corn. This is especially desirable for a crop such as strawberries where few chemical options exist after the crop is planted. This particularly strategy is effective for getting yellow nutsedge under control in a prospective strawberry field since both the cultivation and the herbicides registered for corn can control this noxious weed. Because strawberry plants are poor competitors due to their low stature, they are especially weak competitors against yellow nutsedge. Nonselective herbicides such as glyphosate or fumigants like metamsodium (Vapam) can be applied during site preparation prior to planting. A major weed control objective in site preparation is to eliminate perennial broadleaf weeds. Once strawberries are planted, many perennial weed species, especially broadleaves, are impossible to control with herbicides due to few effective options, so controlling them before planting is the most viable option.
rate, so with longer weed control comes a higher risk of stunting the crop plant. This may be especially problematic with strawberries since a large proportion of their shallow root system may be exposed to herbicides effects. For this reason, cultivation is and will remain an important tool. Cultivation and handhoeing should begin as soon as weeds begin to germinate. Repeat as often as required to prevent the establishment of weeds not controlled with herbicides. Mechanical cultivation and hand-hoeing may again be necessary when herbicides lose their effectiveness, usually about two months after planting. Cultivation should be shallow and done carefully to avoid damaging established plants. The cultivator may be used to reposition runners and daughter plants early in their development. The cultivator should be set to throw soil shallowly into the row to anchor the runners and encourage rooting of the daughter plants. Consider applying a supplemental preemergence herbicide in midsummer after the desired number of daughter plantsusually four to five plants per square foot in matted-row productionhave rooted. Use postemergence herbicides recommended for newly planted strawberries when susceptible weeds are observed. Hand-pull weeds in the row that escape the above measures. As mentioned above, herbicides are classified as either preemergence or postemergence in reference to their time of application relative to whether the weed has emerged from the soil. Preemergence herbicides are applied before weed emergence and thus prevent weeds from establishing. Labels often state that preemergence herbicides must be activated by rainfall, cultivation, or irrigation. Typically, the purpose of these activities is to solubilize the herbicide and move it into the zone of weed germination, as well as to prevent herbicide losses as a vapor. Of preemergence herbicides labeled for strawberries, DCPA (Dacthal) and napropamide (Devrinol) work by inhibiting cell division mainly in the roots, and terbacil (Sinbar) works by inhibiting photosynthesis. Sinbar, besides having this effect on germinating weeds, also kills recently emerged weeds (those just at the cotyledon stage).
Chateau is a premergence herbicide that inhibits the manufacture of chlorophyll, and also has burndown activity, similar to that of Goal. When using preemergence herbicides, best results are obtained by 1. carefully matching the chemical with the weeds you need to control (see Table 4.1), 2. applying the rate appropriate for your soil type and organic matter content (see Table 6.18), 3. preparing soil properly, 4. incorporating herbicides that must be incorporated to be effective, and 5. having preemergence herbicides in place before weeds emerge. Apply preemergence herbicides in spring before weed seeds germinate to control summer annual weedsthis means the herbicide should be in the soil when dogwoods are in full bloom. Applying preemergence herbicides in late summer will control winter annual weeds. Postemergence herbicides, used for controlling weeds after they have emerged from the soil, fall into the categories of contact or translocated (systemic). Contact herbicides such as paraquat (Gramoxone), pelargonic acid (Scythe), carfentrazone (Aim), and acifluorfen (Ultra Blazer) kill only the foliage covered by the spray, so thorough coverage is important. Because these herbicides do not translocate (move within the plant), the roots survive. Hence, control of perennial weeds is only temporary since these plants will regrow from their root system. Translocated herbicides such as glyphosate (Roundup, others), 2,4-D, clopyralid (Stinger), fluazifop (Fusilade), sethoxydim (Poast), and clethodim (Select) move within the plant and kill portions with which they may or may not have come in contact, eventually killing the entire plant. Postemergence herbicides also can be classified as selective or nonselective. Selective herbicides kill only certain classes of weeds, while nonselective herbicides kill all weeds. Scythe, Gramoxone, and glyphosate are nonselective herbicides and therefore kill or damage any plant with which they come in con-
96
tact. Scythe and Gramoxone disrupt cell membranes. Glyphosate inhibits amino acid production and thus the production of protein in the plant. Fusilade, Poast, and Select are translocated selective herbicides that work on grasses by inhibiting fatty acid synthesis, thus killing their growing points. The translocated herbicides 2,4-D and Stinger are growth regulatorsthey work through a variety of effects and are effective primarily on broadleaves. When using postemergence herbicides, best results are obtained by: 1. carefully matching the chemical with the weeds you need to control (see Table 4.1), 2. treating when weeds are actively growing and not under drought stress, 3. adding an appropriate surfactant or other adjuvant if the label calls for it, 4. applying contact herbicides when crop and weeds are within the recommended size and/or leaf stage, 5. applying under calm conditions to avoid spray drift, 6. verifying whether two postemergence herbicides can be combined without affecting crop tolerance or weed control when considering tank mixes. To use herbicides effectively, there is no substitute for thorough knowledge of soil and herbicide characteristics. There may be some confusion about the proper rate of herbicides to use on the crop. Most recommendations are given as a range. What factors dictate proper application rates? Generally, heavier soils require more of an herbicide than lighter soils because the chemicals adsorb to clay particles and organic matter in heavier soils. In addition, the presence of undecomposed organic matter on the soil surface can lower herbicide effectiveness. Control may be more difficult if the herbicide is applied over mulching materials. Table 6.18 gives rate ranges for preemergent strawberry herbicides on different soil types, and Table 6.19 gives additional recommendations for weed control in strawberries by time of year. Brief descriptions of herbicides available for use on strawberries follow. Do not use these materials without consulting Table 6.19 for recommended rates, timings, and restrictions.
Napropamide (Devrinol) is a soilapplied, selective, preemergence herbicide that controls many annual grasses and certain broadleaved weeds, including chickweed, at the germination stage. It will not control established weeds. Devrinol at half the maximum rate can be applied to weed-free soil immediately after transplanting strawberries. It can also be applied to new and established plantings in the late summer or early fall, but only after the desired number of daughter plants have established since Devrinol inhibits daughter plant rooting. In addition, Devrinol can be applied from late fall through early winter (not on frozen ground) or in early spring. Application in the fall just before winter mulching is especially useful since Devrinol will prevent growth of any small-grain seedlings emerging from the mulch and will provide control of spring-germinating weeds. While Devrinol is useful at several times, there is a limit of 4 pounds of ai (8 pounds of Devrinol 50DF) per acre per year. Devrinol is broken down by sunlight and therefore must be incorporated by rainfall, inch of irrigation, or shallow cultivation within 24 hours after application. This moves the herbicide into the soil and prevents breakdown. Do not apply from bloom through harvest. DCPA (Dacthal) is a soil-applied preemergence herbicide that can be applied before transplanting if shallowly incorporated or at any time after transplanting to weed-free soil. In established plantings, it can be applied to weed-free soil in the fall or spring but not after bloom. Dacthal primarily controls annual grasses and certain small-seeded broad-leaf weeds such as field pansy, chickweed, lambsquarters, and purslane. Flumioxazin (Chateau) is a soilapplied preemergence herbicide that also has burndown activity, similar to Goal. It must be applied to plants that are dormant and is labeled only for use on established plants during the fall and spring. Damage will occur to green tissue that comes in contact with the herbicide. Chateau can be difficult to clean out of a sprayer. Sprayers used for Chateau must be thoroughly cleaned according to label Clean Out Instructions if the tank or any part of the sprayer will
be used for nondormant applications or on other crops. Otherwise, unexpected damage may occur during subsequent applications. Tank-mixing with 2,4D when treating dormant matted-row strawberries in early spring improves the spectrum of weeds controlled, as does tank-mixing with Gramoxone when applying a shielded spray between the rows of strawberries grown on plastic mulch. Oil concentrate at 1 percent of the spray solution volume or nonionic surfactant at 0.25 percent of the spray solution volume may be added to improve control of emerged weeds but also may increase the risk of crop injury. Chateau provides control of wild pansy (Johnny-Jump-Up), chickweed, groundsel, and many other broadleaf weeds common in strawberry plantings. Terbacil (Sinbar) is a preemergence herbicide that also is effective against susceptible weeds when newly germinated. Sinbar controls many annual broadleaf weeds but may be weak on pigweed species. During the establishment year, Sinbar can be used at low rates after transplanting but before new runner plants start to root. If strawberry transplants have developed new foliage prior to application, the spray must be followed immediately by to 1 inch of irrigation or rainfall to wash the Sinbar off the strawberry foliage since unacceptable crop injury may result through foliar absorption. University data from Rutgers have shown that more consistent weed control and less crop injury occurs when Sinbar 80WP at 1 oz/acre is applied at 3-week intervals rather than higher rates. Applications should be begun 3 to 6 weeks after transplanting when the strawberries have three new full-size trifoliate leaves, but before weeds exceed 1 inch in height. During the establishment year, Sinbar can also be applied in late summer or early fall to control winter annual weeds, such as chickweed, following the application with irrigation or rainfall. In late fall, but before the ground is frozen, Sinbar can be applied to extend weed control through the following harvest season. In established plantings, Sinbar can be used at renovation after the old leaves have been removed but before new growth begins. It can also be used in established
97
Chapter 6: Strawberries
plantings prior to mulching in late fall, though at higher rates than in the establishment year. Growers should note that Sinbar 80WP may be applied at a maximum of 8 ounces per year. Lower rates are recommended for light, textured soils and soils with 1 to 2 percent organic matter. Sinbar should not be used on soils with less than percent organic matter. Do not add surfactant, oil concentrate, or any other spray additive or tank mix with any other pesticide unless the mixture is approved on the Sinbar label. Strawberry varieties vary in their sensitivity to Sinbar. Some varieties (e.g., Earliglow) are tolerant while others (e.g., Guardian) are known to be sensitive. When low rates (fewer than 4 ounces of product) are applied to unstressed plants, injury is unlikely on most varieties. When using maximum labeled rates in established plantings, consider treating a small area to determine whether the variety you are growing is sensitive. Pendimethalin (Prowl H2O) is a preemergence herbicide that controls many annual grasses and some smallseeded broadleaf weeds. As the formulation name implies, the material is water based, which offers certain advantages. However, large amounts rainfall or irrigation after application may result in reduced performance. In matted-row production during the establishment year, it can be used as a broadcast spray either before planting, or soon after planting before new foliage begins to grow. Applying later than this can result in stunting of plants. Once the plants have begun growing, it can be applied between the rows if a shielded sprayer is used. Other allowable timings for use are after the plants are dormant in the fall and after renovation. In plasticulture plantings, this material can be used between the rows. 2,4-D amine is a foliar-applied, selective, postemergence, translocated herbicide used to control established annual and perennial broadleaved weeds. It will not control grasses. It can be used in the spring when the strawberries are still dormant. Some growers find applying 2,4-D in the spring over the straw mulch before removal (when dandelions have
emerged through the straw but before strawberries begin active growth) to be valuable. However, 2,4-D application is particularly useful at renovation to control dandelion and other established broadleaved weeds. Apply immediately after harvest and allow 5 to 7 days for maximum translocation before mowing. Previously issued labels allowed use in late fall when the plants were dormant. However, if applied before plants were fully dormant 2,4-D had the potential to damage developing flower buds. Labels currently issued do not include the latefall timing. Some crops, such as tomatoes and grapes, are especially sensitive to 2,4-D. Follow label instructions to avoid drift to sensitive crops. Do not apply unless possible injury to the crop is acceptable. Clopyralid (Stinger) can be used legally only in states with a Special Local Needs label (in the Mid-Atlantic region: Pennsylvania, New Jersey, Maryland, and Virginia). Stinger is a foliar-applied, selective, postemergence, translocated herbicide. In new plantings, it can be used in late summer and early fall. In established plantings, it can be used in the spring at least 30 days prior to harvest, and after harvest through early fall. Stinger controls weeds in the composite and legume plant families. Common annuals controlled include galinsoga, ragweed species, common cocklebur, groundsel, pineappleweed, clover, and vetch. Perennials controlled include Canada thistle, goldenrod species, aster species, and mugwort (wild chrysanthemum). Spot treatment of Canada thistle colonies with Stinger is often all that is required since fields are rarely completely infested. Stinger will not control many common broadleaved weeds such as pigweed and lambsquarters. Stinger is very effective on weeds less than 2 to 4 inches tall, but it is less effective and takes longer to work when weeds are larger. Use 2 to 4 fluid ounces to control annual weeds less than 2 inches tall. Increase the rate to 4 to 8 fluid ounces to control larger annual weeds. Apply the maximum rate of 10 fluid ounces (2/3 pint) in one application or split into two applications to suppress or control perennial weeds, but do not exceed 10 fluid ounces in one
year. When two applications are used to control susceptible hard-to-kill perennial weeds, spray the first application in the spring at least 30 days before harvest and the second application after harvest at renovation. Spray additives are not needed or required by the label and are not recommended. Do not tank-mix Stinger with other herbicides registered for use in strawberries. Stinger has residual soil activity; therefore, observe restrictions concerning subsequent crops to avoid injury from herbicide carryover. Clethodim (Select) and sethoxydim (Poast) are foliar-applied, postemergence, translocated herbicides for grass control. Both can be applied at any time after the planting is established when grasses are at the specified growth stages. For best results, treat annual grasses when they are actively growing and before tillers are present. Both Select and Poast control many annual and certain perennial grasses. Select controls annual bluegrass but will not consistently control goosegrass. Neither will control yellow nutsedge, wild onion, or broadleaf weeds. Control may be reduced if grasses are large or if hot, dry weather or drought conditions occur. Repeated applications may be needed to control certain perennial grasses. Crop oil concentrate should be added as 1 percent of the spray solution (1 gallon of oil per 100 gallons of spray solution). Using oil concentrate may increase the risk of crop injury when hot or humid conditions prevail. To reduce the risk of crop injury, omit additives or switch to a nonionic surfactant when grasses are small and soil moisture is adequate. Do not tank-mix with or apply within 2 to 3 days of any other pesticide unless labeled because the risk of crop injury may be increased or control of grasses may be reduced. Paraquat (Gramoxone), pelargonic acid (Scythe), carfentrazone (Aim), and acifluorfen (Ultra Blazer) are foliar-applied, postemergence, contact (nontranslocated) herbicides sometimes referred to as burn-down materials. They only affect the parts of plants with which they contact, so incomplete coverage results in incomplete control. They are most useful for annual weeds,
98
especially when the weeds are small. They only burn the tops off of perennial weeds, which have the capacity to regrow from their roots. Scythe can be somewhat less effective than Gramoxone, and relatively large volumes of the herbicide are required. However, Scythe has the advantage of being safer to the applicator and can be used up until the day of harvest.
Weeds between the mulched beds can be controlled with standard herbicides. Band the treatment between the strips of plastic. New option for controlling weeds between rows are Chateau 51DF and Prowl H2O. Chateau 51DF may be applied between the rows of plastic at 3 ounces per acre using a shielded sprayer as soon as possible after planting. Adding Devrinol 50DF at 4 pounds per acre will broaden the spectrum of weeds controlled. Prowl H2O may be applied at 1.5 to 3.0 pints per acre, calculating the rate on only the area treated, not concentrating the entire per acre rate into the row middles. Grasses between the rows and around plant holes can also be controlled postemergence with applications of Poast 1.5EC. See recommendations for Poast 1.5EC in Table 6.19.
crops that get frequent cultivation are often perennial weed free. In the late summer or fall the year before strawberry planting, apply Roundup, 2,4-D, or Stinger, if necessary, to clean up any perennial weeds. Spot treat perennial weeds even if only small patches exist. During the fall that precedes planting, seed a rye cover crop that will overwinter and build soil organic matter; lime and fertilize according to soil test results to raise soil fertility levels. 2. Prevent establishment of weeds by using timely applications of preemergence herbicides and cultivation throughout the establishment year. At planting in the spring, use 2 to 4 pounds of Devrinol 50WP (or other formulation) or 6 to 12 pints of Dacthal 6F per acre (for grasses) plus 2 to 3 ounces of Sinbar 80WP per acre (for broadleaves) immediately after planting. Be sure to see Sinbar precautions about organic matter and variety sensitivity. Irrigation or rainfall immediately after herbicide application is needed to incorporate the herbicide, and, in the case of Devrinol, avoid degradation by sunlight. Dacthal may be preplant incorporated. The Sinbar application can be delayed 3 to 4 weeks after planting. However, if applied after strawberries have produced new foliage, it must be irrigated off of foliage immediately after application. In the summer of the planting year, the initial herbicide application will be effective for 6 to 8 weeks. Following this, cultivation is essential for good strawberry weed control. Frequent cultivation will control seedling weeds. Poast or Select will control grass weeds, and Stinger may be applied later in the summer to control certain broadleaved weeds that escape cultivation. These herbicides only control weeds that are present at the time of application. In late summer and early fall of the planting year (late August or early September), cultivate and then apply 2 to 4 pounds Devrinol 50WP (or other formulation) plus 2 to 3 ounces of Sinbar. This application is important because it will prevent establishment of many fall germinating weeds. Be sure to irrigate or time applications to coincide with rain-
99
Chapter 6: Strawberries
fall to incorporate the Devrinol and wash Sinbar off of strawberry foliage. In late fall after plants are dormant, inspect the planting. If many broadleaved weeds are present, note which types of weeds are present to be ready for spring applications of 2,4-D or Stinger. Just before mulching apply 4 to 6 pounds of Devrinol 50WP (or other formulation) per acre. This is important to prevent germination of wheat or rye seed (and other weed seeds) in the mulch. Mulch immediately after Devrinol application or irrigate it in. The maximum rate of Devrinol 50WP per year is 8 pounds per acre, so subtract previous application rates from 8 and apply the balance. Use plenty of clean rye or wheat straw mulch. Many growers grow their own rye straw, harvesting it before it forms heads. In any event, be sure that the straw used for mulch is not forming seed heads. Straw infested with weed seedheads, such as Canada thistle, should be avoided.
3. Use methods of weed control that are tailored to your weed species during the harvest years. In the spring of the first bearing year, Poast may be applied within 7 days of harvest, but grass weeds are unlikely to be present. Sinbar can be banded over the rows after straw is removed, but if the planting is healthy the strawberry plants will grow quickly and outcompete most weeds, so this application is not likely to be necessary. An application of 2,4-D can be made to emerging dandelions in late winter or early spring, and Stinger can be applied prior to 30 days from harvest. However, due to previous herbicide and straw mulch use, herbicides at this point should not be necessary. During renovation after harvest, apply the full rate (1 quarts) of 2,4-D amine (Formula 40 or Amine 4) or another postemergent herbicide (if a better match with your weeds) immediately after harvest and then wait 5 to 7 days so it can translocate within the weeds. Next, mow off strawberry foliage and fertilize and narrow rows. Then apply
Sinbar at the maximum use rate for your soils and irrigate. Stinger may also be used at renovation and if Canada thistle is present. In the summer, spot treat perennial weed patches (Canada thistle) with Stinger (if your state has a Special Local Needs label), if the maximum yearly rate (2/3 pint) hasnt already been reached. In the late summer or early fall, apply 2 to 4 pounds of Devrinol 50WP per acre. See Step 2 for late-fall application, after plants are dormant. Be sure to apply the balance of your Devrinol (4 to 6 pounds) just prior to mulching or in late fall to control volunteer grain and other weed seed germination over winter. Repeat the bearing year program in subsequent years. 4. Spot treat weeds that escape before they get out of hand.
table 6.18. per-acre rates per application for preemergence (residual) herbicides for common soil types for strawberries.
Rates for each active ingredient are followed by the corresponding rates of a commonly available product containing the active ingredient listed. Sand herbicide Flumioxazin (oz ai) Chateau 51WDG (oz) DCPA (lb ai) Dacthal 6F (pt) Napropamidea (lb ai) Devrinol 50DF (lb) Terbacilb (oz ai) Sinbar 80WP (oz) Pendimethalin (lb ai) Prowl H2O (pt) 01 1.5 3.0 4.56 68 24 48 0.7 1.5 12 1.5 3.0 4.56 68 24 48 1.6 2 0.7 1.5 Loamy Sand 01 12 1.5 1.5 3.0 3.0 4.56 4.56 68 68 24 24 48 48 1.6 2 0.7 0.7 1.5 1.5 soil type / % organic matter Sandy Loam Loam 01 12 24 12 24 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0 4.56 4.56 4.56 67.5 67.5 68 68 68 810 810 24 24 24 24 24 48 48 48 48 48 2.4 2.4 2.4 3.2 3 3 3 4 0.7 0.7 0.7 1.0 1.0 1.5 1.5 1.5 2.0 2.0 Silt Loam 12 24 1.5 1.5 3.0 3.0 67.5 7.59 810 1012 24 24 48 48 3.2 3.2 4 4 1.0 1.2 2.0 2.5 Clay Loam 12 24 1.5 1.5 3.0 3.0 7.59 7.59 1012 1012 24 24 48 48 3.2 3.2 4 4 1.2 1.4 2.5 3.0
= Not labeled (do not use). a. Use the lower recommended rate when tank-mixing with another preemergence herbicide, unless annual grass pressure is severe. b. Use one-half the recommended rate when tank-mixing with another preemergence herbicide.
100
table 6.19. herbicides for matted-row strawberry weed control. Note: See text for description of plasticulture weed control options.The information below is correct to the best of our knowledge. Other formulations with the same active ingredient as some of the products listed below may exist that may or may not be labeled for the same uses. Always consult the label before making pesticide applications. Read the text for information on cultural practices to minimize pest incidence. See Table 3.2 for limits on states in which these cannot be used, use status (general versus restricted), days-to-harvest limitations, and reentry intervals, and Table 6.18 to more closely determine the rate for your soil type where necessary. Information was current as of October 1, 2009.
Weeds Timing of Treatment/Comments trAnsplAnting yeAr: new plAntingsAt plAnting or posttrAnsplAnt Preemergent Annual grasses, certain smallseeded broadleaf weeds Annual grasses, suppresses or controls certain annual broadleaf weeds Apply preplant incorporated with shallow cultivation before transplanting, or apply anytime after transplanting to weed-free soil. Apply to weed-free soil immediately after transplanting. Activate with one-half inch sprinkler irrigation within 24 hours after application. If left on the soil surface, napropamide (Devrinol) is broken down by sunlight. Irrigation moves the herbicide into the soil and prevents breakdown by the sun. Active Ingredient Rate/Aa Product Rate/A (Days to Harvest)b
DCPA, 69 lb
Napropamide, 12 lb
Controls many annual broadleaf weed species, but may be weak on pigweed species
Apply 2 to 3 dry ounces of Sinbar 80WP per acre after Terbacil, 0.100.15 lb transplanting but before new runner plants start to root. Do not add surfactant, oil concentrate, or any other spray additive, or tank-mix with any other pesticide unless the mixture is approved on the Sinbar 80WP label. If strawberry transplants are allowed to develop new foliage prior to application, the spray must be followed immediately by 0.5 to 1.0 inches of irrigation or rainfall to wash the Sinbar 80WP off the strawberry foliage, or unacceptable crop injury may result. University data has shown that more consistent weed control and less crop injury occurs when 0.05 lb/A, 1 dry ounce of Sinbar 80WP is applied at 3 week intervals. Begin applications 3 to 6 weeks after transplanting, when the strawberries have 3 new full size trifoliate leaves, but before weeds exceed 1 inch in height. Certain varieties differ in their sensitivity to Sinbar. Determine varietal tolerance before spraying field. Do not apply Sinbar 80WP to soils with less than 0.5% organic matter. Do not use more than 8 ounces of Sinbar per acre per year. This product may be applied pre- or posttransplant. However, most data as of this writing indicate that application of this material prior to transplanting is safer. May also be applied through sprinkler irrigation prior to transplanting if adequate measure are taken to prevent backflow. See label. Pendimethalin, 0.71.4 lb
continued
101
Chapter 6: Strawberries
Terbacil, 0.100.3 lb Apply 2 to 6 dry ounces of Sinbar 80WP per acre in late summer or early fall to control winter annual broadleaf weeds. Use lower rates on coarse textured sandy soils low in organic matter, and higher rates on fine textured silt and clay soils high in organic matter. Do not add surfactant, oil concentrate, or any other spray additive, or tank-mix with any other pesticide unless the mixture is approved on the Sinbar 80WP label. If the crop is not dormant at the time of application, the spray must be followed immediately by 0.5 to 1.0 inches of irrigation or rainfall to wash the Sinbar 80WP off the foliage, or unacceptable crop injury may result. Certain varieties differ in their sensitivity to Sinbar. Determine varietal tolerance before spraying field. Do not apply Sinbar 80WP to soils with less than 0.5% organic matter. Do not use more than 8 ounces of Sinbar per acre per year. A second application of this material is allowed Pendimethalin, 0.71.4 lb between the rows after the plants are established, but it must not be allowed to contact the plants. Reduce per acre rate to correspond to the area sprayed (i.e., do not concentrate the entire per acre amount into the row middles). Do not exceed 6 pints per acre per season.
Postemergent Emerged annual grasses and certain perennial grasses Clethodim (Select) controls annual bluegrass, but will not consistently control goosegrass The use of oil concentrate may increase the risk of crop injury when hot or humid conditions prevail. To reduce the risk of crop injury, omit additives or switch to nonionic surfactant when grasses are small and soil moisture is adequate. Control may be reduced if grasses are large or if hot, dry weather or drought conditions occur. For best results, treat annual grasses when they are actively growing and before tillers are present. Repeated applications may be needed to control certain perennial grasses. Yellow nutsedge, wild onion, or broadleaf weeds will not be controlled. Do not tank-mix with or apply within 2 to 3 days of any other pesticide unless labeled as the risk of crop injury may be increased or reduced control of grasses may result. Clethodim, 0.0940.125 lb Select 2EC, 68 fl oz plus oil concentrate at 1% of the spray solution volume (1 gal per 100 gal of spray solution) (4), or Selectmax 0.97EC, 1216 fl oz plus nonionic surfactant at 0.25% of the spray solution volume (1 qt/100 gal of spray solution) (4), or Sethoxydim, 0.20.4 lb Poast 1.5EC, 12 pt plus oil concentrate at 1% of the spray solution volume (1 gal per 100 gal of spray solution); do not exceed 2.5 pints of Poast per acre per season (7)
continued
102
estAblished strAwberry beds new plAntingslAte FAll dormAnt Preemergent Annual grasses, certain broadleaf weeds Apply to weed-free soil in the fall and repeat in early spring, but do not apply after bloom. DCPA, 69 lb Napropamide, 24 lb Dacthal 6F, 812 pt () Devrinol 50DF, 48 lb (prebloom)
Annual grasses and certain broadleaf Apply in late fall through early winter (not on frozen weeds including chickweed spp ground) or in early spring. Do not apply from bloom through harvest. Rainfall or irrigation will increase effectiveness. Do not exceed 8 lb of Devrinol 50DF per year. Controls many annual broadleaf Apply just prior to mulching in late fall to extend weeds, but may be weak on pigweed weed control through harvest the following spring. species. Controls certain grasses Use lower rates on coarse textured sandy soils low in organic matter, and higher rates on fine textured silt and clay soils high in organic matter. Do not add surfactant, oil concentrate, or any other spray additive. Certain varieties differ in their sensitivity to Sinbar. Determine varietal tolerance before spraying field. Do not apply Sinbar 80WP to soils with less than 0.5% organic matter. Do not use more than 8 ounces of Sinbar per acre per year. Most annual grasses and certain small-seeded broadleaf weeds Apply after plants are fully dormant in the fall or in early winter. Do not exceed 6 pints per acre per season.
Terbacil, 0.100.2 lb
Pendimethalin, 0.71.4 lb
Preemergent with some burndown activity Broadleaf weeds, such as wild or May be applied only if field was planted in the spring field pansy (not the fall). A maximum of 3 oz per acre of Chateau may be applied per calendar year.
Flumioxazin, 1.5 oz
Chateau WDG, 3 oz ()
continued
103
Chapter 6: Strawberries
beAring yeArslAte winter or eArly spring Preemergent Annual grasses, certain broadleaf weeds Many broadleaf weeds, and suppresses or controls wild pansy Apply to weed-free soil in the early spring. Do not apply after bloom. DCPA, 69 lb Dacthal 6F, 812 pt (prebloom) Chateau WDG, 3 oz ()
Flumioxazin, 1.5 oz Apply to established stands of strawberries in late winter or early spring when strawberries are dormant, or in a hooded shielded spray between the rows before fruit set. Tank-mix with 2,4-D to improve the spectrum of weeds controlled in mattedrow production. Oil concentrate at 1% of the spray solution (1 gal per 100 gal of spray solution) or nonionic surfactant at 0.25% of the spray solution (1 qt per 100 gal of spray solution) may be added to improve the control of emerged weeds, but also may increase the risk of crop injury. A maximum of 3 oz per acre of Chateau may be applied per calendar year. Napropamide, 24 lb
Annual grasses and certain broadleaf In early spring, only if not already applied the weeds previous late fall or early winter. Do not apply to frozen ground. Do not apply from bloom through harvest. Rainfall or irrigation will increase effectiveness. Do not exceed 8 lb of Devrinol 50DF per year. Most annual grasses and certain small-seeded broadleaf weeds Apply as an alternative to fall application. Do not apply if new growth has already begun to emerge from the crowns. Do not exceed 6 pints per acre per season.
Pendimethalin, 0.71.4 lb
continued
104
Certain annual and perennial broadleaf weeds in the composite and legume plant families Common annuals including galinsoga, ragweed species, common cocklebur, groundsel, pineappleweed, clover, and vetch Perennials including Canada thistle, goldenrod species, aster species, and mugwort (wild chrysanthemum)
Clopyralid, 0.0470.25 lb
continued
105
Chapter 6: Strawberries
beAring yeArsrenovAtion through summer Postemergent Many emerged broadleaf weeds including dandelion Apply to established stands immediately after the last picking. Do not apply between mid-August and winter dormancy due to negative effects on flower bud formation. 2,4-D, 11.5 lb Formula 40, 11.5 qt ()
Preemergent Primarily broadleaf weeds but not pigweed species Certain grasses
Terbacil, 0.20.4 lb Apply at postharvest renovation after old leaves have been removed but before new growth begins. If using Sinbar, another product may also be needed to control annual grasses. Use lower rates on coarse textured sandy soils low in organic matter, and higher rates on fine textured silt and clay soils high in organic matter. Do not add surfactant, oil concentrate, or any other spray additive. Certain varieties differ in their sensitivity to Sinbar. Determine varietal tolerance before spraying field. Do not apply Sinbar 80WP to soils with less than 0.5% organic matter. Do not use more than 8 ounces of Sinbar per acre per year. Apply after mowing, but prior to emergence of new growth. Do not exceed 6 pints per acre per season. Apply anytime after harvest to weed-free soil. Pendimethalin, 0.71.4 lb DCPA, 69 lb
Annual grasses and certain smallseeded broadleaf weeds Annual grasses, certain broadleaf weeds
continued
106
Paraquat, 0.5 lb
Gramoxone Inteon 2SC, 2 pt, plus nonionic surfactant at 0.25% of the spray solution volume (1 qt per 100 gal of spray solution) (21)
continued
107
Chapter 6: Strawberries
estAblished plAntingslAte FAll dormAnt Preemergent Annual grasses, certain broadleaf weeds Apply to weed-free soil in the fall and repeat in early spring. Do not apply after bloom. DCPA, 69 lb Napropamide, 24 lb Dacthal 6F, 812 pt () Devrinol 50DF, 48 lb (prebloom)
Annual grasses and certain broadleaf Apply in late fall through early winter (not on frozen weeds including chickweed spp ground) or in early spring. Do not apply from bloom through harvest. Rainfall or irrigation will increase effectiveness. Do not exceed 8 lb of Devrinol 50DF per year. Many annual broadleaf weeds, but not pigweed species Certain grasses Apply just prior to mulching in late fall to extend weed control through harvest the following spring. Use lower rates on coarse textured sandy soils low in organic matter, and higher rates on fine textured silt and clay soils high in organic matter. Do not add surfactant, oil concentrate, or any other spray additive. Certain varieties differ in their sensitivity to Sinbar. Determine varietal tolerance before spraying field. Do not apply Sinbar 80WP to soils with less than 0.5% organic matter. Do not use more than 8 ounces of Sinbar per acre per year. Apply after plants are fully dormant in the fall or in early winter.
Terbacil, 0.20.4 lb
Pendimethalin, 0.71.4 lb
108
a. b. c. d.
Adding a surfactant to these herbicides may improve their effectiveness (see labels). () indicates that days-to-harvest limitations are not specified on the label; however, use directions may limit timing to certain periods of the year or growth stages. Limited to a total of 8 ounces of Sinbar applied per growing season. One to two applications per year not to exceed 0.67 pint per acre per year. Make only one application in the spring.
Additional notes All the rates in this table are given on a full-acre basis. If the material is to be banded along or over the row, use the following formula to calculate the banding rate: rate/A banded = rate/A broadcast x (band width in inches row spacing in inches). With all chemicals, follow label instructions and warnings carefully. Use pesticides safely. Consult label for restriction. It is unlawful to use recommended chemicals for crops not covered on the label or to use chemicals not cleared for such use on strawberry plantings. Formulations other than those listed, with the same active ingredient, may be labeled for the same uses.
109
IntroductIon
Blueberries are grown throughout the Mid-Atlantic region. A large, wellorganized blueberry industry is located in New Jersey where berryland soils, a type of soil made up primarily of sand and a small amount of organic matter, are found. Other areas of the region with well-drained, low-pH soils, where native indicator plants such as wild blueberries, rhododendrons, and mountain laurel grow, are also well suited to blueberry production. Blueberries are cultivated by many growers on heavier soils with a high native pH, but special well-planned measures must be taken if production is to be successful. When the soil type is too heavy (clays or clay loams) and/or the soil is of a limestone parent material, yields will likely be low and struggles with nutrient availability and plant vigor are likely to be continual. Blueberries are long-lived plants. The commercial life of a blueberry planting can be 50 years or longer, making it worthwhile to take the time during establishment to make sure that plant needs are being met.
Blueberries
contents
Introduction ......................................................109 Types of Plants...................................................109 The Blueberry Plant ...........................................109 Anatomy and Morphology ............................109 Cold-Hardiness and Chilling Requirements ..... 109 Pollination....................................................110 General Considerations in Choosing a Site .............110 Topography ..................................................110 Previous Crops and Field Borders .................. 111 Soil Characteristics ....................................... 111 Irrigation Availability ................................... 111 Culture .............................................................. 111 Soils and Soil Preparation ............................. 111 Obtaining Plants........................................... 112 Varieties ....................................................... 112 Planting and Establishment.......................... 116 Fertility ........................................................ 117 Mulching ...................................................... 117 Irrigation ...................................................... 117 Frost Protection ............................................ 117 Pruning ........................................................ 117 Harvest and Postharvest Handling ..................... 119 Economics ......................................................... 119 Pests .................................................................124 Fungal and Bacterial Diseases .......................124 Viruses and Phytoplasmas ............................126 Nematodes ...................................................127 Insect and Mite Pests ....................................127 Vertebrate Pests ..........................................133 Weeds ...............................................................133 Weed Identification ......................................145 Practices for Minimizing Weeds Between the Rows ........................................145 Practices for Minimizing Weeds in the Rows ...................................................146 Herbicides ....................................................146 Problem Perennial Weeds .............................150
types of plants
Several species of blueberries are indigenous to the United States. These include the lowbush blueberry (Vaccinium angustifolium), commercially important primarily in Maine and Canada; the rabbiteye blueberry (V. ashei), grown commercially in the southern United States; and the highbush blueberry (V. corymbosum), the commercially most widely grown blueberry in the MidAtlantic, the Pacific Northwest, and the Midwestern United States. The information given here pertains primarily to highbush blueberry production. While the highbush blueberry plant is indigenous to North America, it has been grown as a domesticated commercial fruit crop for only 80 years. The original breeding work and research was conducted by Miss Elizabeth White of Whitesbog, New Jersey, and Dr. Frederick Coville, USDA botanist, shortly after the turn of the century.
110
of blueberry plants such as rabbiteye and southern highbush types have lower chilling requirements and can therefore come out of dormancy too early in the year when planted in northern areas. Blueberries, like most fruit crops, will bloom in the early spring, so choosing a site that is free of frost is important.
pollinAtion
A blueberry bush is capable of setting 100 percent of its flowers; a 70 to 80 percent set represents a commercially viable yield. Highbush varieties are moderately to highly self-fertile. However, most will benefit from cross-pollination, which can increase the number of seeds per berry, fruit size, and weight and hasten berry ripening, all of which improve yield. Therefore, abundant insect pollinators (bees) are needed to achieve optimal pollination, even in solid-block plantings of highly self-fertile varieties. Interplanting two or more highbush cultivars will often benefit fruiting characteristics. No concrete data exist that indicate what the best arrangement of cultivars is for optimum pollination; however, alternating blocks of four rows of each cultivar is commonly suggested as a good middle ground for both pollination and cultural care considerations. Two cultivars that bloom at the same time are needed. Although cultivar-ripening periods vary, there is sufficient overlap of bloom periods to allow most cultivars to serve as pollen sources for each other. Individual cultivars can bloom for a period of 7 to more than 20 days, depending on environmental conditions. Plants of early blooming cultivars tend to have a longer flowering period than laterblooming cultivars. The top four cultivars grown in the Mid-Atlantic region bloom in the following sequence: Weymouth (early season), Duke (early midseason), Bluecrop (midseason), and Elliott (late season). Pick-your-own farms, in particular, tend to have several cultivars to extend the blueberry-picking season. Blueberry flowers have several characteristics that encourage crosspollination. Inverted flowers with narrow corolla openings protect the reproductive structures from wind and rain, preventing excessive self-pollination.
The heavy, sticky pollen grains cannot be wind blown, and fragrant nectar is secreted explicitly to attract insect pollinators to the open blossoms. Individual blueberry flowers remain receptive to pollen for only a few days, and adequate pollination must occur in this time for proper fruit set to occur. Blueberry pollen is most effectively dislodged from anthers by bees that have sonicating (buzz-pollinating) foraging behavior. These bees vibrate their wing muscles, which shakes the pollen free from the anther structures. Bumble bees (Bombus spp.) and the southeastern blueberry bee (Habropoda laboriosa), both of which are present in the Mid-Atlantic region, have this foraging behavior, while honey bees (Apis mellifera) do not. Although honey bees are less efficient at pollinating blueberry flowers, they make up for this by having larger populations than non-Apis bees, whose populations fluctuate by year and are often inadequate for large plantings. As such, wild bees should not be relied upon as the sole source of pollination. Regardless of species, one rule of thumb is to have four to eight bees foraging on each blueberry plant at any given time during the warmest part of the day. Some growers are interested in using commercial bumble bee colonies for blueberry pollination. However, not enough data are compiled to recommend this practice since commercial bumble bee colonies are currently more expensive to rent than honey bee colonies and have much smaller population sizes (fewer than 300 adults per colony). Providing one or two strong honey bee colonies (i.e., those having 30,000 or more adult bees and six or more frames of brood) per acre of blueberries is usually sufficient. Beehives should be distributed throughout large fields to ensure adequate flower visitation. Hives should be introduced when about 5 percent of the flowers have opened, but no later than when 25 percent are at full bloom. If introduced too early, honey bees will find alternative plant sources and may prefer them over blueberry flowers until the competitive plants stop blooming. Eliminating blooming weed species in the field will help focus bee activity on blueberry plants. Pesticide
use during bloom should be avoided to prevent killing bees. Once petal drop has occurred, honey bee colonies should be removed from the field. The use of bee attractants to increase the efficacy of honey bee pollination has been given minor attention. In one study, spraying a synthetic honey bee queen mandibular pheromone increased the yield of Bluecrop by at least 6 percent and farm gate revenue by $364 per acre. Plant hormone sprays, such as gibberellic acid, have also been shown to increase fruit set in poorly pollinated blueberry fields; however, this hormone induces parthenocarpic fruit set (seedless berries), resulting in small, latermaturing berries. A bumble bee look alike, the carpenter bee (Xylocopa spp.), is not a good blueberry pollinator. These bees rarely visit blueberry flowers legitimately and instead pierce the flower base with their tongues to steal nectar. Such illegitimate floral visits provide little or no pollination. Compounding this problem is the fact that honey bees learn to utilize the holes made by carpenter bees, and research has shown that 80 to 90 percent of foraging honey bees may switch to flower-robbing behavior if enough carpenter bee damage to blueberry flowers has occurred. No recommendations exist for ridding a blueberry field of carpenter bees since any chemical measures taken would likely have negative impacts on legitimate pollinators as well. While actual yield loss due to carpenter bee damage has not been documented, excessive carpenter bee activity could interfere with optimal fruit set. Providing enough honey bee colonies to overcome this potential problem would be the best solution to ensure profitable blueberry yields.
topogrAphy
Blueberries, like most fruit crops, will bloom in the early spring, so choosing a site that is free of frost, or being
111
Chapter 7: Blueberries
prepared to provide frost protection, is important. When blueberries are in full bloom, the flowers can be injured by temperatures slightly below freezing (30F). The earliest flowering varieties are most susceptible to frost injury, so avoid planting these on frost-prone sites.
as aluminum and manganese, into more available forms as well. In addition, blueberries are extremely sensitive to high salt concentrations. The NRAES Highbush Blueberry Production Guide has an excellent in-depth discussion on calcium levels and suitability of soils for blueberry production and should be consulted for further information (see Appendix E for ordering information).
irrigAtion AvAilABility
Blueberries are very sensitive to fluctuating soil moisture levels due to their shallow root systems and fine roots. Long-term damage to the plants fine root system is possible when roots die off during dry spells. Therefore, installing trickle irrigation is highly recommended in plantings. While overhead irrigation for frost protection is not needed in every year, having it available is prudent.
soil ChArACteristiCs
Blueberry roots will not tolerate extremely dry or excessively wet soils. Blueberries will thrive in light soils that are high in organic matter and have a relatively low native pH. Blueberries fall into the category of plants known as calcifuges, which means limefleeing. While heavy (clay or clay loam) soils can be amended with organic matter to improve aeration, and high pH soils can be amended with sulfur to lower the soil pH, nutritional problems are likely to be a continual concern and plant productivity is likely to be lower than in soils that are better suited for blueberry production. When a soil too high in calcium is used for blueberry production, magnesium deficiency is a recurring problem due to competition of the nutrients for uptake. When lowering the pH of a high-pH soil, the same chemical processes that change desirable nutrients, such as iron and zinc, into plant-available forms also change elements that can be toxic, such
higher pH results in the unavailability of certain nutrients, most notably iron. In southern New Jersey where highbush blueberries originally grew, soils are usually sandy loams, the water table is shallow, organic matter is high, and the soil pH is naturally between 4.3 and 5.0. Most areas outside of southern New Jersey do not have these soil characteristics, so soil must be amended and plantings must be mulched and irrigated. Even the best of soils will often have no more than 2 percent organic matter and common limestone and clay soils tend to be more alkaline than is needed for blueberries. Because most blueberry cultivars are not well adapted to heavy upland soils, most soils will require considerable amendment with organic matter if plants are to thrive. Organic matter content can be increased by growing cover crops for two or more successive years prior to planting the blueberries on the site intended. Crops such as sudangrass, hairy vetch, and rapeseed will all contribute needed organic matter if plowed under when green. For a complete discussion of preplant cover crops, see Chapter 2. Manure can be applied, but it should be composted or applied well ahead of planting to allow time for salts to be leached. Added sulfur is generally recommended to lower soil pH, but sulfur needs to be incorporated thoroughly to be effective throughout the rooting zone. Even after incorporating sulfur, the full effects may not be realized for at least 6 months. This, along with the benefits of building organic matter for one or two years, is why early site selection prior to planting is important. See Table 7.1 for
table 7.1. Amount of sulfur required to lower the soil ph.* Target pH of Soil 4.5 Sand Loam Clay Sand Present pH of Soil (lbs/acre)
4.5 5.0 5.5 6.0 6.5 7.0 7.5 0 175 350 520 650 830 1,000 0 520 1,050 1,520 2,000 2,530 3,010 0 610 1,130 1,610 2,090 2,610 3,090 0 175 350 520 650 830
5.0 Loam Clay (lbs/acre) 0 520 1,050 1,520 2,000 2,530 0 610 1,130 1,610 2,090 2,610
112
the amount of sulfur required to adjust your soil pH levels. Iron sulfate may also be used at eight times the rate in the table for sulfur. Do not use aluminum sulfate to lower the soil pH because aluminum is toxic to blueberries and is already present in many soils in the region in quantities that can negatively impact blueberry plants once the pH is lowered. Sulfur is most frequently available in a powdered form, but it is difficult to work with in this state, so some growers apply it as a slurry. Pelletized sulfur is relatively easy to manage. Because sulfur does not move through the soil readily, surface sulfur applications after the plants are in place are relatively ineffective for lowering the pH. Lowering the soil pH only in the plant row is also unadvisable because soil interactions with the high-pH soil in the row middles will make maintaining the proper pH within the row difficult. Thus, incorporating sulfur throughout the blueberry field is recommended. For organic production, select a site that has a soil pH as close to the ideal range (between 4.5 and 5.0) as possible. Fewer options may exist for lowering the soil pH as compared to conventional production. Options may include peat moss, pine bark, organic cottonseed meal, and sulfur. Working closely with your certifying agency when considering options is best to ensure organic certification is not compromised. At least one year before planting, eliminate all noxious weeds (see Controlling Weeds). Phosphorus (if needed) should be added the fall before planting. Potassium can be added either in the fall or spring.
Generally, two-year-old plants are the best buy. One-year-old cuttings require very close management or mortality will be high, and the larger size of the three-year-old plants is often not worth the extra cost. Potted plants are often more expensive as well, but many growers find that the plants establish much more quickly. As long as plants are not pot bound and effort is made to ensure good root-soil contact at planting, potted plants are a reasonable though expensive alternative. If the plant is pot bound, the root ball must be cut so that the roots will branch once the plant is placed in the hole. Remove the pot and place the plant on its side. Then, cut through the perimeter of the root mass four to six times, rotating the root ball between each cut. Cuts should be evenly spaced around the perimeter of the root mass. For organic production, planting stock does not need to be organically produced since blueberries are perennial crops. However, the planting must be managed organically on a certified organic area for one year before harvested berries can be marketed as organic. Since harvesting newly planted blueberries the first year after planting is not recommended, this generally does not affect marketing. The number of plants required per acre at various spacings is given in Table 7.2. For a list of nurseries from which to order blueberry plants, consult Appendix C.
vars are those on which long-term data on production are available. Recent cultivars may have been available for many years, but because of the longevity of blueberry plantings and the time it takes to evaluate new cultivars or plant availability, there still is not much information on their performance. However, some truly are recentreleased in the last few years as of this writing. All of the cultivars in the recent category are currently recommended for trial only.
early season
Standard Cultivars Bluetta
Bush is short, compact, low growing, spreading, and of medium vigor. Fruit is medium sized, soft, and blue black with fair flavor. Stem scars tend to be broad; fruit can hang for a long time. Consistent production may be a problem. Winters well and does not break dormancy too early. Moderately resistant to mummy berry disease; highly susceptible to anthracnose and red ringspot virus.
earliBlue
Bush is vigorous, upright. Fruit is large, firm, and light blue with fair flavor. Not recommended commercially in many areas because of erratic fruit set. Fruit does not drop easily when ripe. Plants have some resistance to powdery mildew. Especially susceptible to phomopsis twig blight and fusicoccum canker.
vArieties
Appropriate cultivar selection is crucial for any perennial crop. Blueberry cultivars can be selected so they can be harvested from July through midSeptember, if so desired. Cultivars are discussed below in order of ripening and are subgrouped as standard cultivars and recent cultivars. Standard culti-
oBtAining plAnts
Blueberries may be purchased as oneyear-old cuttings, as two- or three-yearold bare-root plants, or as potted plants.
Weymouth
Old variety (from 1936) that has been widely grown. Fruit is a bit soft, of average size, and has a mild, sweet flavor. Resistant to many diseases, except phomopsis.
table 7.2. number of blueberry plants required per acre at various spacings. Between Rows In Rows 8 feet 9 feet 10 feet 11 feet 12 feet
4 feet 5 feet 6 feet 1,361 1,089 908 1,210 968 807 1,089 870 726 990 792 660 908 726 605
Example: At a spacing of 5 feet x 10 feet, 870 plants are needed per acre.
113
Chapter 7: Blueberries
Flowers are less resistant to frost than Bluecrop. Moderately resistant to mummy berry and field resistant to shoestring virus. Production is sometimes erratic.
ivanhoe
Vigorous, upright bush with numerous stocky, moderately branched canes. Medium-sized light-blue fruit with good to excellent flavor. Buds and wood tolerate fluctuating winter temperatures well. Moderately resistant to anthracnose; good resistance to mummy blight (primary shoot infection); moderately susceptible to mummy berry fruit infection. Consistent yields in small-scale New Jersey test plot.
Blueray
Plant is vigorous and propagates easily. Fruit is borne on small, tight clusters and canes tend to bend over, making it difficult to harvest mechanically; tight clusters can cause berries to drop, especially in hot weather. Berries are large, dark blue, and firm with medium scar and excellent flavor. Consistently productive, but may overproduce if not pruned properly. Upright habit; very hardy. Highly susceptible to mummy berry disease and anthracnose; also susceptible to red ringspot virus.
hannahs ChoiCe
Vigorous, upright bush. Released in 2000. Fruit has superior firmness, sweetness, and flavor with peachy overtones. Large first-pick berries, with some size decrease in later picks. Relatively resistant to anthracnose. Less productive in some areas than others.
Patriot
Plant is upright and vigorous, though only small to medium in height. Fruit is large and firm with a small dry scar and excellent flavor. Developed in Maine and has excellent cold hardiness, but blooms early and is subject to frost. Resistant to root rot.
Collins
Ripens about 5 to 7 days after Earliblue. Susceptible to winter injury. Bush is vigorous and upright with some spreading canes. May not sucker freely. Fruit is large, firm, light blue, and has very good flavor and a small scar. Has narrow soil adaptation and produces only moderately.
Polaris
A cold-hardy half-high release from Minnesota (1996). Moderate productivity and average berry size, but has very good flavor and aroma. Not self-pollinating.
sPartan
Plants are vigorous, upright, and open. Fruits are large, firm, light blue, and highly flavored. Plant performs poorly on amended upland soils. Blooms late, but harvests relatively early; late bloom date helps prevent frost injury. Highly susceptible to anthracnose; partially resistant to mummy berry.
early midseason
Standard Cultivars Bluehaven
Bush is upright and productive but not sufficiently hardy for northern areas. Berry is large, light blue, and exceptionally flavorful. Scar is small and dry.
Duke
A vigorous, upright bush bearing medium-sized, light-blue, firm fruit with a small dry scar. Blooms late, avoiding early frosts, but ripens relatively early, slightly after Bluetta. Plant has numerous canes that are stocky and moderately branched. Buds and wood tolerate fluctuating winter temperatures well. Harvest can be completed in two or three pickings. Flavor is mild but is said to improve in storage. Moderately susceptible to mummy berry and anthracnose; stem blight problems have been documented.
Bluejay
Bush is vigorous, upright, and open. Berries are long stemmed and hang in loose clusters; they hold on to the bush without losing their quality and until most are ripe. Fruit is of medium size. Berries are firm and light blue with a small stem scar. Wood and buds are resistant to low winter temperatures.
nui
Produces a very high-quality, large berry. Winter hardiness is questionable and growth is slow.
114
reka
An introduction from New Zealand. Upright, very vigorous habit that has been very productive where grown. Trial results in PA indicate potential for high yields. Berries are small with a spicy flavor. This cultivars outstanding characteristic is that it appears to be very adaptable to a wide range of soil types. Moderately susceptible to anthracnose.
elizaBeth
Extremely flavorful, with medium to large berries. No longer commercially important because of inconsistent productivity, but of interest to home gardeners because of excellent flavor.
legaCy
Has some V. darrowi (an evergreen blueberry native to Florida) in its background and holds its leaves through much of the winter, so its winter hardiness is suspect. Outstanding characteristic is extremely high yields due to a long harvest season while maintaining superior flavor and quality. Medium to large fruit. For trial only in milder or protected locations. Resistant to anthracnose.
northlanD
Fruit is of average quality and soft, so it tends not to store well. Plants are bushy. Consistently productive. Resistant to mummy berry.
sunrise
Moderately vigorous bush with taller, easily managed structure. Fruit is similar to that of Bluetta in size and color, but scar and firmness are superior. Very good flavor. Preliminary data from PA trial indicate potential. Suitable for commercial packing and pick-your-own. Resistant to red ringspot virus.
Puru
Purported to have excellent flavor and fruit quality. Upright, moderately vigorous bushes with light-blue, medium to large fruit. Winter hardiness is uncertain.
toro
Vigorous, upright bush that is consistently productive. Fruit is large with small, dry scars and good color and flavor. Begins ripening with Bluecrop but has a concentrated ripening, and harvest can be completed in two pickings. Tolerates fluctuating winter temperatures well. Not very self-fertile, so should be planted with another cultivar.
midseason
Standard Cultivars BlueCroP
Best midseason variety presently available. Bush is vigorous and upright, but canes tend to be slender and whippy, which may make fruit difficult to harvest mechanically. Is reluctant to send up new canes on upland soils. Fruit is medium and numerous, firm, small scarred, good flavored, and resistant to cracking. Consistently high production and good winter hardiness; season tends to be prolonged, making the crop impossible to harvest in one picking. Berries appear to be ripe (completely blue) well before full sweetness is achieved, so they need to be picked 5 to 7 days after the full blue color is present. Field resistant to shoestring and red ringspot virus; moderately resistant to
Caras ChoiCe
Released in 2000 as a specialty cultivar for exceptional fruit quality. Low- to moderate-sized spreading plants. Exceptionally firm, sweet, and flavorful. Medium-sized fruit. Moderate yield; about half that of Bluecrop. Moderately susceptible to anthracnose; resistant to mummy blight; average for mummy fruit infection.
ChiPPeWa
A cold-hardy half-high release from Minnesota (1996). Compact bushes with medium to large, light-blue, firm, sweet fruit.
115
Chapter 7: Blueberries
Winter hardiness is limited. Canes are very stout, sometimes making pruning difficult. Slow to produce new canes. Tends to be susceptible to fungal diseases during wet seasons; also especially susceptible to some viral diseases.
nelson
A vigorous, upright bush. Fruit is large, of size similar to Spartan, firm, and light blue with very good flavor. Initial tests show it to tolerate cold temperatures well. Test-plot yields in New Jersey and Michigan have been high.
Fruit can be tart and berry can be fully blue when not fully ripe, so fruit should be allowed to remain on bush after coloring. Interplanting with another late-blooming variety has provided cross-pollination and improved size and flavor. Stores well. Resistant to anthracnose.
DarroW
Very large fruit on vigorous, upright plants. Fruit is firm with excellent flavor and can be slightly acidic.
jersey
Bush is vigorous and erect with open fruit clusters and is very good for machine harvesting. Medium-sized, firm fruit with good color and good flavor. May have fruit set problems; tends to set fruit without undergoing pollination, so fruit does not size. Considered by some to have the sweetest flavor. Resistant to anthracnose. Susceptible to fusicoccum canker.
ozarkBlue
Very late flowering. Slow to produce new canes. Quality is similar to that of Bluecrop.
ruBel
A wild selection with small, firm fruit. Bush is erect and very productive. Flavor is fair. Fruit retains stems during drought or if harvest is delayed. Has higher concentrations of antioxidants than larger-fruited cultivars. Susceptible to stunt and resistant to red ringspot virus.
sierra
A vigorous, upright, productive bush. Fruit is medium sized with a small dry scar, good color, and excellent flavor and firmness. Because Sierra is an interspecific hybrid of four species, its cold hardiness is unknown.
lateBlue
Bush is erect, vigorous, and very productive. Berries are firm, light blue in color, have small stem scars, and are fine flavored but tart. High temperature during harvest may lead to excessive stemminess.
late season
Standard Cultivars Coville
Bush has very vigorous spreading habit. Has open fruit clusters; excellent for machine harvest. Needs high bee concentration for best pollination. Berry is large, medium blue, highly aromatic, and rated highly for strong blueberry flavor. Does not set fruit well on occasion, which can limit its productivity. Narrow soil adaptation and produces only moderately. Fruit is susceptible to anthracnose.
Brigitta Blue
Upright, vigorous, cold-hardy bush with moderate productivity. Fruit is large, very light blue, and firm with a small dry scar. Plant with other cultivars to ensure good pollination. Clusters are loose and ripening is concentrated. Excellent fruit quality and shelf life. Slow to shut down in the fall, so dont fertilize after early season. Resistant to anthracnose and mummy berry.
liBerty
Released in 2004 from the breeding program at Michigan State. In PA trial, is producing more foliage than fruit. Berries are nice size. Ripens with Elliott, but with better flavor than Elliott.
elliott
Last to fruit of all standard cultivars. Bush is vigorous and upright; plants very productive, hardy, and resistant to mummy berry. Berry size is small and berries are light blue with firm flesh and only fair flavor.
ChanDler
Extremely large fruit ripens over a long harvest season, so this cultivar has good potential, especially for pick-your-own operations. Winter hardy in Northeastern PA, so far.
116
table 7.3. relevant characteristics of various cover crops for row middles. Cover Crop Water Use Establishment Vigor Durabilitya
Creeping red fescue Chewings fescues Hard fescues White (ladino) clover Tall fescue Sudangrass hybrids Kentucky bluegrass Perennial ryegrass Annual ryegrass Rye (Secale cereale) Buckwheat Oats Mc M M H MH H M M M H H H VGb G F F G VG G G G VG VG VG Lc L L M H VH M M M H H H VGb VG E F E P G G P P P P
a. Tolerance to foot traffic or equipment operations. b. E = excellent; VG = very good; G = good; F = fair; P = poor c. VH = very high; H = high; MH = moderately high; M = moderate; L = low
table 7.4. seeding rates and requirements for various seasonal and permanent cover crops for row middles. Nutrient and pH Requireda Cover Crop Seeding Rate (lb/A) Seeding Time (mo) (N-P-K lbs/A) & pH
Creeping red fescues Chewings fescues Hard fescues White (ladino) clover Tall fescue Sudangrass hybrids Kentucky bluegrass Perennial ryegrass Annual ryegrass Rye (Secale cereale) Buckwheat Oats 70 75 80 15 75 80 75 85 60 110 75 100 AprMay or AugSept AprMay or AugSept AprMay or AugSept AprMay AprMay or AugSept JuneAug AprMay or AugSept AprMay or AugSept AprMay or AugSept MaySept MayAug April or Aug 60-80-40 & 67 60-80-40 & 67 60-80-40 & 6-7 10-80-60 & 67 50-60-40 & 57 80-40-40 & 57 60-80-40 & 67 60-80-40 & 67 60-80-40 & 67 30-60-30 & 57 30-40-30 & 57 30-60-30 & 67
a. Nutrient requirements may be satisfied by some soils without amendments. Consult a soil test before applying fertilizers and avoid balanced fertilizers high in chloride.
table 7.5. postplant nitrogen recommendations for blueberries. Actual Nitrogen/A A.S./Aa Urea/A A.S./plantb Age of Planting (lbs) (lbs) (lbs) (grams)
0 (planting year) 1 2 3 4 5 6+ see text 20 30 40 50 60 65 see text 100 150 200 250 300 325 see text 45 65 85 110 130 140 see text 50 70 90 110 140 150
A.S./plantb (oz) see text 1.5 2.5 3.0 4.0 5.0 5.5
a. A.S. = ammonium sulfate. If pH is equal to or higher than 5.0, ammonium sulfate should be used. If pH is lower than 5.0, urea can be used. b. Assumes 5 x 9 foot spacing.
117
Chapter 7: Blueberries
Fall planting (mid- to late October) may also be done if growers wish to plant at a less busy time of the year. Success will vary depending on fall temperatures, and growers may find that some plants become heaved out of the ground. Mulching once plants are in minimizes this problem. Nitrogen fertilization should not take place until the following spring, using the rates for first and second applications given above, applied at bud break and 6 weeks later. Otherwise, follow recommendations below for care during the establishment year. Establishing permanent sod middles between the blueberry rows is a standard recommendation. However, note that sod middles increase the incidence of disease and insect problems. Many plantings are clean cultivated to avoid these problems. Characteristics of various permanent cover crops are listed in Table 7.3 and seeding rates and nutrient and pH requirements are listed in Table 7.4. Experimentation at Penn State has shown that hard fescues perform extremely well as permanent sod covers, being slow growing, relatively noncompetitive, and tough enough to withstand traffic. Planting in the fall rather than the spring has aided in establishment. Additional tips for successfully establishing sod middles are covered under Practices for Minimizing Weeds Between the Rows in the weed control section.
as much as 30 pounds of nitrogen per season. After the plants begin bearing, tissue analysis should be used for nutrient recommendations. Fully bearing mature plants, depending on soil type and plant condition, will need about 65 pounds of nitrogen per acre. The prior seasons tissue analysis (see Appendix B for a listing of labs and interpretation levels) is the best method to fine-tune your blueberry fertility program. Table 7.5 shows recommended starting points for nitrogen application rates for a blueberry planting. After the first year, nitrogen should be applied annually using half of the recommended amount per acre during bloom and the other half approximately 6 weeks later. Split application encourages efficient uptake of nutrients and produces equivalent growth to that of higher rates applied at one time early in the season. Dormant applications of fertilizer to blueberries are not recommended since very little fertilizer is taken up into the plant before the leaves are presenta greater proportion of fertilizer is more likely to be leached into the groundwater.
irrigAtion
Blueberry plants require at least 1 inch of water per week. Although either overhead or trickle irrigation can be used on blueberries, trickle both conserves moisture and supplies the plant with adequate water while avoiding an increase in the amount of foliar disease. The trickle line can be placed under the mulch so it is out of the way and, in some cases, semipermanent. Because the small emitter holes in trickle irrigation components clog easily, the water source must be very clean (such as municipal water or clean spring), or water should be passed through a sand filter. Overhead irrigation has the advantage of cooling plants and berries when temperatures are very high. In addition, overhead irrigation can be used for frost protection.
Frost proteCtion
Damage due to freezes and frost increases after bud break in the spring until flowering or fruit set. When blueberries are in full bloom, temperatures slightly below freezing (30F) can injure the flowers. The exact temperature that damages flowers depends on the rate of temperature change, wind speed, humidity, sugar content of nectar, flower orientation, and so forth. Under certain conditions, open blueberry flowers can tolerate temperatures as low as 23F. The earliest flowering varieties are most susceptible to frost injury, so avoid planting these on frost-prone sites. See Appendix A for additional general information on frost protection.
mulChing
Because the blueberry plant is very sensitive to fluctuating soil moisture, mulching is essential for a healthy planting and consistent yields. Hardwood bark mulch (such as that used for landscaping), rotted sawdust, and chopped corncobs are good mulches. Mixtures of sawdust and bark mulch have been used successfully, providing better infiltration of rain than sawdust alone. Apply mulches to a depth of 4 inches and replenish whenever necessary. As previously mentioned, avoid mulches with a high pH, such as mushroom compost. Also avoid uncomposted leaves, which may be high in natural toxins. Applying uncomposted sawdust or woodchips may tie up nitrogen as the mulch decomposes. Increased amounts of nitrogen fertilizer will be required to compensate; however, predicting how much is impossible due to differences in soil type, microorganism activity, temperature, and other variables. Only leaf analysis accurately depicts nitrogen status.
Fertility
Urea and ammonium sulfate are the recommended nitrogen fertilizers. Urea can be used when the soil pH is in the target range of 4.5 to 5.0, while ammonium sulfate should be used when the pH needs to be lowered or in locations where the soil pH tends to rise. Research has shown that blueberry plants prefer the ammonium form of nitrogen. Also, blueberry plants are sensitive to nitrates, which can cause root damage at high levels. Fertilization practices recommended for the planting year are outlined in the Planting and Establishment section. As a rule of thumb, nonbearing plants require 20 pounds of nitrogen per acre per year, which should be split into 2 applications of 10 pounds each. Depending on soil type and growing conditions, this requirement may be
pruning
Understanding how a blueberry plant grows is important in order to prune correctly. Each year, canes are initiated from the base of the plant. Each succeeding year, a cane produces laterals, which produce laterals the next year and so on. Each year the lateral production on any individual cane decreases in diameterin other words, the wood becomes progressively twiggy. As the wood becomes smaller, fruit size decreases. This is why we detail prune (remove small twiggy growth) to increase fruit size. In addition, pruning controls crop load, thus increasing fruit
118
quality. It also invigorates plants, forcing essential new growth from the plants base. The philosophy behind pruning is to constantly renew the older, decreasingly productive canes by cutting them out and forcing new canes. Plants are continually replacing old canes with new canes while most canes are in a productive, intermediate stage. Pruning is best done toward the end of the dormant season, usually sometime in March. Fall pruning is not recommended because it can force plants to produce new shoots that will be killed by winter cold. In March, flower buds are easily recognizable because they are plumper than vegetative buds (Figure 7.1). For the first two growing seasons, remove all flower buds to force vegetative growth in the plant. Keep these five basic steps in mind when approaching a bush to be pruned: 1. Assess the plants overall vigor. Is the cane production adequate? Mature plants should produce at least three to five new canes per year. If they are not, check your fertilizer program, the pH, or for soil insects or diseases. 2. Prune out all dead wood. 3. Keep the three best one-year-old canes and remove the rest.
4. Locate the oldest canes and prune out one of every six canes, starting with the oldest. For example, if the plant has 12 canes, remove two of the oldest. 5. Prune out all low branches that will never be picked and are a source of disease. 6. Detail prune (i.e., remove as much twiggy wood as time allows). Figure 7.2 shows a mature blueberry plant before and after pruning. New shoot production is somewhat cultivar dependent, and some cultivars may not respond as well as others. Pruning with this method will produce a plant that has two to three canes each of one-, two-, three-, four-, and five-year-old canes, or ten to fifteen canes. As in any biological system, this is an optimal range and many plants will deviate from this ideal. Which canes are pruned will also need to be adjusted depending on the growth habit of the plant.
(A)
Flower buds
vigorous varieties
Leaf buds
These varieties yield better when thinned out rather than detail pruned (removing twiggy, one-year growth). Entirely removing older canes (six years and older) is beneficial for yield and growth, especially in Blueray, Collins, Coville, Earliblue, and Herbert.
(B)
Figure 7.2. Blueberry bush before and after pruning. (A) = mature bush showing typical annual pruning cuts (solid bars) and wood to be removed. (B) = mature bush after pruning.
Courtesy Virginia Polytechnic Institute and State University
119
Chapter 7: Blueberries
growth, or by cutting back half the canes in one year and half the following year. Commercial growers may prefer the latter method since it prevents a lapse in cropping.
prepare for your farm. Costs are often difficult to estimate in budget preparation because they are numerous and variable. Therefore, you should think of these budgets as a first approximation and then make appropriate adjustments using the Your Farm column to add, delete, and adjust items to reflect your specific growing conditions and resource situation. The sample cost-of-production budgets were developed using a computerized budget generator. Input data reflect recommended production practices and current input costs. Major subheadings in the budgets are variable costs, fixed costs, and total specified costs. They are defined as follows: Variable costs are costs that vary depending on the level of production. These include such inputs as fertilizer, herbicides, insecticides, fungicides, and labor. Fixed costs are costs that do not vary by level of production and are incurred by virtue of owning assets such as machinery and land. Depreciation and taxes are examples. Total specified costs are the sum of variable and fixed costs. Most landpreparation activities are assumed to be custom hired in these budgets because the small acreages for many berry farms do not justify the ownership of these implements. If you use your own tillage equipment, the variable costs for custom hire should be subtracted from the budgets and your labor variable costs and machinery fixed costs should be substituted. Cost-of-production budgets are presented for the year of land preparation (Table 7.6), year of planting (Table 7.7), year after planting (Table 7.8) and for a mature planting (Table 7.9). Returns to risk and management is the estimated profit attributable to the acceptance of risk and the contribution of management expertise by the grower (Table 7.10). The table estimates the return to the grower for a range of prices and yields. Because yields, grades, and prices are so variable, growers should use representative values for their operation. It is important to account for cash
flows over the life of the investment when assessing the overall profitability of the enterprise, so prorated land preparation and planting costs are subtracted from the estimates. Breakeven prices and yields are shown in the tables. Breakeven price is an estimate of the unit price required to cover all costs at a given yield; it is also the average cost per unit of production. Breakeven yield is an estimate of the yield required to cover all costs at a given price. Berry production involves large initial investments and can be very risky; weather and animal related crop losses are common and crop prices can be highly variable. Use of whole-farm risk management tools such as AGRLite crop insurance can help you reduce these risks. A land charge of $150/acre has been included in the budgets, but this charge can vary greatly from location to location. If you own the land, you could include your principal, interest payments, and property taxes as a fixed cost. If you lease the land, then the annual rental cost could be included as a variable cost. Production assumptions used in generating the budgets include the following: Fumigation is not used. Trickle irrigation is used and water is applied to 5 acres. Fungicides are rotated to reduce the likelihood of disease resistance. The numbers of pesticide and irrigation applications are average. In any given year or location, growers will need to adjust these for their particular set of circumstances. Both green manure and cover crops are used to increase organic matter. Plants are spaced at 5 feet within the row and 10 feet between rows (870 plants per acre). Two-year-old (12- to 18-inch) bareroot plants are used for establishment. Sawdust is used as a mulch. Hard fescue is planted in the aisles to reduce the need for mowing. Berries are hand-harvested and sold retail as ready-picked berries in pint clamshells.
economIcs
The blueberry budgets given here were prepared to provide general information and do not apply to any specific operation. Use them, with appropriate modifications, as guides for preparing budgets for individual situations. Budgets can be used: for general farm business planning purposes as a basis for obtaining credit to project cash flows to assess profitability Using these sample budgets as guides should help ensure that all costs and receipts are included in budgets you
120
table 7.6. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year of land preparation for blueberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Soil test Chisel plowing Grain drilling Moldboard plowing Disking Spread dry fertilizer Broadcast seeding Fertilizer Urea Sulfur 90% Seed Oat seed Annual ryegrass seed Labor Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost* Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs acre 150.00 1.00 0.00 150.00 746.40 bu lb hour 8.20 0.35 13.50 3.00 30.00 0.50 24.60 10.50 6.75 6.60 596.40 lb ton 0.48 650.00 150.00 0.50 73.35 325.00 each acre acre acre acre acre acre 10.00 16.80 17.90 19.10 18.50 9.20 11.90 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 3.00 2.00 1.00 10.00 16.80 17.90 19.10 55.50 18.40 11.90
Unit Price ($) Quantity Amount ($) Your Farm ($)
*Fixed costs are zero in this budget because it is assumed that all field operations for land preparation are done by custom operators. Ownership of tillage equipment, grain drills, and grass seeders is not economically justified for growers engaged solely in small fruit production.
121
Chapter 7: Blueberries
table 7.7. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: planting year for blueberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Spread dry fertilizer Moldboard plowing Disking Grass seeding Fertilizer Ammonium sulfate Herbicides Devrinol 50DF Solicam 80DF Princep 90WDG Insecticides Provado 1.6F Sevin 80S Other Blueberry plants Hard fescue seed Sawdust mulch Trickle irrigation Trickle operating Labor Hired Operator Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Cost acre acre acre 8.76 7.44 150.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 8.76 7.44 16.20 150.00 8,625.27 hour hour gal acre acre 13.50 15.00 3.25 4.24 2.90 70.00 1.68 4.09 1.00 1.00 945.00 25.28 13.30 4.24 2.90 261.58 8,459.07 each lb acre acre inch 6.25 2.85 250.00 800.00 20.00 870.00 30.00 1.00 1.00 20.00 5,437.50 85.50 250.00 800.00 400.00 oz lb 1.66 8.85 8.00 2.00 13.28 17.70 lb lb lb 11.20 24.90 4.70 4.00 2.50 2.20 44.80 62.25 10.34 lb 0.17 100.00 17.50 acre acre acre acre 7.25 19.10 18.50 11.90 2.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 14.50 19.10 18.50 11.90 Unit Price ($) Quantity Amount ($) Your Farm ($)
122
table 7.8. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year after planting for blueberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Spread dry fertilizer Fertilizer Ammonium sulfate Fungicides Lime sulfur Herbicides Devrinol 50DF Poast Princep 90WDG Insecticides Provado 1.6F Sevin 80S Other Blueberry plants Plant analysis kit Trickle operating Labor Hired Operator Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost* Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs acre acre acre 19.91 17.05 150.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 19.91 17.05 36.96 150.00 1,434.93 hour hour gal acre acre 13.50 15.00 3.25 9.63 10.52 24.50 3.28 9.74 1.00 1.00 330.75 49.22 31.64 9.63 10.52 37.45 1,247.97 each each inch 6.25 24.00 20.00 20.00 1.00 20.00 125.00 24.00 400.00 oz lb 1.66 8.85 8.00 2.00 13.28 17.70 lb gal lb 11.20 89.20 4.70 8.00 0.25 4.40 89.60 22.30 20.68 gal 7.90 5.00 39.50 lb 0.17 100.00 17.50 acre 9.20 1.00 9.20 Unit Price ($) Quantity Amount ($) Your Farm ($)
*Fixed costs are zero in this budget because it is assumed that all field operations for land preparation are done by custom operators. Ownership of tillage equipment, grain drills, and grass seeders is not economically justified for growers engaged solely in small fruit production.
123
Chapter 7: Blueberries
table 7.9. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: mature planting for blueberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Spread dry fertilizer Bee rental Fertilizer Ammonium sulfate Fungicides Captan 80W Indar 75WSP Lime sulfur Pristine 38WDG Herbicides Princep 90WDG Devrinol 50DF Sinbar 80W Surflan AS Insecticides Confirm 2F Imidan 70WSP Malathion 8F Sevin 80S Other Plant analysis kit Trickle operating Clamshell, 1 pint Flats, 1 pint Labor Hired Operator Blueberry harvest Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs acre acre acre 40.75 35.22 150.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 40.75 35.22 75.97 150.00 8,355.29 hour hour pt gal acre acre 13.50 15.00 0.80 3.25 19.74 18.29 41.50 6.35 6,000.00 20.22 1.00 1.00 560.25 95.23 4,800.00 65.70 19.71 18.29 202.43 8,129.32 each inch each each 24.00 20.00 0.13 2.10 1.00 20.00 6,000.00 250.00 24.00 400.00 780.00 525.00 oz lb gal lb 1.36 9.45 37.50 8.85 16.00 1.30 0.63 2.00 21.76 12.29 23.44 17.70 lb lb lb gal 4.70 11.20 39.41 56.35 2.20 8.00 2.00 0.75 10.34 89.60 78.82 42.26 lb lb gal oz 6.29 120.50 7.90 3.45 3.00 0.13 5.00 40.00 18.87 15.06 39.50 138.00 lb 0.17 325.00 56.87 acre acre 9.20 65.00 1.00 1.00 9.20 65.00 Unit Price ($) Quantity Amount ($) Your Farm ($)
124
Prorated land preparation and planting costs included based on a productive life of 25 years. One-pint clamshell of blueberries weighs 17 ounces.
spores, develops. These are the most diagnostic signs of an anthracnose infection. During wet or very humid conditions, spores are dispersed in water droplets to nearby surfaces. Fruit infections often do not become apparent until after harvest and may result in rejection or greatly reduced quality and shelf life at the marketplace. The disease organism may rarely cause a blossom blight as well as brown to black leaf and stem lesions of various sizes and shapes. Causal Agent: The fungus Colletotrichum acutatum.
pests
Pest control involves many aspects of production, and pesticide application is only one. All available practices to reduce the potential for disease and insect problems should be used. Consider site selection, crop rotation, variety selection, soil treatment, and planting stock in relation to disease and insect control before you plant. Information on individual diseases and insects is presented below, with cultural controls discussed. Pesticide information including activity groups, efficacy, labeled uses, and restrictions are presented in tables that follow. Because avoiding buildup of resistant strains of fungi and insects is important, activity groups (for rotational use to avoid buildup of resistant strains) of fungicides and their efficacy on common diseases are presented in Table 7.11, and activity groups and efficacy of insecticides are listed in Table 7.12. Fungicides, insecticides, and miticides that can be used to assist in management are given in Table 7.13, arranged by various growth stages during the year for the crop. Pests are listed at the stages where they are most likely to be problematic or when treatment is most effective. Information in Table 7.13 should be supplemented with the reading below. Table 7.14 presents additional restrictions beyond preharvest intervals and reentry intervals that appear on the label.
Epidemiology: Anthracnose overwinters primarily under bud sales. Spores are produced during wet periods throughout the growing season and are distributed by splashing rains. Fruit are susceptible to infection at any time during their development. Infections that occur are not immediately apparent but remain dormant until the fruit begins to ripen. Controls: Fungicide sprays are needed during bloom and also prior to periods of wet, warm weather from bloom until harvest. The varieties Berkeley, Bluecrop, and Coville are the most susceptible, but the disease can occur on any cultivar when conditions are favorable. Use of overhead irrigation should be minimized. Heavy nitrogen fertilization and failure to harvest ripe fruit promptly may also increase the incidence of anthracnose.
125
Chapter 7: Blueberries
Epidemiology: Infection takes place through wounds, which may be made mechanically or by another disease organism. Symptoms begin showing 4 to 6 weeks after infection. Inoculum is spread mainly by rainfall, with most infections taking place in late spring and early summer, though inoculum is present anytime. Young tissue and plants are most susceptible. Controls: Plants that are fertilized in August are likely to be more susceptible to winter injury as a result of not hardening off properly. This condition will lead to higher infection levels during the following growing season. Unlike phomopsis, fungicides are generally ineffective against botryosphaeria diseases, making the prompt removal of infected branches and, sometimes, whole plants the best approach. Most cultivars are susceptible; however, within the region, this disease has been observed primarily on Duke.
Botrytis Blight
Symptoms: Green tissue, blossoms, fruit, and leaves can become infected. Tips of shoots die back and turn brown to black, eventually bleaching to a lighter tan or gray, which can be confused with winter injury. Infected blossoms appear water soaked and turn brown. This blossom blight causes the most loss. Infected immature fruits shrivel and turn bluish purple, whereas ripe, mature fruits become tan. In damp weather, all infected plant parts become covered with this funguss characteristic gray mold. Causal Agent: The fungus Botrytis cinerea. Epidemiology: Botrytis cinerea overwinters on infected plants and plant debris and is favored by cool, humid weather. Fungal spores are disseminated primarily by wind. The disease does not occur every year, instead occurring in years when conditions are favorable. Controls: Any practice that minimizes leaf wetness such as keeping plantings pruned and weeded, and using trickle instead of overhead irrigation, will help. Refer to Table 7.13 for fungicide recommendations.
ly spring, which then release the spores that infect the blueberries. Controls: Controls are not typically needed, as yields are not reduced unless defoliation is severe. Any practices that minimizes leaf wetness such as using trickle irrigation rather than overhead and keeping plantings well pruned and weed free will help. In small plantings, removal and destruction of leaves soon after they fall may help as long if the planting is isolated from other blueberries. If only a few hemlocks are nearby, their removal may be a viable option. The current recommended distance from hemlocks for protection is 1/3 mile. Indar, Cabrio, and Pristine are labeled for control of blueberry rust, but efficacy is unknown and timing of application for effective control could be problematic.
mummy Berry
Symptoms: In the spring, brown, cupshaped structures (mummy cups), inch in diameter can be found on the soil surface. About 2 weeks later, new shoots and leaves suddenly wilt. Brown discoloration develops along the upper surface of the wilted shoots and along midribs and veins of affected leaves (referred to as strikes). Flower buds can also be affected. All affected parts become covered with a powdery mass of fungal spores and eventually fall off of the plant. No other symptoms are apparent until the berries begin to ripen, when infected berries lighten in color and at first become soft, then shrivel, dry, and drop from the plant, usually before harvest. Causal Agent: The fungus Monilinia vaccinii-corymbosi Epidemiology: The fungus overwinters on shriveled, infected berries called mummies. In the spring, cup-shaped fruiting bodies are produced on the mummies and release spores that infect new growth, causing a shoot blight. Spores from blighted shoots are carried by insects to open flowers along with the pollen. The fungus colonizes the developing fruit by growing into and colonizing flower ovaries. Mummy berry is most serious and widespread in the north after moist spring weather.
leaf rust
Symptoms: Yellow spots appear on the upper leaf surface in early summer that turn reddish brown. Yellow orange pustules develop on the leaf undersides in midsummer directly under these spots. Causal Agent: The fungus Naohidemyces vaccinii, formerly referred to as Pucciniastrum vaccinii. Epidemiology: This disease requires the presence of hemlock as an alternate host in order to complete its life cycle in northern locations. Evergreen blueberries in the South also serve in this role. Spores released from hemlocks infect blueberry leaves in late spring or early summer. Additional infections of other blueberry leaves take place within the planting during the summer. The disease survives the winter on infected blueberry leaves on the ground. Spores released from these leaves infect hemlocks in ear-
126
Controls: Several practices may help control mummy berry. Remove and dispose of fallen leaves and old berries. Cover old berries with at least 2 inches of soil by disking between rows or adding 2 inches of new mulch. An application of urea fertilizer, or a shallow cultivation of the ground between rows and beneath infected bushes before bud break, kills the exposed mushroom-like apothecia (mummy cups). Bluetta, Collins, Coville, and Darrow may have some resistance. Susceptible varieties include Berkeley, Bluecrop, Blueray, Earliblue, Jersey, and Weymouth. Wet sites are especially problematic. Fungicide applications made at bud break and followed up at 7- to 10-day intervals through bloom will control the disease effectively. Once the flowers have been pollinated, no further infection can take place.
place anytime from blossom bud swell through late summer. Controls: Remove and burn all blighted or discolored wood during dormant pruning and whenever blighted tips appear in the summer; cut shoots back to the point that pith appears normal. Avoid planting sites that are prone to spring frosts and use fertilization, irrigation, and weed control practices that discourage late-season growth and that promote early hardening off. Certain sprays for mummy berry and botrytis may help, particularly during flowering. Fungicides active against mummy berry and botrytis may not be active against phomopsis canker and vice versa. Consult Table 7.11 for efficacy ratings.
branches affected. Plants can be killed in 3 to 6 years with all plants eventually infected. Tolerant cultivars may not show symptoms but still serve as sources of inoculum. Epidemiology: This disease is spread by aphids; transmission from infected to uninfected plants takes place quickly (in a matter of minutes or hours). Aphid control is the best method available to stop the infection of the entire field. Virus spreads outward from the first plants infected. Controls: Only virus-free stock should be utilized when setting out new plantings. Affected plants should be removed and burned. Aphids should be controlled to prevent spread. Bluetta, Blueray, Chanticleer, Duke, Elliott, and Weymouth are susceptible; Jersey is tolerant; and Bluecrop is intermediate.
Blueberry stunt
Symptoms: Overall dwarfing of the bush is the primary symptom. Leaves are small, cupped downward, and often chlorotic. Stem internodes become shortened and growth of normally dormant buds causes twiggy branching. Infected bushes appear dense and bushy. The leaves of stunted bushes turn a bright red in early fall before normal plants begin to turn color. Fruit set is decreased. Symptoms are most noticeable after the initial flush of vegetative growth in early summer and when plants begin to turn color in the fall. Epidemiology: This disease is caused by a phytoplasma rather than a virus, but it is often grouped under viruses. Stunt is spread by sharp-nosed leafhopper nymphs or adults. Once the leafhopper acquires the phytoplasma, the insect retains it for its entire life. Controls: Using phytoplasma-free stock, controlling leafhoppers, and removing infected bushes are critical to control stunt. Treat bushes to be removed with an insecticide before removal. Otherwise, leafhoppers on infected bushes will only migrate to other bushes when disturbed, spreading infection further.
127
Chapter 7: Blueberries
Epidemiology: The vector for tomato ringspot virus is the dagger nematode. This virus can infect many different species of plants, including other fruit crops such as apples, peaches, and raspberries and weeds such as chickweed and dandelion. Infection spreads slowly. Controls: The best control for this virus is to test the soil for this nematode before planting, eliminating the nematodes through chemical fumigation or biofumigation if present, and avoiding following fruit crops. Weeds should be controlled.
direct pests
Blueberry Maggot, Rhagoletis mendax (Diptera: Tephritidae)
Symptoms of Damage: The blueberry maggot is the major blueberry pest in the northeast and Mid-Atlantic area, but populations may vary a great deal from farm to farm. Small upland areas may not be as susceptible to injury as are those in southern New Jersey. The presence of infested fruit at harvest can bring about the condemnation of whole fields of harvested fruit. Attacked fruit is soft and mushy with a maggot inside. Identification: The female fly is about 3 16 inch long, just slightly smaller than a housefly (Figure 7.3). It has a black body and one pair of clear wings marked with heavy black bands in the shape of an upside-down W. Its abdomen is black with white cross bands. Several other species of fruit flies can be confused with blueberry maggots if not inspected carefully. The larvae (maggot) is legless, has no head capsule, and starts out transparent but becomes white as it grows, reaching a length of 6 to 7 millimeters ( inch). The puparia in which they overwinter are ovoid, light brown, and about 3 millimeters (1 8 inch) in length. Life Cycle: Overwintering as pupae buried in the top inch of the soil below bushes, flies first emerge from the soil in early to mid-June and continue through July and the first half of August. After emerging, adult females take about 10 days to sexually mature but live for about 30 days. During the time just after emergence, they feed on nectar, dew, and honeydew. Toward the end of this period, mating takes place and females seek large, ripened berries in which to lay eggs. The female pierces the skin of fruit with her egg-laying apparatus and deposits a single egg in each berry. Each fly may lay up to 100 eggs in a 2- to 3-week period. Upon leaving the berry, the female deposits a chemical that deters other flies from laying eggs in that berry. The eggs hatch in 2 to 7 days, and the legless larva burrows into the berry and feeds on the pulp for about 2 weeks. The mature larva then drops to the soil where
nemAtodes
Numerous species of nematodes have been found in association with blueberry plantings, but yield reductions in mature plantings have not been well documented. Highbush blueberries appear to have some resistance to root-lesion nematodes (Pratylenchus penetrans). As vectors of the tomato ringspot and tobacco ringspot viruses, dagger nematodes (Xiphinema spp.) merit watching. Two years of a grass crop with excellent weed control before blueberries are planted will decrease virus inocula so that nematodes, if present, are more likely to be virus free.
shoestring virus
Symptoms: Elongated, reddish streaks about 1 8 by to inch on current-year and one-year-old stems, especially on the side exposed to the sun. During blossoming, the flowers on infected bushes will exhibit pinkish to reddish petals. Infected leaves are often straplike, hence the name shoestring. Many leaves on a bush may appear this way, although in some cases just a few clumps near the crown will show this symptom. Epidemiology: Shoestring is spread by the blueberry aphid. A latent period of four years occurs between infection of the plant and expression of symptoms. Controls: Aphid control is critical to prevent the spread of shoestring. The long latent period makes identifying infected bushes before they serve as sources of inoculum impossible, so roguing is not feasible or effective. Clean planting stock is critical. Bluecrop shows resistance.
128
it pupates and overwinters. Only one generation occurs per year, but a few pupae may remain in the soil for 2 or 3 years. Monitoring and Controls: The potential for infestations of blueberry maggots can be assessed by trapping adults before their numbers reach damaging levels. Traps are yellow, sticky boards placed in the field and hung in the top 6 inches of the bush canopy. Traps should be hung from poles, folded, and hung in a V position with the yellow surface facing down. Traps should be placed at least a week before the first flies are expected to emerge (early June) and be placed at a density of 3 traps per 5 acres, though this depends on the size of the farm. For larger plantings, 1 trap per 9 to 10 acres may be sufficient. Boards are baited with a feeding attractant, either ammonium acetate or protein hydrolysates (see Appendix D for sources). Since most maggot flies will come from wild hosts outside the field, traps should be placed on field borders near wooded areas, with a few traps in the field interior. Continue trapping through harvest, replacing traps every 3 weeks or when they become clogged with insects. Each week count the flies on each trap and then remove them. Several other fly species will be trapped on the boards, along with other insects. Make sure only blueberry maggot flies are counted. If identifying species is difficult, consult an extension educator. If control is necessary, use a relatively nontoxic, short
residual insecticide that does not interfere with harvest. Always check the preharvest interval for the pesticide being used. If ripe berries are present, harvest before the spray is applied. Sprays should be initiated within 10 days after the first adult catch. If using a calendar approach, continue with an application every 7 to 10 days until all unharvested fruit has dropped. Alternatively, if you use yellow sticky boards throughout the season, continue on a 7- to 10-day schedule only as long as at least one fly is caught in any trap per week. Planting early maturing cultivars that may escape blueberry maggot attack may help to minimize damage, especially for organic producers.
129
Chapter 7: Blueberries
webbing do not appear until later in the larvas lifetime when it begins to move between berries. In small plantings, one method of control for this pest is to pick and destroy infested berry clusters showing evidence of webbing. Repeated disking to eliminate weeds and trash also helps in control. Both cranberry and cherry fruitworms can be controlled with one to two insecticide sprays. Use pheromone traps to monitor adult emergence and place the traps when berries first come into bloom. Insecticides can be applied just after the flight peak. Another spray should be made about 10 days later if needed.
wings. Larvae are C-shaped, white grubs that feed on the root system. Life Cycle: One generation occurs per year. Grubs that overwinter in the soil pupate in late May with adults emerging from mid-June through mid-July. Adults will live for 30 to 45 days and can be found throughout the summer. Females lay approximately 50 eggs in the soil, which hatch after 2 weeks. Larvae feed on roots until the soil temperatures cool and then remain dormant until spring. Monitoring and Controls: When numerous, adults can be controlled with the use of broad-spectrum insecticides. Eliminating row-middle sods is helpful, especially in large plantings. Entomopathogenic nematodes are effective for larvae, but they have a limited shelf life and must be applied strictly according to directions.
Cranberry Weevil, also known as the Blueberry Blossom Weevil, Anthonomus musculus (Say) (Coleoptera: Curculionidae)
Symptoms of Damage: Adults feed on developing leaf and flower buds. Feeding signs include the chewing of expanding buds and holes chewed in the sides of flowers. Infested flowers turn purplish, fail to open, and eventually fall to the ground. Identification: Adults are inch long and brown with a few white markings on the wing. The snout is about one-third as long as the body. Grubs are small, Cshaped, and have brown heads.
1 16
Life Cycle: Overwintering adults disperse into fields from wooded areas, hedgerows, weedy areas, or debris early in the spring. Like plum curculio, the cranberry weevil is active on warm, sunny days. Females lay eggs singly through the feeding holes into the developing flower somewhere along the style or anther filaments. The grubs feed throughout their growth within the flower bud in which they hatched. Pupation occurs within infested flowers and adults begin to emerge again in late May to June. The cranberry weevil has one generation per year in most of New Jersey, but a partial second generation in parts of southern New Jersey also occurs. Monitoring and Controls: Most feeding and egg-laying activity occurs near field edges that are bordered by woodlands. Therefore, monitoring should concentrate on fields that border wooded areas. If weevils or weevil injury is
130
insecticide application of a Bacillus thuringiensis (Bt) product, Intrepid, or Confirm may be applied during mid-bloom since these products do not have activity against bees. No other insecticides should be used at this time. Treatments are justified only when the combined number of lepidopteran pests (worms) exceeds 1 larva per 100 blossom clusters.
a few will mate and produce a second generation in southern regions of the Mid-Atlantic area. Monitoring and Controls: Adult curculios are cryptic and may be difficult to see, but they can be found early in the morning or late in the evening by shaking the branches of a bush over a white cloth placed on the ground. Adults disturbed in this manner drop onto the sheet and feign deaththey fold their legs tightly against the body and then remain motionless. They can easily be mistaken for debris. Because the weevil spends much of its life cycle on the ground under the bushes, frequent cultivation can aid in control. Infestations are more common in weedy fields. Some monitoring can be accomplished by using tedder traps, which are pyramid-shaped, wooden traps that attract the adult plum curculio beetle. The most reliable method of monitoring, however, is to sample newly set berries for the presence of egg scars. Early season varieties, especially if planted near wooded areas, should be monitored starting at the end of bloom. Effective control is reached through postpollination applications of insecticides. Make sure flowers have dropped in treated blocks so bees are not killed. Bluetta, Duke, Earliblue, and Weymouth are among varieties heavily attacked.
bark and leaf surfaces. Three generations occur per year. The first flight can start in early April, with a second flight starting in mid-June and peaking by the end of June to early July. The third flight usually peaks by early to mid-August. Egg-laying periods occur at roughly the same times as peak trap catches. Monitoring and Controls: Where first-hatch larvae are numerous, an insecticide application of a Bt product, Intrepid, or Confirm may be applied during mid-bloom since these products do not have activity against bees. No other insecticides should be used at this time. Treatments are justified only when the combined number of lepidopteran pests (worms) exceeds 1 larva per 100 blossom clusters.
indirect pests
Aphids, Illinoia pepperi, Ericaphis spp., Myzus persicae (Sulzer) and Others
Symptoms of Damage: Aphids suck sap out of tender new growth and plants are devitalized. Honeydew is secreted as a waste product, which acts as a substrate for sooty mold. However, it takes heavy populations to create a honeydew film and resulting sooty mold. Six species of aphids are found in New Jersey blueberries. Of primary importance is the fact that three species are known to act as vectors for blueberry scorch virus (BBScV). One aphid (Illinoia pepperi) can also transmit shoestring virus. Since aphids may serve as a disease vector, they should not be tolerated in any significant numbers where BBScV is known to occur. Virus transmission under field conditions can occur from early May to mid-August when aphid populations are common. Identification: Aphids are slow-moving insects, usually 1 to 2 millimeters long, that are usually similar in color to that of the foliage on which they feed. They have sucking mouthparts and cornicles (tubes) extending backward from their posterior. Winged forms are found in the fall. Life Cycle: Aphids overwinter as eggs deposited on stems, small shoots, and bud scales. After the eggs hatch in the spring, females find new growth and mature into stem mothers, giving live
131
Chapter 7: Blueberries
birth to more females. Males and egglaying females are produced in the fall and mate. Females then lay overwintering eggs. Monitoring and Controls: Scouting should begin during bloom and continue through the remainder of the season. Recording the percent of new growth infested with aphid colonies is one way to track aphid populations. In scorch-infested areas, only one to two aphids should define an infested leaf or terminal, and sampling should be heavily biased toward new growth. New terminal growth should be scouted as soon as bees are removed. If significant populations of aphids are present, control can be initiated with Provado at 3 to 4 ounces per acre. Treating fields with Admire for Oriental beetle will also give several weeks of aphid control. Lannate can also be used for aphid control, but it is effective only at a full 1 pound per acre, which is higher than the labeled rate for aphids. Other materials that can keep low populations in check or be used as aphid suppressants include Asana, Diazinon, and Malathion. Controlling aphids combined with removing and destroying infected bushes over a 2- to 3-year period can reduce the spread of the virus.
Monitoring and Controls: Pruning out old canes helps to reduce mite populations. An insecticide and/or oil application will give control. A high water volume (400 gallons per acre) and high pressure (200 pounds per acre) are needed during application.
ing red, dropping off, and then the entire cane dying. Identification: The blueberry stem borer adult is a slender, elongated, light brown beetle. Inspection of a damaged cane may show pinholes down its length with light-yellow frass extruding from the holes. A yellowish grub will be found if the stem is split at the end of its long tunnel. Life Cycle: This beetle deposits eggs in current seasons growth near the shoot tip in June or July. The girdling of the shoot is associated with egg laying and causes the tips to wilt. The grub bores down through the shoot toward the crown of the plant, then moves to adjacent stems and continues feeding. Larvae complete their development by the spring of the third year. Monitoring and Controls: Remove and destroy wilted tips as soon as they appear.
Blueberry Gall Midge, also called the Cranberry Tipworm, Dasineura oxycoccana (Johnson) (Diptera: Cecidomyiidae)
Symptoms of Damage: Small holes and feeding areas around the terminal bud and developing leaves are evident when larvae are feeding. As the larvae mature, infested bud and leaf tissue will dry up, leaving a very small and blackened terminal shoot. Identification: This is a small fly in the gall midge (Cecidomyiidae) family. The adult is just over 1 millimeters long with a wingspread of about 3 millimeters. Larvae are tapered at both ends and legless. They mature from clear to white to yellow orange. Fully grown larvae are only 1.6 millimeters (1 16 inch) long. Life Cycle: The insect overwinters as a pupa and emerges as an adult in early May. Eggs are laid on swelling buds and developing leaf petioles. Larvae feed deep within the terminal growth in developing terminal buds and leaf tissue. Three larval instars occur, which can mature in as little as 9 days. A generation takes from 2 to 4 weeks to mature, depending on temperature. Therefore, four to five or more generations may occur per year in the Mid-Atlantic area. Monitoring and Controls: Suspected damage and buds can be collected in plastic bags and watched for emerging larvae. Larvae, if present, will emerge in about 2 days. Most organophosphate materials have some effect on this insect. Recommendations for best timing of application are under investigation.
132
Identification: Oriental beetle adults are straw colored with black markings to varying extents, though completely black or completely straw-colored beetles are also found. Life Cycle: Oriental beetles overwinter as grubs deep enough in the soil to avoid freezing. As soil temperatures warm in the spring, the grubs move upward and resume feeding on roots. Pupation occurs in May, and adults begin emerging in early June. Peak emergence is near the end of June. Female adults lay an average of 25 eggs each. Eggs hatch into larvae (grubs) from early July though mid-August, which feed on the roots, then move downward for winter. The Oriental beetle, Asiatic garden beetle, and Japanese beetle all have one-year life cycles. Monitoring and Controls: Beetle populations should be monitored with Japanese beetle can traps, which are placed on the soil surface and baited with the Oriental beetle pheromone. In infested areas, traps will fill up in only a few days. Root systems that are excavated in infested areas may yield up to a dozen or more grubs per plant. Admire is currently the only insecticide that gives adequate control. Since Admire works only on first- and second-instar grubs, the applications must be made shortly after the eggs are laid and grubs are close to the soil surface. This means that applications should be made by late June to early July for mid- to late-season varieties and immediately after harvest for early season varieties. Additional controls currently being worked on include the use of pheromone-based mating disruption and entomopathogenic nematodes.
older canes are not removed, especially if the scales parasites and predators have been destroyed by insecticide sprays. They spend most of their lives as legless, sedentary individuals. Putnam scales, which are the scale most commonly attacking blueberry, appear as gray, waxy dots about 1 16 inch in diameter. Most are under loose bark on older canes, but they can also be found on leaves and fruit. An immobile yellow insect can be seen if the scale covering is removed. Terrapin scales are brown or reddish brown, are shaped like a half-sphere about 1 7 inch in diameter, and are marked with black bands like the shell of a turtle. They are present primarily on the canes. Life Cycle: Depending on location, there may be one or two generations of Putnam scale per year with varying life cycles for other species. In general, eggs are laid in the spring. Crawlers emerge in spring to early summer, thereby helping the insects disperse. Monitoring and Controls: Good scale control is accomplished first by good pruning practices. Removing and destroying old wood during pruning often does much to reduce scale populations. The second approach is to use dormant oils to smother the overwintering scales. Oil should be applied early in spring after the bud scales start to expand but before the first leaf stands out from the cluster. Cover sprays during the growing season are usually ineffective because the scales are protected by their secreted shell. However, sprays timed to coincide with crawler emergence can be effective. Crawlers can be detected by wrapping black electricians tape covered by double-sided sticky tape around twigs. Use a hand lens to see the active crawlers on the edge of the sticky tape.
Identification: The adults are brownish gray, wedge shaped, and approximately 3 16 inch long with a distinctly sloped and pointed extension of the head in both the nymphal and adult stages. Both S. frontalis and S. acutus have a yellowish white marking on the front of the head. This marking is missing from S. magdalensis. The nymphs are 1 16 inch long and brownish black with a white or cream hourglass-shaped mark on their backs. Leafhoppers acquire the stunt pathogen by feeding on infected plants. Only the motile adults transmit the disease to healthy plants by subsequent feeding activity. Once leafhoppers have acquired the virus, they have it for life. Life Cycle: The leafhopper overwinters as an egg inside fallen leaves. Eggs hatch in mid- to late spring, with firstgeneration adults appearing by late May to early June. In the northeast and MidAtlantic area, two generations occur per year. Large populations often emerge in abandoned blueberry fields and in wooded habitats where blueberries and huckleberries are common in the ground cover. Adults can fly long distances and tend to disperse from the woods during the spring generation and back into the woods during the fall generation. The stunt pathogen is probably carried back and forth between commercial fields and wild reservoirs by the annual cycle of leafhopper dispersal. Monitoring and Controls: Control of first-generation leafhoppers is usually accomplished by a petal fall cover spray for plum curculio and fruitworms. Blueberry maggot traps can be used to monitor leafhoppers and to help time an insecticide spray, if necessary. Traps should be hung vertically, yellow side out, with the bottom about 18 inches above the ground. The yellow sticky traps used for leafhoppers do not have to be baited as they are for blueberry maggot. Apply an insecticide if the leafhopper population increases sharply between one week and the next. Make sure to apply at least one insecticide for the second generation just prior to flight peak. This will normally occur shortly after the last berries have been picked, or mid to late August to early September.
Scales Including Putnam Scale, Aspidiotus ancylus (Homoptera: Diaspididae), and Terrapin Scale, Lecanium nigrofasciatum (Homoptera: Coccidae)
Symptoms of Damage: Decreased vigor and yields and plant decline if in high numbers. The scale insects feed on sap and secrete honeydew on which black sooty mold develops. Infested berries are undersized and unmarketable. Identification: These insects may be common in blueberry plantings if pruning has been neglected for several years and
Sharp-Nosed Leafhoppers (three species), Scaphytopius magdalensis, Scaphytopius frontalis, and Scaphytopius acutus (Homoptera: Cicadellidae)
Symptoms of Damage: All three species of sharp-nosed leafhopper, while causing little outright injury to blueberry plants, are important in blueberry culture because they can transmit the phytoplasma that causes blueberry stunt disease, for which there is no control.
133
Chapter 7: Blueberries
thrips to a much lesser extent. Of these choices, only Spintor may be used during bloom, but it is highly toxic to bees exposed to the spray before it has dried. Do not apply within 3 hours of bee activity, and if used during bloom, then apply the product in the evening after bees have stopped foraging for the day.
Weeds
Blueberry root systems are shallow and lack root hairs, which put them at a disadvantage when competing with weeds for water and nutrients. Weeds also compete with blueberry plants for light and space. They acts as hosts for insects, diseases, and nematodes; provide cover for undesirable animals; reduce quality and yield; and impede harvest. Thus, good weed control is essential if optimum growth and yields are to be realized. Weeds may be controlled by a number of different methods or combinations of methods, but an integrated approach including the following methods is the most effective: 1. Avoid sites infested with persistent perennial weeds such as quackgrass, nutsedge, and wild brambles. 2. If such sites must be used, eradicate weeds in the years before planting. Cover crops such as sudangrass or rye are very effective in outcompeting
verteBrAte pests
With blueberries, birds are frequent vertebrate pests, as are voles. However, deer can also cause damage to young plantings, and miscellaneous other rodents cause occasional damage. Chapter 5 contains a complete discussion of vertebrate pests, including information on identification of various species of pests, diagnosis of damage when the culprit is not seen, and management/control measures.
table 7.11. Activity groups and effectiveness of fungicides for blueberry disease control.
Not all fungicides listed below are labeled for all the diseases listed. This table is intended to provide information on effectiveness for diseases that appear on the label and additional diseases that may be controlled from application. See Table 7.13 for labeled uses. Fungicide Abound Aliette Bravo Cabrio Captan Captevate Elevate Indar Lime sulfur Messenger Omega Orbit, Tilt Phosphorous Acidd Pristine Ridomil Gold Switch Ziram Activity Groupa 11 33 M 11 M 17, M 17 3 M 29 3 33 7, 11 4 9, 12 M Anthracnose Fruit Rot +++b +c ++ +++ ++ ++ 0 0 0 0 +++ 0 0c +++ 0 ++ +++ Mummy Berry ++ 0 + 0 0 0 0 +++ 0 0 +++ 0 ++ 0 ++ 0 Alternaria Fruit Rot ++ + ++ + + + 0 0 0 + 0 +++ 0 Botrytis Blight ++ 0 + ++ ++ +++ +++ 0 0 0 0 +++ 0 +++ ++ Phomopsis Twig Blight ++ ++ 0 ++ ++ ++ + +++ ++ 0 0 0 +++ 0 0 ++ Phytophthora Root Rot 0 +++ 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 +++ 0 +++ 0 0
a. Chemistry of fungicides by activity groups: 3 = demethylation inhibitors (includes triazoles); 4 = acylalanines; 7 = carboxamides; 9 = anilinopyrimidines; 11 = strobilurins; 12 = phenylpyrroles; 17 = hydroxyanilides; 29 = activity group not named, chemical group = 2,6-dinitroanilines; 33 = unknown (phosphonates); M = chemical groups with multisite activity. Fungicides with two activity groups listed contain active ingredients from two activity groups. b. 0 = not effective; + = slight effectiveness; ++ = moderate effectiveness; +++ = very effective; = insufficient data c. Aliette and the phosphorous acid fungicides are not effective for prevention of anthracnose fruit rot; however, they can be used to improve storage. d. Phosphorous acid fungicides have the same active ingredient as Aliette. These include Phostrol, Prophyte, and Rampart.
134
table 7.12. Activity groups and effectiveness of insecticides and miticides on blueberry pests. Not all insecticides listed below are labeled for all the insects listed. This table is intended to provide information on effectiveness for insects that appear on the label plus additional insects that may be controlled from application. See Table 7.13 for labeled uses.
Activitya Group Actara 4A Admire 4A Asana 3 Assail 4A Avaunt 22 Aza-Direct un Brigade 3 Bt Products 11 Confirm 18 Danitol 3 Delegate 5 Diazinon 1B Esteem 7 Guthion (NJ only) 1B Imidan 1B Intrepid 18 Lannate 1A Malathion 1B M-Pede Mustang Max 3 Platinum 4A Provado 4A Pyganic 3 Pyrellin 3, 21 Sevin 1A Spintor, Success, Entrust 5 Superior Oil Surround Thionex 2A Blueberry Maggot + + ++ +++ + ++ +++ +++ ++ +++ + +++ + + + +++ 0 + 0 Bud Mite 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 + +++ Cranberry Weevil +++ +++ ++ +++ +++ ++ + + + Fruitworms 0 0 ++ + ++ ++ +++ ++ +++ +++ +++ + ++ 0 + + +++ + Japanese Beetle LeafAdults hoppers ++ +++ ++ ++ ++ ++ ++ ++ + ++ 0 0 +++ ++ 0 0 +++ 0 + ++ +++ ++ +++ ++ + + + ++ ++ ++ +++ +++ + ++ +++ ++ 0 +++ 0 0 Leafrollers ++ +++ +++ ++ +++ +++ ++ ++ ++ + +++ Plum Curculio + ++ 0 ++ +++ +++ +++ + ++ ++ + + + 0 ++ + White Grubs +++ +
a. Chemistry of insecticides by activity groups: 1A = carbamates; 1B = organophosphates; 2A = chlorinated cyclodienes; 3= pyrethrins and synthetic pyrethroids; 4A =neonicotinoids; 5 = spinosyns; 7 = juvenile hormone mimics; 11 = Bt microbials; 18 = ecdysone agonists/molting disruptors; 21 = botanical (Site I electron transport inhibitors); 22 = voltage-dependent sodium channel blocker b. indicates insufficient data; +++ = good control; ++ = moderate control; + = some control; 0 = little or no control c. Dormant to delayed dormant only; effective on eggs.
135
Chapter 7: Blueberries
When dormant, prune out diseased canes and burn. Continue Lime sulfur, 56 gal in 100150 gal of diluted spray/A () to remove and burn blighted wood during the season. Apply lime sulfur at sufficient volume to achieve coverage of the canes. Do not use within 14 days of an oil spray or when temperature is above 75F. Do not mix with other insecticides or fungicides. Will also aid in control of scale insects. Bury old mummies by disking before mummy cup formation. Burial of mummies (infected berries) a least 1 inch deep, and 2 inches preferably, will greatly reduce germination of mummy cups. Apply oil only if scales are present and there is no danger of freezing temperatures for 24 hours. Apply when buds have swollen but no green tissue is present. Good coverage is essential. Lime sulfur applied in the dormant stage for phomopsis will also aid in control of scale insects. Pruning out old canes prevents heavy infestations. Superior oil, 3.0 gal. Apply 250300 gal water/A at a pressure of 300400 psi, or follow manufacturers recommendations for water volume and pressure to be used. Esteem 35WP at 5 oz/A may be added to the oil for increased scale control.
Mummy berry
Insects Scale
Bud BreAK through preBloom Diseases Phytophthora root rot Make the first soil application of Ridomil now, unless used when dormant in spring (see above). Ridomil is at risk for resistance development, so have an accurate diagnosis made of the need for this treatment before applying. Phosphorous acid products (Aliette, Phostrol, Prophyte, and Rampart) can be used as a soil application at this time, or as a foliar application if leaves are developed.
continued
136
table 7.13. pesticides for blueberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Mummy berry (primary infection) Timing of Treatment/Comments Rake, sweep, or hoe under plants to disturb mummy cups through blossom period. Limited success has been achieved by applying 200 lb of 50% urea mix as a ground application as first mummy cups are formed (burns only open cups). Apply a fungicide when leaf buds show green, repeating once in 10 days. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in a different chemical class. Indar, Orbit, and Tilt are in the same fungicide group and cannot be rotated with each other for resistance management. Make this application immediately before bloom. Apply in sufficient water to cover emerging flowers and bud scales, in which anthracnose inoculum overwinters. When leaf buds show green and blossom buds show white and are separating in the cluster. Do not apply within 7 days of pollination, as Asana repels bees. Confirm is a selective insecticide effective against most caterpillar pests (larvae only). Confirm, Bt products, Delegate, and Intrepid are effective only on early instars. Producta Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Indar 75WSP, 2.0 oz or 2F, 6 fl oz (30), or Orbit, 6 fl oz (30), or Tilt, 6 fl oz (30), or Pristine, 18.523.0 oz (0), or Switch 62.5 WDG, 1114 oz (0), or Abound F, 6.215.4 oz (0)see note in Table 7.14 about severe toxicity of Abound to McIntosh, Gala, and related apple cultivars.
Anthracnose
Leafrollers
Confirm 2F, 16.0 fl oz (14), or Bt products, var. kurstaki (0), or Mustang, 4.3 oz (1), or Mustang Max, 4.0 oz (1), or Delegate WG, 36 oz (3), or Intrepid 2F, 16 oz (7) Confirm 2F, 16.0 fl oz (14), or Dipel DF, 0.51.0 lb (0), or Intrepid 2F, 16 oz (7) Confirm 2F, 4.08.0 fl oz (14), or Dipel DF, 0.51.0 lb (0), or Intrepid 2F, 48 oz (7)
Spanworms
Confirm is a selective insecticide effective against most caterpillar pests (larvae only). Apply these products to early instars. Confirm is a selective insecticide effective against most caterpillar pests (larvae only). Apply these products to early instars.
Gypsy moth
At 7- to 10-day intervals through petal fall. This spray is designed to prevent flower infections and is necessary if primary mummy berry (shoot blight) infections were not controlled previously. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in a different chemical class.
Indar 75WSP, 2 oz or 2F, 6 fl oz (30), or Orbit, 6 fl oz (30), or Tilt, 6 fl oz (30), or Abound F, 6.215.4 oz (0)see note in Table 7.14 about severe toxicity of Abound to McIntosh, Gala, and related apple cultivars, or Switch 62.5WG, 11.014.0 oz (0), or Pristine, 18.523.0 oz (0)
continued
137
Chapter 7: Blueberries
table 7.13. pesticides for blueberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Botrytis Timing of Treatment/Comments Begin application at early bloom. Combine treatments with anthracnose controls. Spray at 7- to 10-day intervals through petal fall. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in a different chemical class. Note that although captan has a 0-day PHI, it has a longer REI for blueberries, and Captevate has a 48-hr REI. Apply at mid-bloom and repeat in 7 to 10 days. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in a different chemical class. Captevate has a 48-hr REI. Producta Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Pristine, 18.523.0 oz (0), or Captan 50W, 5 lb or 80WDG, 3.125 lb (0), or Captec 4L, 2.5 qt, or Captevate 68WDG, 3.54.7 lb (0), or Switch 62.5WG, 11.014.0 oz (0), or Elevate, 1.5 lb (0)
Anthracnose
Abound F, 6.215.4 oz (0)see note in Table 7.14 about severe toxicity of Abound to McIntosh, Gala, and related apple cultivars, or Switch 62.5WG, 11.014.0 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0), or Pristine, 18.523 oz (0), or Captevate 68WDG, 4.7 lb (0), or Ziram 76DF, 3 lb ()see special local needs label (24C) allowing 4 lb/acre rate and 14-day PHI in NJ
Only insecticides nonharmful to bees (e.g., Bt, Confirm, Intrepid) can be applied during bloom. Confirm is a selective insecticide effective against most caterpillar pests (larvae only). Only insecticides nonharmful to bees (e.g., Bt, Confirm, Intrepid) can be applied during bloom. Confirm is a selective insecticide effective against most caterpillar pests (larvae only). Apply products to early instars. Spintor is toxic to bees exposed to the spray before it has dried. Apply in the evening after bees have stopped foraging for the day.
Confirm 2F, 16 oz (14), or Dipel DF, 0.51.0 lb (0), or Intrepid 2F, 16 oz (7) Confirm 2F, 4.08.0 fl oz (14), or Dipel DF, 0.51.0 lb (0), or Intrepid 2F, 48 oz (7) Spintor 2SC, 4.06.0 fl oz (3)
Gypsy moths
Thrips
This is intended to be the follow-up spray for the one applied at mid-bloom. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in a different chemical class. Captevate has a 48-hr REI.
Abound F, 6.215.4 oz (0)see note in Table 7.14 about severe toxicity of Abound to McIntosh, Gala, and related apple cultivars, or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0), or Captevate 68WDG, 4.7 lb (0), or Pristine, 18.523.0 oz (0), or Switch 62.5 WG, 11.014.0 oz (0), or Ziram 76DF, 3 lb ()see special local needs label (24C) allowing 4 lb/acre rate and 14-day PHI in NJ
continued
138
table 7.13. pesticides for blueberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Insects Cranberry or cherry fruitworm Timing of Treatment/Comments At petal fall (May 25 to June 7 in NJ) and again 10 days later. Sprays for insects at this time will also give control of spanworms and gypsy moth. Confirm is a selective insecticide effective against most caterpillar pests (larvae only). Growers using Guthion should be aware of restrictions on use and long re-entry intervals for the general public. Guthion use on blueberries is prohibited after Sept. 30, 2012. A yearly maximum amount of 0.75 lb ai/a applies for 2010, 2011, and 2012. Producta Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Diazinon 50W, 1 lb or AG500, 1 pt (7), or Malathion 57EC, 1.6 pt or 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or Imidan 70W, 1.33 lb (3), or Asana XL, 4.89.6 oz (14), or Lannate SP, 0.51.0 lb or LV, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.92.3 oz/a, or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1), or Avaunt, 3.56.0 oz (7) Danitol 2.4EC, 10.6716 fl oz (3), or Intrepid 2F, 16 oz (7), or Delegate WG, 36 oz (3), or Confirm 2F, 16 oz (14), or Esteem 35WP, 5 oz (7), or nJ onlyc: Guthion 50WP, 1.01.5 lb Imidan 70W, 1.33 lb (3), or Lannate SP, 1 lb or LV, 3 pt (3), or Confirm 2F, 16 oz (14), or Dipel DF, 0.51.0 lb (0), or Malathion 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or Intrepid 2F, 16 oz (7), or Spintor 2SC, 4.06.0 fl oz (3), or Danitol 2.4EC, 10.6716 fl oz (3), or Mustang, 4.3 oz (1), or Mustang Max, 4.0 oz (1), or Delegate WG, 36 oz (3) Malathion 57EC, 2.83.2 pt or 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or Imidan 70W, 1.33 lb (3), or Surround 95WP, 25.050.0 lb (0), or Danitol, 10.6716 fl oz (3), or nJ onlyc: Guthion 50WP, 1.01.5 lb (7)
Leafrollers
At petal fall (May 25 to June 7 in NJ). Danitol is labeled for obliquebanded leafroller only. Confirm is a selective insecticide effective against most caterpillar pests (larvae only). In NJ, leafroller resistance to malathion has been noted.
Plum curculio
At petal fall (May 25 to June 7 in NJ). Apply if there is a history of this pest, or oviposition scars are seen on earliest forming green berries. Growers using Guthion should be aware of restrictions on use and long reentry intervals for the general public. Guthion use on blueberries is prohibited after Sept. 30, 2012. A yearly maximum amount of 0.75 lb ai/a applies for 2010, 2011, and 2012.
Thrips
Assail 70WP, 1.92.3 oz, or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1), or Provado 1.6F, 6.08.0 fl oz (3), or Spintor 2SC, 4.06.0 fl oz (3) As crawlers are detected. Esteem 35WP, 5 oz (7)
12 WeeKs AFter petAl FAll Diseases Anthracnose Early to mid-June, especially when weather is warm and rainy. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in a different chemical class. Ziram has a 14-day PHI in NJ; however, applications should be avoided within 28 days prior to harvest due to the visibility of white residues. Captevate has a 48-hr REI.
Abound F, 6.215.4 oz (0)see note in Table 7.14 about severe toxicity of Abound to McIntosh, Gala, and related apple cultivars, or Pristine, 18.523.0 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0), or Captevate 68 WDG, 4.7 lb (0), or Ziram 76DF, 3 lb ()see special needs label (24C) allowing 4 lb/acre rate and 14-day PHI in NJ
continued
139
Chapter 7: Blueberries
table 7.13. pesticides for blueberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Insects Sharpnosed leafhopper Timing of Treatment/Comments Early to mid-June. As necessary. Sharpnosed leafhoppers transmit stunt, which is lethal to blueberries. Rogue out affected plants (refer to text discussion) and apply an insecticide when sharpnosed leafhoppers appear on yellow sticky traps. Producta Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Lannate SP, 0.5 lb or LV, 1.5 pt (3), or Asana XL, 4.89.6 oz (14), or Provado 1.6F, 3.0-4.0 fl oz (3), or Malathion 57EC, 2.83.2 pt or 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or Actara, 3.04.0 oz (3), or Brigade WSB, 5.316 oz (1), or Assail 70WP, 1.02.3 oz, or 30SG 2.55.3 oz (1) Lannate SP, 0.5 lb or LV, 1.5 pt (3), or Diazinon 50W, 1 lb or AG500, 1 pt (7), or Provado 1.6F, 3.04.0 fl oz (3), or Malathion 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or M-Pede, 12% v/v (0), or Actara, 3.04.0 oz (3), or Brigade WSB, 5.316 oz (1), or Assail 70WP, 1.02.3 oz , or 30SG 2.55.3 oz (1), or nJ onlyd: Asana XL, 4.89.6 oz (14) Esteem 35WP, 5 oz (7)
Blueberry aphids
Early to mid-June.
Scale crawlers
lAter postpollinAtion sprAys Diseases Anthracnose For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides per crop year. Captevate has a 48-hr REI.
Abound F, 6.215.4 oz (0)see note in Table 7.14 about severe toxicity of Abound to McIntosh, Gala, and related apple cultivars, or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0), or Switch 62.5 WDG, 11.014.0 oz (0), or Captevate 68WDG, 4.7 lb (0)
Several phosphorous acid products can be used. Product names include Aliette, Phostrol, Prophyte, and Rampart.
Confirm is a selective insecticide effective against most caterpillar pests (larvae only). Growers using Guthion should be aware of restrictions on use and long reentry intervals for the general public. Guthion use on blueberries is prohibited after Sept. 30, 2012. A yearly maximum amount of 0.75 lb ai/a applies for 2010, 2011, and 2012.
Diazinon 50W, 1 lb or AG500, 1 pt (7), or Malathion 57EC, 1.6 pt or 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or Sevin 80S, 1 7/82.5 lb or 4F, 1.52.0 qt (7), or Imidan 70W, 1.33 lb (3), or Asana XL, 4.89.6 oz (14), or Lannate SP, 0.51.0 lb or LV, 1.53.0 pt (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.92.3 oz, or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1), or Avaunt, 3.56.0 oz (7), or Danitol, 10.6716 fl oz (3), or Confirm 2F, 16 oz (14), or Esteem 35WP, 5 oz (7), or Spintor 2SC, 46 fl oz (3), or nJ onlyc: Guthion 50WP, 1.01.5 lb (7)
continued
140
table 7.13. pesticides for blueberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Leafrollers Timing of Treatment/Comments When populations are high. Danitol is labeled for obliquebanded leafroller only. Confirm is a selective insecticide effective against most caterpillar pests (larvae only). In NJ, leafroller resistance to malathion has been noted. Producta Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Imidan 70W, 1.33 lb (3), or Lannate SP, 1 lb or LV, 3 pt (3), or Confirm 2F, 16 oz (14), or Dipel DF, 0.51.0 lb (0), or Malathion 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or Spintor 2SC, 46 fl oz (3), or Sevin 80S, 2.5 lb or 4F, 2.0 qt (7), or Danitol 2.4 EC, 10.6716 fl oz (3), or Mustang, 4.3 oz (1), or Mustang Max, 4.0 oz (1), or Delegate WG, 36 oz (3) Lannate SP, 0.5 lb or LV, 1.5 pt (3), or Provado 1.6F, 3.04.0 fl oz (3), or Asana XL, 4.89.6 oz (14), or Actara, 3.04.0 oz (3), or Malathion 57EC, 2.83.2 pt or 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or Brigade WSB, 5.316 oz (1), or Assail 70WP, 1.02.3 oz, or 30SG 2.55.3 oz (1) Lannate SP, 0.5 lb or LV, 1.5 pt (3), or Provado 1.6F, 3.04.0 fl oz (3), or Malathion 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or M-Pede, 12% v/v (0), or Actara, 3.04.0 oz (3), or Brigade WSB, 5.316 oz (1), or Assail 70WP, 1.02.3 oz, or 30SG 2.55.3 oz (1) Insecticides applied for fruitworms usually also control this pest. Malathion 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1)
Sharpnosed leafhopper
As necessary. Sharpnosed leafhoppers transmit stunt, which is lethal to blueberries. Rogue out affected plants (refer to text discussion) and apply an insecticide when sharpnosed leafhoppers appear on yellow sticky traps.
Aphids
For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides per crop year. Captevate has a 48-hr REI. Aliette is not effective for the prevention of anthracnose fruit rot; however, it can be used to improve storage.
Abound F, 6.215.4 oz (0)see note in Table 7.14 about severe toxicity of Abound to McIntosh, Gala, and related apple cultivars, or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0), or Switch 62.5 WDG, 11.014.0 oz (0), or Captevate 68WDG, 4.7 lb (0), or Aliette WDG, 5.0 lb (0.5) Sevin 80S 1.872.5 lb or 4F, 1.52.0 qt (7), or Lannate SP, 0.250.5 lb or LV, 0.751.5 pt (3), or Imidan 70W, 1.3 lb (3), or Malathion 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or Asana XL, 9.6 oz (14), or Danitol 2.4 EC, 10.6716 fl oz (3), or Surround 95WP, 12.550 lb (0), or Provado 1.6F, 6.08.0 fl oz (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.92.3 oz, or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1)
continued
Begin treatments 10 days after the first maggot adult catch in monitoring traps. Repeat every 10 days through harvest. If traps are not used and maggots are a problem, begin sprays when berries first turn blue. Adding a bait to the spray mixture will enhance its activity. Watch days-to-harvest limitations. Surround is for suppression and is recommended for application only within the first three weeks after fruit set due to likelihood of visible residues.
141
Chapter 7: Blueberries
table 7.13. pesticides for blueberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Leafrollers Timing of Treatment/Comments When populations are high. Danitol is labeled for obliquebanded leafroller only. In NJ, leafroller resistance to malathion has been noted. Producta Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Imidan 70W, 1.33 lb (3), or Lannate SP, 1 lb or LV, 3 pt (3), or Malathion 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or Danitol 2.4 EC, 10.6716 fl oz (3), or Mustang, 4.3 oz (1), or Mustang Max, 4.0 oz (1) Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb or 4F, 12 qt (7), or Imidan 70W, 1.33 lb (3), or Provado 1.6F, 6.08.0 fl oz (3), or Actara, 4.0 oz (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.92.3 oz or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1), or Danitol 2.4 EC, 10.6716 fl oz (3)
Fall webworm
No pesticides are currently labeled for this pest. However, broad-spectrum pesticides applied for other pests will give control. Admire works well on young larvae as they hatch from eggs but has little effect if applied later in the summer. Apply from June to mid-July at least 7 days before harvest begins for most varieties and right after harvest for the earliest varieties. Material should be applied to moist soil and watered in with 0.5 to 1 inch of water. The active ingredient is broken down by sunlight, so evening applications are best. Once in the soil, the insecticide will remain present for several months. Admire Pro, 714 oz (7)
As soon as possible after harvest. Make this application August 1 to 20 in NJ. See Special Local Needs label for NJ. Late fall through early winter. This spray will also help with controlling black shadow, a recently identified disease that causes a blackened appearance to twigs and a decline of affected plants. Not often a problem.
Ziram 76DF, 3 lb (), or nJ only: Ziram 76DF, 4 lb (14) Lime sulfur, 56 gal in 100150 gal of diluted spray/A ()
Powdery mildew
142
table 7.13. pesticides for blueberry disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Insects Sharpnosed leafhopper Timing of Treatment/Comments As necessary. Sharpnosed leafhoppers transmit stunt, which is lethal to blueberries. Rogue out affected plants (refer to text discussion) and apply an insecticide when sharpnosed leafhoppers appear on yellow sticky traps.Actara and Platinum contain the same active ingredient. Actara is for foliar applications, while Platinum is applied to the soil. Producta Labeled Rate/A (Days to Harvest) Malathion 57EC, 2.83.2 pt or 8F, 1.52.5 pt (1), or Asana XL, 4.89.6 oz (14), or Lannate LV, 1.5 pt or SP, 0.5 lb (3), or Provado 1.6F, 3.04.0 fl oz (3), or Brigade WSB, 5.316 oz (1), or Assail 70WP, 1.02.3 oz, or 30SG, 2.55.3 oz (1), or Actara, 3.04.0 oz (3), or Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (75) Admire Pro, 714 oz (7), or Platinum, 5.012.0 fl oz (75)
This includes larvae of Japanese beetle, Oriental beetle, and Asiatic garden beetle. Earlier applications, prior to the end of July, are more effective. Postharvest application may be of value only on the earliest cultivars. Immediately after harvest and 68 weeks later. Use oil when Putnam scale is also a problem. In NJ, make applications between September 15 and 30.
a. Some pesticides may be phytotoxic to plants. If in doubt, test a small area of the field first. This is especially important when new formulations are being used or tank-mixed. Be sure sprayer is calibrated properly. Diazinon and captan should not be tank-mixed as the combination may be phytotoxic. Liquid formulations of captan have caused phytotoxicity to blueberries under conditions of high humidity and cloudiness, when the leaf cuticle may be thinner than usual. b. Berkeley, Coville, Jersey, and Weymouth cultivars are particularly susceptible to phomopsis twig blight. c. Guthion is labeled for blueberries in the states of AL, AR, FL, GA, IN, MI, NC, NJ, and NY only. d. Asana is labeled for use against aphids only in NJ. e. Do not apply after buds are well formed. Do not make more than two applications per year.
143
Chapter 7: Blueberries
Actara
Imidan 70W
144
Platinum Pristine
Spintor, Success, Entrust Do not apply more than a total of 0.45 lb ai of spinosad per acre per crop. Do not make more than 6 applications per year. Do not make applications less than 6 days apart. Do not apply more than 3 times per crop. When applied two times in succession, rotate to another insecticide class for at least one application. Switch Thionex Ziram 76DF Do not exceed 56 oz of Switch per acre per year. Do not make more than 2 applications before using a fungicide in another resistance management group. Do not make more than 2 applications per year. Do not exceed 1.5 lb ai per acre per year. Ziram applications should be avoided within 28 days prior to harvest due to the visibility of white residues.
145
Chapter 7: Blueberries
noxious weeds; they also help build up soil organic matter if plowed under at the end of the season. For a more complete discussion of cover crops, see Chapter 2. Weeds can also be controlled the year before planting with glyphosate (Roundup), Touchdown, and selective broadleaf herbicides in grass crops. For a general discussion of weed control practices that will aid in minimizing weed pressure, see Chapter 4. 3. Control weeds in crops that precede blueberries on the site. 4. Control weeds in fencerows and adjacent fields. 5. Correctly identify the weeds that are in your planting so you can implement measures that will be effective for the weeds that you have. 6. Minimize weeds between the rows through the use of cultivation or establishment of a weed-free sod. 7. Use weed-free mulching materials within the row. 8. If cultivation is required, do so only shallowly since the blueberry root system is easily damaged. 9. In conventional systems, use recommended herbicides properly (see Table 7.18). Practices 5, 6, 7, and 9 are discussed below. In organic production, cultural practices that successfully manage weeds take on increased importance. Weed management strategies include planting permanent sod between rows of blueberries, mulching along the length of the row of blueberries, and using mechanical or hand cultivation. Placing a wide and deep mulch (6 inches deep and 4 feet wide) or fabric weed barrier around blueberry plants are also weed management strategies to consider.
Cultivation
When cultivation is used between the rows, it should be shallow and frequent during the growing season. Annual weeds are easily controlled by cultivation when they are less than one inch tall. Weeds that are more than two inches tall are more difficult to control and may have already competed with the blueberries.
Weed identiFiCAtion
Knowing what the weed is and its life cycle (whether a summer annual, winter annual, biennial, or perennial) is a critical first step in implementing effective control measures. General information on the above terms is provided in Chapter 4 and in Table 4.1. Resources for weed identification are provided in Appendix E.
requirement, but it is moderately slow and difficult to establish. The addition of clover or other legumes is not recommended. Prepare for sod establishment before the blueberries are planted. Control perennial weeds and nematodes and correct soil pH and nutrient deficiencies first. Complete primary tillage operations the summer before planting. If building gently sloping raised ridges for blueberry rows to improve drainage, do so before sowing grass or planting blueberries. The success of a sod planting will depend on accurate seeding and timing. Sow tall or hard fescue in late summer into a well-prepared seedbed. Use 50 to 75 pounds of seed per broadcast acre to establish tall fescue, or 25 to 50 pounds of seed per broadcast acre to establish hard fescue. Blend up to 5 pounds of perennial ryegrass per 100 pounds of hard fescue seed to provide a fast, thin cover while the hard fescue gets established. The perennial ryegrass will be eliminated from the stand by disease and drought in a few years. If perennial ryegrass is not used, a significantly greater amount of hard fescue seed should be used. See Tables 7.3 and 7.4 for additional information on cover crop characteristics and rates. Use a seeder that will ensure good seed placement in a firm seedbed with good seed and soil contact. Failure to use adequate equipment for seeding frequently results in poor establishment. In an area like New Jersey, complete seeding by September 1 in the northern counties of New Jersey and by September 20 in the southern counties. Apply 50 pounds of nitrogen (N) per acre at seeding and repeat in late fall or early spring to encourage rapid establishment. Establishment of a dense sod that is competitive with weeds will require 15 to 20 months. Some additional effort during this period will ensure success. Broadleaf weeds are undesirable in a sod growing between blueberry rows. Competition with the crop and mowing requirements may be increased. Many weeds may be alternate hosts for diseases, insects, or nematode pests. The flowers of dandelion, clover, mustard species, and other weeds may coincide with bloom and are preferred by pol-
146
linating insects. The same weedsand othersmay also bloom before or after the crop blooms and attract bees into the field when insecticides must be sprayed. The seedheads of dandelion clog tractor radiators and cause overheating, which can interfere with crop maintenance operations. Apply Gallery 75DF to the sod early each spring after the sod is at least 6 months old and while the field is nonbearing to control large crabgrass and other summer annuals. Use 1.0 pound of Gallery (0.75 pounds of active ingredient) per acre. This is the same rate of Gallery recommended for use in the row on newly planted nonbearing blueberries. Clover is difficult to control but can be suppressed or controlled in a sod with good management practices and herbicides. Manage fertilizer applications to favor grass rather than the clover. Nitrogen fertilizer stimulates grass growth, and phosphorus and potassium stimulate clover growth in a mixed grass and legume sod. Do not apply fertilizer containing phosphorous or potassium to sod if clover control is a problem. Apply fertilizer for blueberry growth in the vegetation free strip only. Mowing height also influences the composition of a mixed grass and clover sod. Close mowing favors the clover. Taller sod will favor the grass. Mow no closer than 4 inches if clover control is a problem in the sod.
full width of the vegetation-free zone in new plantings to achieve maximum growth of the blueberries.
bicide combinations, herbicide rotations, and sequential or spot treatments in a well-managed weed control program to eliminate or minimize problems. The recommended herbicides covered below have been evaluated for crop safety and effectiveness. Information on all varieties is incomplete. Use herbicides with care on new varieties. Remember that weeds also compete with each other besides competing with your crop. Thus, controlling a particular weed or group of weeds may allow other weed species to take over. A combination of two preemergence herbicides gives better weed control than a single herbicide. Combining a grass herbicide with a broadleaf herbicide results in wider-spectrum control. Consult the label and Table 7.18 for compatible tank mixes.
terminology
Herbicide terminology may not be everyones cup of tea, but it is important to understand in order to effectively use herbicides and to avoid undesirable consequences from herbicide application. Residual herbicides remain in the soil and kill weeds for up to several months. They are applied before weeds germinate. Weeds begin to compete with most crops within 2 to 4 weeks. Some products are effective only on germinating seeds. If weeds are present, a postemergence herbicide can be combined with a residual herbicide. Residual herbicides are applied incorporated or preemergence. Incorporated herbicides are mechanically mixed with the soil. This application method is not well suited to blueberries. It is difficult or impossible to incorporate herbicides near the crown of the blueberry plant, and shallow roots may be pruned by the incorporation equipment. Preemergence herbicides are applied to the soil surface and are used to prevent weeds from establishing before they emerge from the soil, not to prevent weeds from germinating. Labels often state that preemergence herbicides must be activated by cultivation or irrigation. As mentioned above, cultivation is not a recommended practice for incorporating herbicides in blueberries.
mulching
Mulches control annual weeds and provide additional horticultural benefits in many fields. When using mulch for weed control, apply the mulch 3 to 4 inches thick when the rows are weed free. Thinner layers of mulch may not smother emerging weeds. Organic mulches may tie up important nutrients as they break down, so the use of mulch may require additional fertilizer. Reapply mulches annually or when needed to maintain weed suppression. Choose mulch products such as sawdust or wood chips, or a mixture of the two for improved infiltration of water over sawdust alone. Avoid mulches such as straw that provide a favorable environment for rodents such as field mice and voles that may damage blueberries, materials that are not already decomposed, or those that have a high pH such as mushroom compost.
herBiCides
Choose herbicides for use in the row that are labeled, have adequate crop safety (Table 7.15), and control the weeds in your field (see Table 4.1). The use of a single herbicide repeatedly will lead to an increase in resistant weeds. Use her-
147
Chapter 7: Blueberries
However, rainfall or overhead irrigation is needed to move the herbicide into the soil before the weeds emerge and, ideally, just into the zone of weed seed germination. Use a preemergence herbicide in combination with a postemergence herbicide if weeds have emerged, unless the preemergence herbicide also controls weeds postemergence. Of preemergence herbicides labeled for blueberries, Devrinol, Kerb, and Surflan work by inhibiting cell division. Solicam and Callisto inhibit pigment synthesis. Casoron inhibits cellulose biosynthesis and Chateau disrupts cell membranes. Princep and Sinbar work by inhibiting photosynthesis. Sinbar, besides having this effect on germinating weeds, kills small emerged annual weeds. Casoron, Kerb, Chateau, and Callisto also control emerged plants of certain weed species. Repeatedly using herbicides that act on weeds with the same mode of action may lead to weed populations that are resistant to those herbicide(s). Postemergence herbicides are used after weeds have emerged from the soil and kill weeds through the leaves. They are used by carefully applying the herbicide to the weeds without allowing it to contact desirable plants that could be affected, such as blueberries or sod row middles. The best time to apply postemergence herbicides is when weeds are growing rapidly. Do not treat weeds that are dormant or under stress. Most herbicides that enter the plant through the leaves need a minimum rain-free period of at least 1 to 8 hours after application for maximum effectiveness. Postemergence herbicides may be selective or nonselective. Selective postemergence herbicides kill only certain susceptible weeds. Poast, Select, and Fusilade DX are examples that kill only grasses and will not control broadleaf weeds or harm the blueberries. Nonselective postemergence herbicides kill or injure any treated plant. They may be contact or translocated. Contact herbicides (Gramoxone Inteon, Scythe) affect only the plant tissue with which they come in contact. Thorough spray coverage is essential for good results. Roots of established annual weeds and perennial weeds often survive. Translocated herbicides (glyphosate, Fu-
silade, Poast, Select) move systemically in the weed (or crop plant if contacted) after treatment. Application at the proper growth stage will often result in good control of the roots as well as tops of established annuals and perennial weeds. Results of translocated herbicides may not be evident for several days or weeks. Herbicides have no activity after application for one of two reasons. Some herbicides are too tightly bound to the soil to be available to plants after application. Care must be exercised in soilless growing environments, where surprising residual activity can be observed from these herbicides. Other herbicides are highly soluble in water and are not bound to soil particles. Residual activity from these herbicides can be observed in the soil, but it often lasts only a few days. They are rapidly leached out of the zone of weed seed germination and degraded by soil microorganisms. Table 7.16 lists the solubility and soil adsorption characteristics of herbicides labeled for use on blueberries. A complete discussion of the effects that trickle
irrigation can have on increasing weed growth under the trickle line is included in Chapter 4: Weed Management. Glyphosate productsincluding Roundup products, Touchdown products, Glyphomax Plus and othersand paraquat products, including Gramoxone Inteon, Firestorm, and others are too tightly bound to the soil to have residual activity. These herbicides are completely unavailable to plants after application. They remain tightly bound to the soil until broken down. Glyphosate can be degraded or digested by soil microorganisms. Residual activity from glyphosate has been observed when used in greenhouses, on plastic mulch, and near hydroponic growing systems. Paraquat is degraded by sunlight and is less likely to cause problems when used on plastic mulch, in greenhouses, or near soilless growing systems. On coarse-textured sandy soils low in organic matter, Surflan (oryzalin) and Princep (simazine), respectively, are the best choices for annual grass and annual broadleaf weed management based
G = good; F = fair (use with care; recommended); P = poor (not recommended); ? = labeled but data insufficient; = not labeled (do not use) *Do not allow spray to contact young or green (living) bark or leaves.
148
on very low water solubility of both herbicides. On fine-textured soils and soils higher in organic matter, Surflan (oryzalin) and Karmex (diuron; New Jersey and Maryland only), respectively, are the best choices for annual grass and annual broadleaf weed control based on their low and very low water solubility and strong adsorption to the soil. Unfortunately, certain weeds, including yellow nutsedge, escape this herbicide combination.
such as a paraquat or glyphosate product should be avoided during the year of planting unless shields are in place. Avoiding contact of these products with the plant is critical.
rate Control
Strict rate control is necessary. Improperly applied herbicides or herbicides applied above recommended rates may cause damage to blueberries. Using rates that are too low will result in a lack of efficacy or short duration of control. Residual herbicide rates must be matched with soil type and percentage of organic matter to obtain good weed control and crop safety. Determine type and percentage of organic matter for each soil on the farm with a separate soil test. Be aware that most herbicide labels are written for typical agricultural soils and that many common blueberry fields are not typical. Most coarsetextured soils, such as loamy sands and sandy loams, are low in organic matter, often less than 2 percent. Mediumtextured soils, such as loams, may have 2 to 4 percent organic matter. Many traditional black blueberry soils may be classified as loamy sands but may have organic matter contents over 8 percent. Have your soil analyzed for percent organic matter. This is a separate test that must be requested from most soils laboratories. If your soil has an organic matter content higher than the choices listed on the herbicide label for your soil texture, choosing the correct rate may be difficult. See Table 7.17 for recommended rates of specific herbicides for various soil types and organic matter levels. Consult your Cooperative Extension service for assistance in determining the correct herbicide rate to use on your soil if needed. Adjust by changing tractor speed and maintaining pressure when spraying a field with soil that requires different herbicide rates. Herbicide application and equipment are discussed in Chapter 4.
Source: Weed Science Society of America (2002), Herbicide Handbook, 8th ed. Controlling Weeds in Nursery and Landscape Plantings. 2007. Penn State College of Agricultural Sciences. a. pH dependent
149
Chapter 7: Blueberries
table 7.17. per-acre rates per application for preemergence (residual) herbicides for common soil types for blueberries.
Rates for each active ingredient are followed by the corresponding rates of a commonly available product containing the active ingredient listed. Sand herbicide Napropamide (lb ai)a Devrinol 50DF (lb)a Mesotrione (oz ai)a Callisto 4F (fl oz)a Flumioxazin (oz ai)a Chateau 51WDG (oz)a Isoxaben (lb ai)b Gallery 75DF (lb)b Pronamide (lb ai)b Kerb 50WP (lb)b Diclobenil (lb ai)a Casoron CS (gal)a Simazine (lb ai)b Princep 90DF (lb)b Terbacil (lb ai)b Sinbar 80WP (lb)b Norflurazon (lb ai)b Solicam 80DF (lb)b Oryzalin (lb ai)a Surflan 4AS (qt)a Hexazinone (lb ai)b Velpar L (pt)b nJ and md only: Diuron (lb ai) Karmex DF (lb) 01 24 48 1.5.3 36 36 612 0.75 1.0 2 4 24 1.42.8 24 24 12 24 48 1.5.3 36 36 612 0.75 1.0 2 4 24 1.42.8 24 24 Loamy Sand 01 12 24 24 48 48 1.5.3 1.5.3 36 36 36 36 612 612 0.75 0.75 1.0 1.0 2 2 4 4 24 24 1.42.8 1.42.8 2 2.5 24 24 24 24 1.0 1.25 soil type / % organic matter Sandy Loam Loam Silt Loam Clay Loam 01 12 24 12 24 12 24 12 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 1.5.3 1.5.3 1.5.3 1.5.3 1.5.3 1.5.3 1.5.3 1.5.3 1.5.3 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 612 612 612 612 612 612 612 612 612 0.75 0.75 1 0.75 1 1 1 1 1 1.0 1.0 1.33 1.0 1.33 1.33 1.33 1.33 1.33 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 2 2 2 3 2 3 3 4 2.2 2.2 2.2 3.3 2.2 3.3 3.3 4.4 1 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 2.4 2.4 1.25 2 2 2 2 2 3 3 2 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 3 3 4 2.5 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.75 3.75 5 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 0.5 0.5 0.75 0.75 1.0 2.0 2.0 3.0 3.0 4.0 1.5 1.9 1.5 1.9 1.5 1.9 2.0 2.5 2.0 2.5 2.0 2.5 2.0 2.5 2.0 2.5
a. Use the lower recommended rate when tank-mixing with another preemergence herbicide, unless annual grass pressure is severe. b. Use one-half the recommended rate when tank-mixing with another preemergence herbicide. = not labeled or not recommended (do not use).
150
a paraquat product to the tank. In recent years, Princep and Karmex have not performed as reliably as in previous years at some sites. Reasons may include weed species shifts to annual broadleaf weeds, such as groundsel, that are less susceptible to these herbicides, the development of triazine-resistant biotypes, or the establishment of perennial broadleaf weeds. If this is the case on your farm, an alternative is to apply Casoron in the late fall at rates given in Table 7.18 to control these weeds. Casoron will control early season annual grasses, but a residual annual grass herbicide should be applied in the spring for full-season grass control. The use of a grass herbicide in the fall depends on the product chosen. Kerb 50WP is the only grass herbicide that must be applied in the fall. Choose Kerb to control cool season perennial grasses such as quackgrass. An additional residual annual grass herbicide is needed in the spring to provide full season summer annual grass control following a fall application of Kerb 50WP. Solicam 90DF, Surflan 80WP, and Devrinol 50DF are annual grass herbicides that should be applied in late fall or as a split application, half in the fall and the second half in the spring. Use the split application when grass pressure is heavy for best results. The use of these herbicides in spring only has resulted in inconsistent weed control when dry weather followed the application. Sinbar 80WP applications should be applied only in the spring. The relatively high solubility of Sinbar 80WP results in leaching when applied in the fall. Increased risk of crop injury and poor weed control can result. Consider spot treating with a labeled glyphosate product if perennial weeds are present; treatment is recommended in the fall. Application by use of a wick applicator is a safer option in order to avoid contact of the herbicide with the blueberry plants. Follow-up late spring applications should include a different residual broadleaf weed herbicide and a residual grass herbicide. Add a postemergence herbicide only if needed. Use Karmex 80DF (New Jersey and Maryland only) for residual broadleaf weed control if Princep was used in the fall, or use Princep if Karmex was used in the fall.
Apply Sinbar 80WP or the second half of a split herbicide treatment of Solicam 80DF, Surflan 80WP, or Devrinol 50DF for annual grass control. Include a paraquat product if seedling annual weeds are observed. As mentioned above under Late Fall Herbicide Applications, Princep and Karmex have recently not performed reliably at some sites. This has also been the case with the spring application of Princep and Karmex, as well as Sinbar. Reasons for failure at this time of the year may be the same as those listed above, plus the possibility that biotypes may exist that germinate later in the summer when these herbicides are less effective. In these cases, add Callisto or Chateau to your spring tank mixture to improve control of summer annual broadleaf weeds. Spot treat with a labeled glyphosate product to control established perennial grasses and broadleaf weeds. Sinbar 80DF is also effective for seedling weed control postemergence. No other postemergence herbicide may be needed if no established weeds are present and seedling annual weeds are sprayed with Sinbar before they exceed 1 inch in height. See Table 7.18 for recommended herbicides and timings at which they can be used.
in the soil. Nutlets are small, about the size of a pea, and are tan to reddish brown in color. They sprout in the spring and establish a plant about 8 to 12 inches tall with narrow leaves and parallel veins. At a glance the plant may appear to be a grass, but close inspection of the plant reveals that the leaves are not divided into two parts, a blade and a sheath. Further inspection reveals that just below the soil, the triangular stem could be detected by rolling the shoot between two fingers. Nutlets can resprout six to eight times if cultivation kills the shoot. After the plant becomes established, rhizomes, which are horizontal underground stems, begin to grow in late spring or early summer. By early to midsummer, the rhizomes curve upward and produce additional plants. The vegetative spread of the weed continues until late summer. By August in most locations, the weed can sense the approach of fall by the longer nights, and a burst of rhizome growth follows. These rhizomes do not curve up and produce more daughter plants. They grow out and down. By early fall, a pronounced swelling can be observed at the tip of each rhizome, which matures into a new dormant nutlet. Later in the fall, the still longer night signals that it is time for the mother plant to enter dormancy, effectively separating the nutlets from the mother plant and each other. Yellow nutsedge can be managed and eventually eliminated from a field by preventing new nutlet production. This can be done by persistent management of nutsedge from late summer through early fall (see below). The results of the effort will not be evident after one year. Too many old nutlets remain dormant in the soil for several years before they sprout, but after several years, success will be evident.
yellow nutsedge
Yellow nutsedge, a perennial, may be the most serious weed in agriculture worldwide. Yellow nutsedge is sometimes referred to a nutgrass, even though it is not a grass. Although yellow nutsedge can reproduce from seed, where it is established, annual reinfestation is primarily due to dormant nutlets
Cultural Management
Avoid spreading nutsdege into clean fields from infested soils with equipment or in mulches such as straw and manure. Nutsedge is intolerant of shade. Using close row spacing can result in shading and minimize yellow nutsedge growth. Mulches, including plastic, straw, and cover crop residues can also provide shade as well as provide a physical barrier that reduces plant emergence.
151
Chapter 7: Blueberries
Nutsedge is also a poor competitor with vigorous crops. Use management practices that promote crop health. Also, include vigorous cover crops in your rotation, and include corn and soybeans in the rotation to shade nutsedge and allow the use of herbicides that are effective against nutsedge. Repeated mowing prevents seed production and helps with depleting root reserves. While seeds are not the not the primary method for spreading yellow nutsedge, they are important for spreading the plant greater distances. Preventing seed production by mowing prior to flowering and seed set will prevent the formation of seeds. Mowing can exhaust the energy reserves of nutlets; however, it can take seven or more mowings until reserves are depleted. Tilling in fall can directly destroy small nutlets and expose larger nutlets to killing cold temperatures. In the fall, chisel plowing or using tillage tools that bring vegetative structures to the soil surface are better than tools that invert soil (moldboard plow) and bury the nutsedge. Tillage in the spring, however, can help spread yellow nutsedge. This is particularly a problem when using more shallow types of tillage. Yellow nutsedge tends to be a larger problem on low or wet areas in a field. Using raised beds in areas with poor drainage can help to manage yellow nutsedge.
synthates to their roots. A follow-up application in spring may be needed. Applications made in late spring and early summer when bindweed is actively growing will have little effect. Broadcast: 2.25 lb ae (acid equivalent)/A. Spot Treatment: See your products label for rate. Wet the weed foliage as thoroughly as possible. Use the highest labeled percent solution rate when only partial wetting of the weed foliage is possible. Wet a minimum of 50 percent of the weed foliage for effectiveness. Ropewick Applicator: Wipe twice; travel in opposite directions for each wipe.
Canada thistle
This perennial weed has deep vertical roots for food storage and horizontal roots that spread the weed vegetatively. Shoots emerge from this extensive root system in the spring. Flowers appear in late June, and seed is dispersed in July. The shoots die after the seed is dispersed. New shoots appear in late summer and grow vegetatively until frost. These fall shoots make food for the roots and do not flower.
Cultural Management
Bindweed is sensitive to shading. However, because roots store significant reserves, shading is ineffective after bindweed is well established. Cultivation is effective only if repeated frequently. Regrown shoots begin to replenish root reserves in as little as 2 weeks after shoot emergence.
Cultural Management
Mowing in spring at bud to bloom time will assist with depleting root reserves, as plant reserves are already at a low point, and mowing (either physically, or chemically with a burndown material) will force the plant to use additional root reserves for regrowth. Repeated frequent tillage will be effective prior to planting and between rows; however, if tillage is infrequent, this plant may become the dominant weeds as other more easily controlled weeds become less numerous. Only extremely shallow tillage can be used near blueberry plants in order to avoid damaging their root systems.
Chemical Management
Glyphosate products. Apply initial application at higher labeled rate when plants are more than 6 inches tall but before going to seed. Repeated subsequent applications at lower rates will be needed for control. Use lower gallonages of water to allow a greater amount of glyphosate to remain on the foliage, as nutsedge foliage will not retain much spray solution. Broadcast: 2.25 lb ae (acid equivalent)/A. Spot Treatment: See your products label for rate. Wet the weed foliage as thoroughly as possible. Use the highest labeled percent solution rate when only partial wetting of the weed foliage is possible. Wet a minimum of 50 percent of the weed foliage for effectiveness. Ropewick Applicator: Wipe twice; travel in opposite directions for each wipe.
Chemical Management
Casoron/Norosac (dichlobenil, 46 lb ai/A). Use 100 to 150 pounds of Casoron/ Norosac 4G or 2.8 gallons of Casoron CS per acre. Apply between November 15 and March 15 to control labeled annual, biennial, and perennial weeds. Late-fall treatments, after November 15 but before the soil freezes, have had a more consistent effect on susceptible perennial weeds than late winter applications. Treat before weed growth begins and when daily high temperatures do not exceed 50F. Casoron/Norosac is volatile in warm temperatures and must be irrigated or incorporated after application if applied in warm weather to prevent significant loss of the herbicide. This product is for established (bearing) fields. Glyphosate products. Apply in fall when plants are translocating photo-
Chemical Management
Casoron/Norosac (dichlobenil, 46 lb ai/A). Use 100 to 150 pounds of Casoron/Norosac 4G or 2.8 gallons of Casoron CS per acre. See paragraph on use of this product under Bindweed Species. Glyphosate products. Apply in late June when Canada thistle has flower buds or flowers, or in the fall after the shoots are 6 to 8 inches tall but before
152
frost. Roundup translocates into the vertical roots of the plant well but in less quantity into the horizontal roots. Follow-up spot treatments may be needed to control regrowth from pieces of horizontal roots that were not killed by the initial application. Broadcast: 2.25 lb ae (acid equivalent)/A. Spot Treatment: See your products label for rate. Wet the weed foliage as thoroughly as possible. Use the highest labeled percent solution rate when only partial wetting of the weed foliage is possible. Wet a minimum of 50 percent of the weed foliage for maximum effectiveness. Ropewick Applicator: Wipe twice; travel in opposite directions for each wipe.
Table 7.18.) Broadcast: 2.25 lb ae (acid equivalent)/A. Spot Treatment: See your products label for rate. Wet weed foliage as thoroughly as possible. Use the highest labeled percent solution rate when only partial wetting of the weed foliage is possible. Wet a minimum of 50 percent of the weed foliage for effective control. Ropewick Applicator: Wipe twice; travel in opposite directions for each wipe.
for maximum effectiveness. Ropewick Applicator: Wipe twice; travel in opposite direction for each wipe.
horseweed
Horseweed is a biennial plant with seed that usually germinates in late summer or early fall. Though biennial, it usually behaves like a winter annual in that the seedling grows as a rosette during the fall and early spring. The plant bolts during the summer, flowers, sets seed, and dies during its second late summer and fall season. It may also behave like a typical spring-germinating biennial or summer annual as well. The weed produces a large number of wind-distributed seed in late summer and early fall. Some people refer to horseweed as marestail which is a misnomer. Herbicide labels that state marestail control may be referring to another weed. Note: Glyphosate-resistant horseweed, also called marestail or stickweed locally, has been identified in the MidAtlantic Region, including New Jersey. Due to the windborne distribution of the seed, it is likely that glyphosate-resistant biotypes will spread to your farm despite good integrated weed management by individual growers. Therefore, all horseweed populations should be considered potentially glyphosate resistant. Glyphosate, formulated as Roundup Ultra Max, Touchdown, Glyphomax Plus, and other generic formulations, were recommended for horseweed control prior to 2003 but have been removed from the recommendations for horseweed control due to the resistance development.
goldenrod species
These closely related weeds are perennials that begin growth in April from rosettes or rootstocks. Typically, yellow blooms appear in late summer and the stems die in the fall. Some regrowth, as short stems or rosettes, often occurs before winter. Strong root systems overwinter and resume growth in the spring. The weeds spread using underground horizontal roots. Once established, management of this weed is difficult since it is tolerant to most herbicides and the roots can be spread by cultivation or other tillage practices.
dandelion
This perennial plant grows actively during the spring and fall and forms a robust tap root that may resprout several new tops when the plant top is broken off.
Cultural Management
Hoeing or hand removal is typically ineffective since removing the entire tap root is difficult, and since cultivation in blueberry fields must be done shallowly, a significant portion of the root system is not likely to be destroyed. Mowing before flower heads bloom can aid in reducing the number of seeds produced.
Cultural Management
Best options are shallow tillage or removal when first plants to invade field are small, and mowing of any nearby goldenrod infested areas to avoid spread of the weed into cultivated fields.
Chemical Management
Norosac/Casoron (dichlobenil, 46 lb ai/A). Use 100 to 150 pounds of Norosac/Casoron 4G or 2.8 gallons of Casoron CS per acre. Apply between November 15 and March 15 to control labeled annual, biennial, and perennial weeds. Late-fall treatmentsafter November 15 but before the soil freezes have controlled susceptible perennial weeds more consistently than late-winter applications. Treat before weed growth begins and when daily high temperatures do not exceed 50F. Norosac/Casoron is volatile in warm temperatures and must be irrigated or incorporated after application if applied in warm weather to prevent significant loss of the herbicide. Glyphosate products. Apply when the weed is growing actively and has flower buds. Spring or fall applications are more effective than applications made in midsummer. (See warnings in
Chemical Management
Casoron/Norosac (dichlobenil, 46 lb ai/A). Use 100 to 150 pounds of Casoron/Norosac 4G or 2.8 gallons of Casoron CS per acre. See paragraph on use of this product under Bindweed species. Glyphosate products. Apply in late spring after spring growth is 8 to 10 inches tall, but before the shoots become too tall for good coverage with the spray solution. Generally, banded or broadcast sprays must be applied earlier in the spring, while spot treatments and ropewick applications can be applied later in the spring. Broadcast: 1.5 to 3 pounds ae (acid equivalent)/A. Spot Treatment: See your products label for rate. Wet weed foliage as thoroughly as possible. Use the highest labeled percent solution rate when only partial wetting of the weed foliage is possible. Wet a minimum of 50 percent of the weed foliage
Cultural Management
Best options are shallow tillage or removal when first plants to invade field are small, and mowing of any nearby horseweed infested areas to avoid spread of the weed into cultivated fields.
Chemical Management
Casoron/Norosac (dichlobenil, 46 lb ai/A). Use 100 to 150 pounds of Casoron/Norosac 4G or 2.8 gallons of Casoron CS per acre. See paragraph on use of this product under Bindweed Species. Karmex (diuron, 1.03.2 lb ai/A), New Jersey and Maryland only. Use 1.25 to
153
Chapter 7: Blueberries
2.5 pounds/A Karmex 80DF, depending on soil texture and organic matter. Apply in late fall to weed-free soil, or tank-mix with a paraquat product to kill existing vegetation. This product is for established (bearing) fields. Princep (simazine, 14 lb ai/A). Use 1.1 to 4.4 pounds/A Princep 90DF (or other labeled formulations), depending of soil texture and organic matter. Apply in late fall to weed-free soil, or add a paraquat product to kill existing vegetation. This product is for established (bearing) fields. Paraquat (Gramoxone Inteon, Firestorm, or other labeled formulations, 0.61.0 lb ai/A). Use 2.4 to 4.0 pints/A Gramoxone Inteon or 1.7 to 2.7 pints/A Firestorm 3SC (or other labeled formulations). Contact killer only; has no translocation or residual activity. Best results occur when horseweed seedlings are treated in late fall or are less than 1 inch in diameter. Two applications two weeks apart are more effective than a single application. Regrowth may occur from the root systems of established weeds. Use a surfactant to be 0.25 percent of the spray solution (1 quart per 100 gallons of spray solution). Combine with recommended preemergence herbicide(s) for residual effectiveness. Do not allow spray or drift to contact green bark, leaves, or fruit. Crop damage may result. The use of shields, such as grow tubes or paper milk cartons, greatly reduces the risk of injury in young plantings. This product is for newly planted (nonbearing) fields and for established (bearing) fields. DANGER: Do not breathe spray mist. Read safety precautions on the label.
Chemical Management
Glyphosate products. Apply in mid- to late summer after the weed flowers in late June or early July, or in early fall before fall colors appear. Results of the fall application may not become evident until the following spring. Best results have been obtained in late summer after the fruit has formed. Broadcast: 3 to 3.75 pounds ae (acid equivalent)/A. Spot Treatment: See your products label for rate. Wet weed foliage as thoroughly as possible. Use the highest labeled percent solution rate when only partial wetting of the weed foliage is possible. Wet a minimum of 50 percent of the weed foliage for maximum effectiveness. Ropewick Applicator: Not recommended. Cut Stump Treatment: See your products label for rate. Apply to the cambium (inner bark area) of the stump of woody plants immediately after cutting. Cut and treat stumps only when the target is actively growing and not under stress. Best results are often obtained in late summer and early fall before fall color is observed in the foliage. Warning: Injury due to root grafting may occur in adjacent plants. Do not treat cut stumps if there is a possibility of root grafting to desirable vegetation.
rhizomes into small pieces that are more susceptible to herbicides and additional cultivation. Repeated cultivation forces plants to use rhizome reserves. Cultivation during hot dry spells causes rhizomes to dry out. Failure to follow initial cultivations with control measures will only result in propagation of rhizomes.
Chemical Management
Glyphosate products. Apply in late spring (May or June) or in the fall (October or November) when the weed has vigorous healthy foliage, a minimum of 4 to 6 leaves, and has begun to tiller. Do not till the field or otherwise disrupt the root and rhizome system of the weeds in the soil for a minimum of 8 months before treatment. Broadcast: 1.5 lb ae (acid equivalent)/A. Spot Treatment: See your products label for rate. Wet weed foliage as thoroughly as possible. Use the highest labeled percent solution rate when only partial wetting of the weed foliage is possible. Wet weed foliage as thoroughly as possible. Ropewick Applicator: Wipe in late May or June after the weed is at least one foot tall. Not recommended in the fall due to the more prostrate growth habit of the weed. Kerb (pronamide), 12 lb ai/A. Use 2 to 4 pounds/A Kerb 50WP. Apply in November when soil temperatures are between 35 and 55F (1.7 and 12.8C). Primarily effective against perennial grasses, including quackgrass, bluegrass, ryegrass sp., and fescue sp., and also provides early management of annual grasses the following spring. Apply Surflan, Prowl (nonbearing only), Solicam, or Sinbar the following May or June for full season annual grass control. Tank-mix Kerb with Gramoxone Inteon or a glyphosate product and with Princep for postemergence and residual broadleaf weed control. This product is for established (bearing) fields. Fusilade (nonbearing fields only), Poast, and Select. Provide partial control. Repeat applications needed for additional control.
quackgrass
This perennial plant grows actively in the late spring and early fall when daily high temperatures range between 65 and 80F (18.3 and 26.7C). High midsummer temperatures, above 85F (29.4C), and/or low soil moisture cause the weed to become dormant or semidormant until moisture and cooler weather return. The weed reproduces by seed and vegetatively by rhizomes, horizontal underground stems that eventually curve upward and make new shoots. The seedhead, which appears in June, resembles ryegrass, except each floret is rotated one quarter turn compared to ryegrass. The rhizomes are about 1/8 inch in diameter and may grow horizontally for up to several feet in length before curving upward and making a new shoot. Ryegrass does not have rhizomes.
poison ivy
This woody perennial vine or shrub is capable of climbing a trellis. Contact with any part of the plant may result in an itching, blistering skin rash. Nonselective postemergence herbicides must be used to control this weed. Take measures to eradicate before the vine grows up into the plants or trellis.
Cultural Management
No cultural controls recommended.
Cultural Management
Prior to planting, plowing followed by disking or repeated disking chops
154
virginia Creeper
Virginia Creeper is a woody perennial vine capable of climbing a trellis and smothering a plant.
Cultural Management
No effective cultural controls have been identified.
Chemical Management
Nonselective postemergence herbicides must be used to suppress or control this weed. Remove the vine from the trellis during winter pruning and put it on the ground or plan a cut stump treatment during the growing season. Do not prune out the vine during the dormant season. Good growth and maximum leaf area are needed at the time of herbicide application during the summer. Glyphosate products. Apply in mid- to late summer after the vine flowers in early July but before fall color appears in the foliage. Applications in spring or early summer, before flowering, have been less effective. Repeat applications may be needed. One application may merely suppress Virginia Creeper. Broadcast: 3 to 3.75 pounds ae (acid equivalent)/A. Spot Treatment: See your products label for rate. Wet weed foliage as thoroughly as possible. Use the highest labeled percent solution rate when only partial wetting of the weed foliage is possible. Wet a minimum of 50 percent of the weed foliage for maximum effectiveness. Ropewick Applicator: Not recommended; the creeping nature of plant is difficult to wipe. Cut Stump Treatment: See your products label for rate. Apply to the cambium (inner bark area) of the stump of woody plants immediately after cutting. Cut and treat stumps only when the target is actively growing and not under stress. Best results are often obtained in late summer and early fall before fall color is observed in the foliage. Warning: Injury due to root grafting may occur in adjacent plants. Do not treat cut stumps if there is a possibility of root grafting to desirable vegetation.
Cultural Management
Once established, management of this weed is difficult since it is tolerant to most herbicides and the roots can be spread by cultivation or other tillage practices.
Chemical Management
Casoron/Norosac (dichlobenil, 46 lb ai/A). Use 100 to 150 pounds of Casoron/Norosac 4G or 2.8 gallons of Casoron CS per acre. See paragraph on use of this product under Bindweed Species. Glyphosate products. Apply in May or June after spring growth is 8 to 10 inches tall, but before the shoots become too tall for good coverage with the spray solution. Generally, broadcast sprays must be applied in May, while spot treatments and ropewick applications can be delayed until June. Broadcast: 1.53 lb ae (acid equivalent)/A. Spot Treatment: See your products label for rate. Wet weed foliage as thoroughly as possible. Use the highest labeled percent solution rate when only partial wetting of the weed foliage is possible. Wet a minimum of 50 percent of the weed foliage for maximum effectiveness. Ropewick Applicator: Wipe twice; travel in opposite direction for each wipe.
155
Chapter 7: Blueberries
Mesotrione, 1.53.0 oz
Flumioxazin, 3.06.0 oz
Isoxaben, 0.751.0 lb
Oryzalin, 2.04.0 lb
continued
156
Primarily for annual grass control; may provide partial control of many broadleaf weeds
Norflurazon, 2.04.0 lb
PostemergenceSelective Emerged annual grasses and perennial grasses, depending on rate (see information in column to right)
Fluazifop-P-butyl, 0.180.38 lb
Sethoxydim, 0.20.5 lb
Poast 1.5EC, 1.02.5 pt, plus 2.0 pints crop oil concentrate per acre (30)
Most grass weed species, including certain hard-tocontrol grass weeds, such as small grain volunteers and cover crops, and perennials, such as hard fescue, tall fescue, Bermudagrass, orchardgrass, quackgrass, Johnsongrass, and wirestem muhly
Clethodim, 0.10.125 lb
continued
157
Chapter 7: Blueberries
PostemergenceNonselective Annual weeds Contact killer only; no translocation or residual activity. Best results occur when weeds are 2 inches tall or less. Regrowth may occur from the root systems of established weeds. Use a surfactant to be 0.25% of the spray solution (1 qt. per 100 gallons of spray solution). Combine with recommended preemergence herbicide(s) for residual weed control. Do not allow spray or drift to contact green bark, leaves, or fruit. Crop damage may result. The use of shields, such as grow tubes or paper milk cartons greatly reduces the risk of injury in young plantings. DANGER: Do not breathe spray mist. Read safety precautions on the label. Annual and perennial weeds Glyphosate is a translocated, slow-acting herbicide with no soil or residual activity. Results will become evident 1 to 3 weeks after application. Apply lower rates to control seedlings and annual weeds and to suppress established perennial weeds. Use shields and do not allow glyphosate to contact the foliage or green shoots. Optimum rate and time of application depend on weed species and growth stage. Weeds should be growing vigorously when treated. Do not treat weeds that are under stress from drought, extreme heat, cold, or other adverse growing conditions. When using a ropewick applicator, fill the pipe only half full to avoid excessive dripping. Repeated wiping may be needed to provide control equal to broadcast or spot applications. A ropewick applicator offers significant herbicide cost savings. Warnings: (1) Do not allow glyphosate to contact the leaves, young green bark, fresh trunk wounds, or root suckers, or severe crop injury may occur. (2) Do not allow glyphosate to contact any immature part of blueberry plants. (3) Do not use galvanized containersglyphosate may react with the container to produce explosive hydrogen gas.
Glyphosate Broadcast: 0.563.0 lb ae (acid equivalent). Spot treatment: See label; wet foliage thoroughly. Ropewick applicator: See label for product/ water ratio. One gallon of product will treat 10100 acres depending on weed density.
BeAring Fields Preemergence Primarily for annual grasses; suppresses or controls certain annual broadleaf weeds
Apply in late fall and/or early spring to weed-free soil, or add an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Use the high rate for long-term control (4 to 8 months) and the low rate for short-term control (2 to 4 months). Tank-mix with Princep plus a postemergence herbicide in late fall or reduced rates of Princep, Karmex (New Jersey and Maryland only), or Sinbar in the spring, if planting has been established for at least one year, to control annual broadleaf weeds. Activate with one-half inch sprinkler irrigation within 24 hours after application. If left on the soil surface, napropamide (Devrinol) is broken down by sunlight. Irrigation moves the herbicide into the soil and prevents breakdown by the sun.
Napropamide, 2.04.0 lb
continued
158
Diclobenil, 4.06.0 lb
Simazine, 1.04.0 lb Apply in late fall or spring to weed-free soil, or add an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Tank-mix at 1.02.0 lb ai (1.12.2 lb of Princep 90DF), depending on soil texture and organic matter, with Surflan, Solicam, or Devrinol. This rate is one-half the labeled Princep rate for use alone for each soil type. Tank-mixing will improve crop safety and the range of weeds controlled. In recent years, Princep has not perfomed as reliably as in the past in some locations. For fall applications, using Casoron in the fall plus a residual annual grass herbicide applied in the spring may be a suitable alternative. For spring applications, adding Callisto or Chateau to your spring tank-mix will improve control of summer annual broadleaf weeds. Add nonionic surfactant to be 0.25% of the spray volume, or 1 qt per Mesotrione, 1.53.0 oz acre crop oil concentrate. Apply in the late fall after leaf drop and/or in early spring before bud break as a spray directed toward the base of the bush. If applying in the fall, use a 3 fl oz rate and repeat with 3 fl oz prebloom for longer control. If applying in the spring, up to 6 fl oz can be used. Broadleaf weeds controlled include horseweed and common lambsquarter. Tank-mix with an appropriate postemergence herbicide for broad-spectrum control of emerged weeds. Tank-mix with a residual grass herbicide to improved annual grass control. Do not apply more than 6 fl oz of Callisto per acre within one year.
continued
159
Chapter 7: Blueberries
Add crop oil concentrate to be 1% of spray volume. Apply in late fall Flumioxazin, 3.06.0 oz after leaf drop or in early spring before bud break. Tank-mix with an appropriate postemergence herbicide for broad-spectrum control of emerged weeds. Tank-mix with a residual grass herbicide to improve annual grass control. Do not allow spray to contact foliage or new green bark. Do not use more than 6 oz/a of product where soil contains more than 80% sand until plants have been in the field for more than 3 years. Follow instructions on label for tank clean-out if any part of the sprayer will be used to spray other crops; otherwise, crop injury may occur. See label for other cautions and restrictions, as even contact with treated residue can cause phytotoxicity. Apply in the spring to weed-free soil, or add an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Tank-mix using terbacil at 0.5 to 1 lb ai/A (Sinbar 80WP at 0.631.25 lb/a), depending on soil texture and organic matter, with Surflan, Devrinol, or a reduced rate of Karmex (New Jersey and Maryland only). This rate is reduced from the labeled Sinbar rate for use alone for the soil type. Tank-mixing will improve crop safety and the range of weeds controlled. In recent years, Sinbar has not perfomed as reliably as in the past in some locations. Add Callisto or Chateau to your spring tank-mix to improve control of summer annual broadleaf weeds in these situations. Apply in late fall or spring to weed-free soil, or add an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Tank-mix with Princep plus a postemergence herbicide in late fall, or with Karmex (New Jersey and Maryland only), or Sinbar in the spring if the planting has been established for at least one year to improve the control of broadleaf weeds. Apply in late fall and/or early spring to weed-free soil, or add an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Use the high rate for long-term control (4 to 8 months) and the low rate for short-term control (2 to 4 months). Tank-mix with Princep plus a postemergence herbicide in late fall or with Karmex (New Jersey and Maryland only), or Sinbar in the spring if the planting has been established for at least one year to control annual broadleaf weeds. Velpar is not recommended in New Jersey because of a narrow margin of safety when applied to soil with a sandy mineral component, and caution is recommended for all states. Blueberry plants must have been established for at least 3 years. Apply to pruned blueberries in the early spring before leaf emergence. Velpar is also labeled for use in lowbush blueberries, but with a 450 day PHI. Warning: The effect of Velpar on blueberries varies with soils, plant vigor, uniformity of application, and rainfall. Most blueberries are resistant to Velpar, but some varieties are susceptible to injury. In some cases, productivity may be affected even when visible symptoms of phytotoxicity are not apparent. Use lower rates on poorly drained soils, but do not apply to standing water. Do not use on sands, loamy sand, or sandy loam soils. Do not apply to snow or frozen ground. Terbacil, 1.02.4 lb
Controls many annual broadleaf weed species but may be weak on pigweed species
Primarily for annual grass control; may provide partial control of many broadleaf weeds
Norflurazon, 2.04.0 lb
Oryzalin, 2.04.0 lb
For briars, wild cherry, goldenrod, aster species, meadowsweet, red (sheep) sorrel, sheep-laurel, and other perennial broadleaf weeds
Hexazinone, 0.51.0 lb
continued
160
PostemergenceNonselective Paraquat, 0.51.0 lb Annual weeds Contact killer only; with no translocation or residual activity. Best results occur when weeds are 2 inches tall or less. Regrowth may occur from the root systems of established weeds. Use a surfactant to be 0.25% of the spray solution (1 qt per 100 gallons of spray solution). Combine with recommended preemergence herbicide(s) for residual weed control. Do not allow spray or drift to contact green bark, leaves, or fruit. Crop damage may result. The use of shields, such as grow tubes or paper milk cartons greatly reduces the risk of injury in young plantings. DANGER: Do not breathe spray mist. Read safety precautions on the label. Annual and perennial weeds Glyphosate is a translocated, slow-acting herbicide with no soil or residual activity. Results will become evident 1 to 3 weeks after application. Apply lower rates to control seedlings and annual weeds and to suppress established perennial weeds. Use shields and do not allow glyphosate to contact the foliage or green shoots. Optimum rate and time of application depend on weed species and growth stage. Weeds should be growing vigorously when treated. Do not treat weeds that are under stress from drought, extreme heat, cold, or other adverse growing conditions. When using a ropewick applicator, fill the pipe only half full to avoid excessive dripping. Repeated wiping may be needed to provide control equal to broadcast or spot applications. A ropewick applicator offers significant herbicide cost savings. Warnings: (1) Do not allow glyphosate to contact the leaves, young green bark, fresh trunk wounds, or root suckers, or severe crop injury may occur. (2) Do not allow glyphosate to contact any immature part of blueberry plants. (3) Do not use galvanized containersglyphosate may react with the container to produce explosive hydrogen gas. Broadcast: 0.563.0 lb ae. Spot treatment: See label; wet foliage thoroughly. Ropewick applicator: See label for product/ water ratio. One gallon of product will treat 10100 acres depending on weed density.
a. Adding a surfactant to these herbicides may improve their effectiveness (see labels). b. No days-to-harvest limitation is specified on the label if days-to-harvest is listed as (). Additional notes All the rates in this table are given on a full-acre basis. If the material is to be banded along or over the row, use the following formula to calculate the banding rate: rate/A banded = rate/A broadcast x (band width in inches row spacing in inches). With all chemicals, follow label instructions and warnings carefully. Use pesticides safely. Consult label for restriction. It is unlawful to use recommended chemicals for crops not covered on the label or to use chemicals not cleared for such use on blueberry plantings. Formulations other than those listed, with the same active ingredient, may be labeled for the same uses.
161
IntroductIon
Brambles offer excellent potential for profit, having both a high value and an ample market, especially where metropolitan markets can be accessed. Many factors still may limit production, however, including a high initial investment, high labor requirements, winter weather, pest susceptibility, and a poor shelf life. A bramble is defined as any plant belonging to the genus Rubus, of which there are many forms. However, raspberries and blackberries are the most commonly grown brambles. Cultivated raspberries and blackberries are related to the wild plants found in fencerows and bordering wooded areas. Wild red raspberries, R. strigosus, are found above 2,500 feet in the Appalachian Mountains and in northern and western Pennsylvania. Wild black raspberries, R. occidentalis, are found throughout the Mid-Atlantic region. The introduced wineberry, R. phoenicolasius, is also widespread. The common blackberries, R. alleghaniensis (having sticky glands on the stem) and R. argutus are also found growing throughout the region, with other species being common.
Red Raspberries
Red raspberries may be either of two types. Floricane-bearing red raspberries bear their fruit from late May in Virginia through July in Pennsylvania. They have the typical biennial life cycle of a bramble, so overwintered canes die after fruiting. Primocane-bearing types fruit in their first year from late July through October (or the first hard frost), depending on location and cultivar. Because both of these red raspberries produce new canes (suckers) from the root system, they can be grown in a hedgerow or, less commonly, in individual hills or as single plants when restricted by mechanical removal of unwanted suckers or plastic mulches. Red raspberries are the most winter hardy of the raspberries (surviving to -30F). Note that all winter-hardiness temperatures are estimates of the temperature some cultivars can tolerate without substantial injury when fully dormant. Once a plant begins to lose its dormancy after 1,200 hours of temperatures between 35 and 50F (usually in January in Pennsylvania and February in Virginia), it can be injured at much higher temperatures.
Brambles
contents
Introduction ......................................................161 The Bramble Plant .............................................161 Types of Plants...................................................161 Red Raspberries ...........................................161 Gold or Yellow Raspberries............................161 Black Raspberries .........................................161 Purple Raspberries .......................................162 Blackberries .................................................162 Other Types of Brambles ...............................162 Cold-Hardiness ..................................................162 Pollination ........................................................162 Culture ..............................................................163 General Considerations in Choosing a Site .....163 Soil Fertility ..................................................163 Plant Sources and Care..................................163 Cultivar Selection .........................................163 Planting and Establishment..........................168 Fertilization..................................................168 Mulching ......................................................169 Irrigation ......................................................170 Row Middle Management .............................170 Pruning ........................................................170 Trellis Systems ..............................................171 Protected Culture .........................................173 Harvest and Postharvest Handling ..................... 174 Economics .........................................................175 Pests .................................................................183 Fungal and Bacterial Diseases .......................183 Viruses .........................................................187 Nematodes ...................................................189 Insects and Mites ..........................................190 Weeds ...............................................................204 Weed Control Between Rows ........................204 Mulching and Cultural Methods ....................204 Herbicides ....................................................204 Problem Weeds ............................................207
Gold or yellow raspberries are usually types of red raspberries with a nonfunctioning pigment gene; therefore, they have the same basic management requirements as red raspberries. Although some yellow raspberries are highly flavored, in general, public acceptance is low, perhaps due to the ease of detecting botrytis or other fruit maladies on a light-colored background. All yellow raspberries that have acceptable quality at this time are primocane bearers. Yellow raspberries may have their highest value when mixed in a container of mainly red raspberries because the combination of colors is eye-catching.
Black Raspberries
Black raspberries initiate new canes solely from the crown of the plant. They are grown in a hill systemeach plant is grown independently with pruning and maintenance done on a per-plant basis. They benefit from summer tipping,
Types of planTs
The various types of brambles differ from each other not only in fruit color, but also in growth habit (and hence the cultural practices used for each type), pest problems, and other characteristics.
162
unlike red raspberries, because they branch readily. If tipping is not done, individual canes grow to unmanageable lengths, they arch over, and their tips root where they touch the ground. To tip, cut 4 inches of growth off of the top of the cane, preferably during a 3- to 4-day period of dry weather. Black raspberries are also the most winter-tender raspberry (hardy only to -5F).
purple Raspberries
Purple raspberries (hybrids between blacks and reds) initiate new canes predominantly from the crown but may sucker between plants as well. They are grown essentially as black raspberries are grown and are intermediate in coldhardiness (down to -10F). Plants may be managed similarly to red raspberries or tipped, depending on the cultivar.
States have also been developed. These include the western trailing blackberries from Rubus ursinus, of which Marion (a cultivar sometimes marketed as Marionberry) is the most well known. Similar forms of trailing, not very winter-hardy brambles include tayberry, tummelberry, loganberries, and boysenberries, all of which are hybrids between red raspberries and western blackberries. Tayberries are red, elongated bramble fruits that retain their receptacle when harvested. The fruit makes a beautiful ruby red jam but is extremely soft when fully ripe and only recommended for pick-your-own operations or for processing. Tayberries should be grown according to recommendations for trailing blackberries. Wyeberries are similar to tayberries but were developed from eastern U.S. blackberries and are thus more erect and slightly cold-hardier.
Blackberries
Eastern blackberries can be either thorny or thornless. Thorny plants tend to be very erect, whereas thornless plants range from semierect to trailing. Thornless types are generally more cold susceptible (damaged at about 0F) than thorny types and cannot be grown consistently in the northern portions of Pennsylvania and New Jersey. Thornless types require trellising. However, with the release of additional new cultivars, these differences are somewhat blurred. Some low-sugar/highacid exotic species have been used for breeding thornless blackberries, resulting in some varieties that have a tart fruit. However, breeders have concentrated on improving fruit quality in the last decade. Thorny types have excellent fruit quality but are not often grown commercially because the thorns are brutal and present an obstacle in harvesting. Generally, thorny types tolerate temperatures to about -10F. Primocane-bearing blackberries have recently been introduced. They are similar to primocane-bearing red raspberries in habit. Trials are currently underway to determine their suitability within the region.
cold-hardIness
Whenever temperatures warm after the cold temperature requirement has been met, the plant begins to lose its dormancy and, thus, its tolerance to cold temperatures. Winter injury is frequently the result of fluctuating winter temperatures rather than absolute low temperatures. This fluctuation occurs more toward the late winter to early spring when solar radiation on clear days can raise the internal temperatures of the canes several degrees higher than ambient air temperatures. When the sunset and air temperatures become even colder, the overheated canes can be severely stressed by the rapid change in temperature as well as by a very low temperature. In locations where this type of injury is a problem, summer-fruiting cultivars should be planted on northfacing slopes, if possible, to minimize exposure to the heating effect of direct winter sunlight. South and southwestfacing slopes are less-optimal locations.
PollInatIon
Many species of cultivated and wild blackberries exist in North America alone. Most commercial varieties are self-pollinating. The blackberry flower has 5 to 8 petals and 50 to 100 stamens
clustered around 50 to 100 pistils; it secretes nectar at the base of the flower. Each pistil, when pollinated and subsequently fertilized, develops into a succulent drupelet; thus, blackberry is an aggregate fruit. Raspberries are also an aggregate fruit. Flowers have 50 to 100 stamens and up to 200 pistils, each of which has an ovary and a slender style. When the flower opens, stamens bend away from the styles and release pollen so only the innermost anthers have a chance to touch the outermost stigmas for selfpollination. Most varieties are selffruitful, although cross-pollination with pollen from other varieties can improve development of maternal tissues with an accompanying increase in fruit weight and shape. Nectar and pollen of blackberry and raspberry are attractive to a host of pollinators. In areas where wild plants are plentiful, honey bee colonies store surplus honey for harvest by beekeepers. Research has documented the importance of bee pollination to blackberry and raspberry crop yield and quality. Optimum pollination requires multiple bee visits over the first two-day period when individual flowers are viable. Incomplete pollination means poor distribution of pollen to receptive stigmas, resulting in small, crumbly, misshapen berries and reduced yield. In the past, abundant, widespread, feral honey bee and native wild bee populations most likely provided adequate pollination of wild and domestic brambles, so pollination was not an issue of concern for bramble growers. However, due to the introduction of parasitic mites and increased diseases, feral honey bee populations have been decimated. In addition, while there is continuing debate among experts, pesticide use and destruction/fragmentation of nesting habitat have caused concern and are blamed for reduced native bee populations in some areas. Growers now need to carefully assess and make decisions concerning pollinators that could have significant economic impact on their operations. One to two colonies per acre of bearing plants is recommended to yield one bee per 100 flowers during favorable flight activity periods.
163
Chapter 8: Brambles
To date, nearly all of the research on insect pollination of blackberry and raspberries has been done with honey bees, and recommendations for ensuring adequate pollination have involved only this pollinator. The contribution of native pollinators, especially bumble bees, is seldom considered. In cases where they are considered, recommendations are lacking on how growers might incorporate information about native bee populations into decisions made on assessing pollinators and/or providing adequate numbers or kinds of pollinators to maximize yield and quality.
tive; however, applications should be made when weather is still warm enough (highs in the 60s or 70s) for plants to translocate the herbicide. Also, be aware that cultivated brambles should not even be slightly exposed to glyphosate in the fall. Repeat this survey of border areas at least once each spring. Wild brambles are commonly found along the margins of wooded areas and fencerows. Before planting brambles, control weeds, especially perennial bindweed, thistle, curly dock, johnsongrass, wiregrass, quackgrass, and nutsedge, by using a competitive preplant cover crop, by applying Banvel or Roundup herbicide to the site, or by fumigating with higher rates of approved fumigants. Treatments must be made by mid-fall at the latest to be effective. Raspberries frequently benefit from fumigation, which eliminates soilborne insects, nematodes (which transmit viruses), and most soilborne pathogens, but keep in mind that fumigation also eliminates beneficial organisms. For further information on fumigation, see Chapter 3.
risk that they may have been exposed to sources of diseases, insects, and mites. Dormant canes are not recommended since experience has shown that they are more often disease infected. Crown gall is a particular hazard because once it infects the soil it cannot be eradicated, even with fumigation. If dormant canes are purchased, they should be planted in March or April. If canes cannot be planted immediately, hold them at 32F or heel them in in a sheltered area. Thoroughly soak dormant plant roots in water before planting. When selecting planting stock for organic production, keep in mind that since brambles are perennial crops, planting stock does not need to be organically produced. However, the planting must be managed organically on a certified organic area for one year before harvested berries can be marketed as organic.
CulTivaR seleCTion
Selecting appropriate cultivars may be the most important decision a grower makes and certainly a difficult one to change once the plants are established. Consider not only the degree to which a cultivar is biologically adapted to a particular site, but also available markets, postharvest facilities, and labor. The listing below contains two letters, N and S, basically indicating the area in the Mid-Atlantic where the cultivars may be grown. Northerly areas (N) are roughly north and west of a line from New York City to Trenton, New Jersey, to Williamsport, Pennsylvania, to Cumberland, Maryland, to Bluefield, West Virginia. Southerly areas (S) extend from this line south and eastward if also below 2,500 feet in elevation. Descriptions of individual cultivars follow.
soil feRTiliTy
Test soil the year before planting. The soil pH should be between 6.0 and 6.5. Apply lime, phosphorus, and/or boron the fall before planting. Potassium may be applied in fall or spring, and nitrogen should be applied in the spring just before planting.
164
esta (s)
Currently available through very few nurseries. Vigorous with high productivity. Trellising system that keeps primocanes and floricanes separate is recommended due to high vigor Canes and leaves resist diseases, including late leaf rust and botrytis. Moderately sized fruit with intense flavor. May winterkill but resists fluctuations in spring temperatures. Esta is resistant to raspberry bushy dwarf virus, the most common pollen vectored virus in the Mid-Atlantic and one of the primary causes of crumbly berries.
Canes are dense and vigorous. Resistant to phytophthora root rot. Preferred by Japanese beetles. For trial.
LathaM (n or s)
Old standard eastern cultivar. Has excellent cold-hardiness and relative tolerance of wet soils. Fruit size is small to medium, flavor is acceptable, and firmness is good. Has a relatively long bearing season. While the plant is susceptible to powdery mildew, it tolerates mosaic viruses fairly well.
reveiLLe (n or s)
A very early berry with good coldhardiness and vigor. Fruit is too soft for shipping but is excellent for pick-your-own. Flavor is good, size is intermediate, and productivity is fair. Very cold-hardy.
newBurgh (n)
Another midseason berry of medium size, good flavor, and cold-hardiness. Fruit may be crumbly and may ripen unevenly. Particularly attractive to Japanese beetles and twospotted spider mites.
Midseason aMos (n or s)
Currently available through very few nurseries. Flavorful, of moderate size and productivity. Fruit has round shape. Fairly hardy and resistant to fluctuating winter temperatures.
Lauren (n or s)
Has very large fruit with good flavor and firmness and a long fruiting season. Tends to winterkill, so avoid late summer fertilization to encourage hardening off. May be tried in areas with mild winters or where winter temperatures are moderated, such as along the shore of Lake Erie. Canes are very vigorous and somewhat brittle; therefore, they should be tied as soon as possible to a trellis. Susceptible to phytophthora root rot.
nova (n or s)
Fruit is bright red, firm with good flavor, and of moderate size. Fruit must be fully ripe in order to be released from the receptacle. Ripens fruit gradually over a long harvest season. Also produces a small fall crop on primocanes. Nearly thornless. Plants are vigorous, high-yielding, and winter-hardy. Resistant to cane diseases and late leaf rust.
CanBy (n)
Moderately winter-hardy and nearly thornless. Productive, with attractive, medium to large fruit. Susceptble to phytophthora root rot.
CLaudia (n)
Currently available through very few nurseries. Very productive in part due to its good cold-hardiness. Canes start growing late in the spring and are stout, resulting in very wellpresented fruit. Fruit is large, soft to moderately firm, and has good flavor.
Moutere (n or s)
Untrialed in the Mid-Atlantic. Harvest season bridges early and midseason cultivars. Fruit is uniform in size and bright red. Canes are uprights, semi-spineless, and vigorous. Resistant to raspberry bushy dwarf virus and raspberry aphids.
titan (n)
A productive cultivar with mildly flavored, very large, cone-shaped berries. Berries are soft, and some growers feel their appearance is too rough. Plants have excellent vigor but poor to moderate winter-hardiness. Particularly susceptible to phytophthora root rot and crown gall but is resistant to raspberry aphid, a vector of certain viruses.
KiLLarney (n or s)
Old standard eastern cultivar thats still popular. Fruit is light colored and sweet Fruit size is small to medium. Winter-hardiness in cold locations may be its most important trait. Support is needed to keep fruit off of ground.
PreLude (n)
Will fruit on primocanes, but produces the majority of its yield as a summer bearer. In warmer areas with a longer growing season, more fruit is produced on primocanes, limiting summer production. Fruit is mildly flavored, dark when fully ripe, and relatively small.
165
Chapter 8: Brambles
K-81-6 (n)
Large, firm, with good flavor. Very vigorous. Winter-hardy but susceptible to high summer temperatures and fluctuating winter temperatures. Susceptible to fire blight. Very susceptible to phytophthora root rot. Will remain unnamed.
hiMBo toP (n or s)
Untrialed in the Mid-Atlantic. From Switzerland. Slightly later than Autumn Bliss. Large firm conic fruit has very good flavor. May need closer spacing (18 inches between plants) due to reduced suckering.
PoLKa (n or s)
Untrialed in the mid-Atlantic. From the same breeding program in Poland that produced Polana. Appearance is similar to that of Polana. Popularity is growing very quickly in Europe. Trials there indicate high yields of large fruit with high sugar levels.
JaCLyn (n or s)
Large, uniform, dark fruit that tends to be a little soft in higher temperatures. Fruit is long and conic, which makes removing it in cold weather somewhat difficult. The earliest primocane bearer in several trials in the United States and Europe. In unheated tunnels in Maryland, fruit ripens in early July on primocanes. Flavor is good to excellent, and production is high, with yields more than 9,000 pounds per acre. Susceptible to late leaf rust but is resistant to sunscald.
tayLor (n)
Medium-sized fruit, excellent flavor, and moderate winter-hardiness. Very susceptible to raspberry mosaic complex, fungal diseases, and twospotted spider mites.
dinKuM (n)
Flavorful, rounded, fleshy fruit. Very good flavor. Shows more damage from leafhoppers than most other cultivars. For trial.
Joan J (n or s)
Fruit is of medium size, firm, glossy, and medium-red. Flavor is good, but not exceptional. Canes are spineless and of medium height. Limited grower trialing indicates good productivity with this cultivar. Disease susceptibilities in this region are undetermined.
CaroLine (n)
Produces 1 to 2 weeks earlier than Heritage with fruiting continuing until first frost. Produces many suckers and is, therefore, very high yielding. Fruit is conical with very good flavor. Caroline fruit is 4 grams at 3,000 feet elevation in Maryland and 2 grams (relatively small) near sea level. Nitrogen applications may be lowered if fruit needs to be stored or shipped. Plants are somewhat susceptible to late leaf rust.
PoLana (n)
Early and high yielding; additional nitrogen is needed for high yields. Beautiful, glossy, clear-red, conical fruit. Fair flavor. In the southern part of the region, including DE, vigor and fruit size is lacking. In a Pennsylvania trial, it was fairly susceptible to anthracnose. Susceptible to phytophthora root rot and verticillium wilt.
JosePhine (s)
Very firm, round fruit that ships very well. Fruit is large even in warmer locations, but can average up to 5 grams at cooler locations in the southern Mid-Atlantic (at elevations higher than 2,500 feet). Too late for the north (zones 6a and cooler) but will grow well in the rest of the region.
166
Where it can be grown, it has been productive; also produces a large crop on floricanes. Improved flavor over Heritage. Resistant to leafhoppers and late leaf rust.
Black Raspberries
Black raspberries bloom in May and ripen in late June through early July. They generally fruit earlier than red raspberries, but very little difference exists among the ripening periods of black raspberry cultivars. Many very old cultivars such as Cumberland and Munger still appear in nursery catalogs as they are still sold in large quantities. Munger, in fact, comprises the vast majority of processing black raspberry acreage in the Pacific Northwest and the world. Even though many older cultivars originated in this regionCumberland is from Pennsylvania and Munger is from Ohiothey do not appear in this list as they generally have a smaller berry size than more recently released cultivars, and significant susceptibility to various diseases, making plantings fairly short lived. These characteristics are not as large of a drawback in regions where plantings are mechanically harvested or can be replaced economically every 3 to 4 years. Cultivars listed below have a relatively large size making them suitable for freshmarket sales.
purple Raspberries
Purple raspberries bloom in late May to June and are ready for harvest in late June to July.
royaLty
Yields heavily, but flavor is not generally preferred. Has cone-shaped fruit that is sweeter than Brandywine. Fruit is too soft for shipping, although it can be picked slightly before ripe for this purpose. Suckers freely from roots, so it grows more like a red raspberry in hedgerows. Does not branch, so it should not be tipped. Especially susceptible to tomato ringspot virus and crown gall.
anne (n)
Large late fruit with excellent, unique flavor. Cane density tends to be sparse. Planting at closer spacing (16 to 18 inches) is recommended. Responds well to tipping canes at 3 to 3 feet to encourage branching and fruitfulness. Can produce a large additional crop on floricanes the following spring/ summer. For trial.
BristoL
High yielding and early with excellent flavor. Susceptible to anthracnose but tolerant of powdery mildew.
FaLLgoLd (n)
Fruit is soft, sometimes develops a reddish blush, and has excellent flavor. Ripens with Heritage in the fall and is moderately winter-hardy. Plants had been infected with bushy dwarf virus from the nursery; be sure to request clean plants.
aPaChe
Early. A favorite for flavor. Similar moderate yields to Navaho. Vigorous plants. Good fruit size. Prone to developing red drupelets.
JeweL
The most widely grown black raspberry in the region. A particularly vigorous and productive plant with very good cold-hardiness. Fruit are larger than Bristol and more susceptible to botrytis development after harvest.
goLdie (n)
Fruit color is gold to apricot. A sport of Heritage; therefore, bearing season and other plant characteristics are identical. Fair flavor. Very susceptible to sunscald. For trial.
araPaho
The earliest erect thornless blackberry. Fruit is medium sized, short, and conical with small seeds. May be cold-hardier than Navaho.
MaC BLaCK
Later than Jewel; extends season significantly. Vigorous stocky canes, large fruit. Fruit releases from receptacles easily. Reports indicate satisfaction with this cultivar in various locations across the region. Recommended for trial.
Chester
Ripens late. Has smaller fruit than most. One of the most commonly grown thornless blackberries.
KiwigoLd (n)
A sport of Heritage; therefore, bearing season and other plant characteristics are identical. For trial.
167
Chapter 8: Brambles
doyLes thornLess
Late. Productive in PA trial. Fruit on small side but firm. Flavor acceptable to good. Winter-hardiness similar to that of Triple Crown. Plants tend to be trailing, and produce few laterals even when tipped, so adjustments in pruning and trellising need to be made. Somewhat susceptible to Gnomonia stem canker, which may be an indication of winter injury.
triPLe Crown
Starts fruiting in midseason, with long gradual dropoff in yields. Large, flavorful fruit with good sweetness. Productive. Very stocky canes once established. Considerable susceptibility to Gnomonia stem canker, which may be an indication of winter injury
darrow
An early, very erect plant that bears medium-sized, firm fruit with good flavor. Plants are vigorous and very winterhardy.
iLLini hardy
Early. Vigorous and very winter-hardy. Compensates for winter injury by producing fruit from secondary buds, resulting in consistent high yields. Thorns are nastier than with most. Smaller-sized berries with average flavor. Fruit size decreases through harvest season. Resistant to phytophthora root rot. The most cold-hardy cultivar but still will be injured in very cold locations.
huLL
Flavor is sweeter (less tart) than that of other cultivars and may be preferred for pick-your-own. The berry does not lose color under high temperatures and is fairly coldhardy.
natChez
Untrialed in the Mid-Atlantic region. Very early, similar season to Arapaho. Large fruit. Needs to be trellised.
ChesaPeaKe
Currently available through very few nurseries. Vigorous, productive cultivar with extremely large, sweet fruit. Has very large thorns. Probably too cold tender for northern New Jersey and most of Pennsylvania.
Kiowa
Highest yields in midseason, but produces for a long time. Large fruit and long harvest season are the characteristics of note. Winter-hardiness has been a problem even in southeastern PA, but it performed well in warmer areas such as DE. Variable yields depending on conditions in previous winter. Good flavor. For trial only.
navaho
Fruits relatively late, and for a long time. Plant growth habit is fairly erect. Yields are moderate. Small to medium-sized fruit with good flavor. Fruit has attractive color and sheen but may be rough. May be especially susceptible to orange rust. Somewhat susceptible to Gnomonia stem canker, which may be an indication of winter injury. Resistant to anthracnose, rosette, and root rot.
ChiCKasaw
Early in PA trial. Relatively brief harvest season. Improved winter-hardiness and yields compared to Shawnee. Bears very large fruit. Very good flavor. Good productivity in a moderate climate (southeast PA). Plants are very vigorous and quite thorny. Winter-hardiness questionable when temperatures are commonly less than 0F.
shawnee
Early. Less productive than other thorny cultivars due to a short harvest season. Good fruit size. Questionable winter-hardiness. Resistant to orange rust.
ouaChita
Fruited relatively early but only for a short time in PA trial, resulting in low yields. Good fruit size and flavor. Winter-hardiness similar to that of Triple Crown and Navaho.
ChoCtaw
Very productive and early fruiting, producing large fruit with small seeds. Probably the least hardy of all cultivars in this group. For trial only.
168
tuned. Growers experiencing problems with winter-hardiness may wish to try this crop on a small scale. Because the crop is produced very late in the season, protection may be needed to mature the crop. If the fall crop cannot be matured, plants should not be relied upon for a summer crop as the canes lack winterhardiness.
PriMe-Jan
Flavor is acceptable. Somewhat less stocky than PrimeJim. Larger fruit and more productive than Prime-Jim in PA trial but still not acceptable.
PriMe-JiM
Stocky plants. Flavor somewhat poorer than that of Prime-Jan. Fruit on small side in PA trial.
The number of plants required per acre for various plant spacings is shown in Table 8.1. Between-row spacings in the region should be no less than 8 feet, although row spacing depends on the size of equipment that will be used to maintain the planting. Allow at least 4 feet more between rows than the width of the widest implement to be used in the planting. In very warm areas, however, closer spacing (6 feet between rows) can remove some of the heat load in the soil by providing more shading. Closely spaced rows do reduce the wind movement and drying conditions necessary to minimize fungal spread. Remove flower blossoms the first year to encourage plant establishment. Fertilizer after planting should be applied as indicated in the fertilization section below, assuming that the soil was amended according to soil test results prior to planting.
PriMe-arK 4.5
Large fruit Excellent flavor Sweet when ripe Though too early to reach conclusions, appears very promising in a PA high tunnel trial. For trial.
feRTilizaTion
If proper preplant preparation is followed as outlined above (soil tested the year before planting; lime, phosphorus, and boron applied, if needed, the fall before planting; potassium applied in the fall or spring; and nitrogen incorporated just before planting), no additional fertilizer other than nitrogen should be needed the first year. Burning young roots and damaging the plants is extremely easy, especially if tissuecultured plants are used. Therefore, a water-soluble starter fertilizer can be applied at planting according to package directions for transplants, but it should be applied after planting and kept 6 inches away from the plants rather than being poured into the planting hole. On heavier soils, nitrogen incorporated prior to planting should be sufficient to supply the plant for the first growing season. Some additional nitrogen fertilization after planting may be needed on light soils, with a maximum of 10 pounds per acre of actual nitrogen applied at any one time. Granular fertilizers should not be applied until at least 8 weeks after planting and should be kept 4 to 6 inches away from the plants. Calcium nitrate is the preferred nitrogen source.
In established plantings, fertilizer should be applied at the full per-acre rate but concentrated in a 2- to 3-footwide band over the row, not adjusted downward as a proportion of the area covered (see Table 8.2 for recommendations). Nitrogen rates should be adjusted based on leaf analysis and plant vigor. In established bramble plants 3 years or older, the general rule of thumb for nitrogen is around 60 pounds of actual nitrogen per acre per year. This may be too much or not enough, depending on soil type, variety, and season. Actual nitrogen required may also vary, depending on management intensity (e.g., drip-irrigated intensive production and native fertility). During the first and second years, the nitrogen requirement may be one-half to two-thirds of the above rule of thumb. Tissue analysis can help you fine-tune your bramble fertility program, as can observations of plant vigor. Raspberry primocanes should grow 5 to 8 feet in a season, while thornless blackberries should fill their allotted space on the trellis. Weekly fertigation of a portion of the annual nitrogen is very efficient in well-managed plantings. Alternatively, apply half of the required amount of nitrogen at bud break and the second half in May to increase uptake efficiency and reduce the potential for fertilizer runoff. Avoid fall applications because they can reduce winter-hardiness. Nutrients other than nitrogen should be applied according to tissue test recommendations. If corrective measures for low nutrient concentrations are not made until deficiencies are observed, yield reductions will have already taken place. For a more complete discussion, see NRAES-35, Bramble Production
169
Chapter 8: Brambles
Guide (see Appendix E for information on obtaining this guide). Tissue analysis procedures and critical values are listed in Appendix B. Balance this information with your experiences, especially observations on vigor, yield, fruit flavor (K), and fruit firmness (N).
Table 8.2. postplant nitrogen recommendations for brambles (lbs n/acre). Irrigated Nonirrigated Year Sand Loam Clay Sand Loam Clay
FaLL-BEaRING RaSPBERRIES (WITH NO SuMMER CROP)* 1 (Year after planting) 40 30 25 2 70 60 50 3+ 100 90 80 SuMMER-BEaRING RED RaSPBERRIES aND BLaCkBERRIES 1 (Year after planting) 35 30 25 2 50 45 40 3+ 70 60 50 SuMMER-BEaRING BLaCk aND PuRPLE RaSPBERRIES 1 (Year after planting) 30 25 20 2 45 40 35 3+ 60 50 45 35 70 90 30 45 60 25 35 45 30 65 80 25 40 50 20 30 40 25 50 70 25 35 40 20 25 30
mulChinG
Good weed control during the first year is essential. However, tissue-cultured plants, and dormant plants to a lesser extent, are extremely sensitive to most herbicides until about 4 months after planting. Research from Cornell has shown that applying a clean straw mulch (4 inches deep) to newly planted, tissuecultured raspberries provides good weed control. On heavy soils, mulch should be used only in the first year since straw mulch over a prolonged period can encourage the development of root rots. For further information, see Weeds at the end of this chapter. A fast start is critical to successful establishment of bramble plantings in the Mid-Atlantic region. Vigorous bramble plantings outcompete weed seedlings by shading them, thus reducing the need for herbicides. If large patches of row exposed to sun still exist during the second year of the planting, weed pressure often necessitates greater use of residual herbicides. These residual herbicides can reduce bramble growth, particularly on red raspberries in warmer climates. This further necessitates greater weed control. The use of plastic mulch may have merit in establishing a new planting. Landscape fabric, aluminized plastic, black plastic, or a black-on-white plastic (white side up) can be used. Advantages of plastic use are good weed and grass control the first season, along with moisture conservation. Growth and suckering should be increased; however, canes can become winter-tender if growth is pushed too far into the fall. The addition of trickle (drip) irrigation eliminates moisture stress and can be used for fertigation. When landscape fabric is used to completely cover the ground, the row spacing can be reduced to minimize costs. A propane torch with a self-igniter can be used to burn holes in the mulch. Burn a hole 3 inches in diameter for
*Split the amount listed into two equal applicationsone made in spring and the second made by early July. Note: Rates should be adjusted according to leaf analysis. Modified from information provided by Cornell University.
planting containerized plants and tissuecultured plugs. If the mulch remains in place for the following years, enlarge the hole before April 1 since most suckers are formed in February and March, and heat damage can occur on these new canes, especially on the side facing south. For transplants with a larger root system, such as nursery-matured plants or vigorous cultivars that sucker heavily, lengthwise slits can be made. If plastic mulch or landscape fabric is used with cultivars that produce a hedgerow of new canes (red raspberries, gold raspberries, and most thorny blackberries), any additional openings (a gap up to 8 to 12 inches wide) should be made near the center of the row. This will allow the new growth to emerge while encouraging the canes to remain contained in narrow hedgerows. Alternatively, the mulch can remain in strips between the hedgerows. If cultivars are being grown that produce new canes primarily from the crown area (black raspberries and thornless blackberries), the mulch may remain in place relatively intact. When using landscape fabric or plastic mulch for the long term, continuous cover has caused problems in enhancing winter injury, except in tunneled plantings. This effect may be due to the soil prematurely heating in winter, or to tender fall growth failing to harden off sufficiently. In any system, use of plastic
mulch or landscape fabric can encourage a buildup of rodent populations. Raised beds or hilled rows are recommended with or without plastic mulch because they minimize root rots and other root disease problems, especially phytophthora root rot. (See information on phytophthora root rot later in this chapter.) Caution: Before raising beds or hills in a field, the natural water drainage pattern must be taken into account. Failure to do so can create major drainage problems if raised beds become mini dams. Take care of your field water drainage first by installing a grass waterway, field tile, or drainage ditches. In subsequent years, composted sawdust or woodchips or shredded hardwood bark can be used on light and medium soils. All are excellent mulch materials and help reduce weeds, heat stress, and water loss during the growing season, especially in warmer areas of the region. The depth should be 2 inches or less to minimize a buildup of vole populations. Noncomposted sawdust or woodchips should not be used since the biological breakdown of these products will use much of the available nitrogen needed for healthy plant growth. While labor and materials needed for mulching can be costly, mulched plantings generally require fewer herbicide treatments. Good mulches can and do lower the
170
incidence of water and heat stress on the planting, reducing plant leaf drop and fruit sunscalding.
iRRiGaTion
Brambles benefit from irrigation, especially during fruit swell, which occurs the week before fruit ripens. Trickle irrigation is preferred for brambles because wetting the fruit with overhead irrigation may encourage disease. Plants generally require 1 to 2 inches of water per week during the growing season and 2 to 3 inches per week during harvest. Correctly timed irrigation may help in reducing sunscald (see the later section on physiological disorders).
Information on establishment and management of sod row middles is covered in greater detail in Chapter 7. Characteristics of various cover crops are listed in Table 7.3, and seeding rates and nutrient and pH requirements are listed in Table 7.4. Hard fescues such as Spartan, Aurora, SR3000, SR3100, and Reliant (the number of available cultivars is rapidly increasing) and sheep fescues are low growing and adapt readily to a wide range of soil pH. Once established, these plants are competitive enough to outgrow weeds. They do not propagate from rhizomes like many grasses but are a bunch grass, so no encroachment occurs on the crop plant. They form a dense sod with deep extensive roots that protect soil structure. Though the seed is relative expensive, fewer mowings are needed, which more than offsets the higher price of the seed. While some growers have reported difficulty in establishing the hard fescues, this has not been our experience. Seeding rates can vary from 20 to 30 pounds per acre to 80 pounds per acre depending on how quickly dense cover is required. When seeded at the lower rate, plants take from 6 to 9 months to establish a good cover, while the higher seeding rate will result in a full cover much more rapidly. Plan on seeding the fall before or the fall after planting because this will improve establishment since grasses prefer cool seasons of the year for growth. This will also give the grass a chance to establish during a time of the year when dry spells are not likely and few operations using equipment are taking place in the field. For additional information on sod row middle management, see Chapter 7 and additional resources listed in Appendix E.
pRuninG
Red summer-Bearing Raspberries
Floricanes of all brambles die after fruiting is completed. Prior recommendations have stressed that spent fruiting canes should be removed immediately after fruiting to allow air circulation through the canopy and to remove possible sources of disease inocula from the canopy. Research has shown, however, that winter injury was more severe on
the cold-tender cultivar Titan when spent fruiting canes were removed in the summer as opposed to during the subsequent fall or winter. For this reason, when floricanes retain their leaves (primarily in the north), we now recommend leaving the spent fruiting canes until dormant pruning if cane diseases are minimal. However, if cane diseases are present to any significant extent, or if excessive summer heat or unseen winter injury weakens canes and causes leaves to abscise, spent fruiting canes should be removed as soon as possible after harvest. Floricane-bearing red raspberries grow naturally in a hedgerow system, as indicated in Figure 8.1a. The suckers, originating from the root system, fill in the entire length of the row, spreading to several feet wide. This would reduce drying conditions in the middle of the row. Thus, row widths should be reduced to no more than 1 foot wide in the spring and maintained at this width. Removing suckers further improves air movement. Removing excess canes in the spring will stimulate more cane growth to some extent, but removing canes outside the 1 foot width of the row allows taller, more easily trellised canes for next years crop. The optimal number of canes per foot of row is site dependent. Growers should monitor yearly numbers of healthy canes produced to determine whether the plantings productivity is changing due to an excessive or insufficient number of canes being allowed to fruit. Brambles have an ability to adapt to excessive number of canes by reducing the productivity of each bud or cane. Raspberries can also adjust for excessive shortening of canes by winterkill or pruning. For final adjustment of cane numbers, late March is the best time to prune because any cane dieback from cold will be apparent. However, raspberries can be pruned any time canes are fully dormant. In the dormant season, remove canes outside the 12-inch width of the row (Figure 8.1b), thin canes to 4 to 6 inches between canes, leaving about 4 to 5 canes per linear foot (Figure 8.1c), and top remaining canes to 48 to 72 inches in height, ideally removing about one-fourth of the cane (Figure 8.1d). Be sure to keep canes that have the largest diameters.
171
Chapter 8: Brambles
nating on the lower 2 to 3 feet of the canes, and tip back remaining laterals to 12 to 18 inches.
TRellis sysTems
Trellis systems can increase yields per acre because they expand the bramble canopy surface area by supporting it. Several trellises have been developed and successfully used. A simple supported hedgerow trellis (Figure 8.3) consists of a wire at 3 feet high, a second optional wire at 5 feet high, and posts every 30 to 50 feet of row. This trellis can be used with all overwintered brambles in all situations. Experiments in Pennsylvania using the T or Lincoln canopy trellis (Figure 8.4) resulted in black and red raspberry fruit that was borne on top of the canopy, allowing for excellent fruit exposure. This was particularly true for black raspberries. Better fruit exposure also allows harvesters to avoid the thorny canes. With the V trellis (Figure 8.5), the floricanes are tied to the wires during dormant pruning and the primocanes grow in the center of the row. Both T and V systems are fairly labor intensive during pruning, but fruit is more easily found during harvest. Where vigorous growth and satisfactory winter-hardiness are commonly achieved, the Gjerde system has been found to be productive, easy on fruit, and labor saving. The Gjerde system uses wires that can be moved from the center of the row to the outside, forming a V. Canes are held in the center before flowering to force flowers to grow toward the outside of the trellis. After flowering, the top wires (and the canes attached to them) are moved to the outside of the trellis so the crop is borne on the outside, leaving room in the middle for newly emerging primocanes. The rotatable cross-arm trellis system is designed for use with blackberry production in areas where winter protection is needed. With this sytem, canes can be rotated to ground level so they can protected with row covers or snow in areas that receive reliable snowfall. In the spring and early summer, three or four new primocanes are tied horizontally to a low trellis wire and pinched after reaching canes from a neighboring
summer-Bearing Blackberries
Erect blackberries (thorny or thornless) do not require trellising; but even they will benefit from having a trellis sytem in place. They have, as the name suggests, very strong upright canes. They can be pruned similarly to black and purple raspberries: specifically, head primocanes back to 36 to 48 inches in the summer. Spent floricanes should be removed immediately after harvest. Also, during dormant pruning, cut back laterals to 12 to 18 inches and thin canes to 10 inches apart in the hedgerow. Semi-upright and erect blackberries can be grown with either a supported hedgerow or a V-trellis system as described under Red Raspberries. They should be summer tipped at about 6 inches above the highest trellis wire and tied to it during the summer months. Spent floricanes should be removed immediately after harvest. For dormant pruning, select 5 to 8 of the strongest canes per plant, remove all laterals origi-
172
3 feet
6 feet
3 feet
3 feet
6 feet
(c) pruning red raspberriescanes thinned to four to six per foot of row.
3 feet
6 feet
173
Chapter 8: Brambles
plant. Because they are tied horizontally, once tipped, many laterals break along the full length of the canes. These laterals grow upwards and are tied to several trellis wires that are run horizontally above the wire that supports the main canes. For winter, this tellis is pivoted to ground level, remaining in this position until fruiting laterals break in the spring. At that point, fruiting laterals are all growing upward, and the system is then pivoted back past the original position so that the fruiting laterals are on one side facing slightly downward, allowing ease of harvest. One main drawback to this system has been its cost; however, commercialization of production using fiberglass components rather than metal, and some adoption by the industry is reducing the cost considerably. Additional information on this sytem is listed in Appendix E. The Stiles shift trellis was developed at Virginia Tech. Canes are attached to a movable side arm containing several wires. The arm is held at the nineoclock position during flowering. This sets the fruiting trusses upright since they grow toward the sun. At 2 weeks post flowering, the arm is swung around to the one-oclock position. Immature fruit now hangs down to reduce sunscald and ease picking. Shift trellises are particularly useful for maximizing yield and providing exposure for thornless blackberry fruit.
of production under protected cultivation will rise as time goes on, as has been the case in Europe.
(a)
(b)
(c) figure 8.2. pruning black raspberries. (a) Primocanes tipped in midsummer. (b) Lateral branches grow. (c) Laterals are shortened during dormant pruning.
pRoTeCTed CulTuRe
Brambles may be grown in protected culture to increase the length of the harvest season or to produce berries during the off-season when production otherwise might not be possible. Both high tunnel and greenhouse production involve higher costs, and information may be lacking for solving various problems that may arise. Production difficulties can be considerably different in type or magnitude from those encountered in field production. For these reasons, growers are advised to proceed with caution when embarking on a new enterprise in these areas. It is expected, however, that interest in these systems will grow and that the amount
174
Greenhouse production
A greenhouse raspberry production system to produce berries during the winter and early spring was developed at Cornell University and is adapted only in the northern part of the MidAtlantic. Raspberries grow best in cool temperatures, so less supplemental heat is needed than for most other crops. In this system, summer-bearing raspberries (usually Tulameen) are grown. Tissue-cultured plants are planted into pots in the spring, grown outdoors until December, and then brought into the greenhouse. Here, supplemental lighting may speed up fruit development but is not mandatory for production. Plants are moved outdoors again after fruiting and the cycle is repeated. As is true of high tunnels, spider mites are the primary pest. We recommend that growers who wish to try greenhouse raspberry production become familiar with details of the required management practices first since these are very different from the practices of field production. See Appendix E for Web sites with additional information. A similar tunnel system in Spain utilizes dormant, bare-root, chilled long-cane plants grown in northern nurseries.
34 ft
1 1/22 ft
6 ft
34 ft
6 ft
6 ft
3 ft
175
Chapter 8: Brambles
2. Harvest as early in the morning as possible, after the dew has dried. Try to harvest all berries before noon, and keep harvested fruit out of direct sunlight. For long-distance shipping, fruit must be harvested when pink to slightly unripe. Never ship ripe fruit long distances. 3. Always handle berries gently. Roll, dont pull, berries off the plant. Be sure to instruct harvesters and drivers to pick and transport the fruit gently. 4. Harvest into appropriate containers. For raspberries and blackberries, use either half-pints or low pints (pints with the footprint of a quart). This ensures that fruit is never stacked more than two or three berries high. Research has shown that having more than three layers crushes the bottom layers. 5. Remove field heat from berries as soon as possible. The best approach is to use convective cooling before placing fruit in a cold room. A fan inside a cooler, with tarps placed to direct airflow through the fruit, forces air through the berries and works quite well for smaller operations. 6. Cover fruit after cooling to minimize moisture loss. You may also loosely cover berries before cooling, being sure to remove the covering (and the water from condensation) after cooling has occurred. 7. Keep fruit cool during transport and make sure berries are not treated roughly. Ensuring your customers know the limitations of small fruits is essential for your continued existence as a wholesaler. If you are retailing, also provide information for consumers to help them extend the shelf life of their purchases. 8. The optimal storage temperature is 31 to 32F, and the optimal relative humidity is 90 to 95 percent. Fruit will freeze at lower temperatures. Maintaining relative humidities this high at such low temperatures is often difficult, but the highest possible relative humidity should be maintained. By adhering to the above precautions, field-grown raspberries can be kept for 3 to 5 days. Controlledatmosphere storage (15 to 20 percent
carbon dioxide and 2 to 5 percent oxygen) extends shelf life even more, although it cannot be used as a substitute for refrigeration. Blackberries should be handled similarly, although their shelf life is several days longer than that of raspberries. For more information on bramble production, consult NRAES-35: Bramble Production Guide (see Appendix E for ordering information).
ery and land. Depreciation and taxes are examples. Total specified costs are the sum of variable and fixed costs. Most landpreparation activities are assumed to be custom hired in these budgets because the small acreages for many berry farms do not justify the ownership of these implements. If you use your own tillage equipment, the variable costs for custom hire should be subtracted from the budgets and your labor variable costs and machinery fixed costs should be substituted. For red raspberry and thornless blackberry production, one budget is presented for the years of land preparation (Table 8.3) since costs for either crop at this time would be the same. For red raspberries, additional cost-ofproduction budgets are presented for the planting year (Table 8.4), the year after planting (Table 8.5), and mature production (Table 8.6). For thornless blackberry production, similar cost-ofproduction budgets are presented for the planting year (Table 8.7), the year after planting (Table 8.8), and for a mature planting (Table 8.9). Returns to risk and management is the estimated profit attributable to the acceptance of risk and the contribution of management expertise by the grower (Tables 8.10 and 8.11). The tables estimate the return to the grower for a range of prices and yields. Because yields, grades, and prices are so variable, growers should use representative values for their operation. It is important to account for cash flows over the life of the investment when assessing the overall profitability of the enterprise, so prorated land preparation and planting costs are subtracted in the estimates. Breakeven prices and yields are shown in the tables. Breakeven price is an estimate of the unit price required to cover all costs at a given yield; it is also the average cost per unit of production. Breakeven yield is an estimate of the yield required to cover all costs at a given price. Berry production involves large initial investments and can be very risky; weather and animal related crop losses are common and crop prices can be highly variable. Use of whole-farm risk management tools such as AGR-
economIcs
The summer-bearing red raspberry and thornless blackberry budgets given here were prepared to provide general information and do not apply to any specific operation. Use them, with appropriate modifications, as guides for preparing budgets for individual situations. Budgets can be used: for general farm business planning purposes as a basis for obtaining credit to project cash flows to assess profitability Using these sample budgets as guides should help ensure that all costs and receipts are included in budgets you prepare for your farm. Costs are often difficult to estimate in budget preparation because they are numerous and variable. Therefore, you should think of these budgets as a first approximation and then make appropriate adjustments using the Your Farm column to add, delete, and adjust items to reflect your specific growing conditions and resource situation. The sample cost-of-production budgets were developed using a computerized budget generator. Input data reflect recommended production practices and current input costs. Major subheadings in the budgets are variable costs, fixed costs, and total specified costs. They are defined as follows: Variable costs are costs that vary depending on the level of production. These include such inputs as fertilizer, herbicides, insecticides, fungicides, and labor. Fixed costs are costs that do not vary by level of production and are incurred by virtue of owning assets such as machin-
176
Lite crop insurance can help you reduce these risks. A land charge of $150/acre has been included in the budgets, but this charge can vary greatly from location to location. If you own the land, you could include your principal, interest payments, and property taxes as a fixed cost. If you lease the land, then the annual rental cost could be included as a variable cost. Production assumptions used in generating the budgets include the following: Fumigation is not used. Under certain conditions, fumigation may be warranted.
Irrigation system costs are calculated assuming that they apply water to 5 acres. Fungicides are rotated to reduce the likelihood of disease resistance. The numbers of pesticide and irrigation applications are average. In any given year or location, growers will need to adjust these for their particular set of circumstances. Hard fescue is planted in the aisles to reduce the need for mowing. A supported hedgerow trellis is used to support the canes. A trickle irrigation system is used in calculating water application.
Berries are harvested as ready-picked in pint plastic clamshells for red raspberries and pint plastic clamshells for blackberries. For raspberry budgets, the plant spacing assumed is 2 feet within the row and 10 feet between rows (approximately 2,200 plants per acre). For thornless blackberry budgets, the plant spacing assumed is 5 feet within the row and 12 feet between rows (726 plants per acre).
Table 8.3. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year of land preparation for summer-bearing red raspberries or thornless blackberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Soil test Custom apply lime Moldboard plowing Disking Grass seeding Herbicides Glyphosate 4 Seed Annual ryegrass seed Labor Hired Operator Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost* Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs acre acre acre 2.84 3.41 150.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 2.84 3.41 6.25 150.00 318.46 hour hour gal acre acre 13.50 15.00 3.25 2.32 1.65 0.50 0.60 1.63 1.00 1.00 6.75 9.06 5.30 2.32 1.65 3.47 162.21 lb 0.35 25.00 8.75 gal 35.00 0.50 17.50 each ton acre acre acre 10.00 24.00 19.10 18.50 11.90 1.00 2.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 10.00 48.00 19.10 18.50 11.90 unit Price ($) Quantity amount ($) Your Farm ($)
*Estimated fixed costs in this budget assume that all field operations for land preparation are done by custom operators. Ownership of tillage equipment, grain drills, and grass seeders is not economically justified for growers engaged solely in small fruit production. Fixed costs in this budget reflect the ownership of a sprayer and mower.
177
Chapter 8: Brambles
Table 8.4. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: planting year for summer-bearing red raspberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Spread dry fertilizer Moldboard plowing Disking Post driving Grass seeding Fertilizer 10-10-10 Urea Insecticides Sevin 80S Other Trickle irrigation Trickle operating Raspberry plants Wheat straw Hard fescue seed Trellis posts Trellis wire Trellis anchors/tensioners Labor Hired Operator Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs acre acre acre 3.58 2.56 150.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 3.58 2.56 6.14 150.00 6,588.29 hour hour gal acre acre 13.50 15.00 3.25 1.73 0.87 48.00 0.65 1.70 1.00 1.00 648.00 9.70 5.53 1.73 0.87 111.91 6,432.15 acre inch each ton lb each mft each 800.00 20.00 1.02 150.00 2.85 5.00 32.00 20.00 1.00 12.00 2,200.00 0.60 21.00 200.00 8.70 34.00 800.00 240.00 2,244.00 90.00 59.85 1,000.00 278.00 680.00 lb 8.85 2.50 22.13 lb lb 0.12 0.48 300.00 100.00 36.00 48.90 acre acre acre acre acre 9.20 19.10 18.50 100.00 11.90 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.70 9.20 19.10 18.50 100.00 8.33 unit Price ($) Quantity amount ($) Your Farm ($)
178
Table 8.5. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year after establishment for summer-bearing red raspberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Spread dry fertilizer Fertilizer Urea Fungicides Captan 80W Elevate 50WDG Herbicides Princep 90WDG Devrinol 50DF Surflan AS Insecticides Malathion 8F Actara Other Plant analysis kit Trickle operating Clamshell, pint Flats, pint Labor Hired Operator Raspberry harvest Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs acre acre acre 23.78 20.45 150.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 23.78 20.45 44.23 150.00 2,085.92 hour hour pt gal acre acre 13.50 15.00 0.60 3.25 11.50 11.38 17.50 3.78 1,000.00 11.74 1.00 1.00 236.25 56.68 600.00 38.15 11.50 11.38 51.77 2,041.69 each inch each each 24.00 20.00 0.13 2.10 1.00 20.00 1,000.00 42.00 24.00 400.00 130.00 88.20 gal oz 37.50 6.00 0.38 3.00 14.06 18.00 lb lb gal 4.70 11.20 56.35 2.20 8.00 0.75 10.34 89.60 42.26 lb lb 6.29 43.55 8.00 3.00 50.32 130.65 lb 0.48 60.00 29.34 acre 9.20 1.00 9.20 unit Price ($) Quantity amount ($) Your Farm ($)
179
Chapter 8: Brambles
Table 8.6. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: mature planting of summer-bearing red raspberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Spread dry fertilizer Fertilizer Urea Fungicides Captan 80W Elevate 50WDG Lime sulfur Pristine 38WG Herbicides Devrinol 50DF Princep 90WDG Surflan AS Insecticides Malathion 8F Actara Other Plant analysis kit Trickle operating Clamshell, pint Flats, pint Labor Hired Operator Raspberry harvest Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs
*Calculations assume that a -pt clamshell of red raspberries weighs 5 oz.
unit
Price ($)
Quantity
amount ($)
acre lb lb lb gal oz lb lb gal gal oz each inch each each hour hour pt gal acre acre
9.20 0.48 6.29 43.55 7.90 3.45 11.20 4.70 56.35 37.50 6.00 24.00 20.00 0.13 2.10 13.50 15.00 0.60 3.25 11.97 11.08
1.00 140.00 8.00 3.00 12.00 20.00 8.00 4.40 0.75 0.38 3.00 1.00 20.00 10,000.00 417.00 51.50 4.01 10,000.00 12.15 1.00 1.00
9.20 68.46 50.32 130.65 94.80 69.00 89.60 20.68 42.26 14.06 18.00 24.00 400.00 1,300.00 875.70 695.25 60.19 6,000.00 39.48 11.97 11.08 252.60 10,277.29 24.74 22.31 47.05 150.00 10,474.34
180
Table 8.7. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year of establishment for thornless blackberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Spread dry fertilizer Moldboard plowing Disking Post driver Grass seeding Fertilizer 10-10-10 Urea Insecticides Sevin 80S Other Trickle irrigation Trickle operating Trellis posts Trellis wire Trellis anchors/tensioners Hard fescue seed Blackberry plants Labor Hired Operator Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs acre acre acre 3.58 2.56 150.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 3.58 2.56 6.14 150.00 9,745.36 hour hour gal acre acre 13.50 15.00 3.25 1.73 0.87 48.00 0.65 1.70 1.00 1.00 648.00 9.70 5.53 1.73 0.87 182.98 9,589.22 acre inch each mft each lb each 800.00 20.00 5.00 32.00 20.00 2.85 2.35 1.00 20.00 200.00 8.70 34.00 21.00 2,200.00 800.00 400.00 1,000.00 278.40 680.00 59.85 5,170.00 lb 8.85 2.50 22.13 lb lb 0.12 0.48 300.00 100.00 36.00 48.90 acre acre acre acre acre 9.20 19.10 18.50 100.00 11.90 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.70 9.20 19.10 18.50 100.00 8.33 unit Price ($) Quantity amount ($) Your Farm ($)
181
Chapter 8: Brambles
Table 8.8. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: year after establishment for thornless blackberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Spread dry fertilizer Fertilizer Urea Fungicides Captan 80W Elevate 50WDG Herbicides Devrinol 50DF Princep 90WDG Surflan AS Insecticides Malathion 8F Actara Other Plant analysis kit Trickle operating Clamshell, 1 pt Flats, 1 pt Labor Hired Operator Berry harvest Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs acre acre acre 23.78 20.45 150.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 23.78 20.45 44.23 150.00 3,489.71 hour hour pt gal acre acre 13.50 15.00 0.60 3.25 11.50 11.38 17.50 3.74 2,500.00 11.74 1.00 1.00 236.25 56.68 1,500.00 38.15 11.50 11.38 80.36 3,295.48 each inch each each 24.00 20.00 0.13 2.10 1.00 20.00 2,500.00 104.00 24.00 400.00 325.00 218.40 gal oz 37.50 6.00 0.38 3.00 14.06 18.00 lb lb gal 11.20 4.70 56.35 8.00 2.20 0.75 89.60 10.34 42.26 lb lb 6.29 43.55 8.00 3.00 50.32 130.65 lb 0.48 60.00 29.34 acre 9.20 1.00 9.20
unit Price ($) Quantity amount ($) Your Farm ($)
182
Table 8.9. summary of estimated costs per acre, 2009: mature planting of thornless blackberries.
Item Variable Cost Custom Spread dry fertilizer Fertilizer Urea Fungicides Captan 80W Elevate 50WDG Lime sulfur Pristine 38WDG Herbicides Devrinol 50DF Princep 90WDG Surflan AS Insecticides Malathion 8F Actara Other Plant analysis kit Trickle operating Clamshell, 1 pint Flats, 1 pint Labor Hired Operator Berry harvest Diesel Fuel Repairs and Maintenance Tractors Implements Interest on Operating Capital Total Variable Cost Fixed Cost Tractors Implements Total Fixed Cost Land Charge Total Specified Costs acre acre acre 28.62 25.05 150.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 28.62 25.05 53.67 150.00 8,865.18 hour hour pt gal acre acre 13.50 15.00 0.60 3.25 13.84 12.84 57.50 4.51 8,000.00 14.16 1.00 1.00 776.25 67.68 4,800.00 46.01 13.84 12.84 182.25 8,661.51 each inch each each 24.00 20.00 0.13 2.10 1.00 20.00 8,000.00 334.00 24.00 400.00 1,040.00 701.40 gal oz 37.50 6.00 0.38 3.00 14.06 18.00 lb lb gal 11.20 4.70 56.35 8.00 4.40 0.75 89.60 20.68 42.26 lb lb gal oz 6.29 43.55 7.90 3.45 8.00 3.00 12.00 20.00 50.32 130.65 94.80 69.00 lb 0.48 120.00 58.68 acre 9.20 1.00 9.20 unit Price ($) Quantity amount ($) Your Farm ($)
183
Chapter 8: Brambles
Table 8.10. Returns to risk and management for red raspberries, 2009.
Price ($/half pint) $2.00 $2.50 $3.00 $3.50 $4.00 Breakeven price Yield ( pt/a) 6,000 $3,810 $6,810 $9,810 $12,810 $15,810 $1.37 8,000 $6,175 $10,175 $14,175 $18,175 $22,175 $1.23 10,000 $8,540 $13,540 $18,540 $23,540 $28,540 $1.15 12,000 $10,905 $16,905 $22,905 $28,905 $34,905 $1.09 14,000 $13,270 $20,270 $27,270 $34,270 $41,270 $1.05 Breakeven Yield 2,778 1,953 1,505 1,225 1,032
fruit diseases
Gray Mold (Botrytis Fruit Rot)
Symptoms: In the field, ripe berries or receptacles remaining on the plant after harvest are covered with a dusty gray mold. This disease is equally important as a postharvest rot, where, due to high humidity, mycelial growth is less dense and appears as a light-gray growth. If extended wet weather occurs during bloom, blossoms may be blighted and the infection invades their supporting stems. If the weather becomes dry after such infections, blossoms and stems will blacken and appear like fire blight disease on apples and pears. Botrytis can also cause a cane blight and leaf spotting. Causal Agent: The fungus Botrytis cinerea. Epidemiology: The fungus has a wide host range and can survive on either living or dead tissue. It overwinters in dead leaves and plant debris and on stems. Inoculum is produced from fruiting structures on canes, from dead leaves, and from mummified berries in the spring. Flowers are infected soon after they open as the inoculum lands on the stigma, germinates, and grows into floral tissues that will develop into the fruit. The fungus then lies dormant in the developing fruit until the fruit is nearly ripe or harvested, at which time gray mold symptoms develop. Some direct fruit infection can also take place at harvest when moldy berries infect nearby fruit. Controls: To help control the disease, choose a planting site with good air movement and prune out weak canes to speed the drying of plants. Also eliminate weeds (again, to aid in quicker drying of foliage and fruit) and harvest fruit before it is overripe. Under protected culture, tunnels should be opened early in the morning to reduce humidity or left open. If using a type of tunnel where covering is temporary, plants should be covered by bloom and remain covered until after fruiting. Fungicides should be applied during bloom, with additional applications made during harvest if necessary. Refer to Table 8.15 for fungicide recommendations.
Prorated land preparation and planting costs included are based on a productive life of 7 years. A half-pint clamshell of raspberries weighs 5 ounces.
Prorated land preparation and planting costs included are based on a productive life of 8 years. A one-pint clamshell of blackberries weighs 14 ounces.
Pests
Pest control involves many aspects of productionpesticide application is only one. All available practices to reduce the potential for disease and insect problems should be used. Consider site selection, crop rotation, variety selection, the use of tunnels, soil treatment, and planting stock in relation to disease and insect control before you plant. Information on individual diseases and insects is presented below, with cultural controls discussed. Disease control strategies are given in Table 8.12. Pesticide information, including activity groups, efficacy, labeled uses, and restrictions, are presented in tables that follow. Because avoiding buildup of resistant strains of fungi and insects is important, activity groups (for rotational use to avoid buildup of resistant strains) of fungicides and their efficacy on common diseases are presented in Table 8.13, and activity groups and efficacy of insecticides are listed in Table 8.14.
Fungicides, insecticides, and miticides that can be used to assist in management are given in Table 8.15, arranged by various growth stages during the year for the crop. Pests are listed at the stages where they are most likely to be problematic or when treatment is most effective. Information in Table 8.15 should be supplemented with the reading below. Table 8.16 presents additional restrictions beyond preharvest intervals and reentry intervals that appear on the label. For information on bird and deer control, see the section on vertebrate pests in the blueberry chapter.
184
Symptoms: Yellow masses of spores are noticed primarily on fall fruit of primocane-bearing cultivars, making the fruit unmarketable. Because symptoms on the fruit do not usually develop until late in the season, infections in plantings of summer-bearing cultivars may go unnoticed. Powdery, yellow spores also form on the undersides of leaves, causing badly infected leaves to drop prematurely. Causal Agent: Several species of late leaf rust fungi are present worldwide. In our region, Pucciniastrum americanum is believed to be the causal agent. Epidemiology: Late leaf rust infects red and purple raspberries but not black raspberries or blackberries. Late leaf rust, unlike orange rust, is not systemic. White spruce and Engelmann spruce serve as alternate hosts, and their closeness to a planting may increase the likelihood of occurrence. Spores are produced on infected spruce needles in early summer and can infect raspberries. High humidity is necessary for infection to take place. If the infection spreads, the raspberries will show symptoms shortly afterward. However, spruce are not thought to be necessary for the rust to survive in a planting once infected since this disease has occurred in successive years in plantings with no spruce in the vicinity. Spores are disseminated by wind but may also be physically moved from infected to uninfected plantings by people or machinery. Controls: Clean nursery stock is important since planting stock can be the initial source of inoculum. Control is aided by cultural practices that increase air circulation within the planting, such as thinning canes, keeping rows narrow, and practicing good weed control. Removing floricanes and infected primocanes in winter will reduce the amount of inoculum. This disease has been especially problematic on summer-bearing Festival and fall-bearing Heritage and Jaclyn. Josephine fall-bearing and Nova and Esta June-to-July-bearing red raspberries tend to be resistant. Plants grown yearlong in a tunnel have a very low amount of rust occurrence compared to outdoor grown plants. Because this fungus is not sys-
temic, eliminating the disease from plants is possible. See Table 8.15 for recommended fungicides.
of spore forms on these newly infected leaves that infects buds and growth at the base of new shoots in August and September and travels into the roots. The fruiting bodies for these spores are not visible. Newly infected plants dont show symptoms until the following spring when the shoots arising from these newly infected roots show characteristic symptoms. Orange rust is favored by cool, wet conditions. Disease development is greatly reduced when the temperature is above 80F. Controls: Start with disease-free nursery stock. Inspect all plants in the spring for symptoms of infection. As soon as symptoms are visible, remove the entire plant. Ideally, plants should be removed at the time when spindly growth is seen, rather than waiting until orange pustules are seen, because infection of nearby plants has already begun to take place by the time the pustules are noticeable. If orange pustules are noted, infected plants should be removed and the planting should be monitored for areas with spindly, lightgreen growth the following spring with additional plants removed at that point. Any practice that speeds the drying of foliage, such as keeping plantings weeded and rows narrowed back, will assist in control since spores need a relatively long period of leaf wetness in order to be able to germinate and penetrate the leaves in the spring. Avoid tipping canes in the fall since transporting inoculum on hands is easy during this operation. Remove and destroy all wild blackberries and raspberries in the area that may serve as a source of disease. Some blackberries, specifically Eldorado, Raven, and Ebony King, are reported to exhibit resistance. Recommended fungicides should be applied from the time that orange pustules are first seen until the leaves on which they were produced die and dry up, and then again during late summer or fall when temperatures cool. See Table 8.15 for fungicides. All effective fungicides are at risk for resistance development, so unnecessary use should be avoided and fungicides of different classes should be rotated.
Anthracnose
Symptoms: The symptoms of infection can be found on all plant parts, including canes, leaves, petioles, flowers, and fruit.
185
Chapter 8: Brambles
In late spring the primocanes will have small, purplish, slightly raised spots. As the disease progresses, the spots enlarge. The center of the lesion (referred to as a pit lesion) becomes sunken and cracked. Infections that occur later in the season cause gray bark lesions, which are grayish white and more superficial. Gray bark is apparent on the current seasons shoots by fall or winter. On red raspberry canes, pit lesions tend to be less numerous and smaller than on black raspberries. With many individual lesions, the disease can be severe enough to girdle and kill canes. Lesions like those formed on the canes may also form on petioles. Leaf lesions start out as small, purple spots, which may turn white in the center, and eventually become shot holed. Flower parts can be infected, but the lesions are not easily seen. Fruit infection is not common, except with high levels of inoculum (spores). Infected fruits wither while still green, or individual drupelets shrink and turn brown. In severe infections, fruit is typically dry and seedy. Most economic loss results from defoliation, reduction in fruit size and quality, and death of canes, either directly from the disease or from winter injury. Causal Agent: The fungus Elsinoe veneta. Epidemiology: Black and purple raspberries are more susceptible than red raspberries. The fungus overwinters on canes infected the previous season. Inoculum is produced in the spring from fungal hyphae in both gray bark lesions and pit lesions and is washed by rain to the plants crown. Here, new shoots are infected as they emerge among old, diseased canes. Infection of new canes and leaves can continue through the summer. During rainy periods in late spring, spores are also produced that are shot from the fruiting bodies into the air and carried by wind to other bramble plants where new infections become established. Fruiting bodies develop on the new lesions as the season progresses, but spores do not mature until the following spring. Young and succulent growth is most subject to infection. Controls: Infections that take place early in the growing season cause the most
damage, so controls should be instituted early in the season. Anthracnose can be managed by sanitation and spraying. A dormant to delayed-dormant application of lime sulfur is the most effective method of reducing the incidence of this disease. Sanitation is a labor-intensive but effective tactic for a long-term management strategy. Planting clean, diseasefree nursery stock is also important. Cut off cane handles and any infections observed on new plants after planting. Since the spores that infect new shoots come from lesions on the previous years canes, diseased canes must be cut out as close to the ground as possible immediately after harvest when anthracnose is present. Weeds and weak spindly canes should be eliminated to improve air movement since moisture provides favorable conditions for spore germination and infection. All noncultivated brambles in the vicinity should be removed to eliminate outside sources of infection. Refer to Table 8.15 for fungicide recommendations. Fungicides used for anthracnose control should be concentrated on protecting new, emerging canes.
airflow should help. Floricanes should be removed soon after harvest, though it is unclear whether this practice helps with this particular disease. There appear to be variations in cultivar susceptibility, but whether this is due to disease susceptibility or winter injury susceptibility is unknown. Operations that employ a regular fungicide schedule seem to have a lower incidence of problems than lowspray or no-spray operations.
Cane Blight
Symptoms: Lesions start out a chocolate brown color on the stem of blackberry cultivars, often surrounded by a scarlet red area. Lesions do not appear until the spring, at first near a bud, and they then rapidly enlarge, commonly reaching 6 to 8 inches long by full bloom, sometimes larger. The lesions may girdle and kill the entire cane, killing it and causing a light gray surface to develop on the oldest portions of the lesion. Causal Agent: The fungus Gnomonia rubi. Epidemiology: Very little is known about the epidemiology of this disease, but there seems to be a strong relationship between winter injury and disease development. In roses, which are affected by the same species of fungus, canes weakened by severe winters are also more susceptible. Controls: Because little is known about the life cycle of this fungus, it is difficult to pinpoint an optimum time when various practices should be employed. However, any practices that maximize
Symptoms: Failure of buds to beak in the spring, wilting of lateral shoots, or death of fruiting canes, usually when fruit begins to ripen. Canes are usually brittle at the point of infection and may break if bent. On raspberry primocanes, a brown stripe can be found under the epidermis near a wound, but the epidermis needs to be scraped off for this to be visible. On blackberry primocanes, lesions are dark-red to purple areas around wounds, with the lesion center becoming grayish. Symptoms also appear late in the season on new shoots where plants are tipped. Infected areas are at first brownish purple and develop from the cut ends. Laterals originating in the infected areas wilt and die. Weakened canes are more susceptible to winter injury. By spring, the epidermis develops a silver color. Causal Agent: The fungus Leptosphaeria coniothyrium. Epidemiology: Black raspberries are more susceptible to cane blight than other brambles. The fungus overwinters on dead canes, and it is here that inoculum is produced in the spring. Old stubs can continue to produce inoculum for several years. Infection continues to occur in late spring or summer through wounds made by pruning or insects or through sites of injury from cane abrasion or spines. Spores are spread by splashing rain, wind, and insects. Controls: Any practice that improves foliage drying, such as keeping rows narrow and weeded. Prune out and dispose of old canes promptly after harvest (see the section on pruning). Time pruning and tipping so that cuts have 3 days to dry before a rain. Fungicide coverage should be thorough, especially toward the base of canes. Dormant and delayed-
186
dormant lime sulfur sprays are important. Refer to Table 8.15 for fungicide recommendations.
Causal Agent: The fungi Sphaerulini rubi (raspberry leaf spot) and Septoria rubi (septoria leaf spot). Epidemiology: These two fungi, though specific to raspberries and blackberries respectively, behave similarly. Both overwinter in dead leaves and infect new growth primarily in the spring, though infection can continue to take place during rainy spells when susceptible tissue is present. Controls: Any management practices that improve canopy drying are beneficial. Few fungicides are labeled for either disease. However, fungicides specifically applied for leaf spots are not normally necessary since most materials applied for other diseases, especially botrytis, usually give sufficient control.
Spur Blight
last season, begin fungicide sprays in mid-June and continue applications at 14-day intervals. Three to four applications may be required.
Symptoms: In late spring or early summer, chocolate-brown, dark-blue, or purplish spots or bands appear on new canes and petioles, usually on the lower half of the plant. These lesions enlarge until the cane is girdled. By late summer, canes may crack and split lengthwise, revealing reproductive, pimplelike, black fruiting structures of the fungus. Cane symptoms become less obvious in the fall. Symptoms on leaves occur as chocolate-brown, V-shaped areas with yellow margins with the wide area at the leaf edge. Damage from winter injury may be increased. Yield may be reduced as a result of the withering and eventual death of infected laterals. Causal Agent: The fungus Didymella applanata. Epidemiology: Red and purple raspberries are more severely affected than other brambles. Blackberries appear to be immune. The fungus overwinters in infected canes. The following spring, spores are discharged into the air or may ooze to the surface of the stem during wet periods from May to August. Infection can continue to take place through the growing season. Controls: Suggested controls are the same as for cane blight, botrytis blight, and anthracnose. Thorough pruning that includes the removal of pruned canes from the planting is helpful. Lime sulfur and sanitation are useful, and keeping row width narrow to increase air movement is particularly effective. Studies in areas outside of the Mid-Atlantic suggest that a moderate amount of spur blight is tolerable without reduction in yield. Producing only the fall crop on primocane bearers has greatly reduced the incidence of the disease. Several fungicides can be used during the season.
Powdery Mildew
Symptoms: The characteristic sign of this disease is a white, powdery growth, primarily on the undersides of leaves. Infected leaves are dwarfed and twisted and appear yellow on their upper surfaces. Causal Agent: The fungus Sphaerotheca macularis. Epidemiology: The fungus overwinters in infected cane tips and dormant buds. When temperatures reach 50 to 60F, spores are discharged and spread by wind. Powdery mildew is favored by warm weather without rainfall, so tunnel culture is conducive to powdery mildew. It is most serious in years and in plantings where there is poor air circulation. Blackberries are seldom severely infected by powdery mildew. However, powdery mildew is occasionally a serious problem for red and black raspberries, especially the Latham and Black Hawk varieties. Controls: Unlike with most fungi, free water will reduce the incidence of this disease. Whether this effect, higher humidity, or an effect of tunnels on reducing cuticle thickness (by reducing water stress) contributes to additional mildew incidence in tunnels is not known. Apply fungicide sprays (see Table 8.15) when symptoms first appear, usually from midsummer through fall. In black raspberries, if powdery mildew was severe
Symptoms: Circular to angular spots on leaves. The center will usually develop a whitish center and may drop out, creating a shot-hole effect.
187
Chapter 8: Brambles
root rot are good soil drainage, the use of raised beds, and proper cultivar selection. All brambles should be planted in well-drained soilat no time should water be standing in the field or in a tunnel. If well-drained soil is not available, planting on raised beds will minimize exposure to saturated soil conditions. Highly susceptible cultivars include Hilton, Ruby, and Titan. Canby, Cumberland, Festival, K81-6, Munger, Reveille, and Taylor also appear to be very susceptible and should be avoided when planting on ground known to contain this pathogen. Tolerant/resistant red or gold raspberry cultivars such as Anne, Boyne, Caroline, Killarney, Latham, Newburgh, and Prelude and are the least susceptible and the safest choices if berries are to be planted on marginal sites. Black raspberries Bristol, Dundee, and Jewel are relatively resistant, but not completely. The purple raspberry cultivars Brandywine and Royalty are susceptible under greenhouse testing but display some degree of field tolerance. Ridomil fungicide can be used as a soil drench for raspberries (see Table 8.15) in fall and/or early spring, although Ridomil use cannot make up for poor site selection. Repeated use is also likely to result in the development of resistant strains of the fungus. Aliette is absorbed through the leaves and is labeled for phytophthora control as are Phostrol and similar materials. Phostrol is a salt of phosphorous acid, may stimulate the plants defense system, and has a zeroday preharvest interval.
and become more susceptible to winter injury. The plants may show water stress and nutrient deficiency symptoms as the movement of water and nutrients throughout the plant is disrupted. With cane gall, black and purple raspberries are more often infected than red raspberries and blackberries. Causal Agent: Soilborne bacteria Agrobacterium tumifaciens (crown gall) and Agrobacterium rubi (cane gall). Epidemiology: Plants are infected only through wounds. The bacteria overwinter in the soil and galls and are spread by splashing rain, running water, cultivation, and pruning. The bacteria can survive in galls for years, so soil containing galls can remain infested for many years. Controls: The best control measure is prevention. Plant only certified, diseasefree nursery stock and take care not to wound plants, especially the root system, at planting. Titan seems to be especially susceptible, as do some of its relatives. Plant only in sites with no history of the diseases, or wait at least 3 to 5 years before replanting in the site. If a diseased plant is detected, remove and burn the roots and tops of the plant and dispose of the soil surrounding the roots. No chemical control is known. Fumigation is not effective.
Causal Agent: Two species of fungi are implicated: Verticillium albo-atrum and Verticillium dahliae. Epidemiology: Black raspberries and susceptible cultivars of blackberries are most severely affected, though red raspberries also can be affected. This common soilborne fungus has a wide host range and attacks more than 300 woody and herbaceous plants. It can exist in the soil prior to planting, may be brought in on planting stock, or may move in on windblown soil. The fungus survives either in plant debris or free in the soil. The fungus enters the roots and moves into the vascular system, causing a systemic infection. After the plant or plant portions die, the fungus continues to survive in the soil. Controls: Chloropicrin-based fumigants can be used prior to planting (refer to Chapter 3); however, no effective fungicides exist for management once the plants are in the ground. The use of competitive fungi as a plant dip or soil drench is being investigated, but no conclusive results are yet available. Choose a planting site with no known history of this problem. Avoid land recently planted with tomatoes, potatoes, eggplant, peppers, strawberries, raspberries, or stone fruits and land infested with horsenettle, ground cherry, red-root pigweed, nightshade, and lambsquarters. The number of years required to eliminate verticillium from the soil is unknown. In spite of this, planting with verticillium-free black raspberry stock on uninfested soil usually ensures many years of avoidance of this disease.
Verticillium Wilt
Symptoms: Spongy, rough, tumorlike swellings that resemble callus growth at first, but then become brown and woody with age. The growths range in size from that of a pinhead to that of a golf ball. Crown galls develop in the spring on the underground plant parts, the roots, and the crown. Cane galls develop as whitish eruptions on the fruiting canes in midJune. More intense gall formation seems to occur in years with higher incidence of winter injury. These eruptions later turn brown and then black and begin to disintegrate. The diseases cause dry, seedy berries to be produced and can stunt or prevent cane formation. Weakened canes are easily broken by wind
Symptoms: Symptoms become obvious by June or early July. Shoots are stunted and leaves, starting at the base of the infected plant, turn yellow, wilt, and drop. Soon the entire shoot withers and dies. Black raspberry canes may show a blue or purple streak from the soil line extending upward. This purple streak is not detectable on red raspberry canes. Fruiting canes infected the previous year either die in the spring or the new leaves at the base of the cane may be yellow and stunted. If canes die before reaching maturity, fruit becomes mummified. Verticillium is favored by cool weather and is most severe in poorly drained soils following a cool, wet spring. Most blackberry plants and red raspberry plants are less severely affected than black raspberries.
viRuses
Virus infections lower productivity and fruit quality and reduce the productive life of a raspberry planting. Virus diseases are widespread in our plantings and are easily spread. No cure for viruses existsonce a plant is infected, the entire plant is diseased for the remainder of its life. Therefore, it is important to start a raspberry planting with healthy plant stock from a reputable nursery and take steps to reduce the spread of any viruses in the field. If virus-indexed negative, i.e., clean, plants are established in a field, viruses
188
can move to raspberry bushes only by means of a vector. The vectors responsible for spreading viruses are pollen, aphids, nematodes, and possibly leafhoppers and whitefly. Thus, the control of virus diseases is based on preventing the infection of clean stock by removing virus reservoirs such as wild brambles and broadleaf weeds, and by controlling the vectors. If a planting shows virus symptoms during the same season it was planted, the planting stock was probably infected at the time of planting. After its first winter or after its first flowering, however, entire plantings can be infected by infected pollen from wild plants or from neighboring infected cultivars. Only ELISA testing, PCR-based testing, or mechanical or graft inoculation of indicator plants can indicate whether a virus is present in a plant. Even with testing, obtaining false negatives (i.e., test results indicating no virus is present when plants are in fact infected) is possible since viral content is not evenly distributed within the plant and is much lower in hotter weather. Consequently, sampling the correct plant part (usually shoot tips or young leaves) in the spring or fall may increase the chances of detecting the virus. Symptoms are not proof of virus content nor are they reliable for identification of a virus. Herbicides, winter injury, zinc or boron deficiencies, genetic maladies, fungi (mildew), and poor care or management can mimic viral symptoms.
Epidemiology: Plants are infected when pollen is transferred by pollinators or wind from infected plants, such as those found in the wild, to flowering plantings. New plantings located near infected plants frequently become infected within two or three flowering seasons. This is the most common bramble virus in the Mid-Atlantic region. Controls: Because this virus is pollen vectored, management is especially difficult. Wild brambles in the vicinity should be eliminated, but because pollinators can travel long distances, eliminating enough plants to eliminate the virus may not always be possible. Esta and Heritage seem to be resistant to this virus.
Canes are more commonly stunted, and this virus will eventually render a planting unproductive. Fruit is commonly crumbly and small, as with other viruses that affect pollen viability. Epidemiology: Tomato ringspot virus is very common in the Mid-Atlantic region. It is vectored by dagger nematodes (Xiphinema spp.) and possibly pollen. This virus has a wide host range, including many weeds such as dandelion and chickweed and other fruit crops including strawberries, blueberries, apples, and peaches. Seeds of chickweed and dandelion can be infected, and plants developing from these seeds can serve as sources of infection if spread throughout or into the field. Controls: Prior to planting, fields should be tested for the presence of dagger nematodes. If test results indicate that a high enough population to warrant management exists, the field should be fumigated, the protocol for management of dagger nematodes with green manure crops should be followed (see Chapter 2 and Appendix A), or the field should be kept free of possible hosts plants for a period of 18 months. Planting stock that is free of tomato ringspot virus should be used, along with roguing of infected plants and their neighbors, which may be symptomless. Weeds should be controlled. Yield and fruit quality in the cultivar Canby appear to be relatively unaffected even when the plants are infected.
189
Chapter 8: Brambles
the virus and show no symptoms. Several viruses that affect only Rubus are involved and, when present in combination, result in more severe symptoms. Epidemiology: The mosaic virus complex overwinters in infected plants and is spread by aphids. Feeding time needed to transmit viruses in the complex is only a few minutes. Controls: The standard practices of establishing plants as far as possible from wild or older populations of brambles and using planting stock propagated from virus-free plants are useful. Controlling aphids may assist in slowing the spread of viruses within the planting; however, because the viruses are transmitted very quickly, it is unlikely that transmission can be thwarted. Of purple and black raspberries, Black Hawk, Bristol, and New Logan are tolerant; Cumberland is very susceptible. Canby, Reveille, and Titan red raspberries are reportedly resistant because aphid vectors avoid them; most other red raspberry varieties are susceptible. Aphid vectors also avoid Royalty.
Aphid control is important in reducing the secondary spread of the virus. To reduce the virus problem: 1. Eliminate virus-infected wild and cultivated raspberries. One aspect to remember is that not all viruses show symptoms, and healthy-looking plants may still harbor virusesa reason to remove wild brambles. 2. Plant raspberries certified to be virus free and use proper fertilization, pruning, and irrigation practices. Certified virus-free stock remains infection free for at least 2 years after planting, if well isolated and well managed, and produces larger crops on healthy, vigorous plants. However, the local spread of viruses after planting must be maintained at low levels. This means roguing infected plants and controlling aphid vectors. 3. Control aphids with insecticides and by conserving natural enemies. 4. Use aphid-resistant varieties. For instance, the varieties Canby, Royalty, and Titan are immune or resistant to two aphid species. 5. Check virus susceptibility information of raspberry types and cultivars in the above virus descriptions. Use varieties that are virus resistant. 6. Maintain 500 to 1,000 feet between new plantings and potentially virus-infected wild and cultivated raspberries.
nemaTodes
Two types of nematodes cause concern in Mid-Atlantic region bramble plantings: dagger nematodes (Xiphinema spp.) and root-lesion nematodes (Pratylenchus penetrans). Dagger nematodes are efficient vectors of tomato ringspot virus (see above). Because they are virus vectors, a low tolerance exists for this type of nematode. Root-lesion nematodes cause symptoms that contribute to a lack of winter-hardiness. The symptoms of their damage can be confused with those of root rots. In early stages, small, elongate lesions appear on new roots. Eventually, fine feeder roots are killed, leaving only large-diameter roots. Above ground, the number of canes is reduced, vigor
190
is lessened, and winter injury appears to increase. Symptoms may occur in patches. Sampling should be done from both poor and good areas to determine if nematodes are at high enough levels to cause a problem, as nematodes are likely to exist in many fields (see Chapter 1 for more information). Nematode populations may take a number of years to increase to the point where symptoms are apparent and another 2 to 3 years before canes begin to die out. Rootlesion nematodes have a very wide host range, so rotations are of limited use in controlling them. Preplant fumigation is the chemical option for controlling either type of nematode. See Chapter 3 for more information on fumigation.
cane tips, weakened canes, and deformed fruit. Any insect or plant damage that is unrecognizable and significant in numbers or extent should be collected and brought to the county extension office for identification.
necessary, apply when more than 20 to 25 plant bug nymphs per 50 flower clusters are found. Pay particular attention to field borders.
fruit feeders
Tarnished Plant Bugs, Lygus lineolaris (Heteroptera: Miridae)
Symptoms of Damage: Feeding on buds and immature berries causes deformed berries. Identification: Adult tarnished plant bugs are about inch long and coppery brown with a yellow-tipped, triangular area on the back (see Figure 6.4). The nymphs are smaller and bright green. Several generations of this insect develop each year using various host plants. Life Cycle: Plant bugs, especially tarnished plant bugs but also including stink bugs and others, are generalist plant pests, feeding on a variety of crop and noncrop species. Tarnished plant bugs appear when fruit buds form and plants begin to bloom. Plant bugs are more serious in small fields bordered by woods and fencerows, where weeds are plentiful. Monitoring and Controls: Deformed berries can have a variety of causes, and being able to diagnose the causes of the various deformities is important. Raspberry fruits are clusters of drupelets attached to a central receptacle. Each drupelet is made up of a hard seed and a sugary, soft, fleshy portion. If the fruit appears abnormally small, then problems of fertility, plant vigor, or soil moisture should be suspected. If the fruit is of normal size but has abnormally few drupelets with no deformed drupelets, then poor pollination should be suspected, which can have several causes. However, if abnormally few fully developed drupelets are present and the remaining drupelets are shriveled and seedlike, then plant bug feeding should be suspected. Mowing nearby forage crops or alfalfa during the bramble flowering and fruit-setting stages encourages the movement of tarnished plant bugs into blackberry and raspberry plantings. Weeds, especially red sorrel, also harbor plant bugs. If an insecticide treatment is
191
Chapter 8: Brambles
flower stems, and bases of petals, pistils, and anther filaments. Identification: Thrips are tiny insect pests of various horticultural and ornamental crops. Adult thrips are very smallless than 2 millimeters in lengthand usually yellow tan to dark brown with four featherlike wings. Young thrips are smaller, wingless, yellowish, and active. Life Cycle: Thrips breed on grasses, weeds, and various flowering species and then move to brambles at blooming time. They insert their eggs in plant tissue at the base of flowers and in tender, new foliage. Monitoring and Controls: Under normal conditions, thrips predators such as lady beetles, mites, and spiders should provide adequate control. Under very heavy pressure, an insecticide application may be necessary, but sprays must be timed to avoid injury to pollinators.
Monitoring and Controls: The adult beetles are active mainly during early evening hours. They are more of a problem on early red raspberry varieties, but they may also attack other bramble types. This pest is reportedly more of a problem in weedy fields. Cultivating plant rows during the late season will reduce larval and pupal population in the soil. If long holes on leaves are visible, giving them a tattered appearance, fruit should be checked for larvae. If this pest is a significant problem, insecticides should be applied before eggs are depositedwhen blossom buds separate and again just before blossoms open.
work on Japanese beetle appear to be fairly effective for green June beetles. These beetles appear to be more problematic than in the past.
actual length
(1 inch)
192
eggs singly on the undersides of leaf edges. When the eggs hatch (September to November) the young borers crawl down the canes and enter the soil near the crown to overwinter. In late April of the following spring, the larvae enter the canes near the base and remain in the crown area, feeding until midsummer of their second year. They then pupate and emerge as adults in late summer. Monitoring and Controls: Plantings near wild bramble populations have been extensively damaged since crown borer populations frequently build in wild raspberry and blackberry patches. Therefore, the first step in management is removing nearby wild sources of this pest, as well as removing infested plants within the planting. An insecticidal soil drench may be used if necessary. Controlling this pest may take more than 2 years because of its long life cycle.
next growing season and spend their second winter in the crown near or below ground level. The following spring, they pupate and then emerge as adults. Monitoring and Controls: Remove wilted tips several inches below punctures by midsummer. Check for hollowed-out centers and make cuts farther down the cane, if needed. Remove and destroy older canes whenever observed. Destroy any wild brambles nearby. Insecticide applications made just before blossoms begin to open will have some efficacy against raspberry cane borers.
from the cane as adults in late spring and early summer by chewing a D-shaped hole through the cane. Monitoring and Controls: This insect is usually controlled by cutting out and removing infested canes with swellings from late fall to early spring. A prebloom spray and/or postharvest sprays may be considered when populations are heavy.
foliage feeders
Most leaf-feeding insects of raspberries can be tolerated to some degree. Monitoring for these insects is straightforward and, if done diligently, problems can be treated well before they become serious. Many years, one or more leaf-feeding insects may occur in low numbers or not
193
Chapter 8: Brambles
actual length
( inch)
plant species). The last winged female generation of the season flies back to the primary host species. In the fall, wingless males and egg-laying females are produced and mated; eggs are laid on the primary host. All stages except the egg in the aphid life cycle can transmit virus. The minimum feeding time necessary for aphids to pick up a virus from infected plants is about 15 to 30 minutes. Aphids can retain the virus for several hours and are very efficient in transmitting it from plant to planta single feeding probe by a single aphid lasting a few minutes is enough to transmit a virus. Monitoring and Controls: Monitor plantings starting when aphid eggs hatch (approximately May), and begin a spray program when aphids are spotted. Look for aphids on new growth and on the undersides of leaves. To reduce within-field spread of viruses, apply an insecticide if more than two aphids per cane tip are detected. Other insects such as ladybird beetles can devour great numbers of aphids. These beneficial insects should be conserved by using insecticides only when necessary and by using recommended rates. See additional information on aphids in the discussion of virus transmittal.
and migrate to conifers to overwinter shortly thereafter. Monitoring and Controls: Monitor plants at the field edge weekly, especially edges near woods and fence rows. Insecticides should be applied when adults first appear. Inspect curled leaf clusters for nymphs. If nymphs are not found, inspect additional leaf clusters since symptoms remain even when the nymph has moved to a new location. Curled leaf clusters should be removed and destroyed immediately. Avoid planting within 250 yards of conifers.
194
reinfest plantings. Therefore, inspecting plantings weekly is recommended from harvest onward. Japanese beetle larvae feed on sod planted in row middles. This should be considered in developing a soil and weed management plan. However, this source of adults is minor compared with neighboring fields if pasture is adjacent to the planting. Entomopathogenic nematodes are effective for larvae but have a limited shelf life and must be applied strictly according to directions.
color. Red raspberry varieties are the most commonly affected. Predatory mites, lady beetles, or lacewings can naturally control mite populations in the field, but insecticides applied for other pests can accelerate mite problems. Predatory mite releases and miticides that target eggs and nymphs are effective only if used when the twospotted mite population is low. Chemicals that kill beneficial predators of mites often do not kill twospotted mites themselves. Since little is available at present for chemical control of mites on brambles, preserving natural enemies is especially important. Learning to identify predatory species to determine whether they are present is worthwhile (see Appendix E for sources of information). When applying miticides, thorough coverage is a must, so use plenty of water (at least 100 gallons per acre) and high enough pressure to treat the undersides of the leaves. Treat with a miticide if a sharp population increase is noted or leaf stippling appears. Resistance to miticides can develop quickly, so they should not be used unnecessarily. When used, make two applications 7 to 10 days apart; the first to target the adults, and the second to reach newly hatched mites that were protected as eggs during the first spray. Populations isolated within a field may be spot treated. The insecticidal soap M-Pede will only suppress mite populations. Multiple applications of M-Pede may be necessary to reduce the mite population.
where they are most often found on the underside. The adults (see Figure 6.7) fly quickly when disturbed. Life Cycle: Potato leafhoppers are a pest of many crops. Potato leafhoppers overwinter as adults in southern states and move northward mainly by the action of storm fronts. The pests movement and severity depend on many weatherrelated phenomena and the availability and proximity of alternate food sources. Therefore, the seriousness of this pest is sporadic in northern parts of the region (Pennsylvania and West Virginia) and is common in more southern states. Monitoring and Controls: Brambles planted near other hosts of the potato leafhopper, such as alfalfa, are much more readily invaded by this pest. Thus, brambles at the edge of a planting near the alternate host will show damage first. Increased pressure from leafhoppers on brambles may be observed after the surrounding vegetation has been harvested or mowed. Apply an insecticide if leafhoppers become a problem. Josephine red raspberry tends to be resistant to leafhopper damage.
195
Chapter 8: Brambles
physiological disorders
Though physiological disorders are not caused by any pest, they are discussed in this section since their symptoms could be mistaken for those that might be caused by a disease or insect.
Sunscald
Red and yellow raspberries have a tendency to develop white (colorless) drupelets on the fruits as a result of exposure to high heat and natural UV radiation. In the southern Mid-Atlantic region, most of this damage can be traced back to clear or partly cloudy
summer days when temperatures reach the high 90s or even exceed 100F. Information developed in California suggests that thorough watering the night before each anticipated high-heat day aids natural transpirational cooling of the fruit and fruiting canopy. This practice will reduce most radiation and/or high-temperature damage. Watering during the day of the heat episode or later that evening has little effect in reducing this type of damage. Using a lightweight shade cloth may also aid in minimizing damage. Heritage and yellow sports of Heritage seem especially susceptible.
a. Viruses: See text for descriptions. b. Cane blights for purposes of this table include anthracnose, cane blight, spur blight, and botrytis blight. c. Rotation is effective for ringspot virus only: two years of a grass crop (e.g., corn) with excellent weed control before planting red raspberry should eliminate need to fumigate for Xiphinema nematode vector. d. Rotation for verticillium wilt: Avoid fields planted to susceptible crops (tomatoes, potatoes, eggplant, peppers, strawberries, raspberries, and stone fruit) within the past five years. Avoid fields with a history of verticillium wilt unless soil is fumigated. e. Virus resistance, tolerance, and immunity: Mosaicblackberries are not affected; black and purple raspberries are more severely affected than red raspberries. Of purple and black raspberries, Black Hawk, Bristol, and New Logan are tolerant; Cumberland is susceptible. Of red raspberries, Canby, Titan, and Reveille are resistant because aphid vectors avoid them. Aphid vectors also avoid Royalty. Leaf curlblackberries are symptomless; all raspberries are affected. Tomato ringspotred raspberries are affected. Streakblack and purple raspberries are affected primarily. Raspberry bushy dwarf-Esta appears immune. f. Verticillium tolerance: Some blackberries are resistant; red raspberries are more tolerant than black raspberries. g. Orange rust resistance: Red raspberries are immune. Other brambles are affected. h. Fungicide program for cane blights: The lime-sulfur spray is most important for anthracnose (delayed dormant) and cane blight (late fall dormant); apply other effective fungicide sprays when blossoms are in bud and again two weeks later to help control anthracnose, botrytis blight, and spur blight on raspberries. Refer to Table 8.15. i. Fungicide program for powdery mildew: Refer to Table 8.15. j. Keep black and purple raspberries away from old plantings of red raspberries because mosaic virus can spread from red raspberries and is more severe on black and purple raspberries; keep all red raspberries away from old plantings of blackberries because blackberries can be a symptomless carrier of curl virus.
196
Table 8.13. activity groups and effectiveness of fungicides for bramble disease control. Not all fungicides listed below are labeled for all the diseases listed. This table is intended to provide information on effectiveness for diseases that appear on the label, plus additional diseases that may be controlled during application. See Table 8.15 for labeled uses.
Fungicide Abound Aliette Cabrio Captan Captevate Elevate Lime sulfur Orbit, Tilt Phostrol Pristine Rally Ridomil Gold Rovral Switch Tanos activity Groupa 11 33 11 M 17+M 17 3 33 7+11 3 4 2 9+12 11 Phytophthora Root Rot 0 +++ 0 0 0 0 0 0 +++ 0 0 +++ 0 0 0 Orange Rust ++ 0 ++ 0 0 0 0 ++ 0 ++ ++ 0 0 0 0 anthracnose + ++ + Spur Blight + ++ ++ Gray Mold + 0 ++ ++ +++ +++ 0 0 0 +++ 0 0 +++ ++
0 = not effective; + = slight effectiveness; ++ = moderate effectiveness; +++ = very effective; = insufficient data a. Chemistry of fungicides by activity groups: 2 = dicarboximides; 3 = demethylation inhibitors (includes triazoles); 4 = acylalanines; 7 = carboxamides; 9 = anilinopyrimidines; 11 = strobilurins; 12 = phenylpyrroles; 17 = hydroxyanilides; 33 = unknown (phosphonates); M = chemical groups with multisite activity. Fungicides with two activity groups listed contain active ingredients from two activity groups.
Table 8.14. activity groups and effectiveness of insecticides and miticides on bramble pests. Not all insecticides listed below are labeled for all the insects listed. This table is intended to provide information on effectiveness against insects that appear on the label, plus additional insects that may be controlled during application. See Table 8.15 for labeled uses.
Pesticide Acramite Actara Admire Asana Assail Aza-Direct Brigade Confirm Delegate Dipel Intrepid Malathion M-Pede Mustang Max Provado Pyganic Savey Sevin Spintor, Entrust, Success activity Groupa 25 4A 4A 3 4A 18 3 18 5 11 18 1B 3 4A 3 10 1A 5 aphids +++ +++ ++ ++ +++ +++ +++ + Leafhoppers +++ +++ ++ ++ ++ +++ ++ Spider Mites +++ ++ + + +++c Japanese Beetle adults 0 ++ ++ ++ ++ + 0 0 + ++ +++ + 0 +++ 0 Tarnished Plant Bugs ++b ++ +++ ++ Sap Beetles 0 + +++ + ++ Thrips + ++ ++ +++ +++
0 = not effective; + = slight effectiveness; ++ = moderate effectiveness; +++ = very effective, indicates that insufficient data exists to rank effectiveness of this insecticide or miticide on these pests a. Chemistry of insecticides by activity groups: 1A = carbamates; 1B = organophosphates; 3 = pyrethrins and synthetic pyrethroids; 4A = neonicotinoids; 5 = spinosyns; 10 = mite growth inhibitors with unknown or nonspecific sites of action; 11 = Bt microbials; 18 = ecdysone agonists/molting disruptors; 25 = neuronal inhibitors b. Moderate effect on nymphs, but little or no effect on adults c. Effective on eggs and immatures, but little or no effect on adults.
197
Chapter 8: Brambles
Table 8.15. pesticides for bramble disease and insect control. The recommendations below are correct to the best of our knowledge. Other formulations with the same active ingredient as some of the products listed below may exist and may or may not be labeled for the same uses. Always consult the label before making pesticide applications. Read the text for information on cultural practices to minimize pest incidence. If control cannot be achieved with a particular material, it is possible that resistant populations exist. Use a material in a different activity group, which will have a different mode of action. See Table 3.2 for use status, chemical names of active ingredients in products, and reentry intervals. See Table 3.1 for toxicity to non-target organisms, and Tables 8.13 and 8.14 for activity groups and efficacy ratings to help determine products that best suit your situation. See Table 8.16 for other use restrictions, such as quantity allowable per season. Information was current as of October 1, 2009.
Pest delayed doRmanT Diseases Anthracnose, spur blight, cane blight Anthracnose Insects Scales Cane emeRGenCe Diseases Anthracnose, spur blight Timing of Treatment/Comments Product Labeled Rate/aa (Days to Harvest)
When buds begin to break. This is the most important treatment for these diseases. Prune and remove dead and diseased canes prior to primocane emergence. Specified rates vary by manufacturer. See cautions on Aliette label concerning its use if applied subsequent to a copper compound application. Not a common problem in this region.
Lime sulfur (0), 1012 gal per 100 gal of spray solution, applied at 100160 gal/A Kocide 3000, 0.75 lb (0)
Lime sulfur (0), 8 gal/100 gal of spray solution, applied at 100160 gal/A
When young canes are 810 inches tall and again 2 weeks later. Needed only if diseases are present. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in another chemical class.
Captan 80WDG, 2.5 lb (3), or Pristine, 18.523 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0), or Abound, 6.215.4 fl oz (0), or Tanos, 610 oz (0) plus captan, or Captevate 68 WDG, 3.5 lb (3), raspberries only Fungicides for orange rust will serve no purpose until orange spores are present. However, plantings should be monitored for presence of orange spores starting in midspring. Once found, fungicides listed under Prebloom for orange rust may be used. None expected to be needed at this time. If adults of insects listed under Prebloom are found, insecticides listed under Prebloom may be used.
Orange rust
Inspect plantings when plants are 1218 inches high for symptoms (see text for description). Remove infected plants before orange spores are produced.
Monitor for adults of insects listed under Prebloom. See text for details.
pReBloom (when Blossoms in ClusTeRs sepaRaTe) Diseases Anthracnose, spur blight Sprays for anthracnose and spur blight at this time will also control cane blight. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in another chemical class.
Captan 80WDGb, 2.5 lb (3), or Pristine, 18.523 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0), or Abound, 6.215.4 fl oz (0), or Tanos, 610 oz (0) plus captan, or Captevate 68 WDG, 3.5 lb (3), raspberries only Rally 40W , 1.252.5 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0), or Pristine, 18.523 oz (0)
Orange rust
For orange rust, while orange pustules are visible, on a 10- to 14-day schedule until temperatures are above 75F. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in another chemical class.
continued
198
Table 8.15. pesticides for bramble disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Powdery mildew Timing of Treatment/Comments Sprays for powdery mildew are not usually required but may help on highly susceptible cultivars such as Latham. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in another chemical class. Product Labeled Rate/aa (Days to Harvest) Rally 40W, 1.252.5 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0), or Pristine, 18.523 oz (0), or Abound, 6.215.4 fl oz (0), or Orbit, 6 fl oz (30), or Tilt, 6 fl oz (30) Brigade WSB, 16 oz or 2EC, 6.4 fl oz (3)
As a drench in at least 200 gal of water/A. Direct to lower portion of canes and soil. See text for life cycle information on this pest. Do not make both foliar and drench applications pre-bloom. Inspect tender cane growth and undersides of leaves. Aphids may be easily overlooked. Sprays for aphids will also suppress blackberry psyllid. Do not apply Asana within 7 days of pollination, as it repels bees.
Malathion 57ECb, 3 pt or 8F, 2-4 pt (1), or Asana XL, 4.8-9.6 oz (7), or M-Pede, 2% solution (0), or Actara, 2.03.0 oz (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.02.3 oz or 30SG, 2.55.3 oz (1)
Rednecked caneborer
This is the time when caneborer and fruitworm adults appear to lay their eggs. One spray just before bloom and another one at the end of bloom should help. Direct sprays toward the base of canes where adults are more likely to be present. Materials with a broad label such as Pyganic, Pyrenone, or Evergreen may help. Just before blossoms open to target adults. No materials are specifically labeled for this pest at this time. However, materials with a broad label such as Pyganic, Pyrenone, or Evergreen may help. When first adults are noted. Apply when blossom buds separate and again just before blossoms open. See text for thresholds and cultural controls. Sevin 80S, 2.5 lb or XLR Plus, 2 qt (7), or Spintor 2SC, 46 fl oz (1) Spintor 2SC, 46 fl oz (1), or Delegate WG, 36 oz (1) Sevin 80S, 1.872.5 lb or XLR Plus, 1.52 qt (7), or Assail 70WP, 1.02.3 oz or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1) Assail 70WP, 1.92.3 oz or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1), or Malathion 8Fb, 14 pt or 57ECb, 1.5 pt (1), or Aza-Direct, 1656 fl oz (0)
Raspberry caneborer
Thrips
When adults appear on plants. See text for their description. See note above under Aphids. Materials with a broad label such as Pyganic, Pyrenone, or Evergreen may help, and Surround may provide suppression. Not generally a problem. Needed only if past experience has shown leafrollers to be a problem. Confirm and Dipel are also labeled for gypsy moth control. Do not make both foliar and drench applications of Brigade pre-bloom. Asana XL, 4.89.6 oz (7), or Brigade WSB, 816 oz or 2EC, 3.26.4 fl oz (3), or Confirm 2F, 16 oz (14), or Dipel DF, 0.51.0 lb (0), or Spintor 2SC, 46 oz (1), or M-Pede, 2% solution (0), or Mustang, 4.3 oz (1), or Mustang Max, 4.0 oz (1), or Delegate WG, 36 oz (1)
continued
Leafrollers
199
Chapter 8: Brambles
Table 8.15. pesticides for bramble disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Bloom Diseases Botrytis fruit rot Timing of Treatment/Comments Product Labeled Rate/aa (Days to Harvest)
At 510 percent bloom, full bloom, and up to three more times at intervals specified on the label. Bloom sprays also help control anthracnose and spur blight. Do not make more than two sequential applications of Group 11 fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in a different chemical class.
Rovral 4F, 12 pt (0), or Captan 80WDG, 2.5 lb (3), or Switch 62.5WG, 1114 oz (0), or Elevate 50WDG, 1.5 lb (0), or Pristine, 18.523 oz (0), or Captevate 68WDG, 3.5 lb (3), raspberries only Rally 40W, 1.252.5 oz (0), or Pristine, 18.523 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0) Rally 40W, 1.252.5 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0), or Pristine, 18.523 oz (0), or Abound, 6.215.4 fl oz (0), or Orbit, 6 fl oz (30), or Tilt, 6 fl oz (30)
Orange rust
For orange rust, while orange pustules are visible, on a 10- to 14-day schedule until temperatures are above 75F. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in another chemical class. Specific sprays for powdery mildew are not usually required but may help on highly susceptible cultivars such as Latham raspberries. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in another chemical class.
Powdery mildew
Insects None at this time peTal fall ThRouGh haRvesT Diseases Botrytis fruit rot Three to five days before harvest; repeat at 7- to 10-day intervals through harvest if pressure is high (wet weather, rotting berries on the canes). Resistance development is a concern especially with Rovral and Elevate. Rotate fungicides in different classes.
Rovral 4F, 12 pt (0), or Captan 80WDG, 2.5 lb (3), or Elevate 50WDG, 1.5 lb. (0), or Pristine, 18.523 oz (0), or Switch 62.5WG,1114 oz (0), or Captevate 68WDG, 3.5 lb (3), raspberries only Pristine, 18.523 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0)
Primarily a problem on fall-bearing raspberries. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in another chemical class. If aphids are present. Watch days-to-harvest limitations.
Malathion 8Fb, 24 pt or 57ECb, 3 pt (1), or Asana XL, 4.89.6 oz (7), or M-Pede, 12% solution (0), or Provado 1.6F, 8.0 fl oz (3), or Actara, 2.03.0 oz (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.02.3 oz or 30SG 4.55.3 oz (1), or Admire Pro, 7.014.0 fl oz (7) Assail 70WP, 1.92.3 oz or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1), or Malathion 57ECb, 1.52.0 pt (1), raspberries only
continued
Admire is applied to the soil. Sap beetles Only if needed. Avoiding a buildup of overripe fruit is the best deterrent. Sap beetles are listed on the Malathion 57EC label for raspberries but not blackberries, presumably because sap beetles are typically a greater pest on raspberries.
200
Table 8.15. pesticides for bramble disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Tarnished plant bugs Timing of Treatment/Comments See text for thresholds and cultural controls. Product Labeled Rate/aa (Days to Harvest) Assail 70WP, 1.92.3 oz or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1), or Sevin 80S, 1.872.5 lb or XLR Plus, 1.52 qt (7), or Actara, 3.0 oz (3) Admire Pro, 10.514.0 fl oz/a (7)
Rednecked caneborer
When adults are observed. Admire Pro is systemic within the plant. It appears in recommendations at this timing, but not prebloom, to avoid possible residual effects on pollinators. Note days-to-harvest limitation. As needed. Note long days-to-harvest limitations on some products.
Leafhoppers
Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb or XLR Plus, 1.02.0 qt (7), or Malathion 8Fb, 1.04.0 pt or 57 ECb, 1.5 pt (1), or Provado 1.6F, 8.0 fl oz (3), or Actara, 2.03.0 oz (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.02.3 oz or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1), or Admire Pro, 7.014.0 fl oz (7) Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb or XLR Plus, 1.02.0 qt (7), or Malathion 8Fb, 1.04.0 pt or 57 ECb, 1.5 pt (1), or Actara, 3.0 oz (3), or Assail 70WP, 1.92.3 oz or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1) Sevin 80S, 2.5 lb or XLR Plus, 2.0 qt (7)
Admire is applied to the soil. Japanese beetles As needed. Note long days-to-harvest limitations on some products.
Materials effective against Japanese beetles are typically effective for green June beetles. Sevin is the only material currently labeled for June beetles, but the long days-to-harvest limitation is problematic since green June beetles are mainly a problem on ripe fruit. Use of Sevin can also encourage spider mite outbreaks. If presence is problematic.
Thrips
Assail 70WP, 1.92.3 oz or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1), or Provado 1.6F, 8.0 fl oz (3), or Malathion 8Fb, 14 pt or 57ECb, 1.5 pt (1), or Aza-Direct, 1656 fl oz (0) Acramite 50 WS, 0.751.0 lb (1). One application per year allowed, or Savey 50WP, 46 oz (3). One application per year allowed, or Brigade WSB, 16 oz or 2 EC, 6.4 fl oz (3), or Stylet oil, 36 qt/100 gal (0)
Spider mites
Savey is effective only against immatures. Both Acramite and Savey are fairly safe to beneficial predatory mites. Application must be made while mite populations are low. Brigade and Capture are effective only at high rates and may increase the likelihood of spider mite population explosions by destroying predatory mites. Insecticidal soaps such as M-Pede may offer some benefit in mite control. Stylet oil is effective against mite eggs.
Late summer through frost. A second infection period occurs at this time. See text for discussion. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in another chemical class. In the fall after old canes are removed. For resistance management, do not make more than two sequential applications of strobilurin (group 11) fungicides before rotating to a fungicide in another chemical class.
Rally 40W, 1.252.5 oz (0), or Pristine, 18.523 oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0) Captan 80WDG, 2.5 lb (3), or Pristine, 18.523 oz (0), or Abound, 6.215.4 fl oz (0), or Cabrio EG, 14 oz (0), or Tanos, 610 oz (0) plus captan, or Captevate 68WDG, 3.5 lb (3), raspberries only
continued
Anthracnose
201
Chapter 8: Brambles
Table 8.15. pesticides for bramble disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Insects and Mites Japanese beetles Timing of Treatment/Comments Whenever beetles are causing significant damage. Product Labeled Rate/aa (Days to Harvest) Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb or XLR Plus, 12 qt (7), or Assail 70WP, 1.92.3 oz or 30SG, 4.55.3 oz (1), or Malathion 8Fb, 14 pt or 57ECb, 1.5 pt (1), or Actara, 3.0 oz (3) Acramite 50 WS, 0.751.0 lb (1). One application per year allowed, or Savey 50WP, 46 oz (3). One application per year allowed, or Brigade WSB, 16 oz or 2EC, 6.4 fl oz (3), or Stylet oil, 36 qt/100 gal (0)
Spider mites
Insecticidal soaps such as M-Pede may offer some benefit in mite control. See additional comments under Petal Fall through Harvest.
As a drench in at least 200 gal of water/A. Directed to lower canes and soil; see Brigade WSB, 16 oz or 2EC, 6.4 fl oz (3) label for specific restrictions. This drench will only affect new larvae. Because this insect requires more than one year to complete its life cycle, applications probably will be needed for more than one year. Watch for appearance of adult clear-winged moths after harvest. No materials are specifically labeled for this pest at this time. However, materials with a broad label such as Pyganic, Pyrenone, or Evergreen may help.
Raspberry crown borer adults speCial spRays Diseases Phytophthora root rot
Ridomil Gold SL and Ridomil Gold GR are soil-applied systemic fungicides. Apply to soil surface in a 3-foot band over the row. Make one application in the spring and another in the fall after harvest. Planting on raised beds also significantly reduces phytophthora incidence. Apply the first foliar spray in the spring when new growth is 13 inches long. Reapply on a 45- to 60-day schedule. Phytotoxicity may be an issue with use of phosphorous acid compounds such as Phostrol, especially when applied under high temperatures, when tank-mixed with other materials, and/or when applied on a frequent schedule as with bloom sprays or sprays during harvest.
Ridomil Gold GR, 5 lb/1,000 ft of row (45) raspberries only, or Ridomil Gold SL, 0.25 pt/1,000 ft of row (45) raspberries only, or Aliette 80WDG, 5 lb (60), or Phostrol, 4.5 pt ()
Savey is effective only against immatures. Application must be made while mite populations are low. Both Acramite and Savey are fairly safe to beneficial predatory mites. Insecticidal soaps such as M-Pede may offer some benefit in mite control. Brigade and Capture must be used at high rates in order to obtain control of spider mites and may increase the likelihood of spider mite population explosions. Before or when characteristic egg-laying trails first appear.
Acramite 50WS, 0.751.0 lb (1). One application per year allowed, or Savey 50WP, 36 oz (3). One application per year allowed, or Brigade WSB, 16 oz or 2EC, 6.4 fl oz (3), or Stylet oil, 36 qt/100 gal (0) Sevin 80S, 1.252.5 lb or XLR Plus, 12 qt (7)
Tree crickets
Nematodes (Raspberries Only) Nematodes No nematicides are available for sale as of this writing. Sales of Nemacur were prohibited after May 31, 2008. Existing supplies may be used until depleted.
a. Some pesticides may be phytotoxic to plants. If in doubt, test a small area of the field first. Be sure the sprayer is calibrated properly. b. Many trade names of malathion are currently available, including Cythion, Malaspray, Malathone, etc. Follow the label for use on bramble crops. Please test a small area before trying a new formulation. Some formulations, especially the emulsifiable concentrates (EC), have caused phytotoxicity on raspberries, particularly in hot weather.
202
Acramite 50WS Actara Admire Pro Asana XL Assail Brigade Cabrio EG Captan 80WDG Captevate 68WDG Confirm 2F Delegate
Phostrol Pristine
203
Chapter 8: Brambles
Spintor, Entrust, Success Do not apply more than a total of 0.45 lb ai of spinosad per acre per crop. Do not make more than 6 applications per year. Do not make applications less than 5 days apart. Whenever Spintor (or Success or Entrust) is applied two times in succession, this should be followed by rotation to another insecticide class for at least one application. Switch 62.5WG Tanos Do not exceed 56 oz of Switch per acre per year. Do not make more than two applications before using a fungicide in another resistance management group. Do not make more than one application before alternating with a fungicide with a different mode of action. Apply in a minimum of 20 gallons of spray per acre. Do not apply more than 72 oz of product per acre per cropping season. The minimum interval between applications is 5 days.
204
Weeds
Because blueberry and brambles are both perennial crops, weed management practices and problem weeds are very similar with a few exceptions. See Chapter 4: Weed Control for a discussion of the importance of weed identification and various categories of weed types, cultural practices that minimize weed pressure, a discussion on types of herbicides, how they work, correct application techniques, and factors that influence herbicide effectiveness. See the weed management section of Chapter 7: Blueberries for information on controlling weeds between rows, including the establishment and management of sod row middles, and discussions on cultural and chemical methods of managing specific problem weeds that are likely to become problematic in blueberry fields. As mentioned above, because brambles are perennial, problematic weeds are similar in both situations, though controls may vary between crops.
required to prevent weeds from becoming established. Cultivation should be shallow and done carefully to avoid damaging established plants. Do not continue straw mulching past the first year on wet sites since this practice can exacerbate root rot injury and cause slug infestation. Where nontissue-cultured plants are used (nursery-matured or dormant canes), consider applying one of the preemergence herbicides listed in Table 8.20 after the soil has settled (after irrigation or rainfall), according to labeled rates. These herbicides require to 1 inch of irrigation following application to activate them. Plastic mulchand preferably landscape fabriccan be used for controlling weeds in bramble plantings. See Planting and EstablishmentMulching in this chapter for details.
heRBiCides
Choose herbicides for use in the row that are labeled, have adequate crop safety (Table 8.17), and control the weeds in your field (see Table 4.1). The use of a single herbicide repeatedly will lead to an increase in resistant weeds. Use herbicide combinations, herbicide rotations, and sequential or spot treatments in a well-managed weed control program to
G = good; F = fair (recommended; use with care); P = poor (not recommended); ? = labeled (insufficient data); = not labeled (do not use) *Do not allow spray to contact young or green (living) canes or leaves.
205
Chapter 8: Brambles
eliminate or minimize problems. The recommended herbicides covered below have been evaluated for crop safety and effectiveness. Information on all varieties is incomplete. Use herbicides with care on new varieties. Remember that weeds also compete with one another besides competing with your crop. Thus, controlling a particular weed or group of weeds may allow other weed species to take over. A combination of two preemergence herbicides gives better weed control than a single herbicide. Combining a grass herbicide with a broadleaf herbicide results in wider-spectrum control. Consult the label and Table 8.20 for compatible tank mixes.
herbicide Terminology
Herbicide terminology may not be everyones cup of tea, but is important to understand in order to effectively use herbicides, and to avoid undesirable consequences from herbicide application. Residual herbicides remain in the soil and kill weeds for up to several months. They are applied before weeds germinate. Weeds begin to compete with most crops within 2 to 4 weeks. Some products are effective only on germinating seeds. If weeds are present, a postemergence herbicide can be combined with a residual herbicide. Residual herbicides are applied incorporated or preemergence. Incorporated herbicides are mechanically mixed with the soil. This application method is not well suited to brambles. It is difficult or impossible to incorporate herbicides near the crown of the bramble plant, and shallow roots may be pruned by the incorporation equipment. Preemergence herbicides are applied to the soil surface, and are used to prevent weeds from establishing before they emerge from the soil, not to prevent weeds from germinating. Labels often state that preemergence herbicides must be activated by cultivation or irrigation. As mentioned above, cultivation is not a recommended practice for incorporating herbicides in brambles. However, rainfall or overhead irrigation is needed to move the herbicide into the soil before the weeds emerge, and ideally,
just into the zone of weed seed germination. Use a preemergence herbicide in combination with a postemergence herbicide if weeds have emerged, unless the preemergence herbicide also controls weeds postemergence. Of preemergence herbicides labeled for brambles, Devrinol and Surflan work by inhibiting cell division. Casoron inhibits cellulose biosynthesis and also controls emerged plants of certain weed species. Princep and Sinbar work by inhibiting photosynthesis. Solicam inhibits carotenoid synthesis, which exposes chlorophyll to damage by sunlight. Sinbar, besides inhibiting photosynthesis of geminating weeds, also kills recently germinated weeds (those just at the cotyledon stage). Repeatedly using herbicides that act on weeds with the same mode of action may lead to weed populations that are resistant to those herbicide(s). Postemergence herbicides are used after weeds have emerged from the soil. They are used by carefully applying the herbicide to the weeds without allowing it to contact desirable plants that could be affected, such as caneberries or sod row middles. The best time to apply postemergence herbicides is when weeds are growing rapidly. Do not treat weeds that are dormant or under stress. Most herbicides that enter the plant through the leaves need a minimum rain-free period of at least 1 to 8 hours after application for maximum effectiveness. Postemergence
herbicides may be selective or nonselective. Selective postemergence herbicides kill only certain susceptible weeds. Poast, Select, and Fusilade DX are examples that kill only grasses, and will not control broadleaf weeds or harm the brambles. Nonselective postemergence herbicides kill or injure any treated plant. They may be contact or translocated. Contact herbicides (Gramoxone Inteon, Scythe) affect only the plant tissue with which they come in contact. Thorough spray coverage is essential for good results. Roots of established annual weeds and perennial weeds often survive. Translocated herbicides (glyphosate products, Fusilade, Poast, Select) move systemically in the weed (or crop plant if contacted) after treatment. Application at the proper growth stage will often result in good control of the roots as well as tops of established annuals and perennial weeds. Results of translocated herbicides may not be evident for several days or weeks. Herbicides have no activity after application for one of two reasons. Some herbicides are too tightly bound to the soil to be available to plants after application. Care must be exercised in soilless growing environments, where surprising residual activity can be observed from these herbicides. Other herbicides are highly soluble in water and are not bound to soil particles. Residual activity from these herbicides can be observed in the soil, but it often lasts only a few days. They are rapidly leached out
Table 8.18. Bramble herbicide water solubility and soil adsorption characteristics. Solubility Soil adsorption
Residual Herbicides Casoron/Norosac (dichlobenil) Devrinol (napropamide) Gallery (isoxaben) Princep (simazine) Sinbar (terbacil) Solicam (norflurazon) Surflan (oryzalin) Nonresidual Herbicides Fusilade DX (fluazifop-P-butyl) glyphosate products paraquat products Poast (sethoxydim) Select products (clethodim) Low Moderate Very low Very low Moderate Low to moderate Very low Very low Very high Very high Moderate to very higha Not available Moderate Strong Strong Moderate Weak Strong Strong Very strong Very strong Very strong Moderate Weak
Source: Weed Science Society of America (2002), Herbicide Handbook, 8th ed. Controlling Weeds in Nursery and Landscape Plantings. 2007. Penn State College of Agricultural Sciences. a. pH dependent
206
of the zone of weed seed germination and degraded by soil microorganisms. See Table 8.18 for solubility and soil absorption characteristics of bramble herbicides. A complete discussion of the effects that trickle irrigation can have on increasing weed growth under the trickle line, as related to this subject, is included in Chapter 4: Weed Management. Glyphosate products, including Roundup products, Touchdown products, Glyphomax Plus, and others, and paraquat products, including Gramoxone Inteon, Firestorm, and others, are too tightly bound to the soil to have residual activity. These herbicides are completely unavailable to plants after application in field production. They remain tightly bound to the soil until broken down. Glyphosate can be degraded or digested by soil microorganisms. However, residual activity from glyphosate has been observed when used in greenhouses, on plastic mulch, and near hydroponic growing systems. Paraquat is degraded by sunlight, and is less likely to cause problems when used on plastic mulch, in greenhouses, or near soilless growing systems.
your soil texture, choosing the correct rate may be difficult. See Table 8.19 for recommended rates of specific herbicides for various soil types and organic matter levels. Consult your Cooperative Extension service office for assistance in determining the correct herbicide rate to use on your soil if needed. Adjust by changing tractor speed and maintaining pressure when spraying a field with soil that requires different herbicide rates. Herbicide application and equipment is discussed in Chapter 4.
Table 8.19. per-acre rates per application for preemergence (residual) herbicides for common soil types for raspberries and blackberries.
Rates for each active ingredient are followed by the corresponding rates of a commonly available product containing the active ingredient listed. Sand Loamy Sand 01 12 01 12 24 24 24 24 48 48 48 48 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 24 24 24 24 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 2 2.5 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 soil Type / % organic matter Sandy Loam Loam Silt Loam Clay Loam 01 12 24 12 24 12 24 12 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 0.75 0.75 1 0.75 1 1 1 1 1 1.0 1.0 1.33 1.0 1.33 1.33 1.33 1.33 1.33 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 1.42.8 2 2 2 3 2 3 3 4 2.2 2.2 2.2 3.3 2.2 3.3 3.3 4.4 1 1.2 1.2 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.25 1.5 1.5 2 2 2 2 2 2 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 3 3 4 2.5 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.75 3.75 5 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24
herbicide Napropamide (lb ai)a Devrinol 50DF (lb)a Isoxaben (lb ai)b Gallery 75DF (lb)b Diclobenil (lb ai)a Casoron CS (gal)a Simazine (lb ai)b Princep 90DF (lb)b Terbacil (lb ai)b Sinbar 80WP (lb)b Norflurazon (lb ai)b Solicam 80DF (lb)b Oryzalin (lb ai)a Surflan 4AS (qt)a
a. Use the lower recommended rate when tank-mixing with another preemergence herbicide, unless annual grass pressure is severe. b. Use one-half the recommended rate when tank-mixing with another preemergence herbicide. = not labeled or not recommended (do not use).
207
Chapter 8: Brambles
the soil has settled the soil around the roots of the new plants, but before weeds emerge or the brambles break bud. Waxed paper milk cartons are effective and recommended shields. The use of shields adds an additional margin of safety when installed prior to herbicide application. An alternative to shields is the use of granular formulations when available. Granular formulations fall through the bramble canopy to the soil surface, provided applications are made when the foliage and shoots are dry. The use of nonselective postemergence herbicides such as a paraquat or glyphosate product should be avoided during the year of planting unless shields are in place. Avoidance of contact of these products with the plant is critical.
winter applications. Casoron/Norosac is volatile in warm temperatures and must be irrigated or mechanically incorporated after application. Significant herbicide loss may occur if applied in warm weather. The use of a grass herbicide in the fall depends on the product chosen. Solicam 90DF, Surflan 80WP, and Devrinol 50DF are annual grass herbicides that should be applied in late fall or as a split applicationhalf in the fall and the second half in the spring. Use the split application when grass pressure is heavy for best results. The use of these herbicides in spring only has resulted in inconsistent weed control when dry weather followed the application. Sinbar 80WP applications for annual weed control should be applied only in the spring. The relatively high solubility of Sinbar 80WP results in leaching when applied in the fall. Increased risk of crop injury and poor weed control can result. In follow-up late spring applications, apply Sinbar 80WP or the second half of a split herbicide treatment of Solicam 80DF, Surflan 80WP, or Devrinol 50DF for annual grass control. Include a paraquat product if seedling annual weeds are observed. Spot treat with a labeled glyphosate product to control established perennial grasses and broadleaf weeds. Sinbar 80WP is also effective for seedling weed control postemergence. No other postemergence herbicide may be needed if no established weeds are present and seedling annual weeds are sprayed with Sinbar before they exceed 1 inch in height. See Table 8.20 for a complete listing of recommended herbicides and timings at which they can be used.
ever, there are some notable exceptions, especially with postemergent nonselective translocated herbicides, such as glyphosate products. Because suckers and canes are often connected to each other through their root system, damage can be more widespread than expected when canes are contacted. For this reason, recommendations vary between crops. See Table 8.20 for labeled herbicide use patterns on brambles.
pRoBlem weeds
Especially in perennial crops, certain problem weeds can become well-established since the field is not worked after crop establishment, and herbicides may have limited or no effectiveness at this point. Many of the weeds that are likely to become problematic are discussed in Chapter 7, along with their life cycle, and cultural and chemical means for management. Many of the herbicides as discussed in the blueberry chapter under Problem Weeds are labeled at the identical rates for use in brambles. How-
208
Apply in late fall and/or early spring to weed-free soil, or add an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Use the high rate for long-term control (4 to 8 months) and the low rate for short-term control (2 to 4 months). Tank-mix with Princep plus a postemergence herbicide in late fall or reduced rates of Princep or Sinbar in the spring, if the planting has been established for at least one year to control annual broadleaf weeds. Activate with one-half inch sprinkler irrigation within 24 hours after application. If left on the soil surface, napropamide (Devrinol) is broken down by sunlight. Irrigation moves the herbicide into the soil and prevents breakdown by the sun. Apply in late fall or early spring to weed-free soil to control many broadleaf weeds. If newly planted, allow the soil to settle and fill any depressions around the plant before application. Add a postemergence herbicide to improve the control of emerged weeds. Gallery primarily controls annual broadleaf weeds. Tank-mix with Surflan to control annual grasses. Note: Gallery is not labeled for bearing brambles. Apply in late fall and/or early spring to weed-free soil, or add an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Use the high rate for long-term control (4 to 8 months) and the low rate for short-term control (2 to 4 months). Tank-mix with Princep plus a postemergence herbicide in late fall, or Sinbar in the spring, if the planting has been established for at least one year, to control annual broadleaf weeds. Note: Planting must have been in the ground for at least 12 months before application in order for this material to be used. Apply in late fall or spring to weed-free soil, or add an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Tank-mix with Princep plus a postemergence herbicide in late fall, or Sinbar in the spring, if the planting has been established for at least one year, to improve the control of broadleaf weeds.
Napropamide, 2.04.0 lb
Isoxaben, 0.751.0 lb
Oryzalin, 2.04.0 lb
Primarily for annual grass control; may provide partial control of many broadleaf weeds
Norflurazon, 2.04.0 lb
continued
209
Chapter 8: Brambles
Sethoxydim, 0.20.5 lb
Poast 1.5EC, 12.5 pt, plus 2 pints crop oil concentrate per acre (45)
Most grass weed species, including certain hard to control grass weeds, such as small grain volunteers and cover crops, and perennials such as hard fescue, tall fescue, bermudagrass, orchardgrass, quackgrass, johnsongrass, and wirestem muhly
Clethodim, 0.10.125 lb
Contact killer only; with no translocation or residual activity. Best results occur when weeds are 2 inches tall or less. Regrowth may occur from the root systems of established weeds. Use a surfactant to be 0.25 percent of the spray solution (1 qt per 100 gallons of spray solution). Combine with recommended preemergence herbicide(s) for residual weed control. Do not allow spray or drift to contact green canes, leaves, or fruit. Crop damage may result. The use of shields, such as grow tubes or paper milk cartons greatly reduces the risk of injury in young plantings. danger: do not breathe spray mist. Read safety precautions on the label.
Paraquat, 0.51.0 lb
continued
210
esTaBlished planTinGs Preemergence Primarily for annual grasses, suppresses or controls certain annual broadleaf weeds
Apply in late fall and/or early spring to weed-free soil, or add an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Use the high rate for long-term control (4 to 8 months) and the low rate for shortterm control (2 to 4 months). Tank-mix with Princep plus a postemergence herbicide in late fall or reduced rates of Princep in the spring, or Sinbar in the spring if the planting has been established for at least one year to control annual broadleaf weeds. Activate with one-half inch sprinkler irrigation within 24 hours after application. If left on the soil surface, napropamide (Devrinol) is broken down by sunlight. Irrigation moves the herbicide into the soil and prevents breakdown by the sun. Apply in late fall/early winter to control labeled perennial, biennial and annual weeds or in late winter/early spring before weed growth begins and daily high temperatures exceed 50F to control labeled annual weeds. Perennial weed control following late winter/early spring applications has been less consistent than late fall applications. Casoron/Norosac is volatile in warm temperatures and must be irrigated or mechanically incorporated after application. Significant herbicide loss may occur if applied in warm weather.
Napropamide, 2.04.0 lb
Diclobenil, 2.04.0 lb
continued
211
Chapter 8: Brambles
Primarily for annual broadleaf weed Apply in late fall or spring to weed-free soil, or add an control appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Tank-mix at 1.02.0 lb ai (1.12.2 lb of Princep 90DF) depending of soil texture and organic matter with Surflan, Solicam, or Devrinol. This rate is one-half the labeled Princep rate for use alone for each soil type. Tank-mixing will improve crop safety and the range of weeds controlled. Controls many annual broadleaf weed species, but may be weak on pigweed species Apply in the spring to weed-free soil, or add an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Tank-mix using terbacil at 0.4 to 0.8 lb ai/A (Sinbar 80WP at 0.51.0 lb/a), depending on soil texture and organic matter, with Surflan, or Devrinol. Tank-mixing will improve crop safety and the range of weeds controlled.
Terbacil, 0.81.6 lb
Primarily for annual grass control; may provide partial control of many broadleaf weeds
Apply in late fall or spring to weed-free soil, or add Norflurazon, 2.04.0 lb an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Tank-mix with Princep plus a postemergence herbicide in late fall, or Sinbar in the spring, if the planting has been established for at least one year, to improve the control of broadleaf weeds. Apply in late fall and/or early spring to weed-free soil, or add an appropriate postemergence herbicide to kill existing vegetation. Use the high rate for long-term control (4 to 8 months) and the low rate for shortterm control (2 to 4 months). Tank-mix with Princep plus a postemergence herbicide in late fall or Sinbar in the spring, if the planting has been established for at least one year, to control annual broadleaf weeds. Use the lower rate to control annual grasses less than 6 inches tall. Use the higher rate to control annual grass 6 to 12 inches tall and to control perennial grasses. Do not tank-mix Poast with any other pesticide. Do not apply within 1 hour of rainfall. Do not apply to grasses suffering from drought, heat, cold, or any other stress condition. Oryzalin, 2.04.0 lb
Sethoxydim, 0.20.5 lb
Poast 1.5EC, 12.5 pt, plus 2 pints crop oil concentrate per acre (45)
continued
212
Paraquat, 0.51.0 lb Contact killer only; with no translocation or residual activity. Best results occur when weeds are 2 inches tall or less. Regrowth may occur from the root systems of established weeds. Use a surfactant to be 0.25 percent of the spray solution (1 qt per 100 gallons of spray solution). Combine with recommended preemergence herbicide(s) for residual weed control. Do not allow spray or drift to contact green canes, leaves, or fruit. Crop damage may result. The use of shields, such as grow tubes or paper milk cartons greatly reduces the risk of injury in young plantings. danGeR: do not breathe spray mist. Read safety precautions on the label. Glyphosate is a translocated, slow-acting herbicide with no soil or residual activity. Results will become evident 1 to 3 weeks after application. Apply lower rates to control seedlings and annual weeds and to suppress established perennial weeds. Use shields and do not allow glyphosate to contact the foliage or green shoots. Optimum rate and time of application depend on weed species and growth stage. Weeds should be growing vigorously when treated. Do not treat weeds that are under stress from drought, extreme heat, cold, or other adverse growing conditions. When using a ropewick applicator, fill the pipe only half full to avoid excessive dripping. Repeated wiping may be needed to provide control equal to broadcast or spot applications. A ropewick applicator offers significant herbicide cost savings. warnings: (1) Do not allow glyphosate to contact the leaves, young green bark, fresh trunk wounds, or root suckers, or severe crop injury may occur. (2) Do not allow glyphosate to contact any immature part of bramble plants. (3) Do not use galvanized containers; glyphosate may react with the container to produce explosive hydrogen gas. Glyphosateno per acre broadcast rate recommended
Roundup, Touchdown, or other labeled formulations (14). Broadcast applications not recommended in brambles. For spot applications, see label and wet foliage thoroughly. Ropewick Applicator: See label for product/water ratio. One gallon of product will treat 10100 acres depending on weed density and formulation.
a. Adding a surfactant to these herbicides may improve their effectiveness (see labels). Rates are given in units of commercial product per acre. b. No days-to-harvest limitation is specified on the label if days-to-harvest is listed as (). additional notes All the rates in this table are given on a full-acre basis. If the material is to be banded along or over the row, use the following formula to calculate the banding rate: rate/A banded = rate/A broadcast x (band width in inches row spacing in inches). With all chemicals, follow label instructions and warnings carefully. Use pesticides safely. Consult label for restriction. It is unlawful to use recommended chemicals for crops not covered on the label or to use chemicals not cleared for such use on blueberry plantings. Formulations other than those listed, with the same active ingredient, may be labeled for the same uses.
213
IntroductIon
Decisions to commercially produce specialty small fruit crops such as gooseberries and currants should be driven by availability of market outlets for the fruit. A market should be secured before plants are set in the ground. Fresh fruit sales are options for direct marketers, though most consumers are unfamiliar with the fruit and their uses. Consequently, processing the crop into jams, jellies, fresh juice products, and wine may be the best way to utilize these crops. In Europe, significant fresh and processing markets exist, which may be an indication of the undeveloped market potential in this country. Growers near populations of people who are already familiar with the crop may have a ready market. Successfully producing these unique fruit involves knowledge of cultivars, their horticultural characteristics and requirements, and successful pest management.
contents
Introduction ......................................................213 Types of Plants...................................................213 Currants .......................................................213 Gooseberries ................................................213 Jostaberries ..................................................214 Legality of Culture .............................................214 Culture ..............................................................214 General.........................................................214 Site Selection................................................214 Soils .............................................................215 Cultivars .......................................................215 Site Preparation ...........................................217 Spacing and Planting Systems ......................218 Obtaining Plants...........................................218 Planting .......................................................218 Establishment ..............................................218 Cultivation and Mulching .............................218 Fertility ........................................................218 Notes on Sod Row Middles ...........................219 Irrigation .....................................................219 Pollination Considerations ...........................219 Pruning and Training ...................................219 Harvest .............................................................220 Propagation ......................................................220 Pest Management .............................................221 Diseases .......................................................221 Insects ..........................................................222 Weeds ...............................................................223
a strig. Cultivars may be classified under several species; however, keep in mind that some debate exists as to which species different types of plants belong. Species are Ribes rubrum (most red currants and some whites), R. petraeum (white), R. vulgare (pink, white, and red), and R. nigrum and R. ussurienses (black). Native currants, sometimes considered more closely related to gooseberries, belong to the species R. odoratum, the Buffalo Currant, with some selections known as Clove Currant (for example, the cultivar Crandall) because of the fragrance of their blossoms. Because of their tart flavor, currants are seldom eaten out of hand but are used for processing into juices, jams, and jellies. Black currants are noted for their strong (to some, offensive) odor and astringent flavor, yet they are highly prized in Europe for juice products and their high nutrient content. Vitamin C concentrations can be as high as 250 milligrams per 100 grams of juice, even after 6 months of storage.
types of plants
Currants and gooseberries are two closely related species within the genus Ribes. This genus is diverse with more than 150 known species and hundreds of cultivated varieties (cultivars). Currants and gooseberries can be easily distinguished by the presence or absence of thorns; gooseberries usually have thorns, while currants do not. Ribes plants are long-lived perennial shrubs that are cold-hardy, some to USDA Zone 2. Species and cultivars vary in plant size and form but are usually upright to spreading in habit (3 to 6 feet). Disease and insect resistance is variable. The fruit is versatile and nutritious and varies in presentation, flavor, shape, size, texture, and color.
Gooseberries
Cultivated forms of gooseberries are divided into two major types, European (Ribes grossularia var. uva-crispa) and American (R. hirtellum). European types are native to North Africa and the Caucasus Mountains of eastern Europe and western Asia, while the American types are native to the northern United States and Canada. Within the European types, fruit size varies widely, from pea sized to small egg sized. Color varies widely as well, with fruit colors in shades of green, pink, red, purple, white, and yellow. This diversity is due to the historical popularity of the European gooseberry. Over the past two centuries, hundreds of cultivars have been developed with a focus on prize-winning fruit size and color. Native American gooseberry species have smaller fruit size and less flavor, but they are more resistant to diseases when compared to European cultivars, which are noted for powdery mildew and leaf spot susceptibility. This problem has limited the culture of most of the European types in this country. However, disease resistance is improving through additional breed-
Currants
Most cultivated currants are of European origin, though many native North American species also exist. Currant color types include red, white, pink, and black. Plants are thornless and fruit is small (pea sized) and produced and harvested in a grapelike cluster called
214
ing with American types, and several new promising European cultivars have recently been introduced in the United States and Canada. In comparison, most known American cultivars in the trade today have had some historical infusion of European genetics to improve size and flavor, which can be traced to a handful of crosses made in the 1800s. All gooseberry cultivars have varying degrees of thorniness. Fruit is produced in small groups or singularly on stems and are picked individually.
Jostaberries
Lastly, the jostaberry is an interspecies cross between gooseberries and black currant. Its fruit is larger than currants, similar to gooseberries, and black in color. The stems are thornless. Fruit quality has not gained wide appeal for either fresh or processed use, but it has inspired renewed breeding efforts, with new and improved crosses being developed. It has a vigorous growth habit and is resistant to white pine blister rust. Disease (mildew) resistance is similar to that of black currants.
legalIty of culture
The history of Ribes production in America is of significant interest. Cultivated currants and gooseberries were first introduced in America in the Massachusetts Bay colony in 1629. By the mid-1800s commercial acreage of currants and newly developed European and American gooseberry crosses such as Downing and Houghton were common in the eastern United States. In 1899, reported production in the United States reached nearly 7,000 acres. In the early 1900s, Ribes species were implicated in the spread of white pine blister rust (Cronartium ribicola), a devastating disease for white pine trees brought into this country on imported nursery tree stock. Ribes, in particular black currants, are a secondary host to this disease, which requires both pine and Ribes to complete its life cycle. Red currants and gooseberries exhibit varying degrees of susceptibility. In 1912, federal and state governments introduced restrictions on importing, planting, and cultivating
Ribes species to protect the lucrative timber industry. Soon after, a sweeping federal law was passed banning only black currants, while some northern states passed outright bans on all Ribes species. A program of eradication of both native stands and domestic plantings was begun, with Civilian Conservation Corp (CCC) crews doing much of the work. The federal law was rescinded in 1966, but today laws regarding Ribes culture remain on the books in many states. While some states allow all species to be cultivated, others continue full or partial bans geographically or by selected species, namely black currant. Laws banning Ribes species range from being well to poorly enforced, or in some instances agencies responsible for enforcement no longer exist as originally designated. Restrictions often vary by township within a state. For information on state laws, contact your states Department of Agriculture or a cooperative extension office. Cultivars resistant to white pine blister rust are now available and should be selected. The early Ribes industry was dealt a great setback because of these bans and has yet to recover. Variable and often confusing legal issues are still an effective roadblock to development of a viable industry. Nevertheless, the threat of white pine blister rust remains a reality today, and site selection in new plantings should take into account the presence of nearby susceptible pine species, identifiable by the characteristic of five needles per needle cluster. Most commonly this means consideration of native or planted stands of white pine in the area, but several other susceptible species may be cultivated in nearby nursery operations or your neighbors yard as ornamentals.
above 85F can cause currant leaves to begin to flag and extended direct sunlight can cause leaf sunburn. Temperatures of 95F sustained for three or more days may cause most of the fruit to drop from the plant, especially if the fruit is nearly ripe. Partial shade, a soil mulch, and adequate water are essential in drier, hotter areas. American gooseberries are more tolerant of direct light and warm temperatures than European types. Currant and gooseberry plants can be very productive at maturity, with yields of 4 to 6 quarts per plant considered good (by weight, gooseberries produce 8 to 10 pounds per plant and currant, 5 to 8 pounds per plant). Black currant yields are usually 50 percent less. Red currants and gooseberries reach economic bearing capacity in 3 to 4 years, and black currants in 4 to 5 years. With care, the life of currant plantings is about 8 to 15 years, and that of gooseberry plantings is 15 to 20 years. The fruit ripen over a several-week period and, depending on variety, can remain on the plant for extended periods of time in cool weather, allowing harvest schedule flexibility.
site seleCtion
Unlike other fruit crops, currants and gooseberries can tolerate partial shade. Northern to northeastern exposure is often ideal because the air and soil will be cooler and moister and plants will be protected from direct sunlight. Full sun exposure in cooler or mountainous climates, however, is desirable and leads to increased yields. Air circulation and movement is an important consideration in site selection, as foliar disease can be a problem in many cultivars. Consider summer prevailing winds and align rows to take advantage of air movement. Currants and gooseberries require approximately 1,000 to 1,200 chilling hours to break dormancy, so plants bloom early in the spring. Avoid low areas where late spring frosts can injure the blossoms. Though tolerant to cold, temperatures below 28F can cause damage to flowers and reduce yields. An additional advantage of cooler, northern slopes is slow spring warmup and delayed plant growth, which can further reduce frost risk.
culture
Overall, cultural requirements are similar for all Ribes species, and they can be grown successfully in most of the Mid-Atlantic.
General
Ribes are adapted to cooler climates; therefore, excessive summer heat can be a limiting factor to culture. Temperatures
215
Plants have shallow, fibrous roots and should be situated where irrigation can be provided. They should be grown beyond the canopy of shade trees, away from competition for moisture. Though currants and gooseberries are not excessively damaged by white pine blister rust, their proximity to susceptible pine species (those with five needles per needle cluster) should be considered. Locate plantings at least 1,500 feet away from valuable ornamental plantings, commercial nurseries, commercial pine crops or native stands.
Currants
Most currants are self-fruitful; therefore, only one cultivar is needed for fruit production, unless otherwise noted in cultivar descriptions. However, currants will produce better and larger fruit crops when more than one cultivar is planted. A few cultivars may be locally available through nurseries and garden centers, but specialty mail order nursery suppliers are the primary source of stock. See Appendix C for a listing of nurseries that carry Ribes.
Fruit is large, firm, light red, subacid, and is on easy-to-pick long strigs with high juice content. Easily found in nurseries. Plants are productive, upright, dense and hardy. Has a low tolerance to frost. Susceptible to mildew.
rovada
Late season. Fruit is large and produced on long, compact strigs. Dependable bearer and productive. Blooms late, so frost can be less of a problem than with other cultivars. Resistant to mildew and other leaf diseases.
soils
Currants and gooseberries are fairly tolerant of a wide range of soil conditions and less than perfect sites. They perform best in well-drained silt to sandy loam soils with an organic matter content greater than 1 percent and good waterholding capacity. Planting in light sandy or heavy clay soils should be avoided, as well as areas in which water stands for any length of time. If your area is poorly drained, improve the site by tiling or building raised beds. Both heavy and light soils can be improved by additions of organic matter. The ideal soil pH is slightly acidic, from 5.5 to 6.5. Micronutrient deficiencies may occur at a pH greater than 7.0. Saline or salty soils near coastal areas should be avoided.
tatran
Late season. A sister selection of Detvan, with many similar characteristics. Plants are robust and upright. Fruit is very large and produced on long strigs of 25 to 30 berries. Very high yielding and resistant to runoff. Should be planted at least 5 feet apart both within the row and between rows. Canes become very heavy with fruit and may need some support.
detvan
Midseason. A selection from Slovakia. Plants are very large, robust, and upright. Fruit is large and produced on very long strigs, often with as many as 25 to 30 berries per strig. Should be planted on at least 5-foot row centers. Very high yielding. Good resistance to gray mold (also called runoff).
Cultivars
Several factors should be considered when choosing a cultivar. Adaptability, availability of nursery stock, productivity, ripening time, fruit size, appearance, flavor, ease of harvest, and disease resistance are just a few important considerations. Selection for cold-hardiness is usually not an issue, though bloom time and bloom hardiness should be considered in areas where late spring frosts commonly occur. More importantly for the MidAtlantic, relative tolerance to summer heat, foliar disease, and insect pressure should be considered. Documentation of the performance of cultivars in our region is limited, and test plantings of cultivars are strongly recommended before larger plantings are committed.
WiLder
Mid- to late season. Fruit is large, dark red, subacid, and produced on large compact clusters. Plants are productive, large, and upright to spreading. Resistant to leaf spots.
BLanka
Mid to late season. Known for heavy yields and dependability.
red Lake
Mid- to late season.
216
Produces long strigs of large, opaque, off-white fruit. Plants are vigorous and spreading and easy to grow.
not recommended and usually are in the target group still prohibited by law.
Fruit ripens evenly and has very high vitamin C levels. Has reported immunity to white pine blister rust and also is resistant to mildew. Not yet available in the United States.
Ben Lomond
Known for even ripening and high yields of large, firm fruit that have a long hang time and high vitamin C content, despite high pectin levels. Plants are compact yet spreading and have good frost tolerance at flowering. Plants have variable resistance to mildew and slight resistance to white pine blister rust.
Pink ChamPagne
Midseason. Quality and flavor are good. Fruit is a translucent pink color. Yields are generally low. Plants are vigorous, upright, and resistant to leaf diseases.
titania
Midseason. Fruit is large and of high quality. Yields are high. Plants are vigorous, growing up to 6 feet tall, come into full production by the third year, and are well-suited for machine harvest. Nearly immune to white pine blister rust, but is susceptible to a cane blight disease, possibly from the genus Botryosphaeria.
Primus
Late season. Has white to yellowish fruit on upright, vigorous plants. Similar to Blanka in fruit quality, but yields may be slightly lower.
Ben sarek
Early to midseason. Known for strong set of very large fruit, ease of hand harvest, and tolerance to frost and cold injury. Growth habit is very compact. Recommended for small-scale growers with limited land area. Has slight to moderate resistance to white pine blister rust.
White imPeriaL
Midseason. One of most commonly available white varieties. Lowest acidity of currant cultivars. Produces small fruit on long strigs. Yields are moderate. Plants have a spreading growth habit.
BLaCk sePtemBer
Late season variety. Fruit is large and firm with a mild flavor. Yields are poor. No resistance to white pine blister rust.
Black Currants
Black currants are prized for their strong aroma, flavor and high vitamin C content. Some varieties, particularly those that are purely Ribes nigrum, are highly susceptible to white pine blister rust. Resistance has been developed in cultivars through crossing of R. nigrum and R. ussurienses. However, juice and processing quality of initial crosses (Consort, Coronet, Crusader) are considered substandard as compared to standard nonresistant cultivars. Recent backcrosses (crosses back to a parent), such as the cultivar Titania, have retained near immunity to white pine blister rust. These backcrosses also have improved commercial traits such as tolerance of adverse weather at flowering, and suitability for machine harvest. In addition, they have a long hang time, even fruit-ripening within clusters, high yield, improved resistance to mildew and leaf diseases, and better juice quality. Black currants nonresistant to white pine blister rust, though sometimes listed, are
Gooseberries
American gooseberry cultivars are more foliar-disease resistant, more productive, healthier, and more adaptable to varied climatic conditions than European cultivars, which have the advantages of large fruit size, good color, and sweet flavor. Lack of disease resistance and marginal hardiness has limited European cultivar use in North America and a stringent disease management program is required to grow them. Despite the huge number of European cultivars in existence, few are commonly available in the United States. Newer cultivars with American genetic disease resistance are being developed and introduced; however, at this time, few new commercial American cultivars are on the market. Most currently available have been around for many years. While the true genetic lines are somewhat blurred between American and European gooseberries, a distinct separation of the two types still remains. The following cultivars are of American origin:
Consort
Early to midseason. Fruit is medium to small with medium firmness. Juice quality is fair. Does not machine harvest well. Plants are self-fertile with dependable set but are rated fair in productivity. Susceptible to leaf spot and mildew. Resistant to white pine blister rust.
tiseL
Midseason. New cultivar that is a progeny of Titiana. Productive.
217
CaPtivator
Late season. American-European hybrid. Fruit is large, pink to red, teardrop shaped, and sweet. Yields are moderate. Plants are mildew resistant with few thorns.
Fruit is a dull red and of medium to large size. Plants are hardy and have few spines. The following cultivars are of European origin:
inviCta
Midseason. Fruit is large and pale green with a bland flavor. Used for processing, where it provides an even color and flavor. Plants are large and productive and have numerous spines. Resistance to mildew is good, but resistance to other leaf spots is not.
CareLess
Midseason. Fruit is large, oval, and pale green to milky white when ripe with a smooth transparent skin. Plants are moderately vigorous, upright to spreading, and very susceptible to mildew.
oregon ChamPion
Midseason. Fruit is small to medium in size, round to oval, and pale white to greenish yellow at maturity. The fruit has a thin skin and is juicy and tart. Plants are large, vigorous, upright to spreading, and productive. Plants are somewhat susceptible to mildew.
site PreParation
Site preparation should begin by eradicating perennial weeds in the planting area to the fullest extent possible. This can be achieved by applying translocated herbicides in mid- to late summer or by diligent cultivation. A soil test should be taken to determine the soil pH, phosphorus, and potassium levels and needs. These nutrients should be amended to moderate levels, with available phosphorus brought to a range of 50 to 75 pounds per acre and potassium to 150 to 200 pounds per acre. Lime should be added to bring the soil pH to 6.1 if pH levels are below 5.5. Along with lime, phosphorus can be incorporated in the fall; however, potassium and nitrogen (25 to 35 pounds per acre) should be incorporated in the spring to avoid the loss of nutrients to leaching. Currants and gooseberries are sensitive to the chloride contained in muriate of potash (0-0-60), so another form of potassium, such as sulfate of potash, should be used. If plants are to be planted in the fall, nitrogen should not be applied until the following spring. Currants and gooseberries respond well to organic amendments, which improve aeration and drainage and also increase water-holding capacity in all soil types. Organic matter can be applied in the fall or spring before planting. Well-aged manure at 4 to 5 bushels per 100 square feet (1,750 to 2,200 bushels per acre) is a good option; other suitable sources are finished compost, leaves, rotted hay or straw, shredded peat, or sawdust. Any additions should be free of weed seeds and insects. For larger plantings, a cover crop (green manure) can also be grown and turned in to increase organic matter. See Chapter 2 for more information on green
CLark
Mid- to late season. Fruit is very large, red, and of high quality. Plants are thorny, dense, short with branches close to the ground, moderate in vigor, and productive. Thought to be a natural AmericanEuropean cross. Plants are very susceptible to mildew.
PixWeLL
From North Dakota. Fruit is of medium size, pink, in clusters, and of fair quality. Plants are vigorous, productive, hardy, and have few thorns. Recommended for home garden use. Best if used slightly underripe. Mildew resistant.
Poorman
Early to midseason. Fruit is red, of medium size, and oval shaped. Fruit ripens over a long period and is of high quality. Flavor is sprightly sweet. Plants are vigorous, the largest of American cultivars, productive, upright, dense with few short thorns, and mildew resistant.
tixia
Midseason. Red fruit is large and relatively mild in flavor. Plants are vigorous, have few thorns, and are resistant to mildew.
industrY
An older, large, red-fruiting cultivar with slightly hairy fruit. Finding a source of this cultivar may be difficult. Plants are very susceptible to mildew.
WeLCome
Released by the University of Minnesota.
218
manure crops. Two or possibly three green manure crops can be grown during the course of one growing season if the first crop is planted early. At blossom, till or disk down the cover crop and replant immediately. A winter cover (e.g., cereal rye, vetch) should be sown after fall site preparation. At least 3 weeks prior to spring planting, overwintered cover crops should be burned down with herbicides and/or mowed or chopped and incorporated. Be sure to disk or rototill organic materials deeply into the soil to ensure adequate breakdown and soil loosening. If large amounts of non-decomposed materials are added, ammonium nitrate can be applied at 1 pound per 100 square feet (450 pounds of ammonium nitrate per acre) to aid in decomposition. A different nitrogen source can be used, applied at an equivalent rate (150 pounds of actual nitrogen per acre). In areas of questionable drainage, permanent raised beds 3 to 4 feet wide and 4 to 6 inches tall should be formed. A second option to improve drainage is to install drain tiles at least 25 inches deep near the row.
circulation and reduces disease. In this system, spacing is the same as that of freestanding bushes. While trellising the plants is not a requirement, it improves fruit exposure and makes harvesting easier, especially with gooseberries. A simple series of horizontal wires placed about 6 inches apart to which canes can be tied will suffice.
increase renewal cane production. Avoid excessive planting depths. Damaged and straggling root parts should be trimmed; the roots should be spread out, covered with soil, and pressed firmly to remove air pockets. Water the plants to settle the soil, but avoid water logging.
establishment
Newly set plants should be pruned back to 6 to 10 inches above the ground, depending on root system vigor. This will encourage development of new canes. With fall planting, this pruning should be delayed until spring. When practical, blossoms or any set fruit should be removed the year of planting. This helps plants to become well established and make better vegetative growth.
obtaininG Plants
Plants should be one or two years old, vigorous, and well rooted. Reliable disease-free stock can be purchased from a nursery, or nonpatented stock can be easily propagated by means of layering and by cuttings (see section on propagation). Only disease- and insect-free stock should be propagated and planted. Nursery-grown plants will usually come as bare-root stock. Request that the plants be shipped as close to the planting date as possible. After receiving the plants, check the roots for moistness, moisten if necessary, and store plants in a plastic bag in cold storage (separate from apples or other sources of ethylene, as this is lethal to plants) until the site is ready to plant. If storage is necessary for longer than two weeks, plants can be heeled in with roots covered with soil in a temporary outdoor trench.
PlantinG
Because Ribes plants break dormancy early, very early spring planting is recommended. A plant that has just leafed out can easily tolerate 20F, so do not be afraid to plant as soon as the soil can be worked. If dormant nursery stock is available, fall planting should be used; however, avoid nitrogen fertilizer application, which may decrease winter hardiness. In addition, plants should be mulched to reduce winter frost heaving effects. Avoid excessive root drying and exposure as plants are set out. The roots of bare-root plants should be soaked in a bucket of clean water 2 to 3 hours prior to planting. Plants should be set about an inch deeper than they were growing in the nursery. Covering one to three buds on the lower part of canes will encourage a larger root system and
Fertility
Currants and gooseberries are heavy feeders and respond to a regular fertilizer program. Established plants should be fertilized each spring as growth begins. Depending on site fertility and plant vigor, fertilizer applications can be made only once in early spring or split to encourage better growth. Because the
219
plants have shallow roots and fertilizer may quickly leach below the root zone, splitting applications, especially in light textured soils, is recommended. Both currants and gooseberries are sensitive to chloride. Therefore, when applying a balanced fertilizer such as 10-10-10, use a fertilizer made with potassium sulfate rather than potassium chloride. You may need to blend your own. Keep in mind that some fertilizers and certain mixtures absorb moisture very quickly, so the blend should be applied immediately after it is mixed. Other potassium-containing fertilizers that can be used are potassium magnesium sulfate (Sul-Po-Mag), if magnesium is also needed, and potassium nitrate. For second-year plantings, apply approximately 4 to 5 ounces of 10-10-10 fertilizer per plant (or an equivalent rate of a similar fertilizer). A broadcast application should be made, spread under the branches and just beyond the drip line. In third-year plantings, rates should be increased slightly. Fourth-year and mature plantings should receive a maximum of 6 to 8 ounces of 10-10-10 fertilizer per plant (0.6 to 0.8 ounces of actual nitrogen per plant or 25 to 50 pounds of actual nitrogen per acre). Depending on growth, up to double these rates may be needed where fresh sawdust or bark chip mulch is used (using fresh mulch materials is not recommended). When available, manure or other composted materials with a high nitrogen content are the best nutrient sources for Ribes, which respond well to the slow release nature of organic nitrogen sources. These materials can be substituted for all or part of the fertilizer requirement. They should be applied in early spring to allow time for nutrient movement into the root zone. In general, inorganic nitrogen additions can be reduced by one-half or more with the use of manure. Both manure and chemical fertilizers applied in summer or early fall can make plants more susceptible to winter injury.
sowing or drilling seed for best results. Sod eliminates the need for cultivation between rows and provides a clean walking area for hand-picking. Sod should not be allowed to grow closer than one foot from the drip line and should be kept closely mowed and irrigated. Avoid legumes in a sod seed mix because they may provide untimely nitrogen. Plantings under sod culture tend to be more prone to frost injury as compared to cultivated soil since bare soil warms more quickly in the spring and releases more heat on cold nights.
nearby placement of beehives to facilitate pollination. Bumble bees and solitary bees are more efficient in most cases due to the early bloom when weather is colder and honey bees are not as active. As always, only insecticides not harmful to bees should be used during bloom.
irriGation
For quality fruit, currants and gooseberries require about one inch of water per week from bloom to the end of harvest. This ensures good plant growth, high yields, and large berry size. In most areas, rainfall is usually adequate, especially if mulch is being used. However, if rainfall is insufficient, supplemental irrigation is advised. Drip or trickle irrigation is preferable to overhead irrigation, which can increase foliar disease problems. During prolonged dry periods after harvest, plants should be watered periodically until late August or early September. Add enough water to moisten the soil to 6 to 8 inches deep, allowing it to dry out somewhat before watering again. Roots can be injured by overirrigation. As with strawberries, sprinkler irrigation can help to prevent frost injury during bloom. As temperatures fall just below freezing, low volumes of water are applied using special low-delivery nozzles. A protective film of ice forms over the plant and blossoms and, as water is converted to ice, heat is released, which protects blooms and newly set fruit. Trickle systems are not useful for frost protection. See Appendix A for additional information on frost protection.
Pollination Considerations
Since currants and gooseberries (except for a few black currants) are self-fruitful, cross-pollination by a second cultivar is not needed. However, cross-pollination can result in bigger fruit and a larger harvest. Larger plantings may benefit from inclusion of multiple cultivars and
220
When pruning, also remove branches that lie too close to the ground. Heading back is not necessary; however, removal of diseased tips and weak or otherwise damaged branches is advised. Excessively crowded and vigorous canes should be thinned to create an open center to increase light exposure for fruit bud formation and to increase air circulation. Do not make the common mistake of leaving the bushes too thick. Plants may also be thinned in summer by removing many of the side branches on the canes so that the canes are better able to support a heavy fruit load and to facilitate harvest. Pruning red currants to a tree or standard form is also possible. This requires judicious removal of suckers and stem growth and/or the use of grafted plants. Trellising or some means of support is usually required. The advantages of this system are increased yields and air circulation. Disadvantages are increased hand labor in pruning and training, cost of wire support, and decreased plant longevity. This method is recommended for those who have had experience with dwarf tree fruit systems or are interested in specialized or unique methods of production or ornamental aspects. Trellising of large red currant plants reduces wind damage in early spring.
proportion of one-year-old canes kept to older canes is also different, with approximately one-half of all canes kept being one-year-old canes. Remove all shoots more than three years old at ground level.
Method 2
An easier method of pruning black currants takes advantage of its fruiting habit. This system uses only one-yearold canes and an alternate-year production system. Year 1: Plants are pruned to the ground immediately following the harvest, then lightly fertilized and watered. Small immature canes may be allowed to grow. This will usually provide 12 to 18 inches of growth by dormancy. These canes do not set flower buds. Year 2: The previous years canes remain vegetative and additional canes are produced. Year 3: A large crop is produced. Plants are again pruned to the ground after fruiting. The cycle repeats with vegetative growth only the next year. As plants are out of production for a season, the planting should be divided into differently pruned blocks to ensure a crop each year. This method greatly simplifies pruning of black currants and reduces insect and disease carryover. The hedgerow planting system is ideal for this time-saving pruning method. Black currants can also be trained as a standard. This requires diligent pruning to promote one-year-old shoot production on older wood.
it can be left on the bush for a week or more without becoming overmature; but in some varieties, fruit acidity can drop. This allows fruit that matures more slowly to ripen and condenses harvest to two to three pickings. Red currants turn red long before they are fully ripe. They should be allowed to remain on the plant as long as possible to develop additional flavor and sweeten with time. Gooseberry harvest generally requires the use of gloves, especially with thornier varieties. If desired, a canvas may be spread out under the bush and fruit knocked off onto it. Berries can be harvested when they are full size but not yet ripe. This is preferred for pies and jam. For fresh and juice use, fruit should be allowed to reach full ripeness and color expression. Both types of fruit can be frozen and kept for later use.
propagatIon
To increase your plantings, currants and gooseberries are easily propagated by means of cuttings or layering, as long the varieties you intend to propagate are not patented. Cuttings should be taken during the dormant season from new one-year-old wood. Make cuttings 6 to 8 inches long, with the bottom and top cuts made near nodes. Stick in rooting media in the late fall or take later and keep in moist sand, sawdust, or peat moss in a cool place (refrigerator) until they are set in early spring. Cuttings should be set about 6 inches apart in a well-drained nursery bed. They should be inserted so that one to two buds extend out of the soil. Fall stuck cuttings should be mulched with straw or stuck through black plastic. They should be cut and placed as soon as the plants are dormant, which will allow several weeks for rooting to start before the ground freezes. Gooseberriesin particular the European typescan also be propagated by layering. This can be done using a stooling bed (mound layering) or by individual branch layering (ground layering). Stool beds require the use of a stock plant that should be cut back before growth starts in the spring. By early summer a large number of vigor-
black Currants
Black currants produce best on one- and two-year-old wood. They do not fruit on spurs as do red currants and gooseberries. Strong one-year-old shoots and two- and three-year-old stems that have an abundance of strong one-year-old shoots are the most productive. Because of their bearing habit, black currants can be pruned by two different methods. These two methods can be used in both free-standing and hedgerow systems.
harvest
Black currants, jostaberries, and gooseberries are harvested as individual berries; red, white, and pink currants are picked in whole strigs. Red currants are smaller and more tightly bunched than black currants. Gooseberry fruit is borne singularly or in small clusters on spurs. Fruit is harvested in midsummer. Currants ripen over a two-week or longer period, while gooseberries take from 4 to 6 weeks to ripen, depending on weather. Once a berry fully ripens,
Method 1
In a method similar to pruning red currants and gooseberries, plants should have two- and three-year-old canes, along with one-year-old shoots, with a total of 10 to 15 canes per mature bush. Black currants are somewhat more vigorous than red currants; hence the number of canes kept is higher. The
221
ous shoots will have been produced. Soil is mounded around these shoots about halfway to the tips, with care taken to work the soil down among the shoots. The covered parts of the shoots usually become rooted by fall. Cut the newly rooted plant from the parent in the spring and plant in a permanent site or in nursery rows. Branch layering is similar to mound layering and is accomplished by bending down branches while they are still attached to the plant and partly covering them with soil. Pegs may be necessary to hold down the stems. This can be done fall or spring. Plants are kept covered for one growing season. Roots and shoots form along the branch; several plants can often be obtained from one branch. These can be dug and separated after the growing season.
movement and prune out weak canes to speed the drying of plants. Also eliminate weeds to aid in quicker drying of foliage and fruit and harvest fruit before it is overripe. Fungicides should be applied during bloom, with additional applications made during harvest, if necessary. Refer to Table 9.1 for fungicide recommendations.
Powdery mildew, Gooseberry mildew, american Gooseberry mildew, and american Powdery mildew
Symptoms: Powdery, frosty patches on shoots, branch tips, and young leaves, eventually causing dead tissue in the affected area or deformation of leaves and shoots. On the fruit, white patches may occur, but eventually the mildew turns a dark brown, making the fruit rough and unmarketable. Infected fruit might also split open. In severe cases, infection decreases fruit production the following year. Causal Agent: Sphaerotheca mors-uvae is referred to as American gooseberry mildew since it originated in the United States. S. mors-uvae causes more severe symptoms on Ribes than other types of powdery mildew. Sphaerotheca macularis is another species of powdery mildew that occasionally affects Ribes in the United States and causes similar symptoms. Control for both species is the same. Epidemiology: S. mors-uvae affects gooseberries and black currants. The fungus overwinters in buds and infects the shoots produced from those buds in the spring. Spores are produced on infected foliage and spread by wind. The fungus grows most prolifically under conditions of high humidity. Controls: Because mildew is most problematic under conditions of high humidity, any cultural control that decreases humidity in the vicinity of the leaves will be helpful. Avoid damp planting sites; growing Ribes in shady locations to decrease heat stress may make the occurrence of powdery mildew more likely. Do not use closer plant spacings than those recommended above. Keep plantings well pruned and well weeded. Captivator, Glendale, Hinnomaki Yellow, Hinnomaki Red, and Poorman are resistant.
pest ManageMent
Both currants and gooseberries can be affected by several insect and disease problems. Powdery mildew and leaf spot (anthracnose) are two common disease problems. Careful site selection, choosing resistant cultivars, and proper pruning often give adequate control; chemical use is an additional means of management (see Table 9.1).
diseases
botrytis (runoff), dieback, and Fruit rot
Symptoms: The gray fuzz characteristic of botrytis on other crops covers the leaves and fruit. Tips of branches turn dark and die. Fruit drops from the plant before ripening. Causal Agent: The fungus Botrytis cinerea. Epidemiology: The fungus has a wide host range and can survive on either living or dead tissue. It overwinters in dead leaves and plant debris and on stems. Inoculum is produced from fruiting structures on canes, from dead leaves, and from mummified berries in the spring. Controls: To help control the disease, choose a planting site with good air
222
to Ribes plants is of little concern; the main concern is the damage and death of susceptible five-needled pine species (in the east, primarily white pine). Causal Agent: Cronartium ribicola. Epidemiology: Initial infection occurs in the spring when fungal spores from diseased white pines land on the leaves of the Ribes bush and germinate. After 1 to 3 weeks, fruiting bodies on the undersides of the leaves produce spores that infect more Ribes tissue. A second type of spore is produced in late summer and fall that can be wind-carried great distances. These spores then infect white pines. After 1 to 2 years, spores are produced from the pine tree, starting the cycle over. Black currants are the most susceptible Ribes species. Controls: Resistant black currant varieties are listed in the section on cultivars. Avoid planting near white pines.
reddened, brought about by aphid feeding on the leaf undersides. Identification: Small (less than 1/10 inch), slow-moving, pear-shaped, yellow-green insects with cornicles (tubes) extending backwards from their posterior. Life Cycle: Aphids overwinter as tiny, glossy, black eggs on the stems. Green female aphids hatch from these eggs about the time the leaves appear and give birth to live aphids. Winged forms are produced when overcrowding occurs, allowing the aphids to distribute themselves more easily. Male and female forms are produced in the fall and mate, after which the females deposit eggs for overwintering. Monitoring and Control: Especially troublesome on red currants. Predatory insects are helpful in control, and aphid populations may decrease later in the season once populations of predators build. Insecticides as listed in Table 9.1 may be applied.
Currant borer, Synanthedon tipuliformis (Lepidoptera: Sesiidae), also Known as Currant Stem Borer, Clearwing Borer, and Clearwinged Moth
Symptoms of Damage: Withering or yellowing of leaves. Affected canes may die. Watch for a dark hollow stem pith when pruning, as this is evidence of damage. They are particularly troublesome on red currants. Identification: The 1/2-inch-long adult resembles a wasp, though this pest is actually a moth with clear wings and a wingspan of about 3/4 inch. The larva is white with a light-brown head. Life Cycle: Adult moths emerge from the canes in the spring and lay their eggs on the canes in early summer. In a little more than a week, the larvae hatch and enter the cane where they feed while tunneling through the pith. They overwinter as larvae, cause little damage while feeding briefly during the spring, pupate, and emerge as adults. Monitoring and Control: These branches should be pruned below the damage and destroyed. Adults fly well and can be seen hovering around the canes. Insecticides should be applied to target adults and young larvae before they enter the canes. Insecticides applied after the larvae are protected inside the cane will have no effect.
Currant Fruit Fly (Gooseberry maggot, Currant maggot), Euphranta (formerly Epochra) canadensis (Diptera: Tephritidae)
Symptoms of Damage: A dark spot on the berry possibly surrounded by a reddened area. White larvae may be found in affected fruit. Infested berries usually drop prematurely, but when they dont, harvested fruit can be contaminated. Identification: Adults are a fly about 1/3 inch long. Their bodies are yellow with shading and their wings are banded. Life Cycle: Adults emerge from soil in the spring and lay eggs under the skin of fruit. Eggs hatch in 5 to 8 days, and larvae then feed in the fruit for 11 to 16 days. Larvae may continue to feed once berries have fallen to the ground. Larvae enter the soil and pupate over the winter. Monitoring and Control: Early varieties may escape damage. Collecting and destroying fallen fruit regularly before larvae hatch may have some effect on populations. Monitor for adultsusually found in shady areas of the plantstarting at petal fall. Treat if adults are seen.
inseCts
aphids, various species, especially Currant aphid, Cryptomyzus ribis (Homoptera: Aphididae)
Symptoms of Damage: Foliage is distorted, crinkled, curled, and sometimes
223
in midsummer, but it tends to be much lower in numbers, possibly because of predation by natural predators. This second generation overwinters as pupae. Monitoring and Control: Watch for larvae starting just after bloom as the fruits start to enlarge. Cultural control involves being observant of growing conditions and keeping plants vigorous. Insecticides may be applied, if necessary.
young (crawlers), which move to a new location, begin feeding, and form their own shells. The scale insects reach maturity in 25 to 30 days. Two generations occur per year. Monitoring and Control: Superior oil at bud break will help. See Chapter 3 for general guidance on using pesticides safely.
Weeds
Good weed control begins years before planting. Begin by identifying perennial weed problems in the field. Eliminate these weeds before planting by rotating to crops in which the target perennial weed can be controlled and by using herbicides registered for the crop that control the target weeds. After harvest of these preceding crop(s), spend extra effort to continue control strategies. Early to mid-fall applications of glyphosate products or Banvel can be very effective. Use caution when applying residual herbicides including Banvel and Stinger, as carryover can affect crops the following year. Use cover crops to aid in suppressing weed growth. A permanent sod such as hard fescue between the rows is effective in controlling weeds in established plantings. Within-row weeds can then be controlled with appropriate herbicides or landscape fabric. Herbicides labeled for use in bearing and nonbearing currants and gooseberries are Casoron, certain glyphosate products (Roundup, Touchdown, and others), Gramoxone Max 3SC and Gramoxone Inteon 2.76SC, Scythe, Rely, and Surflan AS. Devrinol 50DF is labeled for use on bearing and nonbearing currants. Fusilade DX, Select 2EC, Gallery 75DF, and Snapshot 2.5TG are labeled for use only on nonbearing currants and gooseberries (plants that wont be harvested for at least one year). Other formulations with the same inactive ingredients may exist that are labeled for the same uses. Glyphosate products and Gramoxone, Scythe and Rely are nonselective postemergence materials. Glyphosate products are translocated within and therefore kill the entire plant, even though only a portion of the plant may
have come in contact with the herbicide. Fusilade and Select are selective postemergence materials that are also translocated in the plant, but are effective only on grasses. Gramoxone and Scythe are nontranslocated contact herbicides, and kill only the portion of the plant with which they come in contact. Because of this feature, the roots of treated weeds survive, and control of perennial weeds is only temporary. Good coverage is a necessity, as untreated portions of the leaves and stems will continue to live. Rely is partially translocated. Casoron, Gallery, Surflan, Devrinol, and Snapshot are preemergence materials, so they must be applied before weeds have germinated. Gallery is effective against annual broadleaves, while Surflan and Devrinol are effective against annual grasses and certain annual broadleaves. Casoron and Snapshot are effective against both annual grasses and annual broadleaf weeds. Casoron also controls some perennials. Before use, always consult the herbicide labels for precautions, reentry intervals, and preharvest intervals. Remember that weeds compete with each other, not just with crop plants. Therefore, controlling a particular weed or group of weeds may allow another weed species to take over, requiring adjustments to your control strategies.
224
At bud break. When disease symptoms appear, then as needed. Rally is labeled for anthracnose on gooseberries only.
Powdery mildew
White pine blister rust When pustules are visible on leaf undersides inseCts San Jose scale Aphids At bud break Whenever aphids are found.
Target adults starting soon after bud break, then larvae as fruits start to enlarge. As adults are noted, starting at petal fall. Delegate is for suppression.
225
table 9.1. Pesticides for Ribes disease and insect control, continued.
Pest Currant borer Timing of Treatment/Comments Late spring to early summer. Pyganic should target adults and Bt products should target larvae before they enter the cane. Insecticides will have no effect once larvae are protected inside the cane. Groupa 3 11 3 3 3 Product Labeled Rate/Ab (Days to Harvest) Pyganic EC 5.0, 4.518 oz (0), or Bt products, various rates (0), or Danitol, 10.6716 fl oz (21)c Brigade WSB, 5.316.0 oz (1), or Pyganic EC 5.0, 4.518 oz (0)
Gooseberry fruitworm Target adults at early fruit development and again 10 days later.
a. Fungicide groups are listed in normal type; insecticide groups are italicized. Chemistry of fungicides by activity groups: 2 = dicarboximides; 3 = imidazoles or triazoles; 7 = carboxamides; 9 = anilinopyrimidines; 11 = strobilurins; 12 = phenylpyrroles; 17 = hydroxyanilides; 29 = activity group not named, chemical group = 2,6-dinitroanilines; M = chemical groups with multisite activity; NC = not classified. Fungicides with two activity groups listed contain active ingredients from two activity groups. Chemistry of insecticides by activity groups: 1B = organophosphates; 3 = pyrethrins and synthetic pyrethroids; 4A = neonicotinoids; 5 = spinosyns; 11 = Bt microbials. b. Some pesticides may be phytotoxic to plants. If in doubt; test a small area of the field first. Be sure sprayer is calibrated properly. c. Labeled for currants only.
226
227
it is grown, damage from frosts and freezes may be of concern nearly every year or only occasionally. The likelihood that frost protection will be needed varies because bloom time and critical temperatures are different for each crop. Frost protection will be needed during nearly every year for plasticulture strawberries; in most years for mattedrow strawberries; in only some years for blueberries, gooseberries, and currants; and almost never for brambles.
Contents
Green Manures ..................................................227 Frost and Freeze Protection ...............................227 Critical Temperatures for Frost Damage .......227 Types of Frosts and Freezes/Conditions Causing Their Occurrence ..........................................227 Environmental Parameters Affecting Frost Occurrence and Protection ...........................229 Effects of Environment on Frosts/Freeze Occurrence...................................................229 Methods for Protecting Plants from Frosts and Freezes ........................................................230 Taking Temperature Measurements .............231 Calibrating Temperature Instruments ..........231 Placement of Temperature Instruments.......232 Accuracy versus Resolution ..........................232 Types of Thermometers ...............................232 Other Gadgets .............................................233
228
table a.1. sample two-year preplant soil conditioning program. Timing Site Treatments and Cover Crops
TwO yEARS bEFORE PlAnTInG (year before planting for fall-planted plasticulture strawberries) March to early May Remove old trees, bushes, or vines and their roots. Plow the site thoroughly to expose additional woody roots and large rocks for removal. Collect and submit soil samples drawn from the top 1216 inches of soil for pH and basic fertility determinations. Plant sudex (sorghum x sudan grass hybrid variety of Sorghum bicolor) at 2025 pounds of seed per acre. Note: Sudex is the crop of choice because it produces a large amount of biomass in a short time and its roots will penetrate at least 4 feet deep or more. Mow this crop down in mid to late July before seed heads mature. In late August, an additional mowing may be necessary with a flail mower to reduce regrowth before plowing it down thoroughly with a moldboard plow. Plant Dwarf Essex rapeseed at 8 to 10 pounds of seed per acre. In addition to adding more organic matter to the soil, rapeseed produces chemicals that are toxic to plantparasitic nematodes. Two successive rapeseed crops plowed under as green manure reduce nematode populations equivalent to that achieved with a chemical soil fumigant.
Soil pH and Fertility Adjustments Apply lime to adjust soil pH to 6.06.5 (pH 4.54.8 if site is for blueberries). Incorporate these materials by deep plowing. If more than two tons of lime is required, apply half before plowing and incorporate the remaining half after plowing by disking. Before planting sudex, broadcast 50 pounds of actual nitrogen per acre and the required amounts of potassium and phosphorus needed for forage crops based on soil test results. An additional 30 pounds of actual nitrogen using ammonium sulfate should be applied after the first mowing to support the bulk of the plant residue of the sudex cover crop while providing some sulfur to subsequent rapeseed crop. Retest soil pH throughout the top 1216 inches and add lime to adjust pH to 6.5 if needed. Add 1520 pounds of additional nitrogen per acre as ammonium sulfate to support rapid, early growth of rapeseed crop. Note: The sulfur in the ammonium sulfate may acidify the soil slightly at this level, but the added availability of sulfur should increase the amount of toxicants produced within the plant.
Mid-May
Late August
OnE yEAR bEFORE PlAnTInG (year of planting for fall-planted plasticulture strawberries) Mid-April Mow rapeseed using a flail mower and plow down this plant residue immediately. Note: Mowing injures the plants and initiates a process that releases nematicidal chemicals into the soil. Never mow more area than can be plowed within 12 hours. Two weeks after plowing, plant a second crop of Dwarf Essex rapeseed at the same rate noted above. Mow the second rapeseed crop using a flail mower and plow down this plant residue immediately as done previously. Retest soil for basic fertility adjustments and then broadcast 50 pounds of actual nitrogen per acre (as ammonium sulfate) and sufficient phosphorus and potassium to support rapeseed based on test results.
Mid-August
After plowing down the second rapeseed crop, use a pH test to determine how much additional lime will be required to adjust the overall soil pH to 6.5. The soil pH on sites intended for blueberries should be 4.54.8 at this stage. Broadcast lime along with 1520 pounds of actual nitrogen (use calcium nitrate, not ammonium sulfate as nitrogen source). Disk the site deeply to incorporate these materials before planting the fescue cover crop. Note: Some Kentucky-31 seed is marketed as endophyte enhanced.The presence of these endophytes (fungi that live within the grass plant) improves growth and may improve nematode control. However, some endophytes are capable of producing toxins that are hazardous to livestock, so this seed and sod should be used only for this purpose, and not as a feed for livestock.
continued
Early September
For brambles and blueberries: Approximately 2 weeks after plowing down the second rapeseed crop, plant 20 pounds of certified Kentucky-31 seed and 10 pounds of winter oats per acre. For matted-row strawberries: Plant rye or barley as a winter cover crop unless soil fumigation is used to reduce weed problems. If soil is to be fumigated, plant winter cover crop after labeled treatment safe replant date. For plasticulture strawberries: Plant as discussed in the strawberry plasticulture section.
229
table a.1. sample two-year preplant soil conditioning program, continued. Timing Site Treatments and Cover Crops
yEAR OF PlAnTInG (except for plasticulture strawberries) April For brambles: Two weeks before planting, apply glyphosate (Roundup) herbicide as a directed spray to kill the K-31 sod cover in 4-foot-wide strips marking the planting rows. For matted-row strawberries. Proceed with planting as discussed in the strawberry chapter. For blueberries: Use a two-bottom moldboard plow to open a 4-foot-wide planting strip. See details on final soil preparation in the blueberry chapter.
Soil pH and Fertility Adjustments Leave the killed sod in place and set plants using a mechanical planter or suitable auger. Note: Killed sod does not compete with new plants, traps more rain than bare ground, reduces soil loss through erosion, and provides 14 weeks of weed suppression.
are sometimes called windborne freezes. This type of freeze is the most difficult against which to protect. The large air mass that moves in with this type of freeze is dry; therefore, frequently the dew point is considerably below freezing. Since frost or dew does not form until the temperature drops to the dew point, the white crystals typically seen in a frost or freeze may not form. If no frost crystals are visible, this type of event is sometimes referred to as a black frost. This color also can describe the appearance of the plants that were not sufficiently protected in this type of event.
frosts. Temperatures tend to be more uniform even across a distance of miles when windy conditions exist. Dew point is the temperature at which the relative humidity reaches 100 percent as the air cools. At this point, water vapor contained in the air condenses into fog or dew, which gives off heat, slowing the temperature drop. Consequently, on nights when the dew point is in the upper forties or higher, it is unlikely that temperatures will drop to damaging levels. The risk of frost becomes greater as the dew point becomes lower. When dew points are in the mid-30s, frost is very likely. Condensed moisture droplets that freeze or water vapor that sublimes (directly freezes into the solid form without condensing as a liquid first) release heat in doing so. Therefore, if the dew point is below freezingso that this heat release does not take place until below freezingtemperatures can drop to damaging levels extremely rapidly. Table A.3 can be used for determining
the approximate dew point temperatures as calculated from air temperature and relative humidity, the parameters most commonly available. Relative humidity is the amount of moisture contained in the air relative to the maximum amount that could be held. It changes with temperature and can change quickly with the air mass.
table a.2. Critical temperatures for cold damage of flower buds based on stage of development.
Note that with blueberries there is considerable variability in temperatures at which damage was reported for these growth stages. Strawberries Critical Temperature (F) blueberries Critical Temperature (F) Bud Emergence Tight Bud Popcorn Open Blossom Green Fruit 10 22 26 30 28 Bud Swell Tight Cluster Separate Flowers Visible Late Closed Blossom Open Blossom Petal Fall 1520 1823 2225 2526 27 28
Adapted from K. Perry, B. C. Poling, and Richard Funt. Strawberries. North Carolina State University; and E. Hanson, and M. Longstroth. Protecting Blueberries from Frost. Blueberries: Fruit Crop Advisory Team Alert 18: 3. Michigan State University.
230
warmer than the surrounding land, making the early winter low temperatures less severe, thus giving plants a chance to acclimate. In the late winter and early spring, the water remains cold, which keeps nearby air temperatures low, delaying early bud development on sensitive crops so that the incidence of damaging frosts is reduced. In these areas, less temperature variation also occurs between the daily minimum and maximum temperatures than elsewhere. Topography also affects frost occurrence. Cold air is heavier than warm air and, therefore, flows downhill. Temperatures are often higher at the tops of slopes, while cold air collects in the lower areas (frost pockets). Often the temperature will be 4 to 5 degrees lower in these frosty areas compared to higher surrounding areas. Areas surrounded by a continuous timberline of trees can also form a frost pocket, even though the site is elevated or has a slight slope because the high walls of the tree line prevent the free flow of cold air off of the site. At some point, though, elevation becomes problematic, especially in the more mountainous areas of western Maryland and Pennsylvania, where cold air is routinely encountered due to high elevation. In these regions, because bud break occurs later in the season when nights are shorter, frosts are often less severe. Southern slopes are generally warmer than those facing north, but plants on southern slopes will also come out of dormancy earlier, possibly negating this benefit in many instances. Soil moisture is an important component of frost protection since a moist soil will retain the heat of the day better than a dry soil. Moist soil will radiate captured heat back to the environment over a longer period of time. If the soil is dry, plantings should be irrigated a day or two ahead of an expected cold snap in order to allow time for heat to be captured. Soil texture and compaction are also factors since heavier soils with more clay retain heat better than sandy soils. Sandy soils are also often lighter in color and hence tend to reflect more sunlight, rather than absorbing it in the form of heat. Ground cover affects the amount of heat absorbed and released from the
table a.3. approximate dew points calculated from air temperature and relative humidity values. Relative Humidity (%) Dry-bulb 25 50 75 100 Temperature (F) Dew Point (F)
20 25 30 35 40 45 50 -8 -4 2 5 9 13 17 6 10 15 20 24 28 32 14 19 24 28 33 38 42 20 25 30 35 40 45 50
Adapted from Myers. G.E.S. Handbook No. 1. University of Georgia Cooperative Extension Service.
especially in the unfortunate situation when the sky remains cloudy until after sunset. When row covers are used for frost protection, they should be pulled onto the crop during mid-afternoon to allow heat to build up under the cover. Row covers can also be used in conjunction with sprinkler irrigation (see below) set up on top of the row cover to minimize the amount of water needed. Row covers used in this way have cut the amount of overhead irrigation needed for frost protection by about 50 percent on average. Heating or burning may require burning permits issued by local fire departments. It is the oldest method for frost protection, but it is not practical for low-growing small fruit crops like strawberries and is infrequently used in this region. However, if fires or heaters are used, several small ones are better than one large one. Twice as much heat will need to be produced to protect border rows as compared to interior rows. Wind machines work if a temperature inversion occurs (warm air present above a cold layer) and if there is no wind as with radiant-type freezes. They mix the air by pulling down the warm air from above to replace the colder air trapped near the soil surface. They only provide a few degrees of protection and, therefore, are sufficient protection primarily for crops that bloom relatively late when frosts are usually less severe. Sprinkler irrigation works well on all small fruit crops, but needs to be approached carefully. When used improperly the crop injury level can be greater than if it were not used at all, especially when conditions such as those associated with advective freezes (high wind and low dew point) develop and evaporative cooling occurs at crop level. However, used properly, irrigation can save a crop. Because sprinkler irrigation use can result in the application of large volumes of water to the crop, use should be delayed until greater than 10 percent of the blossoms are in danger of being damaged. Sprinkler irrigation for frost protection works because when water changes from a liquid to a solid (i.e., freezes) it gives off heat (called the heat of fusion)
soil surface. A bare, undisturbed moist soil with no ground cover can release sufficient heat to raise temperatures 2 to 3F in the plant canopy as compared to a sod-, grass-, or straw mulch-covered soil.
231
at the rate of 144 BTUs per pound. Enough water must be applied uniformly over the entire crop area so the heat of fusion offsets evaporative cooling as well as radiational and convective heat losses to maintain the temperature near 32F. As long as a film of water is over the ice that encases the stem and flowers, the plant will be protected against frost damage. Because of the effect of evaporative cooling, once irrigation is started for frost protection, do not stop it until the sun is up on the crop, temperatures are safely rising above critical temperatures, and ice is sloughing off, or damage can occur. Frost protection using irrigation works only if the system is already set up and fully functional prior to the frost event, so it should be tested to ensure that it works. An adequate supply of water is also needed. An acre-inch of water equals 27,154 gallons. To protect a 10-acre planting with solid set sprinklers applying 0.2 inches per hour, 54,308 gallons of water are needed for each hour of operation, or 271,540 gallons over a 5-hour protection period. At some growth stages, the critical temperature is very low, and startup of irrigation perhaps could be delayed until temperatures drop quite far. Even when this is the case, irrigation should still be started before ice freezing in the pump or lines can be a problem. Do not shut off the system if there is any chance water will freeze in the pump. Knowing the temperature at the pump or water source is helpful. A common recommendation is to start the system when the temperature at plant level falls to 4 degrees above the critical temperature (for example, 34F for open strawberry blossoms). If the dew point is below freezing, irrigation must be started soonerat a higher temperature. Table A.4 shows temperatures suggested for starting irrigation systems for cold protection for various critical plant temperatures and dew points. Damage may occur when the air temperature is several degrees above the freezing point because of evaporative cooling. When conditions of wind plus low humidity exist, the droplets could be below 32F by the time they reach the plant, so some injury could occur when the system is first started. Because of
this, the wet bulb temperature appears to be a better indication of when the irrigation system should be used rather than dry bulb (standard thermometer) temperature. Irrigation should be fully operating when the wet bulb temperature equals the critical temperature. Most overhead sprinkler systems are designed to deliver 0.1 to 0.2 acre-inches of water per hour and are useful for radiant freeze or frost protection when wind speeds are light and temperatures are not below the mid-twenties. Microsprinklers provide more uniform distribution than those having larger droplets and/or those covering a larger area. The rate at which water freezes, however, depends on several environmental factors, including air temperature, humidity, and wind speed. Generally, the lower the air and dew point temperatures, and/or the higher the wind speed, the greater the rate of freezing. A higher rate of water application is then required for adequate protection. Table A.5 provides a guide for determining the application rates for frost protection at various temperatures, wind speeds, and relative humidity levels. Note that the relative humidity makes a
table a.4. recommended temperatures for starting irrigation at various critical temperatures and dew points. Critical Dew Suggested Temperature Point Starting Air (F) (F) Temperature (F)
30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 30 29 27 25 24 22 20 17 32 31 29 28 26 24 22 20 18 32 33 34 35 37 38 39 40 34 35 36 37 38 40 41 42 43
large difference in needed application rates. When breezy conditions (5 mph) are forecast overnight, water supply lines should be moved closer together (from 60- to 40- or 30-foot centers) and the volume of sprinkler heads may still need to be increased by 0.15 to more than 0.25 inches per hour. At 5 to 10 mph, protection will be spotty and damage is a possibility despite your efforts. When wind speeds exceed 10 mph, the risks for crop damage from evaporative cooling due to inadequate water supply or uneven distribution of the water may outweigh the potential benefits. As mentioned above under the discussion of row covers, overhead irrigation pipes and sprinklers can be set up on row covers and irrigation started after the temperature under the row covers drops near the critical temperature. This is the safest way to protect crops in the case of advective freezes and greatly reduces the amount of water used regardless of the type of frost event. Water can either remain running or be turned off, as long as temperatures under the row cover are monitored with water turned on again if necessary. Because of the necessity of and time required for removing and reapplying the row covers (they can just be gathered into the row middles in which the irrigation pipes are located), this method is best suited for small-acreage plantings. Be sure to uncover the plants as early in the day as possible so that drying of the foliage and pollination can take place.
Source: Irrigation (formerly Sprinkler Irrigation). 1983. 5th edition. Arlington, Va.: The Irrigation Association.
232
curate temperature. Calibrate them by immersing the sensor in a 32F, gently stirred water and crushed ice slurry. It is best to have more ice than water. Be sure to allow enough time for the device to equilibrate fully, even if you need to keep adding ice to the mixture to keep the temperature at 32F. Make sure that the sensor or thermometer bulb is submerged in the water. Note that with liquid-in-glass min-max thermometers, the bulb is probably located at the top of the thermometer. While the thermometer is still in the slurry, note the temperature for use in correcting future readings. If the reading is above 32F, subtract the difference between 32 and the current reading from future readings. If the reading is below 32, add the difference to future readings. For example, if the ice bath temperature reads 30F, 2 degrees must be added to future outdoor or canopy temperatures measurements when using that particular thermometer. It helps to write the correction factor on a waterproof tag affixed to each thermometer using waterproof ink (for example add 2 degrees) in order to avoid confusion at critical times.
table a.5. irrigation application rates (inches/hour) for adequate protection of strawberries at various air temperatures, wind speeds, and relative humidity levels. Air Temperature, wind Speed (mph) Canopy level (F) 01 24 58 1014 1822
AT 50% RElATIvE HuMIDITy 27 24 20 18 AT 75% RElATIvE HuMIDITy 27 24 20 18 0.10 0.10 0.15 0.20 0.05 0.10 0.10 0.15 0.20 0.30 0.35 0.40 0.10 0.20 0.25 0.30 0.30 0.35 0.45 0.50 0.20 0.30 0.40 0.45 0.40 0.45 0.60 0.65 0.20 0.35 0.45 0.55 0.45 0.60 0.75 0.85 0.25 0.40 0.60 0.70
Adapted from Perry. 1986. FROSTPRO Application Rate Model. North Carolina State University.
give the impression that because the reading can be noted to the closest tenth or hundredth of a degree, the device measuring the temperature must be accurate. This is not necessarily the case. The reading may be very exact, but it may also be very wrong. Resolution is how fine the divisions are to which the thermometer can be read. Accuracy is how correct the device is. For example, a certain digital thermometer may be advertised as having a resolution of 0.1 degrees but an accuracy of plus or minus 2 degrees. Accuracy is the important figure. Sometimes youll see a notation that a thermometer is accurate to a certain percentage within its range. For example, if the device is listed as being accurate to within 0.5 percent in its range, and its range is -60 to 140F, it would be accurate to within 0.5 percent of this 200-degree range, or to within plus or minus 1 degree of any temperature read between -60 and 140F. This does not mean that it is accurate to within 0.5 percent of any given temperature.
is first started. Irrigation should be started when the wet-bulb temperature is 1 to 2 degrees above the critical temperature, depending on how long it takes to get your irrigation system fully operational. The irrigation should be fully running by the time the wet-bulb temperature drops to the critical temperature. Thermocouple thermometers are generally capable of measuring a wide range of temperatures and have very good accuracy, such as being within plus or minus 0.05 percent of the temperatures in their ranges. However, because some types may be capable of reading temperature ranges of hundreds of degrees, the accuracy in terms of degrees may not be much different than that of a liquid-in-glass thermometer, though generally their accuracy is extremely good. So, calibration in an ice-water bath is still recommended before use. The thermocouple probes themselves are quite cheap, but the device to which they connect that produces the readable output can be pricey. Thermistor themometers are probably the best option for accuracy, as they are designed to read a relatively narrow temperature range, and have good accuracy. There are models that will be accurate to within plus or minus 0.5 with prices in the moderate range. Calibration is still recommended.
types of thermometers
Liquid-in-glass thermometers, usually relatively inexpensive in price, can vary in their readings. However, they usually vary less than dial thermometers and are a good value. Just be sure to calibrate them as described above. The thermometer can be laid horizontally in the ice slurry. Wet-bulb thermometers tell to what temperature the plant will drop when irrigation
233
other gaDgets
Electronic devices and plug-in probes offer some useful advantages over standard thermometers. For example, if row covers are being used and the probe is positioned under the row cover with connecting wires outside of it, the temperature under the row cover can be measured without needing to pull the row cover off or crawl under the row cover to check the temperature. Also, once irrigation is turned on, the temperature in the field can be monitored. This may provide peace of mind on windy nights when growers question whether their irrigation rate is sufficient, though little can be done at this point if it is not. One last important note about electronic devices is that the number display on many digital units is not meant to withstand temperatures below freezing, so the display could black out when you need it the most! So, you should not plan on leaving the electronic part of the device outside. Instead, use it in the field only when actually obtaining the reading. Frost alarms and alerts are especially valuable if your field is farther than walking distance away from where you live. Once the temperature drops to a certain point, the alarm sounds a buzzer, calls you on the phone, or flashes a light, depending on the model. If you get a model that calls you, it will likely need to be located where there is access to a phone line. If there is no access to needed utilities near your field, the frost alarm can be installed elsewhere, with the alert temperature set high enough to allow for differences between its location and the field. A recent addition to the equipment that can be used is a device that flashes a light color-coded to the temperature and visible from more than a mile away. This means that it is possible to track the temperature in your field from some distance away or monitor fields in several locations at one time.
234
235
introduction
Various services exist to assist you in making management decisions. These include soil and tissue analysis; disease, insect, or weed identification; and nematode assays. Your extension educator can assist you in determining which service(s) you need. Both university and private laboratories are listed below, along with information on how to obtain sample submission materials. When university-operated labs provide a free service, samples are usually only accepted from clients within the state. When the service is provided at a reduced cost, labs may accept samples from both in-state and out-of-state clients but with a different fee structure. In other cases, labs can accept samples from any state for the same charge. Contact your extension office or visit each laboratorys Web site for current pricing. In any event, when using a university lab, use the one within your home state to the extent possible. Recommendations are likely to be based on research conducted within the state, specific to local conditions and problems. For problem diagnosis, it is strongly recommended that growers work with their county extension offices, as your local extension educator may be able to help with identifying the problem and provide suggestions for avoiding the problem in the future, as well as correcting existing issues. Your county extension office should have sample submission materials available, or be able to provide you with information on how to obtain them for university-operated labs within your state. Most labs also have this information on their Web sites. Private labs should be contacted directly for requirements for sending in samples. Omission of laboratories within the region from the listings below implies only a lack of information about the omitted lab, not a lack of suitability or accuracy.
Diagnostic Services
of the plants, or at the wrong times can waste time and money and result in either inconclusive or erroneous determinations.
contents
Introduction ......................................................235 Collecting Meaningful Samples and Shipping ....235 Soil Samples for Nutrient Analysis................235 Plant Samples for Nutrient Analysis .............235 Plant Samples for Disease Diagnosis ............236 Insect Identification ....................................236 Soil Samples for Nematode Testing ..............236 Other Types of Samples ................................236 University Laboratories .....................................236 Penn State ...................................................236 Rutgers University .......................................237 University of Delaware ................................237 University of Maryland ................................237 Virginia Tech ................................................237 West Virginia University ..............................238 Private Laboratories in the Mid-Atlantic Region .238 Virus Testing......................................................239 Tissue Analysis Results.......................................239 Specific Element Recommendations for Strawberries at Renovation ..................................239 Specific Element Recommendations for Brambles .....................................................240 Specific Element Recommendations for Blueberries ..................................................241 University Nematode Assay Forms/Instructions ... 242 Penn State ...................................................242 Rutgers University .......................................243 University of Delaware ................................243
236
How Many Leaves to Sample A minimum of 30 leaves of raspberries, blackberries, and strawberries, or 60 leaves of blueberries should be selected for each sample. All leaves comprising each sample should preferably be from the same cultivar, although they should be taken from different plants.
a container for your insect, and a preaddressed mailer. Usually soft-bodied insects should be sent in 70 percent alcohol, and hard-bodied insects sent in dry. Check with your lab, however, as preferences may differ. Be sure to send your insect in quickly.
Handling Samples
Detach leaves and remove the petioles. Place leaves in a dry paper bag and send immediately. Note: In the unusual situation that you suspect very variable soil conditions are causing localized nutrient deficiencies, sample the plants from the problem area(s) independently and use another kit to sample leaves from healthier plants.
insect identification
Insect Identification Lab Department of Entomology The Pennsylvania State University 501 Agricultural Sciences and Industries Bldg. University Park, PA 16802 Kits are available at Pennsylvania county extension offices.
inSect iDentification
Various departments and/or clinics at universities in the region provide insect identification services. Kits provided usually consist of an information form,
237
nematode assays
Penn State Nematode Diagnostic Service 290 University Drive Biglerville, PA 17307-0330 A copy of the Penn State Nematode Assay Form is provided at the end of Appendix B. This form may be copied as many times as needed and used for submitting samples to the lab for testing. To take samples, follow the steps outlined above and in Chapter 1.
Street Address (for delivery services other than U.S. Mail): Plant Diagnostic Laboratory Rutgers NJAES Ralph Geiger Turfgrass Education Center 20 Indyk-Engel Way North Brunswick, NJ 08902 Phone: 732-943-9140 Fax: 732-932-1270 E-mail: clinic@njaes.rutgers.edu Web site: njaes.rutgers.edu/plantdiagnosticlab
in PDF format are available at ag.udel. edu/Extension/pdc/pdf/Nematode_Assay_taking_samples.pdf and are also included at the end of this appendix. Check with the lab before sending in a sample to obtain the current pricing.
univerSity of marylanD
Diagnosis of plant Diseases and plant and insect identification
Plant Diagnostic Laboratory Department of Entomology Room 3171 Plant Sciences Building University of Maryland College Park, MD 20742 Phone: 301-405-1611 Fax: 301-314-9290 E-mail: rane@umd.edu Web site: www.plantclinic.umd.edu In-state samples should be submitted through county extension offices, though they may also be mailed in directly. Specimen submission forms may be downloaded from the labs Web site.
rutgerS univerSity
Rutgers has a soil and tissue testing laboratory, and a plant diagnostic laboratory.
univerSity of DelaWare
Soil testing
University of Delaware Soil Testing Program 152 Townsend Hall 531 S. College Avenue Newark, DE 19717-1303 Phone: 302-831-1392 Fax: 302-831-0605 E-mail: 11462@udel.edu Web site: ag.udel.edu/other_websites/ DSTP Kits may be obtained from extension offices in New Castle, Kent, and Sussex counties, at the soil testing lab, or by mail from the soil testing lab.
plant Diagnoses
At Rutgers Plant Diagnostic Laboratory and Nematode Detection Service, services available are disease and insect pest diagnosis and identification, plant and weed identification, fungus and mold identification, nematode assays, fungicide resistance screening, and more. Fee schedules and information forms are from the labs Web site, through Rutgers Cooperative Extension offices, or the lab will fax them to you in response to your phone or fax request. The nematode sampling form and instructions are included at the end of this appendix as well. Check with the lab before sending in nematode samples in case prices have changed since this printing. Mailing Address: Plant Diagnostic Laboratory Rutgers NJAES PO Box 550 Milltown, NJ 08850-0550
virginia tecH
Soil testing
Samples must be submitted through county extension offices, from which submission forms are available. Fee structure varies between commercial and noncommercial samples. Samples are accepted from out-of-state clients for a higher fee. Virginia Tech Soil Testing Lab 145 Smyth Hall (0465) Blacksburg, VA 24061
238
The form to include with weed samples (Pub. 450-138) is available through county extension offices.
Weed identification
Rakesh S. Chandran 1076 Agricultural Sciences Building PO Box 6108 West Virginia University Morgantown, WV 26506-6108 Phone: 304-293-6131 ext. 4225 Web form: www.wvu.edu/~agexten/ipm/ identify/weedform.htm
Soil testing
WVU Soil Testing Laboratory Division of Plant and Soil Sciences PO Box 6108 Morgantown, WV 26506-6108 Phone: 304-293-6023, ext. 4312 Fax: 304-293-2960 E-mail: wvusoilslab@wvu.edu Web site: www.caf.wvu.edu/~forage/3201.htm
insect identification
Insect Identification Laboratory Eric R. Day, Manager Department of Entomology Virginia Tech Blacksburg, VA 24061 Web site: www.idlab.ento.vt.edu
Disease identification
Dr. John F. Baniecki WVU Extension Pest ID Lab G101 south Agricultural sciences Building PO Box 6108 Morgantown, WV 26506-6108 Phone: 304-293-6023, ext. 38835 Web form for diseases: www.wvu .edu/~agexten/ipm/identify/farmdisf.htm
nematode identification
Nematode Assay Laboratory 115 Price Hall Virginia Tech Blacksburg, VA 24061-0331 Phone: 540-231-4650 Fax: 540-231-7477 E-mail: jon@vt.edu Web site: www.ppws.vt.edu/~clinic/ nematode.php Use the Nematode Predictive Assay Report (Pub. 450-098) or Nematode Diagnostic Assay Report (Pub.450-901) for submitting samples. Forms are available through Virginia county extension offices. Instructions on how to sample are available from the labs Web site.
insect identification
Pest Identification Laboratory West Virginia Department of Agriculture 1900 Kanawha Blvd. East Charleston, WV 25305-0191 Phone: 304-558-2212 Samples may also be sent to: Wvu Extension Pest Id Lab G101 South Agricultural Sciences Building Po Box 6108 Morgantown, Wv 26506-6108 Phone: 304-293-6023, ext. 38835 Web form for insects: www.wvu .edu/~agexten/ipm/identify/insform.htm
Weed identification
Weed ID Clinic Department of Plant Pathology, Physiology, and Weed Science Virginia Tech Blacksburg, VA 24061-0331 Web site: www.ppws.vt.edu/~clinic/ weedid.php
239
J. R. Peters analyzes plant tissue, nutrient solutions, and soilless media and offers a media physical analysis.
virus testing
Testing for viral pathogens is relatively expensive, and requires following strict protocols. The lab should be called in order to discuss protocols to be followed before sampling or shipping. Agdia, Inc. 30380 County Road 6 Elkhart, IN 46514 USA Phone: 574-264-2014 or 800-62-AGDIA (800-622-4342) Fax: 574-264-2153 E-mail: info@agdia.com Web site: www.agdia.com
sample is below 2.0 percent. Apply N at renovation and again in midSeptember. N is within desired range, but nitrogen to potassium (K) ratio is greater than 1.5: To improve the balance between N and K in your plants, reduce your N application by 10 percent. Apply N at renovation and again in mid-September. High N (if N is above 2.8 percent): Reduce rate of N application by 10 percent for each 0.1 percent that the sample exceeds 2.8 percent. Apply N at renovation and again in midSeptember.
Source: Hill System Plastic Mulched Strawberry Production Guide for Colder Areas, Virginia Tech, VCE Pub. 438-018.
phosphorus (p)
Low P (if P is below 0.25 percent): Apply superphosphate at 200 pounds per acre (45 percent P2O5) at any time to the soil surface. High P (if P is above 0.4 percent): Omit phosphate from fertilizer program.
K is within range, but N to K ratio is greater than 1.5 and K to Mg ratio is less than 3.0: To improve the balance between N and K, increase K to a total of 80 pounds actual K. K is within range, but N to K ratio is less than 1.0 and K to Mg ratio is greater than 4.0: To improve the balance between K and Mg, omit K from your fertilization program.
potassium (K)
Low K (if K is below 1.5 percent): Apply actual potassium at 45, 50, 70, 90, or 100 pounds per acre for soil management groups I (clay), II, III, IV, and V (sand), respectively. If magnesium (Mg) is also low, sulfate of potash-magnesia (Sul-Po-Mag) can be used as a source of K at five times the above rates. High K (if K is above 2.5 percent): Discontinue use of K fertilizer for one year.
calcium (ca)
Low (if Ca is below 0.7 percent): Apply lime if pH is less than 6.0. See soil test recommendation for adjusting soil pH. If pH is greater than 6.0, apply calcium sulfate at 1,000 pounds per acre. High (if Ca is above 1.7 percent): May indicate improper soil pH. See soil test recommendation for adjustments.
240
magnesium (mg)
Low (if Mg is below 0.3 percent) four alternatives: 1. Apply magnesium sulfate (Epsom salts) to the soil surface in late fall or spring at 200 pounds per acre. 2. Sulfate of potash-magnesia (Sul-PoMag) can be used if potassium is also low. Use at same rate as magnesium sulfate. 3. Apply dolomitic limestone according to soil test recommendations if pH is below 5.5. 4. Three foliar sprays of magnesium sulfate at two-week intervals beginning after renovation will temporarily correct deficiency (15 pounds per 100 gallons per acre). Mg is in range, but K to Mg ratio is greater than 5.0: To improve the balance between K and Mg, increase Mg application to a total of 80 pounds per acre actual Mg. High Mg (if Mg is above 0.5 percent): Omit addition of Mg.
High Fe: May be toxic if levels exceed 500 ppm. Contamination from sprays may give artificially high readings.
pH is within desired range, apply 10 pounds per acre zinc sulfate to soil in fall. Zn is in desired range, but P to Zn ratio is greater than 140: To improve the balance between phosphorus and zinc, apply 2 pounds of zinc chelate per 100 gallons per acre four times during the growing season. Follow label instructions. High Zn (if Zn is above 50 ppm): May indicate fungicide contamination. Toxicity can occur if levels exceed 300 ppm.
copper (cu)
Low Cu (if Cu is below 7 ppm): Apply copper chelate (4 pounds per 100 gallons per acre) in a foliar spray before May 15. If condition persists for several consecutive years and soil pH is within desired range, apply copper sulfate at 20 pounds per acre to soil in late fall. High Cu (if Cu is above 20 ppm): May indicate low soil pH or contamination from sprays. Consult soil test recommendation to determine the need for lime.
boron (b)
Low B (if B is below 30 ppm): Apply solubor to the soil at the rate of 4 pounds per acre in early spring or late fall, or apply a foliar spray of Solubor (20 percent actual boron) at the rate of 1.5 pound of product per 100 gallons per acre in early spring and again after renovation. High B (if B is above 70 ppm): Discontinue use of boron. May be toxic if levels exceed 100 ppm.
manganese (mn)
Low Mn (if Mn is below 50 ppm): Apply a foliar spray of manganese sulfate (2 pounds per 100 gallons per acre) or manganese chelate (6 pounds per 100 gallons per acre) before September 15. Check for high soil pH. High Mn (if Mn is above 200 ppm): May indicate a low soil pH or contamination by fungicide or irrigation water. Consult soil test recommendation to determine need for lime. Contamination from sprays may give artificially high readings.
Zinc (Zn)
Low Zn (if Zn is below 20 ppm): Apply zinc chelate (2 pounds per 100 gallons per acre) once after renovation and again in early May of the following year. If condition persists for several consecutive years and soil
phosphorus (p)
Low P (if P is below 0.25 percent): Apply 200 pounds per acre superphosphate (45 percent P2O5) at any time to soil surface.
iron (fe)
Low Fe (if Fe is below 60 ppm): Apply ferrous sulfate at 4 pounds per 100 gallons per acre or iron chelate at 8 pounds per 100 gallons per acre as a foliar spray before September 15. If condition persists for several consecutive years and soil pH is within desired range, apply 25 pounds per acre iron chelate or 15 pounds per acre ferrous sulfate to soil in early spring.
241
High P (if P is above 0.40 percent): Omit phosphate from fertilizer program.
potassium (K)
Low K (if K is below 1.5 percent): Apply potassium sulfate at 90, 100, 140, 180, or 200 pounds per acre for soil management groups I, II, III, IV, and V, respectively (I = clay, V = sand). If Mg is also low, sulfate of potashmagnesia (Sul-Po-Mag) may be used at 2.5 times the above rates. Do not use muriate of potash. High K (if K is above 2.5 percent): Stop using potassium fertilizer.
High Mn (if Mn is above 200 ppm): May indicate a low soil pH or contamination by fungicide or irrigation water. Consult soil test recommendations to determine need for lime.
boron (b)
Low B (if B is below 30 ppm): Apply Solubor to soil in early spring at 4 pounds per acre, or apply a foliar spray of solubor (20 percent actual boron) at the rate of 1.5 pounds product per 100 gallons per acre in early spring. For summer bearers, apply again after harvest. High B (if B is above 50 ppm): Discontinue use of boron. May be toxic if levels exceed 100 ppm.
iron (fe)
Low Fe (if Fe is below 50 ppm): Apply ferrous sulfate at 4 pounds per 100 gallons per acre or iron chelate at 8 pounds per 100 gallons per acre as a foliar spray between harvest and September 15. For fall fruiting types, apply in June. If condition persists for several consecutive years and soil pH is within desired range, apply 25 pounds per acre iron chelate or 15 pounds per acre ferrous sulfate to soil in early spring. High Fe (if Fe is above 200 ppm): May be toxic if levels exceed 250 ppm. Contamination from sprays may give artificially high readings.
Zinc (Zn)
Low Zn (if Zn is below 20 ppm): Apply zinc chelate at the rate of 3 pounds per 100 gallons per acre in a foliar spray at leaf expansion and after harvest. For fall fruit types, apply in May and early July. If condition persists for several consecutive years and soil pH is within desired range, apply 10 pounds per acre zinc sulfate to the soil in fall. High Zn (if Zn is above 50 ppm): May indicate fungicide contamination. Toxicity may occur if levels exceed 300 ppm.
calcium (ca)
Low Ca (if Ca is below 0.6 percent): Apply lime as needed if pH is less than 6.0. See soil test recommendation for adjusting soil pH. If pH is greater than 6.0, apply 1000 pounds per acre calcium sulfate. High Ca (if Ca is above 2.5 percent): May indicate improper soil pH. See soil test recommendation for adjustments.
copper (cu)
Low Cu (if Cu is below 7 ppm): Apply copper chelate (4 pounds per 100 gallons per acre) in a foliar spray during leaf expansion in May. If condition persists for several consecutive years and soil pH is within desired range, apply 20 pounds per acre copper sulfate to soil in late fall. High Cu (if Cu is above 50 ppm): May indicate low soil pH or contamination from sprays. Consult soil test recommendation to determine the need for lime.
magnesium (mg)
Low Mg (if Mg is below 0.30 ppm): If pH is below 6.0, apply dolomitic limestone according to soil test recommendation. If not, apply 200 pounds per acre magnesium sulfate (epsom salts) or sulfate of potashmagnesia (Sul-Po-Mag) to soil surface in late fall or early spring. Three foliar sprays of magnesium sulfate at 15 pounds per 100 gallons per acre at leaf expansion, after harvest, and in late summer will temporarily correct the deficiency. High Mg (if Mg is above 0.90 ppm): Omit use of magnesium.
manganese (mn)
Low Mn (if Mn is below 50 ppm): Apply a spray of manganese sulfate (2 pounds per 100 gallons per acre) or manganese chelate (6 pounds per 100 gallons per acre) after harvest but before September 15. Check soil pH. For fall fruiting types, apply in June.
242
if below 5.0, use urea. Do not use ammonium nitrate or chloride fertilizers. Apply half of the nitrogen fertilizer at bud break and the remaining half four weeks later. High N (if N is above 2.1 percent): Reduce rate of nitrogen application by 10 percent for each 0.1 percent that sample exceeds desired level. If soil pH is above 5.0, use ammonium sulfate; if below 5.0, use urea. Do not use ammonium nitrate or chloride fertilizers.
Mg is in range and K-to-Mg ratio is greater than 5.0: To improve the balance between K and Mg, increase Mg application to a total of 80 pounds per acre actual Mg. High Mg (above 0.3 percent): May indicate high soil pH. Refer to soil test.
condition persists for several consecutive years and soil pH is within desired range (4.5 to 5.0), apply Solubor at 5 pounds per acre to soil surface in early spring. High B (above 50 ppm): Consult your county extension fruit educator if B is higher than 100 ppm.
manganese (mn)
Low Mn (below 50 ppm): Apply a foliar spray of manganese chelate at 6 pounds per 100 gallons per acre twice during the growing season. If product label offers a different recommendation, follow label recommendation. High Mn (above 500 ppm): Refer to soil test for possible pH adjustment.
Zinc (Zn)
Low Zn (below 15 ppm): Apply zinc chelate at 2 pounds per 100 gallons per acre postbloom, postharvest, and late summer. If product label gives a different recommendation, follow label recommendation. If condition persists for several consecutive years and soil pH is within desired range (4.5 to 5.0), apply 10 pounds per acre zinc sulfate to soil surface in early spring. High Zn (above 30 ppm): No application necessary.
phosphorus (p)
Low P (below 0.06 percent): Apply 180 pounds per acre superphosphate (45 percent P2O5) at any time. High P (above 0.18 percent): Omit phosphate from fertilizer program.
iron (fe)
Low Fe (below 70 ppm): Apply a foliar spray of iron chelate at 6 pounds per 100 gallons per acre in late summer and again after bloom the following year, but check product label and follow its recommendation. If conditions persist for several consecutive years and soil pH is within desired range (4.5 to 5.0), apply 25 pounds per acre iron chelate or 15 pounds per acre ferrous sulfate to soil in early spring. If product label offers a different recommendation, follow label recommendation. High Fe (above 300 ppm): No application necessary.
potassium (K)
Low K (below 0.40 percent): Apply 400 pounds per acre potassium magnesium sulfate or 160 pounds per acre potassium sulfate in fall or early spring. K is in range and K to Mg ratio is greater than 4.0: To improve the balance between K and Mg in your plants, omit K from your fertilization program. High K (above 0.65 percent): Omit K from fertilizer program.
calcium (ca)
Low Ca (below 0.4 percent): Refer to soil test and apply lime as needed if soil pH is below 4.0. Apply 1,000 pounds per acre calcium sulfate in fall or early spring if pH is above 4.0. High Ca (above 0.8 percent): Refer to soil test for pH adjustment.
penn State
(See page 244.)
copper (cu)
Low Cu (below 5 ppm): Apply a postbloom and postharvest spray of copper chelate at 2 pounds per 100 gallons per acre. If product label gives a different recommendation, follow label recommendation. High Cu (above 30 ppm): No application necessary.
magnesium (mg)
Low Mg (below 0.2 percent): Refer to soil test and apply dolomitic limestone if pH is below 4.0. If pH is above 4.0, apply 250 pounds per acre magnesium sulfate or use Sul-Po-Mag (400 pounds per acre) if K is also low. Apply in fall or early spring.
boron (b)
Low B (below 30 ppm): Apply solubor at 1.5 pounds per 100 gallons per acre as a foliar spray in late summer and again during early bloom. If product label gives a different recommendation, follow label recommendation. If
243
the area sampled, the more accurately the sample will represent the site. 2. In each field to be assayed, take a sample from each area that has a common cropping history and that will be planted with a single crop. For example, if a 4-acre field is to be planted with peaches next year and if half the field was in apples last season and the rest in woods, collect a sample from each area. 3. If the soil in the area to be sampled is variable, such as having a heavy clay soil in one portion and a sandy soil in another, take one composite sample from each soil type. 4. Preferably using a 1-by-12 inch sampling tube (or a trowel, small shovel, or similar tool if a sampling tube is unavailable), take at least 20 cores of soil from each sampling area. Samples should be taken to a depth of 9 to 12 inches. 5. Feeder roots, found at varying depths, are usually most abundant at the dripline, directly below the outer leaf canopy. Soil samples should be taken from the same area where the roots are growing. 6. Do not sample from dead or nearly dead trees. Nematodes feed on live roots and may migrate away from dying plants. Therefore, when sampling problem areas, the samples should be taken from adjacent trees that either appear healthy or show early symptoms of stress. Since nematodes are usually not uniformly distributed in a field, a carefully prescribed sampling procedure must be followed to obtain root and soil samples representative of the area surveyed. In addition, the samples must be properly handled and shipped to ensure that the nematodes remain alive until they are processed in the laboratory. Samples can be taken anytime, as long as the soil is moist and the temperature is above 40F. If there has been a prolonged dry spell, or if the soil has been saturated with water for an extended period, wait until normal soil-moisture conditions return before sampling.
Handling Samples
Take the following steps when handling samples: 1. Make certain that all information requested is included on the nematode assay form that you receive with the assay packet. This information is needed to identify the sample and to aid in interpreting assay data. If you collect more than one sample, you must assign a field number to each area sampled and place that number in the appropriate area of the form. Each plastic bag should be sealed tightly by tying it with the twistum found in the bag. A separate assay packet must be used for each composite sample. 2. Keep samples out of direct sunlight to avoid overheating. Samples may also be damaged by heat if they are stored in the trunk of a car or other hot location. Use a cooler to keep samples cool. Heat kills nematodes, and dead nematodes are unsuitable for identification. 3. When the assay forms are completely filled out and the plastic bags are sealed, place the samples in a suitable container and send or bring them promptly to the address below. Note: Send the samples using a service that will assure delivery within 12 days. Penn State Nematode Diagnostic Service College of Agricultural Sciences PO Box 330 290 University Drive Biglerville, PA 17307 4. A fee of $15 will be charged for each sample. Payment by check made out to The Pennsylvania State University must be submitted at the same time as the soil sample. For more information, contact the Penn State Nematode Diagnostic Service at 717-677-6116.
rutgerS univerSity
(See pages 24546.)
univerSity of DelaWare
(See pages 24748.)
244
Fee: $15.00/Sample payable to: The Pennsylvania State University Ph. 717-677-6116 ext #3 FAX 717-677-4112 Paid:___________ Date:__________
Please complete left side of form Grower Sample # _____ Lab Sample # _______ Return results to: _______________________ ____________________________________ Mailing address: _______________________ ____________________________________ ____________________________________ Telephone #: __________________________ County: ______________________________ Sampled by: ________Date sampled: ______ ____________________________________ No. subsamples to make composite: ________ Soil type: ____________________________ {light, medium, heavy, other (describe)} _______ ____________________________________ Has a nematicide or fumigant been used? Yes _______________No _______________ If yes, which product? __________________ When applied? ________________________ Reason for assay: Problem avoidance ______ ____________________________________ Problem diagnosis _____________________ ____________________________________ ____________________________________ Tree Fruit / Small Fruit / Grapes Present Crop:________Variety: ____________ Rootstock: _________Age? _____________ Previous Crop: _______# Years? ___________ Future plans: _______When? ____________ __________________ Field Crops / Vegetables / Turf Present Crop:_____________ Variety: ______ Previous Crops: last yr. ______ 2 yrs ago _____ Future Crop: __________________________ ____________________________________ Description of current problems: Check all that apply. Aboveground symptoms: Yellowing Stunting Stem Pitting Comments Necrosis Wilting _________________________________________________________________ _________________________________________________________________ _________________________________________________________________ _________________________________________________________________ _________________________________________________________________ _________________________________________________________________ _________________________________________________________________ Rot Localized __________________ Nematode Control Options: Soil fumigation __________________________ Rotation Nematicide __________________________ Resistant variety ________________________________________________________________ ________________________________________________________________ GENERAL RECOMMENDATION No action required Risk index (estimated risk that nematodes will damage crop and/or reduce yield) 0 = Zero risk, 1 = Low, 2-3 = Moderate, 4 = High, 5 = Severe Risk index = ________________ DIAGNOSIS A nematode problem is indicated Possible nematode problem Nematode Dagger Root-lesion Ring Root-knot Pin Spiral Stunt Lance Sheath Cyst Stubby root Needle Other Nematode counts by: _________________________________________Date: _______________ (Xiphinema) (Pratylenchus) (Criconemella) (Meloidogyne) (Paratylenchus) (Helicotylenchus) (Tylenchorhynchus) (Hoplolaimus) (Hemicycliophora) (Heterodera) (Trichodorus) (Longidorus) RESULTS Nematodes / 100 cc soil Funnel Centrifuge Nematodes / gm root tissue
No problem detected
Action is advisable
___________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________ _________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
245
246
247
248
249
Aarons Creek Farms, Inc. 380 Greenhouse Dr. Buffalo Junction, VA 24529 Phone: 800-487-8502 Fax: 434-374-2055 E-mail: info@strawberryplants.com Web site: www.strawberryplants.com A. G. Ammon Nursery, Inc. 1610 Rte. 532 Chatsworth, NJ 08019 Phone: 609-726-1370 Fax: 609-726-1270 Awald Farms 2195 Shirley Road North Collins, NY 14111 Phone: 716-337-3162 E-mail: Sales@awaldfarms.com Web site: awaldfarms.com/index.html Barwacz Farm 05146 59th St. Grand Junction, MI 49056 Phone: 888-511-4419 or 269-253-4419 Fax: 269-253-4495 E-mail: info@barwaczfarm.com Web site: www.barwaczfarm.com Boston Mountain Nurseries 20189 N. Hwy. 71 Mountainburg, AR 72946 Phone and Fax: 479-369-2007 E-mail: pense@valuelinx.net Web site: www.alcasoft.com/ bostonmountain Briggs Nursery, LLC 715 South Bank Rd. PO Box 658 Elma, WA 98541 Phone: 800-444-1515 Fax: 360-482-6187 E-mail: sales@briggsnursery.com Web site: www.briggsnursery.com Cedar Valley Nursery 3833 McElfresh Rd. SW Centralia, WA 98531 Phone: 360-736-7490 Fax: 360-736-6600 (Custom propagating of Rubus cultivars in addition to standard production)
Cottle Strawberry Nursery, Inc. 192 Ned Cottle Lane Faison, NC 28341 Phone: 910-267-4531 Fax: 910-267-0156 Web site: www.cottlefarms.com Daisy Farms 28355 M-152 Dowagiac, MI 49047 Phone: 269-782-6321 Fax: 269-782-7131 E-mail: daisyfarms@qtm.net Web site: www.daisyfarms.net DeGrandchamps Farm 76241 14th Avenue South Haven, MI 49090 Phone: 269-637-3915 or 1-888-4837431 Fax: 269-637-2531 E-mail: info@degrandchamps.com Web site: www.degrandchamps.com Fall Creek Farm and Nursery, Inc. 39318 Jasper-Lowell Rd. Lowell, OR 97452 Phone: 541-937-2973 Fax: 541-937-3373 E-mail: blueberries@fallcreeknursery .com Web site: www.fallcreeknursery.com/ Finch Blueberry Nursery 5526 Finch Nursery Lane Bailey, NC 27807 Phone: 800-245-4662 or 252-235-4664 Fax: 252-235-2411 E-mail: danfinch@earthlink.net Web site: www.danfinch.com Ghesquiere Farms, Inc.a, b RR #2 Simcoe, Ontario, Canada N3Y 4K1 Phone: 519-428-1087 Fax: 519-426-0073 E-mail: sales@ghesquierefarms.com G. W. Allen Nursery, Ltd.a 7295 Hwy 221, RR #2 Centreville, NS, Canada B0P 1J0 Phone: 902-678-7519 Fax: 902-678-5924 E-mail: sales@gwallennursery.com Web site: www.gwallennursery.com
As a service to our readers, we have cross-referenced various small fruit crops with the nurseries where they may be purchased (see table below). No endorsement of the nurseries is intended. Nurseries not listed that can supply quality plants in commercial quantities are requested to contact the coordinator of this publication if they wish to be included in this listing.
250
Hartmanns Plant Co. PO Box 100 Lacota, MI 49063-0100 Phone: 269-253-4281 Fax: 269-253-4457 E-mail: info@hartmannsplantcompany .com Web site: www.hartmannsplantcompany .com Indiana Berry and Plant Co. 5218 West 500 South Huntingburg, IN 47542 Phone: 800-295-2226 Fax: 812-683-2004 E-mail: inberry@psci.net Web site: indianaberry.com (Also carries an interesting assortment of berry-related items such as promotion supplies, picking containers, and bird-repellent devices; carries some equipment) Jersey Asparagus Farms, Inc. 105 Porchtown Rd. Pittsgrove, NJ 08318 Phone: 856-358-2548 Fax: 856-358-6127 E-mail: jaf@jafinc.com Web site: www.jerseyasparagus.com J. W. Jung Seed Company 335 S. High St. Randolph, WI 53956-0001 Phone: 920-326-5672 or 800-297-3123 Fax: 800-247-5864 E-mail: info@jungseed.com Web site: www.jungseed.com Koppes Plants, LLC PO Box 441 Watsonville, CA 95077 Phone: 831-724-6009 Fax: 831-724-5123 E-mail: koppesplants@sbcglobal.net Web site: www.koppesstrawberryplants .com Krohne Plant Farms, Inc. 65295 CR342 Hartford, MI 49057 Phone: 269-424-5423 Fax: 269-424-3126 E-mail: info@krohneplantfarms.com Web site: www.krohneplantfarms.com
Kube Pak Corp. 194 Rt. 526 Allentown, NJ 08501 Phone: 609-259-3114 Fax: 609-259-0487 E-mail: sales@kubepak.com Web site: www.kubepak.com Lassen Canyon Nursery, Inc. 1300 Salmon Creek Rd. Redding, CA 96003 Phone: 530-223-1075 Fax: 530-223-6754 E-mail: info@lassencanyonnursery.com Web site: www.lassencanyon-nursery .com Lewis Nursery and Farms, Inc. 3500 NC Hwy. 133 Rocky Point, NC 28457 Phone: 910-675-2394 Fax: 910-602-3106 E-mail: infess@bizec.rr.com Web site: www.ncagr.gov/nc-products/ ShowSite.asp?ID=2827 Norcal Nursery, Inc. PO Box 1012 Red Bluff, CA 96080 Phone: 530-527-6200 Fax: 530-527-2921 Northwoods Wholesale Nursery 28696 S. Cramer Rd. Mollala, OR 97038 Phone: 800-651-3738 or 503-651-3737 Fax: 503-651-3882 E-mail: jgilb@web-star.com Nourse Farms, Inc. 41 River Rd. S. Deerfield, MA 01373 Phone: 413-665-2658 Fax: 413-665-7888 E-mail: info@noursefarms.com Web site: www.noursefarms.com Schlabachs Nursery 2784 Murdock Rd Medina NY 14103 Phone: 585-798-6198 Simmons Berry Farm 11542 North Hwy. 71 Mountainburg, AR 72946 Phone and Fax: 479-369-2345 E-mail: simmonsplantfarm@hotmail .com Web site: www.simmonsplantfarm.com
Southmeadow Fruit Gardens 10603 Cleveland Ave. PO Box 211 Baroda, MI 49101 Phone: 269-422-2411 Fax: 269-422-1464*51 E-mail: smfruit@aol.com Web site: www.southmeadowfruitgardens.com Stokes Berry Farm 2822 Center Road Wilmington, OH 45177 Phone: 937-382-4004 Fax: 937-383-0317 E-mail: info@stokesberryfarm.com Web site: www.stokesberryfarm.com Strawberry Tyme Farms, Inc.a RR #2 Simcoe, Ontario, Canada N3Y 4K1 Phone: 519-426-3099 Fax: 519-426-2573 E-mail: info@strawberrytyme.com Web site: www.strawberrytyme.com Tower View Nursery 70912 CR-388 South Haven, MI 49090 Phone: 269-637-1279 Fax: 269-637-6257 V. Kraus Nurseries, Ltd.a,b PO Box 180, 1380 Centre Rd. Carlisle, Ontario, Canada L0R 1H0 Phone: 905-689-4022 Fax: 905-689-8080 E-mail: sales@krausnurseries.com Web site: www.krausnurseries.com Walter K. Morss & Son 76 Lakeshore Rd. West Boxford, MA 01921 Phone: 978-352-2633 Weeks Berry Nursery 6494 Windsor Island Road North Keizer, OR 97303 Phone: 503-393-8112 Fax: 503-393-2241 E-mail: plants@weeksberry.com Web site: www.weeksberry.com
251
Whitman Farms 3995 Gibson Road NW Salem, OR 97304 Phone: 503-585-8728 Fax: 503-363-5020 E-mail: Lucille@whitmanfarms.com Web site: www.whitmanfarms.com/ index.html Windermere Orchards & Nurserya RR 1 Berwick, NS B0P 1E0 Canada Phone: 902-538-3213 Fax: 902-538-0244 Zilke Bros. Nursery 8924 Cleveland Ave. Baroda, MI 49101 Phone: 269-422-2666
a. Phytosanitary certificates are required for importation of all small fruit crops from Canada. This may mean additional charges by Canadian nurseries; contact individual nurseries for details. In addition, importation of Rubus into the United States from Canada requires Form PPQ587 (application for permit to import plants), which may be obtained from individual states Department of Agriculture offices. Form may also be downloaded from the USDA APHIS Web site. Go to www .aphis.usda.gov/plant_health/permits/downloads/ forms/ppqform587.pdf. b. Distributes plants only through other nurseries. Call for information on distributors.
252
Source
Strawberry Dormant Plugs Blueberry Blackberry Gooseberry Currants Elderberry Hardy Kiwi Cranberry Misc.
Aarons Creek A. G. Ammon Awald Farms Barwacz Farm Boston Mountain Briggs Cedar Valley Nursery Cottle Strawberry Nursery, Inc. Daisy Farms DeGrandchamps Fall Creek Finch Ghesquiereb G. W. Allen Hartmanns Indiana Berry Jersey Asparagus J. W. Jung Koppes Krohne Kube Pak Lassen Canyon Lewis Nor-Cal Northwoods Nourse Schlabachs Nursery Simmons Southmeadow Stokes Strawberry Tyme Tower View V. Krausb Walter K. Morss Weeks Nursery Windermere Whitman Farms Zilke Bros.
a. Also supplies runner tips for growers who wish to root their own plug plants. b. Distributes through other nurseries. Call for information on local distributors.
253
No endorsement of the companies listed below is intended. Suppliers not listed that deal in commercial quantities are requested to contact the coordinator of this publication if they wish to be included in this listing.
Fly Bye Bird Control Products 13609 NE 126th Pl #150 Kirkland, WA 98034 Phone: 800-820-1980 Fax: 425-823-8170 E-mail: nobirds@flybye.com Web site: www.flybye.com (Netting and visual scare devices) Gemplers PO Box 44993 Madison, WI 53744-4993 Phone: 800-382-8473 Fax: 800-551-1128 E-mail: customerservice@gemplers.com Web site: www.gemplers.com (Visual and auditory scare devices) Hartmanns Plant Co. PO Box 100 Lacota, MI 49063-0100 Phone: 269-253-4281 Fax: 269-253-4457 E-mail: info@hartmannsplantcompany .com Web site: www.hartmannsplantcompany .com (Netting) Indiana Berry and Plant Co. 5218 West 500 South Huntingburg, IN 47542 Phone: 800-295-2226 Fax: 812-683-2004 E-mail: inberry@psci.net Web site: indianaberry.com (Scare-eye, netting, reflective tape) Industrial Netting 7681 Seltzer Pkwy. N. Minneapolis, MN 55445 Phone: 800-328-8456 or 763-496-6355 Fax: 763-496-6356 E-mail: info@industrialnetting.net Web site: www.industrialnetting.com (Netting) J. A. Cissel 1995 Rutgers University Blvd. PO Box 2025 Lakewood, NJ 08701 Phone: 800-631-2234 or 732-901-0300 Fax: 732-901-1166 E-mail: info@jacissel.net Web site: www.jacissel.net (Knitted netting)
Contents
Production Supplies ..........................................253 Bird Damage Control.....................................253 Cover Crop Seed ............................................254 High Tunnels.................................................254 IPMBeneficial Insects ...............................254 IPMMonitoring Supplies...........................255 Irrigation and Moisture Monitoring Supplies 255 Mammal Repellents......................................256 Mammal Cage or Box Traps ...........................256 Monofilament Grape Trellis Wire...................256 Packaging.....................................................257 Personal Protective Equipment.....................257 Petiole Sap Meters (Ion Meters) ....................257 pH Meters .....................................................257 Row Covers, Plastic Mulch .............................258 Promotional Supplies ...................................258 Specialized Equipment .................................258 Organic Products ...............................................259 Services .............................................................259 Analysis of Soil and Plant Tissue ....................259 Fumigation ...................................................259 Plastic Recovery ............................................259 Pollinators ....................................................259
254
JWB Marketing, LLC 2308 Raven Trail W. Columbia, SC 29169 Phone: 800-555-9634 or 803-939-9622 Fax: 803-796-0654 E-mail: JimB@birddamage.com Web site: www.birddamage.com (Distress calls, scare windmills, eagle and hawk kites) Nixalite of America, Inc. 1025 16th Ave. East Moline, Il 61244 Phone: 888-624-1189 Fax: 888-624-1196 E-mail: sales@nixalite.com Web site: www.nixalite.com (Netting, repellents, visual scare devices) Orchard Valley Supply, Inc. 5610 Harrisburg Industrial Park Dr. Harrisburg, NC 28075 Phone: 888-755-0098 or 704-455-4933 Fax: 704-455-4952 E-mail: info@orchardvalleysupply.com Web site: www.orchardvalleysupply.com (Visual and auditory scare devices) Reed-Joseph International Co. 800 Main St. PO Box 894 Greenville, MS 38702 Phone: 800-647-5554 Fax: 662-335-8850 E-mail: sales@reedjoseph.com Web site: www.reedjoseph.com (Visual and auditory scare devices, Rejex-it) Sutton Ag Enterprises, Inc. 746 Vertin Ave. Salinus, CA 93901 Phone: 866-280-6229 Fax: 800-482-4240 E-mail: info@suttonag.com Web site: www.suttonag.com (Netting, visual and auditory scare devices) Wildlife Control Technology, Inc. 2501 N. Sunnyside Ave. Fresno, CA 93727 Phone: 800-235-0262 Fax: 559-490-2260 E-mail: sales@wildlife-control.com Web site: www.wildlife-control.com (Netting, visual and auditory scare devices, owl nest boxes)
HigH tunnelS
Farmtek 1440 Field of Dreams Way Dyersville, IA 52040 Phone: 800-245-9881 Fax: 800-457-8887 Web site: www.farmtek.com (Single-bay tunnels) Haygrove USA Ralph and Keith Cramer 116 Trail Rd. North Elizabethtown, PA 17022 Phone: 877-CRAMERS or 717-3679494 Fax: 717-367-7287 E-mail: ralph.cramer@haygrove.com Web site: www.haygrove.co.uk (Multibay and single-bay tunnels) Greenhouse Supply, Inc. 12 Acme Rd., Suite 212 Brewer, ME 04412 Phone: 800-696-8511 Fax: 207-989-1553 E-mail: greenhse@agrotech.com Web site: www.agrotech.com (Single-bay tunnels) Ledgewood Farm 132 old mountain road Moultonborough, NH 03254 Phone: 603-476-8829 E-mail: ed@ledgewoodfarm.com Web site: www.ledgewoodfarm.com (Single-bay tunnels) Rimol Greenhouse Systems, Inc. 40 Londonderry Turnpike Hooksett, NH 03106 Phone: 603-629-9004 Fax: 603-629-9023 Web site: www.rimolgreenhouses.com (Single-bay tunnels, including moveable ones on tracks)
ipmBenefiCial inSeCtS
Biocontrol Network 5116 Williamsburg Road Brentwood, TN 37027 Phone: 800-441-2847 Fax: 615-370-0662 Web site: www.biconet.com
255
IPM Laboratories, Inc. PO Box 300 Locke, NY 13092-0300 Phone: 315-497-2063 Fax: 315-497-3129 E-mail: ipminfo@ipmlabs.com Web site: www.ipmlabs.com The Green Spot, Ltd. 93 Priest Rd. Nottingham, NH 03290-6204 Phone: 603-942-8925 Fax: 603-942-8932 E-mail: info@greenmethods.com Web site: www.greenmethods.com
Forestry Suppliers, Inc. 205 West Rankin St. PO Box 8397 Jackson, MS 39284-8397 Phone: 800-647-5368 Fax: 800-543-4203 E-mail: sales@forestry-suppliers.com Web site: www.forestry-suppliers.com (Tensiometers, other soil moisture sensing equipment) Irrometer Company, Inc. PO Box 2424 Riverside, CA 92516-2424 Phone: 951-689-1701 Fax: 951-689-3706 E-mail: sales@irrometer.com Web site: www.irrometer.com (Tensiometers, other soil moisture sensing equipment) Lee Rain, Inc. 2079 E. Wheat Rd. Vineland, NJ 08361 Phone: 877-533-7878 or 856-691-4030 Fax: 856-691-1990 E-mail: sales@leerain.com Web site: www.leerain.com (Drip and overhead irrigation) Mazzei Injector Corp. 500 Rooster Dr. Bakersfield, CA 93307-5555 Phone: 661-363-6500 Fax: 661-363-7500 E-mail: info@mazzei.net Web site: www.mazzei.net (Injectors) Nolts Produce Supplies 152 North Hershey Ave. Leola, PA 17540 Phone: 717-656-9764 Fax: 717-556-0700 E-mail: j1160@earthlink.net O. A. Newton 16356 Sussex Highway Bridgeville, DE 19933 Phone: 800-726-5745 or 302-337-3718 Fax: 302-337-3780 E-mail: bill.w@oanewtonirrigation.com Web site: www.oanewtonirrigation.com (Irrigation systems and installation)
ipmmonitoring SupplieS
Gemplers PO Box 44993 Madison, WI 53744-4993 Phone: 800-382-8473 Fax: 800-551-1128 E-mail: customerservice@gemplers.com Web site: www.gemplers.com (Traps, monitoring equipment, watersensitive paper targets) Great Lakes IPM, Inc. 10220 Church Road Vestaburg, MI 48891-946 Phone: 800-235-0285 or 989-268-5693 Fax: 989-268-5311 E-mail: glipm@nethawk.com Web site: www.greatlakesipm.com (Baited and unbaited sticky traps, monitoring equipment) Trece, Inc. 7569 Highway 28 West PO Box 129 Adair, OK 74330 Phone: 866-785-1313 (for orders) or 918-785-3061 Fax: 918-785-3063 E-mail: custserv@trece.com Web site: www.trece.com (Traps, baits)
256
Penn State Seed Co. (main office) Highway 309, RR 1 Box 390 Dallas, PA 18612-9781 Phone: 800-847-7333 or 570-675-8585 Fax: 570-675-6562 E-mail: sales@pennstateseed.com Web site: www.pennstateseed.com (Overhead and trickle irrigation supplies)
Troyer Growers supply 810 rt. 975 Waterford, PA 16441 Phone: 866-876-9371 Fax: 814-796-1435 E-mail: sales@troyergrowers.com Web site: troyergrowers.com Zimmerman Irrigation, Inc. 3550 Chambersburg Rd. Biglerville, PA 17307 Phone: 800-452-5699 or 717-337-2727 Fax: 717-337-1785 E-mail: info@trickleez.com Web site: www.trickl-eez.com (Trickle and overhead irrigation supplies)
Miller Chemical and Fertilizer Corp. Box 333, 120 Radio Road Hanover, PA 17331 Phone: 717-632-8921 (Hot Sauce Animal Repellent) Nott Products Co., Inc. PO Box 975 Coran, NY 11727 Phone: 631-563-4455 Fax: 631-563-3950 Web site: www.nottproducts.com (Nibble-Not and Chew-Not) Cleary Corp. 1049 Route 27, PO Box 10 Somerset, NJ 08875 Phone: 800-524-1662 Web site: www.clearychemical.com
mammal repellentS
Biocontrol Network 5116 Williamsburg Road Brentwood, TN 37027 Phone: 800-441-2847 Fax: 615-370-0662 Web site: www.biconet.com Deer-Out, LLC PO Box 290 South Plainfield, NJ 07080 Phone: 908-769-4242 Fax: 908-769-3253 E-mail: info@deerout.com Web site: www.deerout.com (Deer-Off Deer Repellent) Faesy and Besthoff, Inc. 143 River Road PO Box 29 Edgewater, NJ 07020 Phone: 201-945-6200 (Rabbit and Dog Chaser) Havahart Woodstream Corp. 69 N. Locust Street Lititz, PA 17543 Phone: 800-800-1819 E-mail: consumercare@havahart.com Web site: www.havahart.com Hot Pepper Wax 305 Third St. Greenville, PA 16125 Phone: 800-627-6840 Web site: www.hotpepperwax.com
257
paCkaging
Belle Terre Irrigation 8142 Champlin Road Sodus, NY 14551 Phone: 866-478-3747 or 315-483-6155 Fax: 315-483-4064 E-mail: info@dripsupply.com Web site:www.dripsupply.com (Carries packaging supplies in addition to irrigation) First State Packaging, Inc. 511 Naylor Mill Rd. Salisbury, MD 21802 Phone: 410-546-1008 Fax: 410-546-5341 Frecon Orchard Supplies 231 Powder Mill Road Boyertown, PA 19512 Contact: Richard Frecon, Jr. Phone: 610-367-2933 Fax: 610-367-2934 E-mail: www.carton75@aol.com Growers Discount Labels PO Box 70 Tunnel, NY 13848 Phone: 800-693-1572 or 607-693-1572 Fax: 607-693-4415 E-mail: growersdiscountlabels@fds.net Web site: www.growersdiscount-labels .com (Custom labels) Jordan Seeds 6400 Upper Afton Road Woodbury, MN 55125 Phone: 651-738-3422 Fax: 651-731-7690 Web site: www.jordanseeds.com Kurt Zuhlke & Assoc., Inc. 20 Market St. Bangor, PA 18013-0609 Phone: 800-644-8729 E-mail: sales@producepackaging.com Web site: producepackaging.com Monte Package Co. 3752 Riverside Rd. Riverside, MI 49084-0126 Phone: 800-653-2807 or 269-849-1722 Fax: 269-849-0185 E-mail: sales@montepkg.com Web site: www.montepkg.com
Pactiv Corporation 1900 West Field Court Lake Forest, IL 60045 Phone: 888-828-2850 Web site: www.pactiv.com (Company headquarters; not a distributor) Putnam Plastics, Farm Products Div. 255 S. Alex Rd. West Carrollton, OH 45449 Phone: 800-457-3099 Fax: 937-866-9365 E-mail: packaging@putnamfarm.com Web site: www.putnamfarm.com Rockford Package Supply, Inc. 10421 Northland Dr. Rockford, MI 49341 Phone: 800-444-PACK or 616-866-0143 Fax: 616-866-4921 Web site: www.rockfordpack.com Southern Container Corp. 6003 Ward Blvd. Wilson, NC 27894-0216 Phone: 800-261-2295 Fax: 252-237-0308 E-mail: sales@socontainers.com Web site: www.socontainers.com/ BerryPackaging.htm Temple-Inland 342 E. York St. Biglerville, PA 17307 Phone: 800-222-8984 or 717-677-6111 Fax: 717-677-4394 Web site: www.templeinland.com Wasserman Bag Co., Inc. 70 Commerce Place Hicksville, NY 11801 Phone: 800-634-3828 Fax: 576-681-5900 E-mail: wassermanbag@aol.com Web site: www.wassermanbag.com
Lab Safety Supply PO Box 1368 Janesville, WI 53547-1368 Phone: 800-356-0783 Fax: 800-543-9910 Web site: www.labsafety.com Northern Safety Co., Inc. PO Box 4250 Utica, NY 13504-4250 Phone: 888-201-6074 Fax: 800-635-1591 Web site: www.northernsafety.com
pH meterS
Ben Meadows Co. (Lab Safety Supply) PO Box 5277 Janesville, WI 53547-5277 Phone: 800-241-6401 Fax: 800-628-2068 Web site: www.benmeadows.com Forestry Suppliers, Inc. 205 West Rankin St. PO Box 8397 Jackson, MS 39284-8397 Phone: 800-647-5368 Fax: 800-543-4203 Web site: www.forestry-suppliers.com Gemplers PO Box 44993 Madison, WI 53744-4993 Phone: 800-382-8473 Fax: 800-551-1128 E-mail: customerservice@gemplers.com Web site: www.gemplers.com
258
Griffins Greenhouse & Nursery Supplies Main office: 1619 Main St Tewksbury, MA 01876 Phone: 978-851-4346 Fax: 978-851-0012 Web site: www.griffins.com Local office: 200 Mountain View Rd. PO Box 709 Morgantown, PA 19543 Phone: 610-286-0046 Fax: 610-286-0012 E-mail: marbogast@griffinmail.com Pike Agri-Lab Supplies 154 Claybrook Rd Jay, ME 04239 Phone: 207-897-9267 Fax: 207-897-9268 Web site: www.pikeagri.com Spectrum Technologies, Inc. 12360 S. Industrial Drive East Plainfield, IL 60585 Phone: 800-248-8873 or 815-436-4440 Fax: 815-436-4460 E-mail: info@specmeters.com Web site: www.specmeters.com
Ken-Bar, Inc. Summit Industrial Park 147 Summit St. BLD 3B, Suite 3 Peabody, MA 01960 Phone: 800-336-8882 or 781-944-0003 Fax: 781-944-1055 E-mail: info@ken-bar.com Web site: www.ken-bar.com Penn State Seed Co. Highway 309, RR 1 Box 390 Dallas, PA 18612-9781 Phone: 800-847-7333 Fax: 570-675-6562 E-mail: sales@pennstateseed.com Web site: www.pennstateseed.com (See other locations under irrigation suppliers) Robert Marvel Plastic Mulch, LLC 2425 Horsehoe Pike Annville, PA 17003 Phone: 800-478-2214 or 717-838-0976 Fax: 717-838-0978 E-mail: info@robertmarvel.com Web site: www.RobertMarvel.com
SpeCialized equipment
Bdi Machinery Sales Co. 430 East Main St. Macungie, PA 18062-1713 Phone: 800-808-0454 Fax: 610-965-2959 E-mail: buydirect@bdimachinery.net Web site: www.bdimachinery.net Berry Hill Irrigation, Inc. 3744 Highway 58 Buffalo Jct., VA 24529 Phone: 800-345-3747 or 434-374-5555 Fax: 434-374-0131 E-mail: sales@berryhilldrip.com Web site: www.berryhilldrip.com Ferguson Manufacturing Co. PO Box 1098 Suffolk, VA 23434 Phone: 757-539-3409 Fax: 757-934-3612 E-mail: fermfgsu@nettek.net Web site: www.fergusonmfgco.com Hillside Cultivator Co., LLC 911 Disston View Drive Lititz, PA 17543 Phone: 717-626-6194 E-mail: sales@shenkberryfarm.com Web site: www.hillsidecultivator.com Kennco Manufacturing, Inc. PO Box 1149 Ruskin, FL 33575 Phone: 813-645-2591 Fax: 813-645-7801 E-mail: kenncomfg@aol.com Web site: www.kenncomfg.com Mechanical Transplanter Co. 1150 Central Avenue Holland, MI 49423-5230 Phone: 800-757-5268 or 616-396-8738 Fax: 616-396-3619 E-mail: mtc@mechanicaltransplanter .com Web site: www.mechanicaltransplanter .com
promotional SupplieS
Indiana Berry and Plant Co. 5218 West 500 South Huntingburg, IN 47542 Phone: 800-295-2226 Fax: 812-683-2004 E-mail: inberry@psci.net Web site: indianaberry.com Monte Package Co. 3752 Riverside Rd. Riverside, MI 49084-0126 Phone: 800-653-2807 or 269-849-1722 Fax: 269-849-0185 E-mail: sales@montepkg.com Web site: www.montepkg.com Rockford Package Supply, Inc. 10421 Northland Dr. Rockford, MI 49341 Phone: 800-444-PACK or 616-866-0143 Fax: 616-866-4921 Web site: www.rockfordpack.com
259
orgAniC produCts
The Fertrell Company 601 North Second Street Bainbridge, PA 17502 Phone: 800-347-1566 or 717-367-1566 Fax: 717-367-9319 Web site: www.fertrell.com McGeary Organics PO Box 299 Lancaster, PA 17608 Phone: 800-624-3279 Web site: www.mcgearyorganics.com
plaStiC reCovery
Zooks Plastic Recovery 183 S. Farmersville Road Leola, PA 17540 Phone: 717-656-4422 E-mail: daniel@zooksplastic.com Web site: www.zooksplastic.com (Buys used ag plastic; call for details)
pollinatorS
The Web site for the Mid-Atlantic Apiculture Research and Extension Center, maarec.cas.psu.edu/index.html, contains links to beekeeper associations in the Mid-Atlantic region. Bjorn Apiaries at Honeycomb Farms 180 Century Lane Dillsburg, PA 17019 Phone: 717-938-0444 E-mail: Mike@BjornApiaries.com Ernie Luchsinger Box 189 Rossthern, Saskatchewan S0K 3R0 Canada Phone: 306-232-4212 Fax: 306-232-5590 E-mail: luchsinger.ind@sasktel.net (Leafcutter bees) Fisher Bee Farm 1 Belle Ave. Lewistown, PA 17044 Phone: 800-736-6205 or 717-242-4373 Web site: www.fisherbeefarm.com Volker Family Apiaries Bees & Honey Sales RR 3, Box 25 Wyalusing, PA 18853 Phone: 717-746-3152 Rainbow Apiaries 668 Turkey Hill Rd. East Earl, PA 17519-9665 Phone: 717-445-6674
fumigation
Helena Chemical Company Web site: www.helenachemical.com 11 locations in the Mid-Atlantic, including: 62 Mill Road Biglerville, PA Phone: 717-677-4599 Fax: 717-677-7383 440 N. Main St. Building 5 Woodstown, NJ 08098 Phone: 856-769-0147 Fax: 856-769-4011 Hendrix & Dail PO Box 648 Greenville, NC 27835 Phone: 800-637-9466 Web site: www.hendrixanddail.com Landis Spraying Services 587 Strasburg Rd. Paradise, PA 17562 Phone: 717-687-6535 Reddick Fumigants 3002 W. Main St. PO Box 391 Williamston, NC 27892 Phone: 800-358-8837 or 252-792-1613 Fax: 252-792-4615 E-mail: viclilley@reddickfumigants.com or info@reddickfumigants.com Web site: www.reddickfumigants.com (Supplies only)
260
261
Earlier discussions referred the reader to Appendix E for additional sources of information. Topics are listed below according to the chapter in which they appeared, followed by additional reading.
212 pages. From SAREs Sustainable Agriculture Network. SARE Outreach Publications, PO Box 753, Waldorf, MD 20604-0753. Phone: 301-374-9696; fax: 301-843-0159; e-mail: sarepubs@sare. org. Can also be ordered or downloaded from www.sare.org/publications. Cover Crops and Conservation Tillage for Soil Erosion Control on Cropland. Available online at pubs.cas.psu.edu/ FreePubs/pdfs/uc128.pdf. Northeast Cover Crop Handbook (1994) by M. Sarrantonio. Published by the Rodale Institute. To order, contact: The Rodale Institute Bookstore, 611 Siegfriedale Road, Kutztown, PA 19530. Phone: 610-683-6009; fax: 610-6838548, or order online at www.rodaleinstitute.org/store. Overview of Cover Crops and Green Manures. From ATTRANational Sustainable Agriculture Information Service, PO Box 3657, Fayetteville, AR 72702. Phone 800-346-9140. Viewable online at www.attra.org/attra-pub/covercrop.html. The Penn State Agronomy Guide 20092010, Part 1, Section 10: Cover Crops. Paper copies of The Agronomy Guide can be obtained through Pennsylvania county extension offices and from the Publications Distributions Center as listed below. Also available online at agguide.agronomy.psu.edu/cm/sec10/ sec10toc.cfm. Penn States Soil Management Web site with links to other sites: soilmanagement.psu.edu/othercoverinfo.cfm
ChApter 1
How to Do a Bioassay for Triazine and Other Herbicides
Herbicide Persistence and How to Test for Residues in Soils. Chapter 15 in Illinois Agricultural Pest Management Handbook (2007). Available online at ipm.uiuc.edu/pubs/iapmh/15chapter.pdf. Step-by-Step Guide to Conducting a Bio-Assay. Available online at oregonstate.edu/dept/nursery-weeds/feature_ articles/herbicide_carryover/bioassay.htm.
Contents
Chapter 1 ...........................................................261 Chapter 2 ...........................................................261 Chapter 3 ...........................................................261 Chapter 5 ...........................................................262 Chapter 6 ...........................................................262 Chapter 7 ...........................................................262 Chapter 8 ...........................................................263 Appendix D ........................................................263 How to Obtain Extension Publications ...............263 Penn State ....................................................263 Rutgers University ........................................264 University of Delaware .................................264 University of Maryland .................................264 Virginia Cooperative Extension (Virginia Tech and Virginia State University) .......................264 West Virginia University ...............................264 Other Valuable Sources of Berry Production Extension Information.......................................264 Thinking of Growing a Different Crop?................264 Postharvest Handling and Design of Postharvest Cooling Systems.................................................264 Other States Small Fruit Production or Pest Management Guides ..................................264 The Strawberry Plasticulture System .................265 Disease and Insect Compendia ...........................265 General References ............................................265 Books ...........................................................265 Web Sites of Interest .....................................265 Home Pages for Related Organizations .........265
ChApter 2
The Amount of Nitrogen Added to the Soil by Various Cover Crops
Commercial Vegetable Production Recommendations (2009), Table B-9. This publication is a joint effort of Rutgers University, University of Maryland, University of Delaware, Penn State, and Virginia Tech. Available through extension publication distribution channels in each participating state (see listing below). Cover Crops, from Michigan Field Crop Ecology. Michigan State University. Available online at www.covercrops .msu.edu/pdf_files/covercrop.pdf Northeast Cover Crop Handbook (1994) by M. Sarrantonio. Published by the Rodale Institute. To order, contact: The Rodale Institute Bookstore, 611 Siegfriedale Road, Kutztown, PA 19530. Phone: 610-683-6009; fax: 610-6838548, or order online at www.rodaleinstitutestore.org/store/-customer/home.php.
ChApter 3
Pesticide Education Web Sites of Each University in the Region
Penn State: www.pested.psu.edu Rutgers University: www.pest-management.rutgers.edu University of Delaware: ag.udel.edu/ extension/pesticide/index.php University of Maryland: www.pesticide .umd.edu Virginia Tech: www.vtpp.ext.vt.edu
Sources of Information on Growing Cover Crops and Green Manures (Table 2.2)
Building Soils for Better Crops (2002) by F. Magdoff and H. van Es, 2nd ed., 240 pages, and Managing Cover Crops Profitably (2001), by G. Bowman, C. Shirley, and C. Cratmet, 2nd ed.,
262
West Virginia University: www.wvu .edu/~agexten/ipm/pestprog/pestprog. htm Links to additional states Pesticide Education Web sites can be found at www.pested.psu.edu/resources/web/ state.shtml.
ed from pubs.cas.psu.edu/FreePubs/pdfs/ uo228.pdf. Also, many other extension publications exist within the region that explain issues of pesticide use, safety, and regulations. See How to Obtain Extension Publications below.
ChApter 6
Use of Tensiometers and Other Soil Moisture Sensors
Irrigation Scheduling with Tensiometers (FS657). Rutgers University. Can be downloaded at njaes.rutgers.edu/pubs/ publication.asp?pid=FS657.
ChApter 5
Vertebrate (Deer, Birds, etc.) Management
Constructing High-Tensile Wire Fences (Pub. No. 442-132). Posted September 2004 by S. W. Gay and R. D. Heidel, Virginia Tech. Can be downloaded at pubs.ext.vt.edu/442/442-132/442-132 .html. High-Tensile Woven Wire Fences for Reducing Wildlife Damage (FS889). Rutgers University. Can be downloaded at njaes.rutgers.edu/pubs/publication .asp?pid=FS889. Managing Deer Damage in Maryland (Bulletin 354-C). University of Maryland Cooperative Extension. For ordering information, visit extension.umd. edu/publications/index.cfm and click Crops, Farm Animals, and Nursery or download the publication (48 pages, 2.11 MB) at extension.umd.edu/publications/PDFs/EB354-C.pdf. Portable Electric Fencing for Preventing Wildlife Damage (FS888). Rutgers University. Can be downloaded at njaes .rutgers.edu/pubs/publication .asp?pid=FS888. Wildlife Damage Control 14: Controlling Birds on Fruit Crops (UH121); Wildlife Damage Control 6: Geese, Ducks, and Swans (UH087); Wildlife Damage Control 7: Cottontail Rabbits (UH095); and Wildlife Damage Control 9: Voles (UH094). All four titles are available through most Penn State Cooperative Extension offices or from the Publications Distribution Center (as listed below) or from pubs.cas.psu.edu.
ChApter 7
Weed Identification
Weeds of the Northeast (1997), by R. H. Uva, J. C. Neal, and D. M. DiTomaso, Cornell University Press, is an excellent reference with complete information on weeds and look-alike species. Its 416 pages contain 746 color photographs and 118 drawings. Cornell University Press Services, Box 6525, 750 Cascadilla Street, Ithaca, NY 14851-6525. Phone 607-277-2211 or visit www.cornellpress .cornell.edu. The New Jersey Weed Gallery can be found at njaes.rutgers.edu/weeds.
The Penn State Pesticide Safety Fact Sheet EPA Worker Protection Standard for Agricultural Pesticides
This publication can be obtained from Pennsylvania county extension offices, ordered from the Publications Distribution Center as listed below, or download-
263
The Weed Science Society of America has a photo gallery of weeds and links to an assortment of resources at www .wssa.net.
Natural Enemies of Vegetable Insect Pests. This manual and an accompanying 91-slide presentation are available from The Resource Center, Cornell University, PO Box 3884, Ithaca, NY 14850-3884. Phone: 607-255-2080; fax: 607-255-9946; e-mail: resctr@cornell .edu. The slide set may be a bit pricey for an individual grower but would be useful for extension educators or to share. More information on obtaining this information is available online at www.nysaes.cornell.edu/ent/biocontrol/ manual.html. North Carolina State Universitys Biological Control Center has numerous photos of beneficial insects and lookalikes at cipm.ncsu.edu/ent/biocontrol. Predatory Mites (Insect Identification Sheet No. 123). New York State IPM Program. This online fact sheet contains descriptions and photos of predatory mites at different growth stages. Viewable online at nysipm.cornell.edu/factsheets/treefruit/pests/pm/pm.asp.
Appendix d
Pollination Suppliers
The Mid-Atlantic Apiculture Research and Extension Consortium has a valuable Web site with articles on topics of interest, information on beekeeping and pollinators, and links to beekeepers associations, along with many links to sites of interest to beekeepers and growers: maarec.cas.psu.edu/index.html
ChApter 8
The Pan Evaporation Method for Scheduling Irrigation
Basic Irrigation Scheduling in Florida, by A. G. Smajstrla, B. J. Boman, D.Z. Haman, F. T. Izuno, D. J. Pitts, and F. S. Zazueta.University of Florida Extension.
264
Penn State
Visit the Publications Web site at pubs .cas.psu.edu to download most publications. Paper copies of the catalog and publications are also available through Penn State Cooperative Extension offices, or can be requested from the Publications Distribution Center, 112 Agricultural Administration Building, University Park, PA 16802. Call 814865-6713, fax 814-863-5560, or e-mail AgPubsDist@psu.edu for information.
tural Sciences Publications Distribution Center as listed above. Within the berry crop area, Ag Alternatives Publications Strawberry Production (UA290); Red Raspberry Production (UA431); and Highbush Blueberry Production (UA265) are available.
Rutgers University
Most publications can be downloaded for free from njaes.rutgers.edu/pubs. Click on Plant Agriculture or the category of interest.
University of Delaware
Paper copies of some publications are available through county offices. In New Castle County, phone 302-8312506 (2667) or fax 302-831-8934. For Kent County, phone 302-730-4000 or fax 302-735-8130. For Sussex County, phone 302-856-7303 or fax 302-8561845. Some publications can also be downloaded from ag.udel.edu/extension.
University of Maryland
Publications are available through Maryland county extension offices. Many can be downloaded for free from pubs.agnr. umd.edu after clicking on the topic of interest. Nonresidents of Maryland can download a form from this site to order publications.
265
Columbus, Ohio 43210-1044. Phone: 614-292-1607; fax: 614-292-1248; email: pubs@ag.osu.edu. Also available online at ohioline.osu.edu. Integrated Pest Management for Strawberries in the Northeastern United States (IP-STRW). D. Cooley and S. Schloemann, eds. UMass Extension Bookstore, University of Massachusetts Amherst, 101 University Drive, Ste A4, Amherst, MA 01002. Phone: 877-UMASSXT; fax 413-545-5174; to order online, visit umassoutreachbookstore.com/catalog. Pest Management Guide for Horticultural and Forest Crops (Pub. 456-017). Virginia. The small fruit section of this guide may be downloaded at pubs.ext .vt.edu/456/456-017/456-017.html.
generAl referenCes
Books
The Berry Growers Companion (2000). B. L. Bowling. Timber Press, Inc. Portland, OR. www.timberpress.com Uncommon Fruits for Every Garden (2004). Reich, L. Timber Press, Inc. Portland, OR. www.timberpress.com
266
267
Index
A
Alternaria leaf spot and fruit rot 124 angular leaf spot 69 anthracnose in blueberries 124 in brambles 184 in currants and gooseberries 221 in strawberries 71 aphids in blueberries 130 in brambles 193 in currants and gooseberries 222 in strawberries 77, 79 asters 154
B
beetles. See insect sections for crops bindweed 151 bird damage 35 blackberries types of plants 162 blackberry psyllid 193 black root rot 68 black vine weevil. See root weevils blueberry bud mite 131 blueberry gall midge 131 blueberry maggot 127 blueberry plants development 109 types of plants 109, 112 blueberry scorch virus 126 blueberry stem borer 131 blueberry stunt 126 blueberry tip borer 131 Botryosphaeria stem blight 124 Botryosphaeria stem canker 125 Botrytis in blueberries 125 in brambles 183 in currants and gooseberries 221 in strawberries 68 brambles development 161 types of plants 161 bud mite in blueberries 131
Canada thistle 151 Cane blight in brambles 185 in currants and gooseberries 222 cane borers in blueberries 131 in brambles 192 cankers. See disease sections for crops cherry fruitworm 128 clipper. See strawberry bud weevil cold hardiness and blueberries 109 and brambles 162 and currants and gooseberries 214 and strawberries 50, 56 common leaf spot 68 compost use 7 cranberry tipworm. See blueberry gall midge cranberry weevil 129 crop groupings 13 crop rotations 2 crown borer in brambles 191 crown gall in brambles 187 cultivars blackberries primocane-bearing 167 thornless 166 thorny 167 blueberries 112 currants 215 gooseberries 216 raspberries summer-bearing red 163 primocane-bearing red 165 primocane-bearing gold 166 black 166 purple 166 strawberries day-neutral 59 June-bearing matted row 46 June-bearing plasticulture 52 currant borer 222 currant fruit fly 222 currants legality of culture 214 types of plants 213 cyclamen mites 77
in strawberries 71 dandelion 152 day-neutral strawberries matted row production 57 plasticulture production 58 deer 40 disease identification samples 236 diseases of blueberries 124 of brambles 183 of currants and gooseberries 221 of strawberries 68
E
economics of blueberry production 119 of bramble production 175 of strawberry production 61
F
fertilization general information 6, 7 of blueberries 117 of brambles 168 of currants and gooseberries 218 of strawberries day-neutral 57, 59 matted-row 46 plasticulture 51 first aid for pesticide poisoning 17 flea beetles 76 frost protection general information 227 in blueberries 117 in strawberries 50, 56, 60 fruitworms in blueberries 128 in brambles 191 in currants and gooseberries 223 fumigation general information 3 biofumigation 11, 227 chemical 23
G
garden symphylan 78 Gnomonia stem canker 185 goldenrod 152 gooseberries legality of culture 214 types of plants 213 gray mold. See Botrytis greenhouse production of brambles 174 of strawberries 61 green June beetles 191
D
dagger nematodes in blueberries 127 in brambles 189
268
green manures 9 ground beetles 75 grubs in blueberries 131 in strawberries 79 harvest of currants and gooseberries 220 of other crops. See postharvest handling herbicides efficacy 28 for blueberries 146 for brambles 204 for currants and gooseberries 223 for strawberries 95 general information 27 high tunnel production of brambles 173 of strawberries 60 horseweed 152
leaf rust in blueberries 125 in brambles 184 leaf scorch 69 leaf spots in blueberries 124 in brambles 186 in currants and gooseberries 221 in strawberries 68 leather rot 69 lesion nematodes in brambles 189 in strawberries 71 lime application 5 long-necked seed bug 72
P
pesticides activity groups 13 and pH of spray water 15 for blueberries 124, 135 for brambles 183, 197 for currants and gooseberries 221, 224 for strawberries 68, 82 resistance management 13 safe use 15 toxicity to nontarget organisms and beneficials 13 to people 16 first aid 17 phomopsis leaf blight 69 phomposis twig blight 126 Phytophthora root rot in blueberries 126, 135 in brambles 186 in strawberries 70 picnic beetles 190 See also Sap beetles Pillbugs 74 Plant analysis. See leaf analysis Planting blueberries 116 brambles 168 currants and gooseberries 218 strawberries, matted row 46 strawberries, plasticulture 53 strawberries, day neutrals 57, 59 plasticulture production of June-bearers 51 of day-neutrals 58 plum curculio 130 poisoning first aid 17 symptoms of 17 poison ivy 153 pollination of blueberries 110 of brambles 162 of currants and gooseberries 219 of strawberries 44 postharvest handling of blueberry fruit 119 of bramble fruit 174 of strawberry fruit 61 powdery mildew in brambles 186 in currants and gooseberries 221 in strawberries 70 propagation of currants and gooseberries 220 of strawberry plug plants 53
M
manures, use 7, 8 matted row production of June-bearing cultivars 46 of day-neutral cultivars 57 mice 37 mites in blueberries. See bud mites in brambles 194 in strawberries 75, 77 mulching blueberry plants 117, 146 brambles 169 currants and gooseberries 218 strawberries for winter 50 mummy berry 125
I
imported currant worm 222 insect identification services 236 insects of blueberries 127 of brambles 190 of currants and gooseberries 222 of strawberries 72 irrigation for blueberries 111 for brambles 170 for strawberries 45, 52, 60 trickle and herbicide efficacy 32
N
nematode assays 3, 236, 242 nematodes in blueberries 127 in brambles 189 in strawberries 71 nurseries 249
J
Japanese beetles in blueberries 129 in brambles 193 in strawberries 77 jostaberries 214
L
laboratories, diagnostic private 238 university 236 leaf analysis, nutrient interpretation 239 sampling 11, 235 leafhoppers in blueberries 132 in brambles 194 in strawberries 75 leafrollers in blueberries 129, 130 in strawberries 76
O
obtaining plants blueberries 112 brambles 163 currants and gooseberries 218 strawberries 46 orange rust 184 organic matter 9 organic production 4 of blueberries 112, 145 of brambles 173 of strawberries 60 oriental beetle 131
269
Index
pruning blueberries 117 currants and gooseberries 219 primocane-bearing brambles 171 summer-bearing blackberries 171 summer-bearing raspberries 170, 171 psyllid. See blackberry psyllid
Q
quackgrass 153
R
rabbits 38 raspberries types of plants 161 red drupelet disorder 195 red ringspot virus 127 red stele in strawberries 70 ribbon row production 57 root aphids 79 root weevils 78 row middles, sod 117, 145, 170, 219 row orientation 2 rusts. See leaf rust and orange rust
strawberry rootworm 76 sulfur application 6, 111 sunscald in brambles 195 in strawberries 52 suppliers of animal repellents 256 beneficial insects 254 bird control products 253 cover crop seed 254 fumigation services 259 high tunnels 254 ion meters 257 IPM supplies 255 irrigation equipment 255 live traps 256 organic fertilizers 259 packaging for harvest 257 personal protective equipment 257 pH meters 257 plants 249 plastic mulch 258 plastic recovery services 259 pollination services 259 promotional materials 258 row covers 258 specialized field equipment 258 symphylans. See garden symphylan
W
weed management cultural practices 26 herbicide efficacy 28 herbicide usage, general 27 in blueberries 145 in brambles 204 in currants and gooseberries 223 in strawberries 95 of perennial species 150 whitefly 76 white pine blister rust 221 wildlife management 35 wind exposure 2
Y
yellow nutsedge 150
S
sap beetles in raspberries. See picnic beetles in strawberries 72 sawflies 194 scale insects in blueberries 132 in currants and gooseberries 223 sharp-nosed leafhopper 132 shoestring virus 127 site selection general information 1 for blueberries 110 for brambles 163 for currants and gooseberries 214 for strawberries 45 slugs 73 soil structure 1 soil testing 5, 235 sowbugs 74 spider mites in brambles 194 in strawberries 75 spittlebugs 77 spray equipment 13 spur blight 186 strawberry bud weevil 74 strawberry plants development 43 types of plants 43
T
tarnished plant bugs in brambles 190 in strawberries 72 thistle. See Canada thistle thrips in blueberries 133 in brambles 190 in strawberries 74 tomato ringspot virus in blueberries 127 in brambles 188 tree crickets 192 trellis systems 171
V
varieties. See cultivars Verticillium wilt in brambles 187 in strawberries 70 Virginia creeper 154 viruses in blueberries 126 in brambles 187 virus testing 239 voles 37
270
Visit Penn States College of Agricultural Sciences on the Web: agsci.psu.edu Penn State College of Agricultural Sciences research, extension, and resident education programs are funded in part by Pennsylvania counties, the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, and the U.S. Department of Agriculture. This publication is available from the Publications Distribution Center, The Pennsylvania State University, 112 Agricultural Administration Building, University Park, PA 16802. For information telephone 814-865-6713. Where trade names appear, no discrimination is intended, and no endorsement by Penn State Cooperative Extension is implied.